1 //===--- SemaOverload.cpp - C++ Overloading -------------------------------===// 2 // 3 // Part of the LLVM Project, under the Apache License v2.0 with LLVM Exceptions. 4 // See https://llvm.org/LICENSE.txt for license information. 5 // SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0 WITH LLVM-exception 6 // 7 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 8 // 9 // This file provides Sema routines for C++ overloading. 10 // 11 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 12 13 #include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h" 14 #include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h" 15 #include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h" 16 #include "clang/AST/DependenceFlags.h" 17 #include "clang/AST/Expr.h" 18 #include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h" 19 #include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h" 20 #include "clang/AST/TypeOrdering.h" 21 #include "clang/Basic/Diagnostic.h" 22 #include "clang/Basic/DiagnosticOptions.h" 23 #include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h" 24 #include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h" 25 #include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h" 26 #include "clang/Sema/Initialization.h" 27 #include "clang/Sema/Lookup.h" 28 #include "clang/Sema/Overload.h" 29 #include "clang/Sema/SemaInternal.h" 30 #include "clang/Sema/Template.h" 31 #include "clang/Sema/TemplateDeduction.h" 32 #include "llvm/ADT/DenseSet.h" 33 #include "llvm/ADT/Optional.h" 34 #include "llvm/ADT/STLExtras.h" 35 #include "llvm/ADT/SmallPtrSet.h" 36 #include "llvm/ADT/SmallString.h" 37 #include <algorithm> 38 #include <cstdlib> 39 40 using namespace clang; 41 using namespace sema; 42 43 using AllowedExplicit = Sema::AllowedExplicit; 44 45 static bool functionHasPassObjectSizeParams(const FunctionDecl *FD) { 46 return llvm::any_of(FD->parameters(), [](const ParmVarDecl *P) { 47 return P->hasAttr<PassObjectSizeAttr>(); 48 }); 49 } 50 51 /// A convenience routine for creating a decayed reference to a function. 52 static ExprResult 53 CreateFunctionRefExpr(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *Fn, NamedDecl *FoundDecl, 54 const Expr *Base, bool HadMultipleCandidates, 55 SourceLocation Loc = SourceLocation(), 56 const DeclarationNameLoc &LocInfo = DeclarationNameLoc()){ 57 if (S.DiagnoseUseOfDecl(FoundDecl, Loc)) 58 return ExprError(); 59 // If FoundDecl is different from Fn (such as if one is a template 60 // and the other a specialization), make sure DiagnoseUseOfDecl is 61 // called on both. 62 // FIXME: This would be more comprehensively addressed by modifying 63 // DiagnoseUseOfDecl to accept both the FoundDecl and the decl 64 // being used. 65 if (FoundDecl != Fn && S.DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Fn, Loc)) 66 return ExprError(); 67 DeclRefExpr *DRE = new (S.Context) 68 DeclRefExpr(S.Context, Fn, false, Fn->getType(), VK_LValue, Loc, LocInfo); 69 if (HadMultipleCandidates) 70 DRE->setHadMultipleCandidates(true); 71 72 S.MarkDeclRefReferenced(DRE, Base); 73 if (auto *FPT = DRE->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) { 74 if (isUnresolvedExceptionSpec(FPT->getExceptionSpecType())) { 75 S.ResolveExceptionSpec(Loc, FPT); 76 DRE->setType(Fn->getType()); 77 } 78 } 79 return S.ImpCastExprToType(DRE, S.Context.getPointerType(DRE->getType()), 80 CK_FunctionToPointerDecay); 81 } 82 83 static bool IsStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From, QualType ToType, 84 bool InOverloadResolution, 85 StandardConversionSequence &SCS, 86 bool CStyle, 87 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion); 88 89 static bool IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From, 90 QualType &ToType, 91 bool InOverloadResolution, 92 StandardConversionSequence &SCS, 93 bool CStyle); 94 static OverloadingResult 95 IsUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 96 UserDefinedConversionSequence& User, 97 OverloadCandidateSet& Conversions, 98 AllowedExplicit AllowExplicit, 99 bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit); 100 101 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind 102 CompareStandardConversionSequences(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 103 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1, 104 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2); 105 106 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind 107 CompareQualificationConversions(Sema &S, 108 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1, 109 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2); 110 111 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind 112 CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 113 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1, 114 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2); 115 116 /// GetConversionRank - Retrieve the implicit conversion rank 117 /// corresponding to the given implicit conversion kind. 118 ImplicitConversionRank clang::GetConversionRank(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) { 119 static const ImplicitConversionRank 120 Rank[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = { 121 ICR_Exact_Match, 122 ICR_Exact_Match, 123 ICR_Exact_Match, 124 ICR_Exact_Match, 125 ICR_Exact_Match, 126 ICR_Exact_Match, 127 ICR_Promotion, 128 ICR_Promotion, 129 ICR_Promotion, 130 ICR_Conversion, 131 ICR_Conversion, 132 ICR_Conversion, 133 ICR_Conversion, 134 ICR_Conversion, 135 ICR_Conversion, 136 ICR_Conversion, 137 ICR_Conversion, 138 ICR_Conversion, 139 ICR_Conversion, 140 ICR_Conversion, 141 ICR_OCL_Scalar_Widening, 142 ICR_Complex_Real_Conversion, 143 ICR_Conversion, 144 ICR_Conversion, 145 ICR_Writeback_Conversion, 146 ICR_Exact_Match, // NOTE(gbiv): This may not be completely right -- 147 // it was omitted by the patch that added 148 // ICK_Zero_Event_Conversion 149 ICR_C_Conversion, 150 ICR_C_Conversion_Extension 151 }; 152 return Rank[(int)Kind]; 153 } 154 155 /// GetImplicitConversionName - Return the name of this kind of 156 /// implicit conversion. 157 static const char* GetImplicitConversionName(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) { 158 static const char* const Name[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = { 159 "No conversion", 160 "Lvalue-to-rvalue", 161 "Array-to-pointer", 162 "Function-to-pointer", 163 "Function pointer conversion", 164 "Qualification", 165 "Integral promotion", 166 "Floating point promotion", 167 "Complex promotion", 168 "Integral conversion", 169 "Floating conversion", 170 "Complex conversion", 171 "Floating-integral conversion", 172 "Pointer conversion", 173 "Pointer-to-member conversion", 174 "Boolean conversion", 175 "Compatible-types conversion", 176 "Derived-to-base conversion", 177 "Vector conversion", 178 "SVE Vector conversion", 179 "Vector splat", 180 "Complex-real conversion", 181 "Block Pointer conversion", 182 "Transparent Union Conversion", 183 "Writeback conversion", 184 "OpenCL Zero Event Conversion", 185 "C specific type conversion", 186 "Incompatible pointer conversion" 187 }; 188 return Name[Kind]; 189 } 190 191 /// StandardConversionSequence - Set the standard conversion 192 /// sequence to the identity conversion. 193 void StandardConversionSequence::setAsIdentityConversion() { 194 First = ICK_Identity; 195 Second = ICK_Identity; 196 Third = ICK_Identity; 197 DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = false; 198 QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime = false; 199 ReferenceBinding = false; 200 DirectBinding = false; 201 IsLvalueReference = true; 202 BindsToFunctionLvalue = false; 203 BindsToRvalue = false; 204 BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false; 205 ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false; 206 CopyConstructor = nullptr; 207 } 208 209 /// getRank - Retrieve the rank of this standard conversion sequence 210 /// (C++ 13.3.3.1.1p3). The rank is the largest rank of each of the 211 /// implicit conversions. 212 ImplicitConversionRank StandardConversionSequence::getRank() const { 213 ImplicitConversionRank Rank = ICR_Exact_Match; 214 if (GetConversionRank(First) > Rank) 215 Rank = GetConversionRank(First); 216 if (GetConversionRank(Second) > Rank) 217 Rank = GetConversionRank(Second); 218 if (GetConversionRank(Third) > Rank) 219 Rank = GetConversionRank(Third); 220 return Rank; 221 } 222 223 /// isPointerConversionToBool - Determines whether this conversion is 224 /// a conversion of a pointer or pointer-to-member to bool. This is 225 /// used as part of the ranking of standard conversion sequences 226 /// (C++ 13.3.3.2p4). 227 bool StandardConversionSequence::isPointerConversionToBool() const { 228 // Note that FromType has not necessarily been transformed by the 229 // array-to-pointer or function-to-pointer implicit conversions, so 230 // check for their presence as well as checking whether FromType is 231 // a pointer. 232 if (getToType(1)->isBooleanType() && 233 (getFromType()->isPointerType() || 234 getFromType()->isMemberPointerType() || 235 getFromType()->isObjCObjectPointerType() || 236 getFromType()->isBlockPointerType() || 237 First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer || First == ICK_Function_To_Pointer)) 238 return true; 239 240 return false; 241 } 242 243 /// isPointerConversionToVoidPointer - Determines whether this 244 /// conversion is a conversion of a pointer to a void pointer. This is 245 /// used as part of the ranking of standard conversion sequences (C++ 246 /// 13.3.3.2p4). 247 bool 248 StandardConversionSequence:: 249 isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(ASTContext& Context) const { 250 QualType FromType = getFromType(); 251 QualType ToType = getToType(1); 252 253 // Note that FromType has not necessarily been transformed by the 254 // array-to-pointer implicit conversion, so check for its presence 255 // and redo the conversion to get a pointer. 256 if (First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer) 257 FromType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType); 258 259 if (Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion && FromType->isAnyPointerType()) 260 if (const PointerType* ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<PointerType>()) 261 return ToPtrType->getPointeeType()->isVoidType(); 262 263 return false; 264 } 265 266 /// Skip any implicit casts which could be either part of a narrowing conversion 267 /// or after one in an implicit conversion. 268 static const Expr *IgnoreNarrowingConversion(ASTContext &Ctx, 269 const Expr *Converted) { 270 // We can have cleanups wrapping the converted expression; these need to be 271 // preserved so that destructors run if necessary. 272 if (auto *EWC = dyn_cast<ExprWithCleanups>(Converted)) { 273 Expr *Inner = 274 const_cast<Expr *>(IgnoreNarrowingConversion(Ctx, EWC->getSubExpr())); 275 return ExprWithCleanups::Create(Ctx, Inner, EWC->cleanupsHaveSideEffects(), 276 EWC->getObjects()); 277 } 278 279 while (auto *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Converted)) { 280 switch (ICE->getCastKind()) { 281 case CK_NoOp: 282 case CK_IntegralCast: 283 case CK_IntegralToBoolean: 284 case CK_IntegralToFloating: 285 case CK_BooleanToSignedIntegral: 286 case CK_FloatingToIntegral: 287 case CK_FloatingToBoolean: 288 case CK_FloatingCast: 289 Converted = ICE->getSubExpr(); 290 continue; 291 292 default: 293 return Converted; 294 } 295 } 296 297 return Converted; 298 } 299 300 /// Check if this standard conversion sequence represents a narrowing 301 /// conversion, according to C++11 [dcl.init.list]p7. 302 /// 303 /// \param Ctx The AST context. 304 /// \param Converted The result of applying this standard conversion sequence. 305 /// \param ConstantValue If this is an NK_Constant_Narrowing conversion, the 306 /// value of the expression prior to the narrowing conversion. 307 /// \param ConstantType If this is an NK_Constant_Narrowing conversion, the 308 /// type of the expression prior to the narrowing conversion. 309 /// \param IgnoreFloatToIntegralConversion If true type-narrowing conversions 310 /// from floating point types to integral types should be ignored. 311 NarrowingKind StandardConversionSequence::getNarrowingKind( 312 ASTContext &Ctx, const Expr *Converted, APValue &ConstantValue, 313 QualType &ConstantType, bool IgnoreFloatToIntegralConversion) const { 314 assert(Ctx.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && "narrowing check outside C++"); 315 316 // C++11 [dcl.init.list]p7: 317 // A narrowing conversion is an implicit conversion ... 318 QualType FromType = getToType(0); 319 QualType ToType = getToType(1); 320 321 // A conversion to an enumeration type is narrowing if the conversion to 322 // the underlying type is narrowing. This only arises for expressions of 323 // the form 'Enum{init}'. 324 if (auto *ET = ToType->getAs<EnumType>()) 325 ToType = ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 326 327 switch (Second) { 328 // 'bool' is an integral type; dispatch to the right place to handle it. 329 case ICK_Boolean_Conversion: 330 if (FromType->isRealFloatingType()) 331 goto FloatingIntegralConversion; 332 if (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType()) 333 goto IntegralConversion; 334 // -- from a pointer type or pointer-to-member type to bool, or 335 return NK_Type_Narrowing; 336 337 // -- from a floating-point type to an integer type, or 338 // 339 // -- from an integer type or unscoped enumeration type to a floating-point 340 // type, except where the source is a constant expression and the actual 341 // value after conversion will fit into the target type and will produce 342 // the original value when converted back to the original type, or 343 case ICK_Floating_Integral: 344 FloatingIntegralConversion: 345 if (FromType->isRealFloatingType() && ToType->isIntegralType(Ctx)) { 346 return NK_Type_Narrowing; 347 } else if (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() && 348 ToType->isRealFloatingType()) { 349 if (IgnoreFloatToIntegralConversion) 350 return NK_Not_Narrowing; 351 const Expr *Initializer = IgnoreNarrowingConversion(Ctx, Converted); 352 assert(Initializer && "Unknown conversion expression"); 353 354 // If it's value-dependent, we can't tell whether it's narrowing. 355 if (Initializer->isValueDependent()) 356 return NK_Dependent_Narrowing; 357 358 if (Optional<llvm::APSInt> IntConstantValue = 359 Initializer->getIntegerConstantExpr(Ctx)) { 360 // Convert the integer to the floating type. 361 llvm::APFloat Result(Ctx.getFloatTypeSemantics(ToType)); 362 Result.convertFromAPInt(*IntConstantValue, IntConstantValue->isSigned(), 363 llvm::APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven); 364 // And back. 365 llvm::APSInt ConvertedValue = *IntConstantValue; 366 bool ignored; 367 Result.convertToInteger(ConvertedValue, 368 llvm::APFloat::rmTowardZero, &ignored); 369 // If the resulting value is different, this was a narrowing conversion. 370 if (*IntConstantValue != ConvertedValue) { 371 ConstantValue = APValue(*IntConstantValue); 372 ConstantType = Initializer->getType(); 373 return NK_Constant_Narrowing; 374 } 375 } else { 376 // Variables are always narrowings. 377 return NK_Variable_Narrowing; 378 } 379 } 380 return NK_Not_Narrowing; 381 382 // -- from long double to double or float, or from double to float, except 383 // where the source is a constant expression and the actual value after 384 // conversion is within the range of values that can be represented (even 385 // if it cannot be represented exactly), or 386 case ICK_Floating_Conversion: 387 if (FromType->isRealFloatingType() && ToType->isRealFloatingType() && 388 Ctx.getFloatingTypeOrder(FromType, ToType) == 1) { 389 // FromType is larger than ToType. 390 const Expr *Initializer = IgnoreNarrowingConversion(Ctx, Converted); 391 392 // If it's value-dependent, we can't tell whether it's narrowing. 393 if (Initializer->isValueDependent()) 394 return NK_Dependent_Narrowing; 395 396 if (Initializer->isCXX11ConstantExpr(Ctx, &ConstantValue)) { 397 // Constant! 398 assert(ConstantValue.isFloat()); 399 llvm::APFloat FloatVal = ConstantValue.getFloat(); 400 // Convert the source value into the target type. 401 bool ignored; 402 llvm::APFloat::opStatus ConvertStatus = FloatVal.convert( 403 Ctx.getFloatTypeSemantics(ToType), 404 llvm::APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven, &ignored); 405 // If there was no overflow, the source value is within the range of 406 // values that can be represented. 407 if (ConvertStatus & llvm::APFloat::opOverflow) { 408 ConstantType = Initializer->getType(); 409 return NK_Constant_Narrowing; 410 } 411 } else { 412 return NK_Variable_Narrowing; 413 } 414 } 415 return NK_Not_Narrowing; 416 417 // -- from an integer type or unscoped enumeration type to an integer type 418 // that cannot represent all the values of the original type, except where 419 // the source is a constant expression and the actual value after 420 // conversion will fit into the target type and will produce the original 421 // value when converted back to the original type. 422 case ICK_Integral_Conversion: 423 IntegralConversion: { 424 assert(FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType()); 425 assert(ToType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType()); 426 const bool FromSigned = FromType->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType(); 427 const unsigned FromWidth = Ctx.getIntWidth(FromType); 428 const bool ToSigned = ToType->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType(); 429 const unsigned ToWidth = Ctx.getIntWidth(ToType); 430 431 if (FromWidth > ToWidth || 432 (FromWidth == ToWidth && FromSigned != ToSigned) || 433 (FromSigned && !ToSigned)) { 434 // Not all values of FromType can be represented in ToType. 435 const Expr *Initializer = IgnoreNarrowingConversion(Ctx, Converted); 436 437 // If it's value-dependent, we can't tell whether it's narrowing. 438 if (Initializer->isValueDependent()) 439 return NK_Dependent_Narrowing; 440 441 Optional<llvm::APSInt> OptInitializerValue; 442 if (!(OptInitializerValue = Initializer->getIntegerConstantExpr(Ctx))) { 443 // Such conversions on variables are always narrowing. 444 return NK_Variable_Narrowing; 445 } 446 llvm::APSInt &InitializerValue = *OptInitializerValue; 447 bool Narrowing = false; 448 if (FromWidth < ToWidth) { 449 // Negative -> unsigned is narrowing. Otherwise, more bits is never 450 // narrowing. 451 if (InitializerValue.isSigned() && InitializerValue.isNegative()) 452 Narrowing = true; 453 } else { 454 // Add a bit to the InitializerValue so we don't have to worry about 455 // signed vs. unsigned comparisons. 456 InitializerValue = InitializerValue.extend( 457 InitializerValue.getBitWidth() + 1); 458 // Convert the initializer to and from the target width and signed-ness. 459 llvm::APSInt ConvertedValue = InitializerValue; 460 ConvertedValue = ConvertedValue.trunc(ToWidth); 461 ConvertedValue.setIsSigned(ToSigned); 462 ConvertedValue = ConvertedValue.extend(InitializerValue.getBitWidth()); 463 ConvertedValue.setIsSigned(InitializerValue.isSigned()); 464 // If the result is different, this was a narrowing conversion. 465 if (ConvertedValue != InitializerValue) 466 Narrowing = true; 467 } 468 if (Narrowing) { 469 ConstantType = Initializer->getType(); 470 ConstantValue = APValue(InitializerValue); 471 return NK_Constant_Narrowing; 472 } 473 } 474 return NK_Not_Narrowing; 475 } 476 477 default: 478 // Other kinds of conversions are not narrowings. 479 return NK_Not_Narrowing; 480 } 481 } 482 483 /// dump - Print this standard conversion sequence to standard 484 /// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues. 485 LLVM_DUMP_METHOD void StandardConversionSequence::dump() const { 486 raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs(); 487 bool PrintedSomething = false; 488 if (First != ICK_Identity) { 489 OS << GetImplicitConversionName(First); 490 PrintedSomething = true; 491 } 492 493 if (Second != ICK_Identity) { 494 if (PrintedSomething) { 495 OS << " -> "; 496 } 497 OS << GetImplicitConversionName(Second); 498 499 if (CopyConstructor) { 500 OS << " (by copy constructor)"; 501 } else if (DirectBinding) { 502 OS << " (direct reference binding)"; 503 } else if (ReferenceBinding) { 504 OS << " (reference binding)"; 505 } 506 PrintedSomething = true; 507 } 508 509 if (Third != ICK_Identity) { 510 if (PrintedSomething) { 511 OS << " -> "; 512 } 513 OS << GetImplicitConversionName(Third); 514 PrintedSomething = true; 515 } 516 517 if (!PrintedSomething) { 518 OS << "No conversions required"; 519 } 520 } 521 522 /// dump - Print this user-defined conversion sequence to standard 523 /// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues. 524 void UserDefinedConversionSequence::dump() const { 525 raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs(); 526 if (Before.First || Before.Second || Before.Third) { 527 Before.dump(); 528 OS << " -> "; 529 } 530 if (ConversionFunction) 531 OS << '\'' << *ConversionFunction << '\''; 532 else 533 OS << "aggregate initialization"; 534 if (After.First || After.Second || After.Third) { 535 OS << " -> "; 536 After.dump(); 537 } 538 } 539 540 /// dump - Print this implicit conversion sequence to standard 541 /// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues. 542 void ImplicitConversionSequence::dump() const { 543 raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs(); 544 if (isStdInitializerListElement()) 545 OS << "Worst std::initializer_list element conversion: "; 546 switch (ConversionKind) { 547 case StandardConversion: 548 OS << "Standard conversion: "; 549 Standard.dump(); 550 break; 551 case UserDefinedConversion: 552 OS << "User-defined conversion: "; 553 UserDefined.dump(); 554 break; 555 case EllipsisConversion: 556 OS << "Ellipsis conversion"; 557 break; 558 case AmbiguousConversion: 559 OS << "Ambiguous conversion"; 560 break; 561 case BadConversion: 562 OS << "Bad conversion"; 563 break; 564 } 565 566 OS << "\n"; 567 } 568 569 void AmbiguousConversionSequence::construct() { 570 new (&conversions()) ConversionSet(); 571 } 572 573 void AmbiguousConversionSequence::destruct() { 574 conversions().~ConversionSet(); 575 } 576 577 void 578 AmbiguousConversionSequence::copyFrom(const AmbiguousConversionSequence &O) { 579 FromTypePtr = O.FromTypePtr; 580 ToTypePtr = O.ToTypePtr; 581 new (&conversions()) ConversionSet(O.conversions()); 582 } 583 584 namespace { 585 // Structure used by DeductionFailureInfo to store 586 // template argument information. 587 struct DFIArguments { 588 TemplateArgument FirstArg; 589 TemplateArgument SecondArg; 590 }; 591 // Structure used by DeductionFailureInfo to store 592 // template parameter and template argument information. 593 struct DFIParamWithArguments : DFIArguments { 594 TemplateParameter Param; 595 }; 596 // Structure used by DeductionFailureInfo to store template argument 597 // information and the index of the problematic call argument. 598 struct DFIDeducedMismatchArgs : DFIArguments { 599 TemplateArgumentList *TemplateArgs; 600 unsigned CallArgIndex; 601 }; 602 // Structure used by DeductionFailureInfo to store information about 603 // unsatisfied constraints. 604 struct CNSInfo { 605 TemplateArgumentList *TemplateArgs; 606 ConstraintSatisfaction Satisfaction; 607 }; 608 } 609 610 /// Convert from Sema's representation of template deduction information 611 /// to the form used in overload-candidate information. 612 DeductionFailureInfo 613 clang::MakeDeductionFailureInfo(ASTContext &Context, 614 Sema::TemplateDeductionResult TDK, 615 TemplateDeductionInfo &Info) { 616 DeductionFailureInfo Result; 617 Result.Result = static_cast<unsigned>(TDK); 618 Result.HasDiagnostic = false; 619 switch (TDK) { 620 case Sema::TDK_Invalid: 621 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth: 622 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments: 623 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments: 624 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure: 625 case Sema::TDK_CUDATargetMismatch: 626 Result.Data = nullptr; 627 break; 628 629 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: 630 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments: 631 Result.Data = Info.Param.getOpaqueValue(); 632 break; 633 634 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch: 635 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested: { 636 // FIXME: Should allocate from normal heap so that we can free this later. 637 auto *Saved = new (Context) DFIDeducedMismatchArgs; 638 Saved->FirstArg = Info.FirstArg; 639 Saved->SecondArg = Info.SecondArg; 640 Saved->TemplateArgs = Info.take(); 641 Saved->CallArgIndex = Info.CallArgIndex; 642 Result.Data = Saved; 643 break; 644 } 645 646 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: { 647 // FIXME: Should allocate from normal heap so that we can free this later. 648 DFIArguments *Saved = new (Context) DFIArguments; 649 Saved->FirstArg = Info.FirstArg; 650 Saved->SecondArg = Info.SecondArg; 651 Result.Data = Saved; 652 break; 653 } 654 655 case Sema::TDK_IncompletePack: 656 // FIXME: It's slightly wasteful to allocate two TemplateArguments for this. 657 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: 658 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: { 659 // FIXME: Should allocate from normal heap so that we can free this later. 660 DFIParamWithArguments *Saved = new (Context) DFIParamWithArguments; 661 Saved->Param = Info.Param; 662 Saved->FirstArg = Info.FirstArg; 663 Saved->SecondArg = Info.SecondArg; 664 Result.Data = Saved; 665 break; 666 } 667 668 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: 669 Result.Data = Info.take(); 670 if (Info.hasSFINAEDiagnostic()) { 671 PartialDiagnosticAt *Diag = new (Result.Diagnostic) PartialDiagnosticAt( 672 SourceLocation(), PartialDiagnostic::NullDiagnostic()); 673 Info.takeSFINAEDiagnostic(*Diag); 674 Result.HasDiagnostic = true; 675 } 676 break; 677 678 case Sema::TDK_ConstraintsNotSatisfied: { 679 CNSInfo *Saved = new (Context) CNSInfo; 680 Saved->TemplateArgs = Info.take(); 681 Saved->Satisfaction = Info.AssociatedConstraintsSatisfaction; 682 Result.Data = Saved; 683 break; 684 } 685 686 case Sema::TDK_Success: 687 case Sema::TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure: 688 llvm_unreachable("not a deduction failure"); 689 } 690 691 return Result; 692 } 693 694 void DeductionFailureInfo::Destroy() { 695 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) { 696 case Sema::TDK_Success: 697 case Sema::TDK_Invalid: 698 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth: 699 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: 700 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments: 701 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments: 702 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments: 703 case Sema::TDK_CUDATargetMismatch: 704 case Sema::TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure: 705 break; 706 707 case Sema::TDK_IncompletePack: 708 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: 709 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: 710 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch: 711 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested: 712 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: 713 // FIXME: Destroy the data? 714 Data = nullptr; 715 break; 716 717 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: 718 // FIXME: Destroy the template argument list? 719 Data = nullptr; 720 if (PartialDiagnosticAt *Diag = getSFINAEDiagnostic()) { 721 Diag->~PartialDiagnosticAt(); 722 HasDiagnostic = false; 723 } 724 break; 725 726 case Sema::TDK_ConstraintsNotSatisfied: 727 // FIXME: Destroy the template argument list? 728 Data = nullptr; 729 if (PartialDiagnosticAt *Diag = getSFINAEDiagnostic()) { 730 Diag->~PartialDiagnosticAt(); 731 HasDiagnostic = false; 732 } 733 break; 734 735 // Unhandled 736 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure: 737 break; 738 } 739 } 740 741 PartialDiagnosticAt *DeductionFailureInfo::getSFINAEDiagnostic() { 742 if (HasDiagnostic) 743 return static_cast<PartialDiagnosticAt*>(static_cast<void*>(Diagnostic)); 744 return nullptr; 745 } 746 747 TemplateParameter DeductionFailureInfo::getTemplateParameter() { 748 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) { 749 case Sema::TDK_Success: 750 case Sema::TDK_Invalid: 751 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth: 752 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments: 753 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments: 754 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: 755 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch: 756 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested: 757 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: 758 case Sema::TDK_CUDATargetMismatch: 759 case Sema::TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure: 760 case Sema::TDK_ConstraintsNotSatisfied: 761 return TemplateParameter(); 762 763 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: 764 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments: 765 return TemplateParameter::getFromOpaqueValue(Data); 766 767 case Sema::TDK_IncompletePack: 768 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: 769 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: 770 return static_cast<DFIParamWithArguments*>(Data)->Param; 771 772 // Unhandled 773 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure: 774 break; 775 } 776 777 return TemplateParameter(); 778 } 779 780 TemplateArgumentList *DeductionFailureInfo::getTemplateArgumentList() { 781 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) { 782 case Sema::TDK_Success: 783 case Sema::TDK_Invalid: 784 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth: 785 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments: 786 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments: 787 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: 788 case Sema::TDK_IncompletePack: 789 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments: 790 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: 791 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: 792 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: 793 case Sema::TDK_CUDATargetMismatch: 794 case Sema::TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure: 795 return nullptr; 796 797 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch: 798 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested: 799 return static_cast<DFIDeducedMismatchArgs*>(Data)->TemplateArgs; 800 801 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: 802 return static_cast<TemplateArgumentList*>(Data); 803 804 case Sema::TDK_ConstraintsNotSatisfied: 805 return static_cast<CNSInfo*>(Data)->TemplateArgs; 806 807 // Unhandled 808 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure: 809 break; 810 } 811 812 return nullptr; 813 } 814 815 const TemplateArgument *DeductionFailureInfo::getFirstArg() { 816 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) { 817 case Sema::TDK_Success: 818 case Sema::TDK_Invalid: 819 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth: 820 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: 821 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments: 822 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments: 823 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments: 824 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: 825 case Sema::TDK_CUDATargetMismatch: 826 case Sema::TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure: 827 case Sema::TDK_ConstraintsNotSatisfied: 828 return nullptr; 829 830 case Sema::TDK_IncompletePack: 831 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: 832 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: 833 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch: 834 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested: 835 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: 836 return &static_cast<DFIArguments*>(Data)->FirstArg; 837 838 // Unhandled 839 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure: 840 break; 841 } 842 843 return nullptr; 844 } 845 846 const TemplateArgument *DeductionFailureInfo::getSecondArg() { 847 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) { 848 case Sema::TDK_Success: 849 case Sema::TDK_Invalid: 850 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth: 851 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: 852 case Sema::TDK_IncompletePack: 853 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments: 854 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments: 855 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments: 856 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: 857 case Sema::TDK_CUDATargetMismatch: 858 case Sema::TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure: 859 case Sema::TDK_ConstraintsNotSatisfied: 860 return nullptr; 861 862 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: 863 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: 864 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch: 865 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested: 866 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: 867 return &static_cast<DFIArguments*>(Data)->SecondArg; 868 869 // Unhandled 870 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure: 871 break; 872 } 873 874 return nullptr; 875 } 876 877 llvm::Optional<unsigned> DeductionFailureInfo::getCallArgIndex() { 878 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) { 879 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch: 880 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested: 881 return static_cast<DFIDeducedMismatchArgs*>(Data)->CallArgIndex; 882 883 default: 884 return llvm::None; 885 } 886 } 887 888 bool OverloadCandidateSet::OperatorRewriteInfo::shouldAddReversed( 889 OverloadedOperatorKind Op) { 890 if (!AllowRewrittenCandidates) 891 return false; 892 return Op == OO_EqualEqual || Op == OO_Spaceship; 893 } 894 895 bool OverloadCandidateSet::OperatorRewriteInfo::shouldAddReversed( 896 ASTContext &Ctx, const FunctionDecl *FD) { 897 if (!shouldAddReversed(FD->getDeclName().getCXXOverloadedOperator())) 898 return false; 899 // Don't bother adding a reversed candidate that can never be a better 900 // match than the non-reversed version. 901 return FD->getNumParams() != 2 || 902 !Ctx.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FD->getParamDecl(0)->getType(), 903 FD->getParamDecl(1)->getType()) || 904 FD->hasAttr<EnableIfAttr>(); 905 } 906 907 void OverloadCandidateSet::destroyCandidates() { 908 for (iterator i = begin(), e = end(); i != e; ++i) { 909 for (auto &C : i->Conversions) 910 C.~ImplicitConversionSequence(); 911 if (!i->Viable && i->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction) 912 i->DeductionFailure.Destroy(); 913 } 914 } 915 916 void OverloadCandidateSet::clear(CandidateSetKind CSK) { 917 destroyCandidates(); 918 SlabAllocator.Reset(); 919 NumInlineBytesUsed = 0; 920 Candidates.clear(); 921 Functions.clear(); 922 Kind = CSK; 923 } 924 925 namespace { 926 class UnbridgedCastsSet { 927 struct Entry { 928 Expr **Addr; 929 Expr *Saved; 930 }; 931 SmallVector<Entry, 2> Entries; 932 933 public: 934 void save(Sema &S, Expr *&E) { 935 assert(E->hasPlaceholderType(BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast)); 936 Entry entry = { &E, E }; 937 Entries.push_back(entry); 938 E = S.stripARCUnbridgedCast(E); 939 } 940 941 void restore() { 942 for (SmallVectorImpl<Entry>::iterator 943 i = Entries.begin(), e = Entries.end(); i != e; ++i) 944 *i->Addr = i->Saved; 945 } 946 }; 947 } 948 949 /// checkPlaceholderForOverload - Do any interesting placeholder-like 950 /// preprocessing on the given expression. 951 /// 952 /// \param unbridgedCasts a collection to which to add unbridged casts; 953 /// without this, they will be immediately diagnosed as errors 954 /// 955 /// Return true on unrecoverable error. 956 static bool 957 checkPlaceholderForOverload(Sema &S, Expr *&E, 958 UnbridgedCastsSet *unbridgedCasts = nullptr) { 959 if (const BuiltinType *placeholder = E->getType()->getAsPlaceholderType()) { 960 // We can't handle overloaded expressions here because overload 961 // resolution might reasonably tweak them. 962 if (placeholder->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload) return false; 963 964 // If the context potentially accepts unbridged ARC casts, strip 965 // the unbridged cast and add it to the collection for later restoration. 966 if (placeholder->getKind() == BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast && 967 unbridgedCasts) { 968 unbridgedCasts->save(S, E); 969 return false; 970 } 971 972 // Go ahead and check everything else. 973 ExprResult result = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(E); 974 if (result.isInvalid()) 975 return true; 976 977 E = result.get(); 978 return false; 979 } 980 981 // Nothing to do. 982 return false; 983 } 984 985 /// checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload - Check a set of call operands for 986 /// placeholders. 987 static bool checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(Sema &S, 988 MultiExprArg Args, 989 UnbridgedCastsSet &unbridged) { 990 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Args.size(); i != e; ++i) 991 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(S, Args[i], &unbridged)) 992 return true; 993 994 return false; 995 } 996 997 /// Determine whether the given New declaration is an overload of the 998 /// declarations in Old. This routine returns Ovl_Match or Ovl_NonFunction if 999 /// New and Old cannot be overloaded, e.g., if New has the same signature as 1000 /// some function in Old (C++ 1.3.10) or if the Old declarations aren't 1001 /// functions (or function templates) at all. When it does return Ovl_Match or 1002 /// Ovl_NonFunction, MatchedDecl will point to the decl that New cannot be 1003 /// overloaded with. This decl may be a UsingShadowDecl on top of the underlying 1004 /// declaration. 1005 /// 1006 /// Example: Given the following input: 1007 /// 1008 /// void f(int, float); // #1 1009 /// void f(int, int); // #2 1010 /// int f(int, int); // #3 1011 /// 1012 /// When we process #1, there is no previous declaration of "f", so IsOverload 1013 /// will not be used. 1014 /// 1015 /// When we process #2, Old contains only the FunctionDecl for #1. By comparing 1016 /// the parameter types, we see that #1 and #2 are overloaded (since they have 1017 /// different signatures), so this routine returns Ovl_Overload; MatchedDecl is 1018 /// unchanged. 1019 /// 1020 /// When we process #3, Old is an overload set containing #1 and #2. We compare 1021 /// the signatures of #3 to #1 (they're overloaded, so we do nothing) and then 1022 /// #3 to #2. Since the signatures of #3 and #2 are identical (return types of 1023 /// functions are not part of the signature), IsOverload returns Ovl_Match and 1024 /// MatchedDecl will be set to point to the FunctionDecl for #2. 1025 /// 1026 /// 'NewIsUsingShadowDecl' indicates that 'New' is being introduced into a class 1027 /// by a using declaration. The rules for whether to hide shadow declarations 1028 /// ignore some properties which otherwise figure into a function template's 1029 /// signature. 1030 Sema::OverloadKind 1031 Sema::CheckOverload(Scope *S, FunctionDecl *New, const LookupResult &Old, 1032 NamedDecl *&Match, bool NewIsUsingDecl) { 1033 for (LookupResult::iterator I = Old.begin(), E = Old.end(); 1034 I != E; ++I) { 1035 NamedDecl *OldD = *I; 1036 1037 bool OldIsUsingDecl = false; 1038 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(OldD)) { 1039 OldIsUsingDecl = true; 1040 1041 // We can always introduce two using declarations into the same 1042 // context, even if they have identical signatures. 1043 if (NewIsUsingDecl) continue; 1044 1045 OldD = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(OldD)->getTargetDecl(); 1046 } 1047 1048 // A using-declaration does not conflict with another declaration 1049 // if one of them is hidden. 1050 if ((OldIsUsingDecl || NewIsUsingDecl) && !isVisible(*I)) 1051 continue; 1052 1053 // If either declaration was introduced by a using declaration, 1054 // we'll need to use slightly different rules for matching. 1055 // Essentially, these rules are the normal rules, except that 1056 // function templates hide function templates with different 1057 // return types or template parameter lists. 1058 bool UseMemberUsingDeclRules = 1059 (OldIsUsingDecl || NewIsUsingDecl) && CurContext->isRecord() && 1060 !New->getFriendObjectKind(); 1061 1062 if (FunctionDecl *OldF = OldD->getAsFunction()) { 1063 if (!IsOverload(New, OldF, UseMemberUsingDeclRules)) { 1064 if (UseMemberUsingDeclRules && OldIsUsingDecl) { 1065 HideUsingShadowDecl(S, cast<UsingShadowDecl>(*I)); 1066 continue; 1067 } 1068 1069 if (!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(OldD) && 1070 !shouldLinkPossiblyHiddenDecl(*I, New)) 1071 continue; 1072 1073 Match = *I; 1074 return Ovl_Match; 1075 } 1076 1077 // Builtins that have custom typechecking or have a reference should 1078 // not be overloadable or redeclarable. 1079 if (!getASTContext().canBuiltinBeRedeclared(OldF)) { 1080 Match = *I; 1081 return Ovl_NonFunction; 1082 } 1083 } else if (isa<UsingDecl>(OldD) || isa<UsingPackDecl>(OldD)) { 1084 // We can overload with these, which can show up when doing 1085 // redeclaration checks for UsingDecls. 1086 assert(Old.getLookupKind() == LookupUsingDeclName); 1087 } else if (isa<TagDecl>(OldD)) { 1088 // We can always overload with tags by hiding them. 1089 } else if (auto *UUD = dyn_cast<UnresolvedUsingValueDecl>(OldD)) { 1090 // Optimistically assume that an unresolved using decl will 1091 // overload; if it doesn't, we'll have to diagnose during 1092 // template instantiation. 1093 // 1094 // Exception: if the scope is dependent and this is not a class 1095 // member, the using declaration can only introduce an enumerator. 1096 if (UUD->getQualifier()->isDependent() && !UUD->isCXXClassMember()) { 1097 Match = *I; 1098 return Ovl_NonFunction; 1099 } 1100 } else { 1101 // (C++ 13p1): 1102 // Only function declarations can be overloaded; object and type 1103 // declarations cannot be overloaded. 1104 Match = *I; 1105 return Ovl_NonFunction; 1106 } 1107 } 1108 1109 // C++ [temp.friend]p1: 1110 // For a friend function declaration that is not a template declaration: 1111 // -- if the name of the friend is a qualified or unqualified template-id, 1112 // [...], otherwise 1113 // -- if the name of the friend is a qualified-id and a matching 1114 // non-template function is found in the specified class or namespace, 1115 // the friend declaration refers to that function, otherwise, 1116 // -- if the name of the friend is a qualified-id and a matching function 1117 // template is found in the specified class or namespace, the friend 1118 // declaration refers to the deduced specialization of that function 1119 // template, otherwise 1120 // -- the name shall be an unqualified-id [...] 1121 // If we get here for a qualified friend declaration, we've just reached the 1122 // third bullet. If the type of the friend is dependent, skip this lookup 1123 // until instantiation. 1124 if (New->getFriendObjectKind() && New->getQualifier() && 1125 !New->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() && 1126 !New->getDependentSpecializationInfo() && 1127 !New->getType()->isDependentType()) { 1128 LookupResult TemplateSpecResult(LookupResult::Temporary, Old); 1129 TemplateSpecResult.addAllDecls(Old); 1130 if (CheckFunctionTemplateSpecialization(New, nullptr, TemplateSpecResult, 1131 /*QualifiedFriend*/true)) { 1132 New->setInvalidDecl(); 1133 return Ovl_Overload; 1134 } 1135 1136 Match = TemplateSpecResult.getAsSingle<FunctionDecl>(); 1137 return Ovl_Match; 1138 } 1139 1140 return Ovl_Overload; 1141 } 1142 1143 bool Sema::IsOverload(FunctionDecl *New, FunctionDecl *Old, 1144 bool UseMemberUsingDeclRules, bool ConsiderCudaAttrs, 1145 bool ConsiderRequiresClauses) { 1146 // C++ [basic.start.main]p2: This function shall not be overloaded. 1147 if (New->isMain()) 1148 return false; 1149 1150 // MSVCRT user defined entry points cannot be overloaded. 1151 if (New->isMSVCRTEntryPoint()) 1152 return false; 1153 1154 FunctionTemplateDecl *OldTemplate = Old->getDescribedFunctionTemplate(); 1155 FunctionTemplateDecl *NewTemplate = New->getDescribedFunctionTemplate(); 1156 1157 // C++ [temp.fct]p2: 1158 // A function template can be overloaded with other function templates 1159 // and with normal (non-template) functions. 1160 if ((OldTemplate == nullptr) != (NewTemplate == nullptr)) 1161 return true; 1162 1163 // Is the function New an overload of the function Old? 1164 QualType OldQType = Context.getCanonicalType(Old->getType()); 1165 QualType NewQType = Context.getCanonicalType(New->getType()); 1166 1167 // Compare the signatures (C++ 1.3.10) of the two functions to 1168 // determine whether they are overloads. If we find any mismatch 1169 // in the signature, they are overloads. 1170 1171 // If either of these functions is a K&R-style function (no 1172 // prototype), then we consider them to have matching signatures. 1173 if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(OldQType.getTypePtr()) || 1174 isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(NewQType.getTypePtr())) 1175 return false; 1176 1177 const FunctionProtoType *OldType = cast<FunctionProtoType>(OldQType); 1178 const FunctionProtoType *NewType = cast<FunctionProtoType>(NewQType); 1179 1180 // The signature of a function includes the types of its 1181 // parameters (C++ 1.3.10), which includes the presence or absence 1182 // of the ellipsis; see C++ DR 357). 1183 if (OldQType != NewQType && 1184 (OldType->getNumParams() != NewType->getNumParams() || 1185 OldType->isVariadic() != NewType->isVariadic() || 1186 !FunctionParamTypesAreEqual(OldType, NewType))) 1187 return true; 1188 1189 // C++ [temp.over.link]p4: 1190 // The signature of a function template consists of its function 1191 // signature, its return type and its template parameter list. The names 1192 // of the template parameters are significant only for establishing the 1193 // relationship between the template parameters and the rest of the 1194 // signature. 1195 // 1196 // We check the return type and template parameter lists for function 1197 // templates first; the remaining checks follow. 1198 // 1199 // However, we don't consider either of these when deciding whether 1200 // a member introduced by a shadow declaration is hidden. 1201 if (!UseMemberUsingDeclRules && NewTemplate && 1202 (!TemplateParameterListsAreEqual(NewTemplate->getTemplateParameters(), 1203 OldTemplate->getTemplateParameters(), 1204 false, TPL_TemplateMatch) || 1205 !Context.hasSameType(Old->getDeclaredReturnType(), 1206 New->getDeclaredReturnType()))) 1207 return true; 1208 1209 // If the function is a class member, its signature includes the 1210 // cv-qualifiers (if any) and ref-qualifier (if any) on the function itself. 1211 // 1212 // As part of this, also check whether one of the member functions 1213 // is static, in which case they are not overloads (C++ 1214 // 13.1p2). While not part of the definition of the signature, 1215 // this check is important to determine whether these functions 1216 // can be overloaded. 1217 CXXMethodDecl *OldMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Old); 1218 CXXMethodDecl *NewMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(New); 1219 if (OldMethod && NewMethod && 1220 !OldMethod->isStatic() && !NewMethod->isStatic()) { 1221 if (OldMethod->getRefQualifier() != NewMethod->getRefQualifier()) { 1222 if (!UseMemberUsingDeclRules && 1223 (OldMethod->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None || 1224 NewMethod->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None)) { 1225 // C++0x [over.load]p2: 1226 // - Member function declarations with the same name and the same 1227 // parameter-type-list as well as member function template 1228 // declarations with the same name, the same parameter-type-list, and 1229 // the same template parameter lists cannot be overloaded if any of 1230 // them, but not all, have a ref-qualifier (8.3.5). 1231 Diag(NewMethod->getLocation(), diag::err_ref_qualifier_overload) 1232 << NewMethod->getRefQualifier() << OldMethod->getRefQualifier(); 1233 Diag(OldMethod->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 1234 } 1235 return true; 1236 } 1237 1238 // We may not have applied the implicit const for a constexpr member 1239 // function yet (because we haven't yet resolved whether this is a static 1240 // or non-static member function). Add it now, on the assumption that this 1241 // is a redeclaration of OldMethod. 1242 auto OldQuals = OldMethod->getMethodQualifiers(); 1243 auto NewQuals = NewMethod->getMethodQualifiers(); 1244 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 && NewMethod->isConstexpr() && 1245 !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(NewMethod)) 1246 NewQuals.addConst(); 1247 // We do not allow overloading based off of '__restrict'. 1248 OldQuals.removeRestrict(); 1249 NewQuals.removeRestrict(); 1250 if (OldQuals != NewQuals) 1251 return true; 1252 } 1253 1254 // Though pass_object_size is placed on parameters and takes an argument, we 1255 // consider it to be a function-level modifier for the sake of function 1256 // identity. Either the function has one or more parameters with 1257 // pass_object_size or it doesn't. 1258 if (functionHasPassObjectSizeParams(New) != 1259 functionHasPassObjectSizeParams(Old)) 1260 return true; 1261 1262 // enable_if attributes are an order-sensitive part of the signature. 1263 for (specific_attr_iterator<EnableIfAttr> 1264 NewI = New->specific_attr_begin<EnableIfAttr>(), 1265 NewE = New->specific_attr_end<EnableIfAttr>(), 1266 OldI = Old->specific_attr_begin<EnableIfAttr>(), 1267 OldE = Old->specific_attr_end<EnableIfAttr>(); 1268 NewI != NewE || OldI != OldE; ++NewI, ++OldI) { 1269 if (NewI == NewE || OldI == OldE) 1270 return true; 1271 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID NewID, OldID; 1272 NewI->getCond()->Profile(NewID, Context, true); 1273 OldI->getCond()->Profile(OldID, Context, true); 1274 if (NewID != OldID) 1275 return true; 1276 } 1277 1278 if (getLangOpts().CUDA && ConsiderCudaAttrs) { 1279 // Don't allow overloading of destructors. (In theory we could, but it 1280 // would be a giant change to clang.) 1281 if (!isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(New)) { 1282 CUDAFunctionTarget NewTarget = IdentifyCUDATarget(New), 1283 OldTarget = IdentifyCUDATarget(Old); 1284 if (NewTarget != CFT_InvalidTarget) { 1285 assert((OldTarget != CFT_InvalidTarget) && 1286 "Unexpected invalid target."); 1287 1288 // Allow overloading of functions with same signature and different CUDA 1289 // target attributes. 1290 if (NewTarget != OldTarget) 1291 return true; 1292 } 1293 } 1294 } 1295 1296 if (ConsiderRequiresClauses) { 1297 Expr *NewRC = New->getTrailingRequiresClause(), 1298 *OldRC = Old->getTrailingRequiresClause(); 1299 if ((NewRC != nullptr) != (OldRC != nullptr)) 1300 // RC are most certainly different - these are overloads. 1301 return true; 1302 1303 if (NewRC) { 1304 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID NewID, OldID; 1305 NewRC->Profile(NewID, Context, /*Canonical=*/true); 1306 OldRC->Profile(OldID, Context, /*Canonical=*/true); 1307 if (NewID != OldID) 1308 // RCs are not equivalent - these are overloads. 1309 return true; 1310 } 1311 } 1312 1313 // The signatures match; this is not an overload. 1314 return false; 1315 } 1316 1317 /// Tries a user-defined conversion from From to ToType. 1318 /// 1319 /// Produces an implicit conversion sequence for when a standard conversion 1320 /// is not an option. See TryImplicitConversion for more information. 1321 static ImplicitConversionSequence 1322 TryUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 1323 bool SuppressUserConversions, 1324 AllowedExplicit AllowExplicit, 1325 bool InOverloadResolution, 1326 bool CStyle, 1327 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion, 1328 bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit) { 1329 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS; 1330 1331 if (SuppressUserConversions) { 1332 // We're not in the case above, so there is no conversion that 1333 // we can perform. 1334 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType); 1335 return ICS; 1336 } 1337 1338 // Attempt user-defined conversion. 1339 OverloadCandidateSet Conversions(From->getExprLoc(), 1340 OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal); 1341 switch (IsUserDefinedConversion(S, From, ToType, ICS.UserDefined, 1342 Conversions, AllowExplicit, 1343 AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit)) { 1344 case OR_Success: 1345 case OR_Deleted: 1346 ICS.setUserDefined(); 1347 // C++ [over.ics.user]p4: 1348 // A conversion of an expression of class type to the same class 1349 // type is given Exact Match rank, and a conversion of an 1350 // expression of class type to a base class of that type is 1351 // given Conversion rank, in spite of the fact that a copy 1352 // constructor (i.e., a user-defined conversion function) is 1353 // called for those cases. 1354 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor 1355 = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction)) { 1356 QualType FromCanon 1357 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(From->getType().getUnqualifiedType()); 1358 QualType ToCanon 1359 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType).getUnqualifiedType(); 1360 if (Constructor->isCopyConstructor() && 1361 (FromCanon == ToCanon || 1362 S.IsDerivedFrom(From->getBeginLoc(), FromCanon, ToCanon))) { 1363 // Turn this into a "standard" conversion sequence, so that it 1364 // gets ranked with standard conversion sequences. 1365 DeclAccessPair Found = ICS.UserDefined.FoundConversionFunction; 1366 ICS.setStandard(); 1367 ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion(); 1368 ICS.Standard.setFromType(From->getType()); 1369 ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType); 1370 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = Constructor; 1371 ICS.Standard.FoundCopyConstructor = Found; 1372 if (ToCanon != FromCanon) 1373 ICS.Standard.Second = ICK_Derived_To_Base; 1374 } 1375 } 1376 break; 1377 1378 case OR_Ambiguous: 1379 ICS.setAmbiguous(); 1380 ICS.Ambiguous.setFromType(From->getType()); 1381 ICS.Ambiguous.setToType(ToType); 1382 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = Conversions.begin(); 1383 Cand != Conversions.end(); ++Cand) 1384 if (Cand->Best) 1385 ICS.Ambiguous.addConversion(Cand->FoundDecl, Cand->Function); 1386 break; 1387 1388 // Fall through. 1389 case OR_No_Viable_Function: 1390 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType); 1391 break; 1392 } 1393 1394 return ICS; 1395 } 1396 1397 /// TryImplicitConversion - Attempt to perform an implicit conversion 1398 /// from the given expression (Expr) to the given type (ToType). This 1399 /// function returns an implicit conversion sequence that can be used 1400 /// to perform the initialization. Given 1401 /// 1402 /// void f(float f); 1403 /// void g(int i) { f(i); } 1404 /// 1405 /// this routine would produce an implicit conversion sequence to 1406 /// describe the initialization of f from i, which will be a standard 1407 /// conversion sequence containing an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion (C++ 1408 /// 4.1) followed by a floating-integral conversion (C++ 4.9). 1409 // 1410 /// Note that this routine only determines how the conversion can be 1411 /// performed; it does not actually perform the conversion. As such, 1412 /// it will not produce any diagnostics if no conversion is available, 1413 /// but will instead return an implicit conversion sequence of kind 1414 /// "BadConversion". 1415 /// 1416 /// If @p SuppressUserConversions, then user-defined conversions are 1417 /// not permitted. 1418 /// If @p AllowExplicit, then explicit user-defined conversions are 1419 /// permitted. 1420 /// 1421 /// \param AllowObjCWritebackConversion Whether we allow the Objective-C 1422 /// writeback conversion, which allows __autoreleasing id* parameters to 1423 /// be initialized with __strong id* or __weak id* arguments. 1424 static ImplicitConversionSequence 1425 TryImplicitConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 1426 bool SuppressUserConversions, 1427 AllowedExplicit AllowExplicit, 1428 bool InOverloadResolution, 1429 bool CStyle, 1430 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion, 1431 bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit) { 1432 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS; 1433 if (IsStandardConversion(S, From, ToType, InOverloadResolution, 1434 ICS.Standard, CStyle, AllowObjCWritebackConversion)){ 1435 ICS.setStandard(); 1436 return ICS; 1437 } 1438 1439 if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 1440 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType); 1441 return ICS; 1442 } 1443 1444 // C++ [over.ics.user]p4: 1445 // A conversion of an expression of class type to the same class 1446 // type is given Exact Match rank, and a conversion of an 1447 // expression of class type to a base class of that type is 1448 // given Conversion rank, in spite of the fact that a copy/move 1449 // constructor (i.e., a user-defined conversion function) is 1450 // called for those cases. 1451 QualType FromType = From->getType(); 1452 if (ToType->getAs<RecordType>() && FromType->getAs<RecordType>() && 1453 (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType) || 1454 S.IsDerivedFrom(From->getBeginLoc(), FromType, ToType))) { 1455 ICS.setStandard(); 1456 ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion(); 1457 ICS.Standard.setFromType(FromType); 1458 ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType); 1459 1460 // We don't actually check at this point whether there is a valid 1461 // copy/move constructor, since overloading just assumes that it 1462 // exists. When we actually perform initialization, we'll find the 1463 // appropriate constructor to copy the returned object, if needed. 1464 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = nullptr; 1465 1466 // Determine whether this is considered a derived-to-base conversion. 1467 if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType)) 1468 ICS.Standard.Second = ICK_Derived_To_Base; 1469 1470 return ICS; 1471 } 1472 1473 return TryUserDefinedConversion(S, From, ToType, SuppressUserConversions, 1474 AllowExplicit, InOverloadResolution, CStyle, 1475 AllowObjCWritebackConversion, 1476 AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit); 1477 } 1478 1479 ImplicitConversionSequence 1480 Sema::TryImplicitConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType, 1481 bool SuppressUserConversions, 1482 AllowedExplicit AllowExplicit, 1483 bool InOverloadResolution, 1484 bool CStyle, 1485 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) { 1486 return ::TryImplicitConversion(*this, From, ToType, SuppressUserConversions, 1487 AllowExplicit, InOverloadResolution, CStyle, 1488 AllowObjCWritebackConversion, 1489 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false); 1490 } 1491 1492 /// PerformImplicitConversion - Perform an implicit conversion of the 1493 /// expression From to the type ToType. Returns the 1494 /// converted expression. Flavor is the kind of conversion we're 1495 /// performing, used in the error message. If @p AllowExplicit, 1496 /// explicit user-defined conversions are permitted. 1497 ExprResult Sema::PerformImplicitConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType, 1498 AssignmentAction Action, 1499 bool AllowExplicit) { 1500 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From)) 1501 return ExprError(); 1502 1503 // Objective-C ARC: Determine whether we will allow the writeback conversion. 1504 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion 1505 = getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount && 1506 (Action == AA_Passing || Action == AA_Sending); 1507 if (getLangOpts().ObjC) 1508 CheckObjCBridgeRelatedConversions(From->getBeginLoc(), ToType, 1509 From->getType(), From); 1510 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = ::TryImplicitConversion( 1511 *this, From, ToType, 1512 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, 1513 AllowExplicit ? AllowedExplicit::All : AllowedExplicit::None, 1514 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, 1515 /*CStyle=*/false, AllowObjCWritebackConversion, 1516 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false); 1517 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, ToType, ICS, Action); 1518 } 1519 1520 /// Determine whether the conversion from FromType to ToType is a valid 1521 /// conversion that strips "noexcept" or "noreturn" off the nested function 1522 /// type. 1523 bool Sema::IsFunctionConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType, 1524 QualType &ResultTy) { 1525 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType)) 1526 return false; 1527 1528 // Permit the conversion F(t __attribute__((noreturn))) -> F(t) 1529 // or F(t noexcept) -> F(t) 1530 // where F adds one of the following at most once: 1531 // - a pointer 1532 // - a member pointer 1533 // - a block pointer 1534 // Changes here need matching changes in FindCompositePointerType. 1535 CanQualType CanTo = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType); 1536 CanQualType CanFrom = Context.getCanonicalType(FromType); 1537 Type::TypeClass TyClass = CanTo->getTypeClass(); 1538 if (TyClass != CanFrom->getTypeClass()) return false; 1539 if (TyClass != Type::FunctionProto && TyClass != Type::FunctionNoProto) { 1540 if (TyClass == Type::Pointer) { 1541 CanTo = CanTo.castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 1542 CanFrom = CanFrom.castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 1543 } else if (TyClass == Type::BlockPointer) { 1544 CanTo = CanTo.castAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 1545 CanFrom = CanFrom.castAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 1546 } else if (TyClass == Type::MemberPointer) { 1547 auto ToMPT = CanTo.castAs<MemberPointerType>(); 1548 auto FromMPT = CanFrom.castAs<MemberPointerType>(); 1549 // A function pointer conversion cannot change the class of the function. 1550 if (ToMPT->getClass() != FromMPT->getClass()) 1551 return false; 1552 CanTo = ToMPT->getPointeeType(); 1553 CanFrom = FromMPT->getPointeeType(); 1554 } else { 1555 return false; 1556 } 1557 1558 TyClass = CanTo->getTypeClass(); 1559 if (TyClass != CanFrom->getTypeClass()) return false; 1560 if (TyClass != Type::FunctionProto && TyClass != Type::FunctionNoProto) 1561 return false; 1562 } 1563 1564 const auto *FromFn = cast<FunctionType>(CanFrom); 1565 FunctionType::ExtInfo FromEInfo = FromFn->getExtInfo(); 1566 1567 const auto *ToFn = cast<FunctionType>(CanTo); 1568 FunctionType::ExtInfo ToEInfo = ToFn->getExtInfo(); 1569 1570 bool Changed = false; 1571 1572 // Drop 'noreturn' if not present in target type. 1573 if (FromEInfo.getNoReturn() && !ToEInfo.getNoReturn()) { 1574 FromFn = Context.adjustFunctionType(FromFn, FromEInfo.withNoReturn(false)); 1575 Changed = true; 1576 } 1577 1578 // Drop 'noexcept' if not present in target type. 1579 if (const auto *FromFPT = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FromFn)) { 1580 const auto *ToFPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(ToFn); 1581 if (FromFPT->isNothrow() && !ToFPT->isNothrow()) { 1582 FromFn = cast<FunctionType>( 1583 Context.getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(QualType(FromFPT, 0), 1584 EST_None) 1585 .getTypePtr()); 1586 Changed = true; 1587 } 1588 1589 // Convert FromFPT's ExtParameterInfo if necessary. The conversion is valid 1590 // only if the ExtParameterInfo lists of the two function prototypes can be 1591 // merged and the merged list is identical to ToFPT's ExtParameterInfo list. 1592 SmallVector<FunctionProtoType::ExtParameterInfo, 4> NewParamInfos; 1593 bool CanUseToFPT, CanUseFromFPT; 1594 if (Context.mergeExtParameterInfo(ToFPT, FromFPT, CanUseToFPT, 1595 CanUseFromFPT, NewParamInfos) && 1596 CanUseToFPT && !CanUseFromFPT) { 1597 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo ExtInfo = FromFPT->getExtProtoInfo(); 1598 ExtInfo.ExtParameterInfos = 1599 NewParamInfos.empty() ? nullptr : NewParamInfos.data(); 1600 QualType QT = Context.getFunctionType(FromFPT->getReturnType(), 1601 FromFPT->getParamTypes(), ExtInfo); 1602 FromFn = QT->getAs<FunctionType>(); 1603 Changed = true; 1604 } 1605 } 1606 1607 if (!Changed) 1608 return false; 1609 1610 assert(QualType(FromFn, 0).isCanonical()); 1611 if (QualType(FromFn, 0) != CanTo) return false; 1612 1613 ResultTy = ToType; 1614 return true; 1615 } 1616 1617 /// Determine whether the conversion from FromType to ToType is a valid 1618 /// vector conversion. 1619 /// 1620 /// \param ICK Will be set to the vector conversion kind, if this is a vector 1621 /// conversion. 1622 static bool IsVectorConversion(Sema &S, QualType FromType, 1623 QualType ToType, ImplicitConversionKind &ICK) { 1624 // We need at least one of these types to be a vector type to have a vector 1625 // conversion. 1626 if (!ToType->isVectorType() && !FromType->isVectorType()) 1627 return false; 1628 1629 // Identical types require no conversions. 1630 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType)) 1631 return false; 1632 1633 // There are no conversions between extended vector types, only identity. 1634 if (ToType->isExtVectorType()) { 1635 // There are no conversions between extended vector types other than the 1636 // identity conversion. 1637 if (FromType->isExtVectorType()) 1638 return false; 1639 1640 // Vector splat from any arithmetic type to a vector. 1641 if (FromType->isArithmeticType()) { 1642 ICK = ICK_Vector_Splat; 1643 return true; 1644 } 1645 } 1646 1647 if ((ToType->isSizelessBuiltinType() || FromType->isSizelessBuiltinType()) && 1648 S.Context.areCompatibleSveTypes(FromType, ToType)) { 1649 ICK = ICK_SVE_Vector_Conversion; 1650 return true; 1651 } 1652 1653 // We can perform the conversion between vector types in the following cases: 1654 // 1)vector types are equivalent AltiVec and GCC vector types 1655 // 2)lax vector conversions are permitted and the vector types are of the 1656 // same size 1657 // 3)the destination type does not have the ARM MVE strict-polymorphism 1658 // attribute, which inhibits lax vector conversion for overload resolution 1659 // only 1660 if (ToType->isVectorType() && FromType->isVectorType()) { 1661 if (S.Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(FromType, ToType) || 1662 (S.isLaxVectorConversion(FromType, ToType) && 1663 !ToType->hasAttr(attr::ArmMveStrictPolymorphism))) { 1664 ICK = ICK_Vector_Conversion; 1665 return true; 1666 } 1667 } 1668 1669 return false; 1670 } 1671 1672 static bool tryAtomicConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 1673 bool InOverloadResolution, 1674 StandardConversionSequence &SCS, 1675 bool CStyle); 1676 1677 /// IsStandardConversion - Determines whether there is a standard 1678 /// conversion sequence (C++ [conv], C++ [over.ics.scs]) from the 1679 /// expression From to the type ToType. Standard conversion sequences 1680 /// only consider non-class types; for conversions that involve class 1681 /// types, use TryImplicitConversion. If a conversion exists, SCS will 1682 /// contain the standard conversion sequence required to perform this 1683 /// conversion and this routine will return true. Otherwise, this 1684 /// routine will return false and the value of SCS is unspecified. 1685 static bool IsStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From, QualType ToType, 1686 bool InOverloadResolution, 1687 StandardConversionSequence &SCS, 1688 bool CStyle, 1689 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) { 1690 QualType FromType = From->getType(); 1691 1692 // Standard conversions (C++ [conv]) 1693 SCS.setAsIdentityConversion(); 1694 SCS.IncompatibleObjC = false; 1695 SCS.setFromType(FromType); 1696 SCS.CopyConstructor = nullptr; 1697 1698 // There are no standard conversions for class types in C++, so 1699 // abort early. When overloading in C, however, we do permit them. 1700 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 1701 (FromType->isRecordType() || ToType->isRecordType())) 1702 return false; 1703 1704 // The first conversion can be an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion, 1705 // array-to-pointer conversion, or function-to-pointer conversion 1706 // (C++ 4p1). 1707 1708 if (FromType == S.Context.OverloadTy) { 1709 DeclAccessPair AccessPair; 1710 if (FunctionDecl *Fn 1711 = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(From, ToType, false, 1712 AccessPair)) { 1713 // We were able to resolve the address of the overloaded function, 1714 // so we can convert to the type of that function. 1715 FromType = Fn->getType(); 1716 SCS.setFromType(FromType); 1717 1718 // we can sometimes resolve &foo<int> regardless of ToType, so check 1719 // if the type matches (identity) or we are converting to bool 1720 if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType( 1721 S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(ToType), FromType)) { 1722 QualType resultTy; 1723 // if the function type matches except for [[noreturn]], it's ok 1724 if (!S.IsFunctionConversion(FromType, 1725 S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(ToType), resultTy)) 1726 // otherwise, only a boolean conversion is standard 1727 if (!ToType->isBooleanType()) 1728 return false; 1729 } 1730 1731 // Check if the "from" expression is taking the address of an overloaded 1732 // function and recompute the FromType accordingly. Take advantage of the 1733 // fact that non-static member functions *must* have such an address-of 1734 // expression. 1735 CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn); 1736 if (Method && !Method->isStatic()) { 1737 assert(isa<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens()) && 1738 "Non-unary operator on non-static member address"); 1739 assert(cast<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())->getOpcode() 1740 == UO_AddrOf && 1741 "Non-address-of operator on non-static member address"); 1742 const Type *ClassType 1743 = S.Context.getTypeDeclType(Method->getParent()).getTypePtr(); 1744 FromType = S.Context.getMemberPointerType(FromType, ClassType); 1745 } else if (isa<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())) { 1746 assert(cast<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())->getOpcode() == 1747 UO_AddrOf && 1748 "Non-address-of operator for overloaded function expression"); 1749 FromType = S.Context.getPointerType(FromType); 1750 } 1751 1752 // Check that we've computed the proper type after overload resolution. 1753 // FIXME: FixOverloadedFunctionReference has side-effects; we shouldn't 1754 // be calling it from within an NDEBUG block. 1755 assert(S.Context.hasSameType( 1756 FromType, 1757 S.FixOverloadedFunctionReference(From, AccessPair, Fn)->getType())); 1758 } else { 1759 return false; 1760 } 1761 } 1762 // Lvalue-to-rvalue conversion (C++11 4.1): 1763 // A glvalue (3.10) of a non-function, non-array type T can 1764 // be converted to a prvalue. 1765 bool argIsLValue = From->isGLValue(); 1766 if (argIsLValue && 1767 !FromType->isFunctionType() && !FromType->isArrayType() && 1768 S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType) != S.Context.OverloadTy) { 1769 SCS.First = ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue; 1770 1771 // C11 6.3.2.1p2: 1772 // ... if the lvalue has atomic type, the value has the non-atomic version 1773 // of the type of the lvalue ... 1774 if (const AtomicType *Atomic = FromType->getAs<AtomicType>()) 1775 FromType = Atomic->getValueType(); 1776 1777 // If T is a non-class type, the type of the rvalue is the 1778 // cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the rvalue 1779 // is T (C++ 4.1p1). C++ can't get here with class types; in C, we 1780 // just strip the qualifiers because they don't matter. 1781 FromType = FromType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1782 } else if (FromType->isArrayType()) { 1783 // Array-to-pointer conversion (C++ 4.2) 1784 SCS.First = ICK_Array_To_Pointer; 1785 1786 // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown 1787 // bound of T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to 1788 // T" (C++ 4.2p1). 1789 FromType = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType); 1790 1791 if (S.IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(From, ToType)) { 1792 // This conversion is deprecated in C++03 (D.4) 1793 SCS.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = true; 1794 1795 // For the purpose of ranking in overload resolution 1796 // (13.3.3.1.1), this conversion is considered an 1797 // array-to-pointer conversion followed by a qualification 1798 // conversion (4.4). (C++ 4.2p2) 1799 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity; 1800 SCS.Third = ICK_Qualification; 1801 SCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime = false; 1802 SCS.setAllToTypes(FromType); 1803 return true; 1804 } 1805 } else if (FromType->isFunctionType() && argIsLValue) { 1806 // Function-to-pointer conversion (C++ 4.3). 1807 SCS.First = ICK_Function_To_Pointer; 1808 1809 if (auto *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(From->IgnoreParenCasts())) 1810 if (auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(DRE->getDecl())) 1811 if (!S.checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(FD)) 1812 return false; 1813 1814 // An lvalue of function type T can be converted to an rvalue of 1815 // type "pointer to T." The result is a pointer to the 1816 // function. (C++ 4.3p1). 1817 FromType = S.Context.getPointerType(FromType); 1818 } else { 1819 // We don't require any conversions for the first step. 1820 SCS.First = ICK_Identity; 1821 } 1822 SCS.setToType(0, FromType); 1823 1824 // The second conversion can be an integral promotion, floating 1825 // point promotion, integral conversion, floating point conversion, 1826 // floating-integral conversion, pointer conversion, 1827 // pointer-to-member conversion, or boolean conversion (C++ 4p1). 1828 // For overloading in C, this can also be a "compatible-type" 1829 // conversion. 1830 bool IncompatibleObjC = false; 1831 ImplicitConversionKind SecondICK = ICK_Identity; 1832 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType)) { 1833 // The unqualified versions of the types are the same: there's no 1834 // conversion to do. 1835 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity; 1836 } else if (S.IsIntegralPromotion(From, FromType, ToType)) { 1837 // Integral promotion (C++ 4.5). 1838 SCS.Second = ICK_Integral_Promotion; 1839 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1840 } else if (S.IsFloatingPointPromotion(FromType, ToType)) { 1841 // Floating point promotion (C++ 4.6). 1842 SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Promotion; 1843 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1844 } else if (S.IsComplexPromotion(FromType, ToType)) { 1845 // Complex promotion (Clang extension) 1846 SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Promotion; 1847 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1848 } else if (ToType->isBooleanType() && 1849 (FromType->isArithmeticType() || 1850 FromType->isAnyPointerType() || 1851 FromType->isBlockPointerType() || 1852 FromType->isMemberPointerType())) { 1853 // Boolean conversions (C++ 4.12). 1854 SCS.Second = ICK_Boolean_Conversion; 1855 FromType = S.Context.BoolTy; 1856 } else if (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() && 1857 ToType->isIntegralType(S.Context)) { 1858 // Integral conversions (C++ 4.7). 1859 SCS.Second = ICK_Integral_Conversion; 1860 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1861 } else if (FromType->isAnyComplexType() && ToType->isAnyComplexType()) { 1862 // Complex conversions (C99 6.3.1.6) 1863 SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Conversion; 1864 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1865 } else if ((FromType->isAnyComplexType() && ToType->isArithmeticType()) || 1866 (ToType->isAnyComplexType() && FromType->isArithmeticType())) { 1867 // Complex-real conversions (C99 6.3.1.7) 1868 SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Real; 1869 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1870 } else if (FromType->isRealFloatingType() && ToType->isRealFloatingType()) { 1871 // FIXME: disable conversions between long double and __float128 if 1872 // their representation is different until there is back end support 1873 // We of course allow this conversion if long double is really double. 1874 1875 // Conversions between bfloat and other floats are not permitted. 1876 if (FromType == S.Context.BFloat16Ty || ToType == S.Context.BFloat16Ty) 1877 return false; 1878 if (&S.Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(FromType) != 1879 &S.Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(ToType)) { 1880 bool Float128AndLongDouble = ((FromType == S.Context.Float128Ty && 1881 ToType == S.Context.LongDoubleTy) || 1882 (FromType == S.Context.LongDoubleTy && 1883 ToType == S.Context.Float128Ty)); 1884 if (Float128AndLongDouble && 1885 (&S.Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(S.Context.LongDoubleTy) == 1886 &llvm::APFloat::PPCDoubleDouble())) 1887 return false; 1888 } 1889 // Floating point conversions (C++ 4.8). 1890 SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Conversion; 1891 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1892 } else if ((FromType->isRealFloatingType() && 1893 ToType->isIntegralType(S.Context)) || 1894 (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() && 1895 ToType->isRealFloatingType())) { 1896 // Conversions between bfloat and int are not permitted. 1897 if (FromType->isBFloat16Type() || ToType->isBFloat16Type()) 1898 return false; 1899 1900 // Floating-integral conversions (C++ 4.9). 1901 SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Integral; 1902 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1903 } else if (S.IsBlockPointerConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) { 1904 SCS.Second = ICK_Block_Pointer_Conversion; 1905 } else if (AllowObjCWritebackConversion && 1906 S.isObjCWritebackConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) { 1907 SCS.Second = ICK_Writeback_Conversion; 1908 } else if (S.IsPointerConversion(From, FromType, ToType, InOverloadResolution, 1909 FromType, IncompatibleObjC)) { 1910 // Pointer conversions (C++ 4.10). 1911 SCS.Second = ICK_Pointer_Conversion; 1912 SCS.IncompatibleObjC = IncompatibleObjC; 1913 FromType = FromType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1914 } else if (S.IsMemberPointerConversion(From, FromType, ToType, 1915 InOverloadResolution, FromType)) { 1916 // Pointer to member conversions (4.11). 1917 SCS.Second = ICK_Pointer_Member; 1918 } else if (IsVectorConversion(S, FromType, ToType, SecondICK)) { 1919 SCS.Second = SecondICK; 1920 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1921 } else if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 1922 S.Context.typesAreCompatible(ToType, FromType)) { 1923 // Compatible conversions (Clang extension for C function overloading) 1924 SCS.Second = ICK_Compatible_Conversion; 1925 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1926 } else if (IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(S, From, ToType, 1927 InOverloadResolution, 1928 SCS, CStyle)) { 1929 SCS.Second = ICK_TransparentUnionConversion; 1930 FromType = ToType; 1931 } else if (tryAtomicConversion(S, From, ToType, InOverloadResolution, SCS, 1932 CStyle)) { 1933 // tryAtomicConversion has updated the standard conversion sequence 1934 // appropriately. 1935 return true; 1936 } else if (ToType->isEventT() && 1937 From->isIntegerConstantExpr(S.getASTContext()) && 1938 From->EvaluateKnownConstInt(S.getASTContext()) == 0) { 1939 SCS.Second = ICK_Zero_Event_Conversion; 1940 FromType = ToType; 1941 } else if (ToType->isQueueT() && 1942 From->isIntegerConstantExpr(S.getASTContext()) && 1943 (From->EvaluateKnownConstInt(S.getASTContext()) == 0)) { 1944 SCS.Second = ICK_Zero_Queue_Conversion; 1945 FromType = ToType; 1946 } else if (ToType->isSamplerT() && 1947 From->isIntegerConstantExpr(S.getASTContext())) { 1948 SCS.Second = ICK_Compatible_Conversion; 1949 FromType = ToType; 1950 } else { 1951 // No second conversion required. 1952 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity; 1953 } 1954 SCS.setToType(1, FromType); 1955 1956 // The third conversion can be a function pointer conversion or a 1957 // qualification conversion (C++ [conv.fctptr], [conv.qual]). 1958 bool ObjCLifetimeConversion; 1959 if (S.IsFunctionConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) { 1960 // Function pointer conversions (removing 'noexcept') including removal of 1961 // 'noreturn' (Clang extension). 1962 SCS.Third = ICK_Function_Conversion; 1963 } else if (S.IsQualificationConversion(FromType, ToType, CStyle, 1964 ObjCLifetimeConversion)) { 1965 SCS.Third = ICK_Qualification; 1966 SCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime = ObjCLifetimeConversion; 1967 FromType = ToType; 1968 } else { 1969 // No conversion required 1970 SCS.Third = ICK_Identity; 1971 } 1972 1973 // C++ [over.best.ics]p6: 1974 // [...] Any difference in top-level cv-qualification is 1975 // subsumed by the initialization itself and does not constitute 1976 // a conversion. [...] 1977 QualType CanonFrom = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType); 1978 QualType CanonTo = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType); 1979 if (CanonFrom.getLocalUnqualifiedType() 1980 == CanonTo.getLocalUnqualifiedType() && 1981 CanonFrom.getLocalQualifiers() != CanonTo.getLocalQualifiers()) { 1982 FromType = ToType; 1983 CanonFrom = CanonTo; 1984 } 1985 1986 SCS.setToType(2, FromType); 1987 1988 if (CanonFrom == CanonTo) 1989 return true; 1990 1991 // If we have not converted the argument type to the parameter type, 1992 // this is a bad conversion sequence, unless we're resolving an overload in C. 1993 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || !InOverloadResolution) 1994 return false; 1995 1996 ExprResult ER = ExprResult{From}; 1997 Sema::AssignConvertType Conv = 1998 S.CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(ToType, ER, 1999 /*Diagnose=*/false, 2000 /*DiagnoseCFAudited=*/false, 2001 /*ConvertRHS=*/false); 2002 ImplicitConversionKind SecondConv; 2003 switch (Conv) { 2004 case Sema::Compatible: 2005 SecondConv = ICK_C_Only_Conversion; 2006 break; 2007 // For our purposes, discarding qualifiers is just as bad as using an 2008 // incompatible pointer. Note that an IncompatiblePointer conversion can drop 2009 // qualifiers, as well. 2010 case Sema::CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers: 2011 case Sema::IncompatiblePointer: 2012 case Sema::IncompatiblePointerSign: 2013 SecondConv = ICK_Incompatible_Pointer_Conversion; 2014 break; 2015 default: 2016 return false; 2017 } 2018 2019 // First can only be an lvalue conversion, so we pretend that this was the 2020 // second conversion. First should already be valid from earlier in the 2021 // function. 2022 SCS.Second = SecondConv; 2023 SCS.setToType(1, ToType); 2024 2025 // Third is Identity, because Second should rank us worse than any other 2026 // conversion. This could also be ICK_Qualification, but it's simpler to just 2027 // lump everything in with the second conversion, and we don't gain anything 2028 // from making this ICK_Qualification. 2029 SCS.Third = ICK_Identity; 2030 SCS.setToType(2, ToType); 2031 return true; 2032 } 2033 2034 static bool 2035 IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From, 2036 QualType &ToType, 2037 bool InOverloadResolution, 2038 StandardConversionSequence &SCS, 2039 bool CStyle) { 2040 2041 const RecordType *UT = ToType->getAsUnionType(); 2042 if (!UT || !UT->getDecl()->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>()) 2043 return false; 2044 // The field to initialize within the transparent union. 2045 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl(); 2046 // It's compatible if the expression matches any of the fields. 2047 for (const auto *it : UD->fields()) { 2048 if (IsStandardConversion(S, From, it->getType(), InOverloadResolution, SCS, 2049 CStyle, /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false)) { 2050 ToType = it->getType(); 2051 return true; 2052 } 2053 } 2054 return false; 2055 } 2056 2057 /// IsIntegralPromotion - Determines whether the conversion from the 2058 /// expression From (whose potentially-adjusted type is FromType) to 2059 /// ToType is an integral promotion (C++ 4.5). If so, returns true and 2060 /// sets PromotedType to the promoted type. 2061 bool Sema::IsIntegralPromotion(Expr *From, QualType FromType, QualType ToType) { 2062 const BuiltinType *To = ToType->getAs<BuiltinType>(); 2063 // All integers are built-in. 2064 if (!To) { 2065 return false; 2066 } 2067 2068 // An rvalue of type char, signed char, unsigned char, short int, or 2069 // unsigned short int can be converted to an rvalue of type int if 2070 // int can represent all the values of the source type; otherwise, 2071 // the source rvalue can be converted to an rvalue of type unsigned 2072 // int (C++ 4.5p1). 2073 if (FromType->isPromotableIntegerType() && !FromType->isBooleanType() && 2074 !FromType->isEnumeralType()) { 2075 if (// We can promote any signed, promotable integer type to an int 2076 (FromType->isSignedIntegerType() || 2077 // We can promote any unsigned integer type whose size is 2078 // less than int to an int. 2079 Context.getTypeSize(FromType) < Context.getTypeSize(ToType))) { 2080 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int; 2081 } 2082 2083 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::UInt; 2084 } 2085 2086 // C++11 [conv.prom]p3: 2087 // A prvalue of an unscoped enumeration type whose underlying type is not 2088 // fixed (7.2) can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of the first of the 2089 // following types that can represent all the values of the enumeration 2090 // (i.e., the values in the range bmin to bmax as described in 7.2): int, 2091 // unsigned int, long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or unsigned 2092 // long long int. If none of the types in that list can represent all the 2093 // values of the enumeration, an rvalue a prvalue of an unscoped enumeration 2094 // type can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of the extended integer type 2095 // with lowest integer conversion rank (4.13) greater than the rank of long 2096 // long in which all the values of the enumeration can be represented. If 2097 // there are two such extended types, the signed one is chosen. 2098 // C++11 [conv.prom]p4: 2099 // A prvalue of an unscoped enumeration type whose underlying type is fixed 2100 // can be converted to a prvalue of its underlying type. Moreover, if 2101 // integral promotion can be applied to its underlying type, a prvalue of an 2102 // unscoped enumeration type whose underlying type is fixed can also be 2103 // converted to a prvalue of the promoted underlying type. 2104 if (const EnumType *FromEnumType = FromType->getAs<EnumType>()) { 2105 // C++0x 7.2p9: Note that this implicit enum to int conversion is not 2106 // provided for a scoped enumeration. 2107 if (FromEnumType->getDecl()->isScoped()) 2108 return false; 2109 2110 // We can perform an integral promotion to the underlying type of the enum, 2111 // even if that's not the promoted type. Note that the check for promoting 2112 // the underlying type is based on the type alone, and does not consider 2113 // the bitfield-ness of the actual source expression. 2114 if (FromEnumType->getDecl()->isFixed()) { 2115 QualType Underlying = FromEnumType->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 2116 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Underlying, ToType) || 2117 IsIntegralPromotion(nullptr, Underlying, ToType); 2118 } 2119 2120 // We have already pre-calculated the promotion type, so this is trivial. 2121 if (ToType->isIntegerType() && 2122 isCompleteType(From->getBeginLoc(), FromType)) 2123 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType( 2124 ToType, FromEnumType->getDecl()->getPromotionType()); 2125 2126 // C++ [conv.prom]p5: 2127 // If the bit-field has an enumerated type, it is treated as any other 2128 // value of that type for promotion purposes. 2129 // 2130 // ... so do not fall through into the bit-field checks below in C++. 2131 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 2132 return false; 2133 } 2134 2135 // C++0x [conv.prom]p2: 2136 // A prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t, or wchar_t (3.9.1) can be converted 2137 // to an rvalue a prvalue of the first of the following types that can 2138 // represent all the values of its underlying type: int, unsigned int, 2139 // long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or unsigned long long int. 2140 // If none of the types in that list can represent all the values of its 2141 // underlying type, an rvalue a prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t, 2142 // or wchar_t can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of its underlying 2143 // type. 2144 if (FromType->isAnyCharacterType() && !FromType->isCharType() && 2145 ToType->isIntegerType()) { 2146 // Determine whether the type we're converting from is signed or 2147 // unsigned. 2148 bool FromIsSigned = FromType->isSignedIntegerType(); 2149 uint64_t FromSize = Context.getTypeSize(FromType); 2150 2151 // The types we'll try to promote to, in the appropriate 2152 // order. Try each of these types. 2153 QualType PromoteTypes[6] = { 2154 Context.IntTy, Context.UnsignedIntTy, 2155 Context.LongTy, Context.UnsignedLongTy , 2156 Context.LongLongTy, Context.UnsignedLongLongTy 2157 }; 2158 for (int Idx = 0; Idx < 6; ++Idx) { 2159 uint64_t ToSize = Context.getTypeSize(PromoteTypes[Idx]); 2160 if (FromSize < ToSize || 2161 (FromSize == ToSize && 2162 FromIsSigned == PromoteTypes[Idx]->isSignedIntegerType())) { 2163 // We found the type that we can promote to. If this is the 2164 // type we wanted, we have a promotion. Otherwise, no 2165 // promotion. 2166 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType, PromoteTypes[Idx]); 2167 } 2168 } 2169 } 2170 2171 // An rvalue for an integral bit-field (9.6) can be converted to an 2172 // rvalue of type int if int can represent all the values of the 2173 // bit-field; otherwise, it can be converted to unsigned int if 2174 // unsigned int can represent all the values of the bit-field. If 2175 // the bit-field is larger yet, no integral promotion applies to 2176 // it. If the bit-field has an enumerated type, it is treated as any 2177 // other value of that type for promotion purposes (C++ 4.5p3). 2178 // FIXME: We should delay checking of bit-fields until we actually perform the 2179 // conversion. 2180 // 2181 // FIXME: In C, only bit-fields of types _Bool, int, or unsigned int may be 2182 // promoted, per C11 6.3.1.1/2. We promote all bit-fields (including enum 2183 // bit-fields and those whose underlying type is larger than int) for GCC 2184 // compatibility. 2185 if (From) { 2186 if (FieldDecl *MemberDecl = From->getSourceBitField()) { 2187 Optional<llvm::APSInt> BitWidth; 2188 if (FromType->isIntegralType(Context) && 2189 (BitWidth = 2190 MemberDecl->getBitWidth()->getIntegerConstantExpr(Context))) { 2191 llvm::APSInt ToSize(BitWidth->getBitWidth(), BitWidth->isUnsigned()); 2192 ToSize = Context.getTypeSize(ToType); 2193 2194 // Are we promoting to an int from a bitfield that fits in an int? 2195 if (*BitWidth < ToSize || 2196 (FromType->isSignedIntegerType() && *BitWidth <= ToSize)) { 2197 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int; 2198 } 2199 2200 // Are we promoting to an unsigned int from an unsigned bitfield 2201 // that fits into an unsigned int? 2202 if (FromType->isUnsignedIntegerType() && *BitWidth <= ToSize) { 2203 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::UInt; 2204 } 2205 2206 return false; 2207 } 2208 } 2209 } 2210 2211 // An rvalue of type bool can be converted to an rvalue of type int, 2212 // with false becoming zero and true becoming one (C++ 4.5p4). 2213 if (FromType->isBooleanType() && To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int) { 2214 return true; 2215 } 2216 2217 return false; 2218 } 2219 2220 /// IsFloatingPointPromotion - Determines whether the conversion from 2221 /// FromType to ToType is a floating point promotion (C++ 4.6). If so, 2222 /// returns true and sets PromotedType to the promoted type. 2223 bool Sema::IsFloatingPointPromotion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType) { 2224 if (const BuiltinType *FromBuiltin = FromType->getAs<BuiltinType>()) 2225 if (const BuiltinType *ToBuiltin = ToType->getAs<BuiltinType>()) { 2226 /// An rvalue of type float can be converted to an rvalue of type 2227 /// double. (C++ 4.6p1). 2228 if (FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float && 2229 ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Double) 2230 return true; 2231 2232 // C99 6.3.1.5p1: 2233 // When a float is promoted to double or long double, or a 2234 // double is promoted to long double [...]. 2235 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 2236 (FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float || 2237 FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Double) && 2238 (ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::LongDouble || 2239 ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float128)) 2240 return true; 2241 2242 // Half can be promoted to float. 2243 if (!getLangOpts().NativeHalfType && 2244 FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Half && 2245 ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float) 2246 return true; 2247 } 2248 2249 return false; 2250 } 2251 2252 /// Determine if a conversion is a complex promotion. 2253 /// 2254 /// A complex promotion is defined as a complex -> complex conversion 2255 /// where the conversion between the underlying real types is a 2256 /// floating-point or integral promotion. 2257 bool Sema::IsComplexPromotion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType) { 2258 const ComplexType *FromComplex = FromType->getAs<ComplexType>(); 2259 if (!FromComplex) 2260 return false; 2261 2262 const ComplexType *ToComplex = ToType->getAs<ComplexType>(); 2263 if (!ToComplex) 2264 return false; 2265 2266 return IsFloatingPointPromotion(FromComplex->getElementType(), 2267 ToComplex->getElementType()) || 2268 IsIntegralPromotion(nullptr, FromComplex->getElementType(), 2269 ToComplex->getElementType()); 2270 } 2271 2272 /// BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType - In a pointer conversion from 2273 /// the pointer type FromPtr to a pointer to type ToPointee, with the 2274 /// same type qualifiers as FromPtr has on its pointee type. ToType, 2275 /// if non-empty, will be a pointer to ToType that may or may not have 2276 /// the right set of qualifiers on its pointee. 2277 /// 2278 static QualType 2279 BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(const Type *FromPtr, 2280 QualType ToPointee, QualType ToType, 2281 ASTContext &Context, 2282 bool StripObjCLifetime = false) { 2283 assert((FromPtr->getTypeClass() == Type::Pointer || 2284 FromPtr->getTypeClass() == Type::ObjCObjectPointer) && 2285 "Invalid similarly-qualified pointer type"); 2286 2287 /// Conversions to 'id' subsume cv-qualifier conversions. 2288 if (ToType->isObjCIdType() || ToType->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) 2289 return ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 2290 2291 QualType CanonFromPointee 2292 = Context.getCanonicalType(FromPtr->getPointeeType()); 2293 QualType CanonToPointee = Context.getCanonicalType(ToPointee); 2294 Qualifiers Quals = CanonFromPointee.getQualifiers(); 2295 2296 if (StripObjCLifetime) 2297 Quals.removeObjCLifetime(); 2298 2299 // Exact qualifier match -> return the pointer type we're converting to. 2300 if (CanonToPointee.getLocalQualifiers() == Quals) { 2301 // ToType is exactly what we need. Return it. 2302 if (!ToType.isNull()) 2303 return ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 2304 2305 // Build a pointer to ToPointee. It has the right qualifiers 2306 // already. 2307 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(ToType)) 2308 return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(ToPointee); 2309 return Context.getPointerType(ToPointee); 2310 } 2311 2312 // Just build a canonical type that has the right qualifiers. 2313 QualType QualifiedCanonToPointee 2314 = Context.getQualifiedType(CanonToPointee.getLocalUnqualifiedType(), Quals); 2315 2316 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(ToType)) 2317 return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(QualifiedCanonToPointee); 2318 return Context.getPointerType(QualifiedCanonToPointee); 2319 } 2320 2321 static bool isNullPointerConstantForConversion(Expr *Expr, 2322 bool InOverloadResolution, 2323 ASTContext &Context) { 2324 // Handle value-dependent integral null pointer constants correctly. 2325 // http://www.open-std.org/jtc1/sc22/wg21/docs/cwg_active.html#903 2326 if (Expr->isValueDependent() && !Expr->isTypeDependent() && 2327 Expr->getType()->isIntegerType() && !Expr->getType()->isEnumeralType()) 2328 return !InOverloadResolution; 2329 2330 return Expr->isNullPointerConstant(Context, 2331 InOverloadResolution? Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull 2332 : Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull); 2333 } 2334 2335 /// IsPointerConversion - Determines whether the conversion of the 2336 /// expression From, which has the (possibly adjusted) type FromType, 2337 /// can be converted to the type ToType via a pointer conversion (C++ 2338 /// 4.10). If so, returns true and places the converted type (that 2339 /// might differ from ToType in its cv-qualifiers at some level) into 2340 /// ConvertedType. 2341 /// 2342 /// This routine also supports conversions to and from block pointers 2343 /// and conversions with Objective-C's 'id', 'id<protocols...>', and 2344 /// pointers to interfaces. FIXME: Once we've determined the 2345 /// appropriate overloading rules for Objective-C, we may want to 2346 /// split the Objective-C checks into a different routine; however, 2347 /// GCC seems to consider all of these conversions to be pointer 2348 /// conversions, so for now they live here. IncompatibleObjC will be 2349 /// set if the conversion is an allowed Objective-C conversion that 2350 /// should result in a warning. 2351 bool Sema::IsPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType FromType, QualType ToType, 2352 bool InOverloadResolution, 2353 QualType& ConvertedType, 2354 bool &IncompatibleObjC) { 2355 IncompatibleObjC = false; 2356 if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromType, ToType, ConvertedType, 2357 IncompatibleObjC)) 2358 return true; 2359 2360 // Conversion from a null pointer constant to any Objective-C pointer type. 2361 if (ToType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && 2362 isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) { 2363 ConvertedType = ToType; 2364 return true; 2365 } 2366 2367 // Blocks: Block pointers can be converted to void*. 2368 if (FromType->isBlockPointerType() && ToType->isPointerType() && 2369 ToType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) { 2370 ConvertedType = ToType; 2371 return true; 2372 } 2373 // Blocks: A null pointer constant can be converted to a block 2374 // pointer type. 2375 if (ToType->isBlockPointerType() && 2376 isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) { 2377 ConvertedType = ToType; 2378 return true; 2379 } 2380 2381 // If the left-hand-side is nullptr_t, the right side can be a null 2382 // pointer constant. 2383 if (ToType->isNullPtrType() && 2384 isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) { 2385 ConvertedType = ToType; 2386 return true; 2387 } 2388 2389 const PointerType* ToTypePtr = ToType->getAs<PointerType>(); 2390 if (!ToTypePtr) 2391 return false; 2392 2393 // A null pointer constant can be converted to a pointer type (C++ 4.10p1). 2394 if (isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) { 2395 ConvertedType = ToType; 2396 return true; 2397 } 2398 2399 // Beyond this point, both types need to be pointers 2400 // , including objective-c pointers. 2401 QualType ToPointeeType = ToTypePtr->getPointeeType(); 2402 if (FromType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && ToPointeeType->isVoidType() && 2403 !getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) { 2404 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType( 2405 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(), 2406 ToPointeeType, 2407 ToType, Context); 2408 return true; 2409 } 2410 const PointerType *FromTypePtr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>(); 2411 if (!FromTypePtr) 2412 return false; 2413 2414 QualType FromPointeeType = FromTypePtr->getPointeeType(); 2415 2416 // If the unqualified pointee types are the same, this can't be a 2417 // pointer conversion, so don't do all of the work below. 2418 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) 2419 return false; 2420 2421 // An rvalue of type "pointer to cv T," where T is an object type, 2422 // can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to cv void" (C++ 2423 // 4.10p2). 2424 if (FromPointeeType->isIncompleteOrObjectType() && 2425 ToPointeeType->isVoidType()) { 2426 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr, 2427 ToPointeeType, 2428 ToType, Context, 2429 /*StripObjCLifetime=*/true); 2430 return true; 2431 } 2432 2433 // MSVC allows implicit function to void* type conversion. 2434 if (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && FromPointeeType->isFunctionType() && 2435 ToPointeeType->isVoidType()) { 2436 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr, 2437 ToPointeeType, 2438 ToType, Context); 2439 return true; 2440 } 2441 2442 // When we're overloading in C, we allow a special kind of pointer 2443 // conversion for compatible-but-not-identical pointee types. 2444 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 2445 Context.typesAreCompatible(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) { 2446 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr, 2447 ToPointeeType, 2448 ToType, Context); 2449 return true; 2450 } 2451 2452 // C++ [conv.ptr]p3: 2453 // 2454 // An rvalue of type "pointer to cv D," where D is a class type, 2455 // can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to cv B," where 2456 // B is a base class (clause 10) of D. If B is an inaccessible 2457 // (clause 11) or ambiguous (10.2) base class of D, a program that 2458 // necessitates this conversion is ill-formed. The result of the 2459 // conversion is a pointer to the base class sub-object of the 2460 // derived class object. The null pointer value is converted to 2461 // the null pointer value of the destination type. 2462 // 2463 // Note that we do not check for ambiguity or inaccessibility 2464 // here. That is handled by CheckPointerConversion. 2465 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && FromPointeeType->isRecordType() && 2466 ToPointeeType->isRecordType() && 2467 !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType) && 2468 IsDerivedFrom(From->getBeginLoc(), FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) { 2469 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr, 2470 ToPointeeType, 2471 ToType, Context); 2472 return true; 2473 } 2474 2475 if (FromPointeeType->isVectorType() && ToPointeeType->isVectorType() && 2476 Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) { 2477 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr, 2478 ToPointeeType, 2479 ToType, Context); 2480 return true; 2481 } 2482 2483 return false; 2484 } 2485 2486 /// Adopt the given qualifiers for the given type. 2487 static QualType AdoptQualifiers(ASTContext &Context, QualType T, Qualifiers Qs){ 2488 Qualifiers TQs = T.getQualifiers(); 2489 2490 // Check whether qualifiers already match. 2491 if (TQs == Qs) 2492 return T; 2493 2494 if (Qs.compatiblyIncludes(TQs)) 2495 return Context.getQualifiedType(T, Qs); 2496 2497 return Context.getQualifiedType(T.getUnqualifiedType(), Qs); 2498 } 2499 2500 /// isObjCPointerConversion - Determines whether this is an 2501 /// Objective-C pointer conversion. Subroutine of IsPointerConversion, 2502 /// with the same arguments and return values. 2503 bool Sema::isObjCPointerConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType, 2504 QualType& ConvertedType, 2505 bool &IncompatibleObjC) { 2506 if (!getLangOpts().ObjC) 2507 return false; 2508 2509 // The set of qualifiers on the type we're converting from. 2510 Qualifiers FromQualifiers = FromType.getQualifiers(); 2511 2512 // First, we handle all conversions on ObjC object pointer types. 2513 const ObjCObjectPointerType* ToObjCPtr = 2514 ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 2515 const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromObjCPtr = 2516 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 2517 2518 if (ToObjCPtr && FromObjCPtr) { 2519 // If the pointee types are the same (ignoring qualifications), 2520 // then this is not a pointer conversion. 2521 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(), 2522 FromObjCPtr->getPointeeType())) 2523 return false; 2524 2525 // Conversion between Objective-C pointers. 2526 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToObjCPtr, FromObjCPtr)) { 2527 const ObjCInterfaceType* LHS = ToObjCPtr->getInterfaceType(); 2528 const ObjCInterfaceType* RHS = FromObjCPtr->getInterfaceType(); 2529 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && LHS && RHS && 2530 !ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs( 2531 FromObjCPtr->getPointeeType())) 2532 return false; 2533 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromObjCPtr, 2534 ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(), 2535 ToType, Context); 2536 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers); 2537 return true; 2538 } 2539 2540 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr, ToObjCPtr)) { 2541 // Okay: this is some kind of implicit downcast of Objective-C 2542 // interfaces, which is permitted. However, we're going to 2543 // complain about it. 2544 IncompatibleObjC = true; 2545 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromObjCPtr, 2546 ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(), 2547 ToType, Context); 2548 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers); 2549 return true; 2550 } 2551 } 2552 // Beyond this point, both types need to be C pointers or block pointers. 2553 QualType ToPointeeType; 2554 if (const PointerType *ToCPtr = ToType->getAs<PointerType>()) 2555 ToPointeeType = ToCPtr->getPointeeType(); 2556 else if (const BlockPointerType *ToBlockPtr = 2557 ToType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) { 2558 // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a pointer to any object 2559 // to a block pointer type. 2560 if (FromObjCPtr && FromObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) { 2561 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers); 2562 return true; 2563 } 2564 ToPointeeType = ToBlockPtr->getPointeeType(); 2565 } 2566 else if (FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>() && 2567 ToObjCPtr && ToObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) { 2568 // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a block pointer type to a 2569 // pointer to any object. 2570 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers); 2571 return true; 2572 } 2573 else 2574 return false; 2575 2576 QualType FromPointeeType; 2577 if (const PointerType *FromCPtr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) 2578 FromPointeeType = FromCPtr->getPointeeType(); 2579 else if (const BlockPointerType *FromBlockPtr = 2580 FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) 2581 FromPointeeType = FromBlockPtr->getPointeeType(); 2582 else 2583 return false; 2584 2585 // If we have pointers to pointers, recursively check whether this 2586 // is an Objective-C conversion. 2587 if (FromPointeeType->isPointerType() && ToPointeeType->isPointerType() && 2588 isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType, ConvertedType, 2589 IncompatibleObjC)) { 2590 // We always complain about this conversion. 2591 IncompatibleObjC = true; 2592 ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(ConvertedType); 2593 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers); 2594 return true; 2595 } 2596 // Allow conversion of pointee being objective-c pointer to another one; 2597 // as in I* to id. 2598 if (FromPointeeType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>() && 2599 ToPointeeType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>() && 2600 isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType, ConvertedType, 2601 IncompatibleObjC)) { 2602 2603 ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(ConvertedType); 2604 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers); 2605 return true; 2606 } 2607 2608 // If we have pointers to functions or blocks, check whether the only 2609 // differences in the argument and result types are in Objective-C 2610 // pointer conversions. If so, we permit the conversion (but 2611 // complain about it). 2612 const FunctionProtoType *FromFunctionType 2613 = FromPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 2614 const FunctionProtoType *ToFunctionType 2615 = ToPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 2616 if (FromFunctionType && ToFunctionType) { 2617 // If the function types are exactly the same, this isn't an 2618 // Objective-C pointer conversion. 2619 if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromPointeeType) 2620 == Context.getCanonicalType(ToPointeeType)) 2621 return false; 2622 2623 // Perform the quick checks that will tell us whether these 2624 // function types are obviously different. 2625 if (FromFunctionType->getNumParams() != ToFunctionType->getNumParams() || 2626 FromFunctionType->isVariadic() != ToFunctionType->isVariadic() || 2627 FromFunctionType->getMethodQuals() != ToFunctionType->getMethodQuals()) 2628 return false; 2629 2630 bool HasObjCConversion = false; 2631 if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromFunctionType->getReturnType()) == 2632 Context.getCanonicalType(ToFunctionType->getReturnType())) { 2633 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do. 2634 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromFunctionType->getReturnType(), 2635 ToFunctionType->getReturnType(), 2636 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) { 2637 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion. 2638 HasObjCConversion = true; 2639 } else { 2640 // Function types are too different. Abort. 2641 return false; 2642 } 2643 2644 // Check argument types. 2645 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, NumArgs = FromFunctionType->getNumParams(); 2646 ArgIdx != NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) { 2647 QualType FromArgType = FromFunctionType->getParamType(ArgIdx); 2648 QualType ToArgType = ToFunctionType->getParamType(ArgIdx); 2649 if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromArgType) 2650 == Context.getCanonicalType(ToArgType)) { 2651 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do. 2652 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromArgType, ToArgType, 2653 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) { 2654 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion. 2655 HasObjCConversion = true; 2656 } else { 2657 // Argument types are too different. Abort. 2658 return false; 2659 } 2660 } 2661 2662 if (HasObjCConversion) { 2663 // We had an Objective-C conversion. Allow this pointer 2664 // conversion, but complain about it. 2665 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers); 2666 IncompatibleObjC = true; 2667 return true; 2668 } 2669 } 2670 2671 return false; 2672 } 2673 2674 /// Determine whether this is an Objective-C writeback conversion, 2675 /// used for parameter passing when performing automatic reference counting. 2676 /// 2677 /// \param FromType The type we're converting form. 2678 /// 2679 /// \param ToType The type we're converting to. 2680 /// 2681 /// \param ConvertedType The type that will be produced after applying 2682 /// this conversion. 2683 bool Sema::isObjCWritebackConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType, 2684 QualType &ConvertedType) { 2685 if (!getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount || 2686 Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType)) 2687 return false; 2688 2689 // Parameter must be a pointer to __autoreleasing (with no other qualifiers). 2690 QualType ToPointee; 2691 if (const PointerType *ToPointer = ToType->getAs<PointerType>()) 2692 ToPointee = ToPointer->getPointeeType(); 2693 else 2694 return false; 2695 2696 Qualifiers ToQuals = ToPointee.getQualifiers(); 2697 if (!ToPointee->isObjCLifetimeType() || 2698 ToQuals.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing || 2699 !ToQuals.withoutObjCLifetime().empty()) 2700 return false; 2701 2702 // Argument must be a pointer to __strong to __weak. 2703 QualType FromPointee; 2704 if (const PointerType *FromPointer = FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) 2705 FromPointee = FromPointer->getPointeeType(); 2706 else 2707 return false; 2708 2709 Qualifiers FromQuals = FromPointee.getQualifiers(); 2710 if (!FromPointee->isObjCLifetimeType() || 2711 (FromQuals.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Strong && 2712 FromQuals.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Weak)) 2713 return false; 2714 2715 // Make sure that we have compatible qualifiers. 2716 FromQuals.setObjCLifetime(Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing); 2717 if (!ToQuals.compatiblyIncludes(FromQuals)) 2718 return false; 2719 2720 // Remove qualifiers from the pointee type we're converting from; they 2721 // aren't used in the compatibility check belong, and we'll be adding back 2722 // qualifiers (with __autoreleasing) if the compatibility check succeeds. 2723 FromPointee = FromPointee.getUnqualifiedType(); 2724 2725 // The unqualified form of the pointee types must be compatible. 2726 ToPointee = ToPointee.getUnqualifiedType(); 2727 bool IncompatibleObjC; 2728 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(FromPointee, ToPointee)) 2729 FromPointee = ToPointee; 2730 else if (!isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointee, ToPointee, FromPointee, 2731 IncompatibleObjC)) 2732 return false; 2733 2734 /// Construct the type we're converting to, which is a pointer to 2735 /// __autoreleasing pointee. 2736 FromPointee = Context.getQualifiedType(FromPointee, FromQuals); 2737 ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(FromPointee); 2738 return true; 2739 } 2740 2741 bool Sema::IsBlockPointerConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType, 2742 QualType& ConvertedType) { 2743 QualType ToPointeeType; 2744 if (const BlockPointerType *ToBlockPtr = 2745 ToType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) 2746 ToPointeeType = ToBlockPtr->getPointeeType(); 2747 else 2748 return false; 2749 2750 QualType FromPointeeType; 2751 if (const BlockPointerType *FromBlockPtr = 2752 FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) 2753 FromPointeeType = FromBlockPtr->getPointeeType(); 2754 else 2755 return false; 2756 // We have pointer to blocks, check whether the only 2757 // differences in the argument and result types are in Objective-C 2758 // pointer conversions. If so, we permit the conversion. 2759 2760 const FunctionProtoType *FromFunctionType 2761 = FromPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 2762 const FunctionProtoType *ToFunctionType 2763 = ToPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 2764 2765 if (!FromFunctionType || !ToFunctionType) 2766 return false; 2767 2768 if (Context.hasSameType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) 2769 return true; 2770 2771 // Perform the quick checks that will tell us whether these 2772 // function types are obviously different. 2773 if (FromFunctionType->getNumParams() != ToFunctionType->getNumParams() || 2774 FromFunctionType->isVariadic() != ToFunctionType->isVariadic()) 2775 return false; 2776 2777 FunctionType::ExtInfo FromEInfo = FromFunctionType->getExtInfo(); 2778 FunctionType::ExtInfo ToEInfo = ToFunctionType->getExtInfo(); 2779 if (FromEInfo != ToEInfo) 2780 return false; 2781 2782 bool IncompatibleObjC = false; 2783 if (Context.hasSameType(FromFunctionType->getReturnType(), 2784 ToFunctionType->getReturnType())) { 2785 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do. 2786 } else { 2787 QualType RHS = FromFunctionType->getReturnType(); 2788 QualType LHS = ToFunctionType->getReturnType(); 2789 if ((!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || !RHS->isRecordType()) && 2790 !RHS.hasQualifiers() && LHS.hasQualifiers()) 2791 LHS = LHS.getUnqualifiedType(); 2792 2793 if (Context.hasSameType(RHS,LHS)) { 2794 // OK exact match. 2795 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(RHS, LHS, 2796 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) { 2797 if (IncompatibleObjC) 2798 return false; 2799 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion. 2800 } 2801 else 2802 return false; 2803 } 2804 2805 // Check argument types. 2806 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, NumArgs = FromFunctionType->getNumParams(); 2807 ArgIdx != NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) { 2808 IncompatibleObjC = false; 2809 QualType FromArgType = FromFunctionType->getParamType(ArgIdx); 2810 QualType ToArgType = ToFunctionType->getParamType(ArgIdx); 2811 if (Context.hasSameType(FromArgType, ToArgType)) { 2812 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do. 2813 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(ToArgType, FromArgType, 2814 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) { 2815 if (IncompatibleObjC) 2816 return false; 2817 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion. 2818 } else 2819 // Argument types are too different. Abort. 2820 return false; 2821 } 2822 2823 SmallVector<FunctionProtoType::ExtParameterInfo, 4> NewParamInfos; 2824 bool CanUseToFPT, CanUseFromFPT; 2825 if (!Context.mergeExtParameterInfo(ToFunctionType, FromFunctionType, 2826 CanUseToFPT, CanUseFromFPT, 2827 NewParamInfos)) 2828 return false; 2829 2830 ConvertedType = ToType; 2831 return true; 2832 } 2833 2834 enum { 2835 ft_default, 2836 ft_different_class, 2837 ft_parameter_arity, 2838 ft_parameter_mismatch, 2839 ft_return_type, 2840 ft_qualifer_mismatch, 2841 ft_noexcept 2842 }; 2843 2844 /// Attempts to get the FunctionProtoType from a Type. Handles 2845 /// MemberFunctionPointers properly. 2846 static const FunctionProtoType *tryGetFunctionProtoType(QualType FromType) { 2847 if (auto *FPT = FromType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) 2848 return FPT; 2849 2850 if (auto *MPT = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>()) 2851 return MPT->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 2852 2853 return nullptr; 2854 } 2855 2856 /// HandleFunctionTypeMismatch - Gives diagnostic information for differeing 2857 /// function types. Catches different number of parameter, mismatch in 2858 /// parameter types, and different return types. 2859 void Sema::HandleFunctionTypeMismatch(PartialDiagnostic &PDiag, 2860 QualType FromType, QualType ToType) { 2861 // If either type is not valid, include no extra info. 2862 if (FromType.isNull() || ToType.isNull()) { 2863 PDiag << ft_default; 2864 return; 2865 } 2866 2867 // Get the function type from the pointers. 2868 if (FromType->isMemberPointerType() && ToType->isMemberPointerType()) { 2869 const auto *FromMember = FromType->castAs<MemberPointerType>(), 2870 *ToMember = ToType->castAs<MemberPointerType>(); 2871 if (!Context.hasSameType(FromMember->getClass(), ToMember->getClass())) { 2872 PDiag << ft_different_class << QualType(ToMember->getClass(), 0) 2873 << QualType(FromMember->getClass(), 0); 2874 return; 2875 } 2876 FromType = FromMember->getPointeeType(); 2877 ToType = ToMember->getPointeeType(); 2878 } 2879 2880 if (FromType->isPointerType()) 2881 FromType = FromType->getPointeeType(); 2882 if (ToType->isPointerType()) 2883 ToType = ToType->getPointeeType(); 2884 2885 // Remove references. 2886 FromType = FromType.getNonReferenceType(); 2887 ToType = ToType.getNonReferenceType(); 2888 2889 // Don't print extra info for non-specialized template functions. 2890 if (FromType->isInstantiationDependentType() && 2891 !FromType->getAs<TemplateSpecializationType>()) { 2892 PDiag << ft_default; 2893 return; 2894 } 2895 2896 // No extra info for same types. 2897 if (Context.hasSameType(FromType, ToType)) { 2898 PDiag << ft_default; 2899 return; 2900 } 2901 2902 const FunctionProtoType *FromFunction = tryGetFunctionProtoType(FromType), 2903 *ToFunction = tryGetFunctionProtoType(ToType); 2904 2905 // Both types need to be function types. 2906 if (!FromFunction || !ToFunction) { 2907 PDiag << ft_default; 2908 return; 2909 } 2910 2911 if (FromFunction->getNumParams() != ToFunction->getNumParams()) { 2912 PDiag << ft_parameter_arity << ToFunction->getNumParams() 2913 << FromFunction->getNumParams(); 2914 return; 2915 } 2916 2917 // Handle different parameter types. 2918 unsigned ArgPos; 2919 if (!FunctionParamTypesAreEqual(FromFunction, ToFunction, &ArgPos)) { 2920 PDiag << ft_parameter_mismatch << ArgPos + 1 2921 << ToFunction->getParamType(ArgPos) 2922 << FromFunction->getParamType(ArgPos); 2923 return; 2924 } 2925 2926 // Handle different return type. 2927 if (!Context.hasSameType(FromFunction->getReturnType(), 2928 ToFunction->getReturnType())) { 2929 PDiag << ft_return_type << ToFunction->getReturnType() 2930 << FromFunction->getReturnType(); 2931 return; 2932 } 2933 2934 if (FromFunction->getMethodQuals() != ToFunction->getMethodQuals()) { 2935 PDiag << ft_qualifer_mismatch << ToFunction->getMethodQuals() 2936 << FromFunction->getMethodQuals(); 2937 return; 2938 } 2939 2940 // Handle exception specification differences on canonical type (in C++17 2941 // onwards). 2942 if (cast<FunctionProtoType>(FromFunction->getCanonicalTypeUnqualified()) 2943 ->isNothrow() != 2944 cast<FunctionProtoType>(ToFunction->getCanonicalTypeUnqualified()) 2945 ->isNothrow()) { 2946 PDiag << ft_noexcept; 2947 return; 2948 } 2949 2950 // Unable to find a difference, so add no extra info. 2951 PDiag << ft_default; 2952 } 2953 2954 /// FunctionParamTypesAreEqual - This routine checks two function proto types 2955 /// for equality of their argument types. Caller has already checked that 2956 /// they have same number of arguments. If the parameters are different, 2957 /// ArgPos will have the parameter index of the first different parameter. 2958 bool Sema::FunctionParamTypesAreEqual(const FunctionProtoType *OldType, 2959 const FunctionProtoType *NewType, 2960 unsigned *ArgPos) { 2961 for (FunctionProtoType::param_type_iterator O = OldType->param_type_begin(), 2962 N = NewType->param_type_begin(), 2963 E = OldType->param_type_end(); 2964 O && (O != E); ++O, ++N) { 2965 // Ignore address spaces in pointee type. This is to disallow overloading 2966 // on __ptr32/__ptr64 address spaces. 2967 QualType Old = Context.removePtrSizeAddrSpace(O->getUnqualifiedType()); 2968 QualType New = Context.removePtrSizeAddrSpace(N->getUnqualifiedType()); 2969 2970 if (!Context.hasSameType(Old, New)) { 2971 if (ArgPos) 2972 *ArgPos = O - OldType->param_type_begin(); 2973 return false; 2974 } 2975 } 2976 return true; 2977 } 2978 2979 /// CheckPointerConversion - Check the pointer conversion from the 2980 /// expression From to the type ToType. This routine checks for 2981 /// ambiguous or inaccessible derived-to-base pointer 2982 /// conversions for which IsPointerConversion has already returned 2983 /// true. It returns true and produces a diagnostic if there was an 2984 /// error, or returns false otherwise. 2985 bool Sema::CheckPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType, 2986 CastKind &Kind, 2987 CXXCastPath& BasePath, 2988 bool IgnoreBaseAccess, 2989 bool Diagnose) { 2990 QualType FromType = From->getType(); 2991 bool IsCStyleOrFunctionalCast = IgnoreBaseAccess; 2992 2993 Kind = CK_BitCast; 2994 2995 if (Diagnose && !IsCStyleOrFunctionalCast && !FromType->isAnyPointerType() && 2996 From->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull) == 2997 Expr::NPCK_ZeroExpression) { 2998 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(From->getType(), Context.BoolTy)) 2999 DiagRuntimeBehavior(From->getExprLoc(), From, 3000 PDiag(diag::warn_impcast_bool_to_null_pointer) 3001 << ToType << From->getSourceRange()); 3002 else if (!isUnevaluatedContext()) 3003 Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_non_literal_null_pointer) 3004 << ToType << From->getSourceRange(); 3005 } 3006 if (const PointerType *ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<PointerType>()) { 3007 if (const PointerType *FromPtrType = FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) { 3008 QualType FromPointeeType = FromPtrType->getPointeeType(), 3009 ToPointeeType = ToPtrType->getPointeeType(); 3010 3011 if (FromPointeeType->isRecordType() && ToPointeeType->isRecordType() && 3012 !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) { 3013 // We must have a derived-to-base conversion. Check an 3014 // ambiguous or inaccessible conversion. 3015 unsigned InaccessibleID = 0; 3016 unsigned AmbiguousID = 0; 3017 if (Diagnose) { 3018 InaccessibleID = diag::err_upcast_to_inaccessible_base; 3019 AmbiguousID = diag::err_ambiguous_derived_to_base_conv; 3020 } 3021 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion( 3022 FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType, InaccessibleID, AmbiguousID, 3023 From->getExprLoc(), From->getSourceRange(), DeclarationName(), 3024 &BasePath, IgnoreBaseAccess)) 3025 return true; 3026 3027 // The conversion was successful. 3028 Kind = CK_DerivedToBase; 3029 } 3030 3031 if (Diagnose && !IsCStyleOrFunctionalCast && 3032 FromPointeeType->isFunctionType() && ToPointeeType->isVoidType()) { 3033 assert(getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && 3034 "this should only be possible with MSVCCompat!"); 3035 Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::ext_ms_impcast_fn_obj) 3036 << From->getSourceRange(); 3037 } 3038 } 3039 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtrType = 3040 ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) { 3041 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtrType = 3042 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) { 3043 // Objective-C++ conversions are always okay. 3044 // FIXME: We should have a different class of conversions for the 3045 // Objective-C++ implicit conversions. 3046 if (FromPtrType->isObjCBuiltinType() || ToPtrType->isObjCBuiltinType()) 3047 return false; 3048 } else if (FromType->isBlockPointerType()) { 3049 Kind = CK_BlockPointerToObjCPointerCast; 3050 } else { 3051 Kind = CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast; 3052 } 3053 } else if (ToType->isBlockPointerType()) { 3054 if (!FromType->isBlockPointerType()) 3055 Kind = CK_AnyPointerToBlockPointerCast; 3056 } 3057 3058 // We shouldn't fall into this case unless it's valid for other 3059 // reasons. 3060 if (From->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) 3061 Kind = CK_NullToPointer; 3062 3063 return false; 3064 } 3065 3066 /// IsMemberPointerConversion - Determines whether the conversion of the 3067 /// expression From, which has the (possibly adjusted) type FromType, can be 3068 /// converted to the type ToType via a member pointer conversion (C++ 4.11). 3069 /// If so, returns true and places the converted type (that might differ from 3070 /// ToType in its cv-qualifiers at some level) into ConvertedType. 3071 bool Sema::IsMemberPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType FromType, 3072 QualType ToType, 3073 bool InOverloadResolution, 3074 QualType &ConvertedType) { 3075 const MemberPointerType *ToTypePtr = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>(); 3076 if (!ToTypePtr) 3077 return false; 3078 3079 // A null pointer constant can be converted to a member pointer (C++ 4.11p1) 3080 if (From->isNullPointerConstant(Context, 3081 InOverloadResolution? Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull 3082 : Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) { 3083 ConvertedType = ToType; 3084 return true; 3085 } 3086 3087 // Otherwise, both types have to be member pointers. 3088 const MemberPointerType *FromTypePtr = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>(); 3089 if (!FromTypePtr) 3090 return false; 3091 3092 // A pointer to member of B can be converted to a pointer to member of D, 3093 // where D is derived from B (C++ 4.11p2). 3094 QualType FromClass(FromTypePtr->getClass(), 0); 3095 QualType ToClass(ToTypePtr->getClass(), 0); 3096 3097 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromClass, ToClass) && 3098 IsDerivedFrom(From->getBeginLoc(), ToClass, FromClass)) { 3099 ConvertedType = Context.getMemberPointerType(FromTypePtr->getPointeeType(), 3100 ToClass.getTypePtr()); 3101 return true; 3102 } 3103 3104 return false; 3105 } 3106 3107 /// CheckMemberPointerConversion - Check the member pointer conversion from the 3108 /// expression From to the type ToType. This routine checks for ambiguous or 3109 /// virtual or inaccessible base-to-derived member pointer conversions 3110 /// for which IsMemberPointerConversion has already returned true. It returns 3111 /// true and produces a diagnostic if there was an error, or returns false 3112 /// otherwise. 3113 bool Sema::CheckMemberPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType, 3114 CastKind &Kind, 3115 CXXCastPath &BasePath, 3116 bool IgnoreBaseAccess) { 3117 QualType FromType = From->getType(); 3118 const MemberPointerType *FromPtrType = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>(); 3119 if (!FromPtrType) { 3120 // This must be a null pointer to member pointer conversion 3121 assert(From->isNullPointerConstant(Context, 3122 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull) && 3123 "Expr must be null pointer constant!"); 3124 Kind = CK_NullToMemberPointer; 3125 return false; 3126 } 3127 3128 const MemberPointerType *ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>(); 3129 assert(ToPtrType && "No member pointer cast has a target type " 3130 "that is not a member pointer."); 3131 3132 QualType FromClass = QualType(FromPtrType->getClass(), 0); 3133 QualType ToClass = QualType(ToPtrType->getClass(), 0); 3134 3135 // FIXME: What about dependent types? 3136 assert(FromClass->isRecordType() && "Pointer into non-class."); 3137 assert(ToClass->isRecordType() && "Pointer into non-class."); 3138 3139 CXXBasePaths Paths(/*FindAmbiguities=*/true, /*RecordPaths=*/true, 3140 /*DetectVirtual=*/true); 3141 bool DerivationOkay = 3142 IsDerivedFrom(From->getBeginLoc(), ToClass, FromClass, Paths); 3143 assert(DerivationOkay && 3144 "Should not have been called if derivation isn't OK."); 3145 (void)DerivationOkay; 3146 3147 if (Paths.isAmbiguous(Context.getCanonicalType(FromClass). 3148 getUnqualifiedType())) { 3149 std::string PathDisplayStr = getAmbiguousPathsDisplayString(Paths); 3150 Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::err_ambiguous_memptr_conv) 3151 << 0 << FromClass << ToClass << PathDisplayStr << From->getSourceRange(); 3152 return true; 3153 } 3154 3155 if (const RecordType *VBase = Paths.getDetectedVirtual()) { 3156 Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::err_memptr_conv_via_virtual) 3157 << FromClass << ToClass << QualType(VBase, 0) 3158 << From->getSourceRange(); 3159 return true; 3160 } 3161 3162 if (!IgnoreBaseAccess) 3163 CheckBaseClassAccess(From->getExprLoc(), FromClass, ToClass, 3164 Paths.front(), 3165 diag::err_downcast_from_inaccessible_base); 3166 3167 // Must be a base to derived member conversion. 3168 BuildBasePathArray(Paths, BasePath); 3169 Kind = CK_BaseToDerivedMemberPointer; 3170 return false; 3171 } 3172 3173 /// Determine whether the lifetime conversion between the two given 3174 /// qualifiers sets is nontrivial. 3175 static bool isNonTrivialObjCLifetimeConversion(Qualifiers FromQuals, 3176 Qualifiers ToQuals) { 3177 // Converting anything to const __unsafe_unretained is trivial. 3178 if (ToQuals.hasConst() && 3179 ToQuals.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone) 3180 return false; 3181 3182 return true; 3183 } 3184 3185 /// Perform a single iteration of the loop for checking if a qualification 3186 /// conversion is valid. 3187 /// 3188 /// Specifically, check whether any change between the qualifiers of \p 3189 /// FromType and \p ToType is permissible, given knowledge about whether every 3190 /// outer layer is const-qualified. 3191 static bool isQualificationConversionStep(QualType FromType, QualType ToType, 3192 bool CStyle, bool IsTopLevel, 3193 bool &PreviousToQualsIncludeConst, 3194 bool &ObjCLifetimeConversion) { 3195 Qualifiers FromQuals = FromType.getQualifiers(); 3196 Qualifiers ToQuals = ToType.getQualifiers(); 3197 3198 // Ignore __unaligned qualifier if this type is void. 3199 if (ToType.getUnqualifiedType()->isVoidType()) 3200 FromQuals.removeUnaligned(); 3201 3202 // Objective-C ARC: 3203 // Check Objective-C lifetime conversions. 3204 if (FromQuals.getObjCLifetime() != ToQuals.getObjCLifetime()) { 3205 if (ToQuals.compatiblyIncludesObjCLifetime(FromQuals)) { 3206 if (isNonTrivialObjCLifetimeConversion(FromQuals, ToQuals)) 3207 ObjCLifetimeConversion = true; 3208 FromQuals.removeObjCLifetime(); 3209 ToQuals.removeObjCLifetime(); 3210 } else { 3211 // Qualification conversions cannot cast between different 3212 // Objective-C lifetime qualifiers. 3213 return false; 3214 } 3215 } 3216 3217 // Allow addition/removal of GC attributes but not changing GC attributes. 3218 if (FromQuals.getObjCGCAttr() != ToQuals.getObjCGCAttr() && 3219 (!FromQuals.hasObjCGCAttr() || !ToQuals.hasObjCGCAttr())) { 3220 FromQuals.removeObjCGCAttr(); 3221 ToQuals.removeObjCGCAttr(); 3222 } 3223 3224 // -- for every j > 0, if const is in cv 1,j then const is in cv 3225 // 2,j, and similarly for volatile. 3226 if (!CStyle && !ToQuals.compatiblyIncludes(FromQuals)) 3227 return false; 3228 3229 // If address spaces mismatch: 3230 // - in top level it is only valid to convert to addr space that is a 3231 // superset in all cases apart from C-style casts where we allow 3232 // conversions between overlapping address spaces. 3233 // - in non-top levels it is not a valid conversion. 3234 if (ToQuals.getAddressSpace() != FromQuals.getAddressSpace() && 3235 (!IsTopLevel || 3236 !(ToQuals.isAddressSpaceSupersetOf(FromQuals) || 3237 (CStyle && FromQuals.isAddressSpaceSupersetOf(ToQuals))))) 3238 return false; 3239 3240 // -- if the cv 1,j and cv 2,j are different, then const is in 3241 // every cv for 0 < k < j. 3242 if (!CStyle && FromQuals.getCVRQualifiers() != ToQuals.getCVRQualifiers() && 3243 !PreviousToQualsIncludeConst) 3244 return false; 3245 3246 // Keep track of whether all prior cv-qualifiers in the "to" type 3247 // include const. 3248 PreviousToQualsIncludeConst = 3249 PreviousToQualsIncludeConst && ToQuals.hasConst(); 3250 return true; 3251 } 3252 3253 /// IsQualificationConversion - Determines whether the conversion from 3254 /// an rvalue of type FromType to ToType is a qualification conversion 3255 /// (C++ 4.4). 3256 /// 3257 /// \param ObjCLifetimeConversion Output parameter that will be set to indicate 3258 /// when the qualification conversion involves a change in the Objective-C 3259 /// object lifetime. 3260 bool 3261 Sema::IsQualificationConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType, 3262 bool CStyle, bool &ObjCLifetimeConversion) { 3263 FromType = Context.getCanonicalType(FromType); 3264 ToType = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType); 3265 ObjCLifetimeConversion = false; 3266 3267 // If FromType and ToType are the same type, this is not a 3268 // qualification conversion. 3269 if (FromType.getUnqualifiedType() == ToType.getUnqualifiedType()) 3270 return false; 3271 3272 // (C++ 4.4p4): 3273 // A conversion can add cv-qualifiers at levels other than the first 3274 // in multi-level pointers, subject to the following rules: [...] 3275 bool PreviousToQualsIncludeConst = true; 3276 bool UnwrappedAnyPointer = false; 3277 while (Context.UnwrapSimilarTypes(FromType, ToType)) { 3278 if (!isQualificationConversionStep( 3279 FromType, ToType, CStyle, !UnwrappedAnyPointer, 3280 PreviousToQualsIncludeConst, ObjCLifetimeConversion)) 3281 return false; 3282 UnwrappedAnyPointer = true; 3283 } 3284 3285 // We are left with FromType and ToType being the pointee types 3286 // after unwrapping the original FromType and ToType the same number 3287 // of times. If we unwrapped any pointers, and if FromType and 3288 // ToType have the same unqualified type (since we checked 3289 // qualifiers above), then this is a qualification conversion. 3290 return UnwrappedAnyPointer && Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType,ToType); 3291 } 3292 3293 /// - Determine whether this is a conversion from a scalar type to an 3294 /// atomic type. 3295 /// 3296 /// If successful, updates \c SCS's second and third steps in the conversion 3297 /// sequence to finish the conversion. 3298 static bool tryAtomicConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 3299 bool InOverloadResolution, 3300 StandardConversionSequence &SCS, 3301 bool CStyle) { 3302 const AtomicType *ToAtomic = ToType->getAs<AtomicType>(); 3303 if (!ToAtomic) 3304 return false; 3305 3306 StandardConversionSequence InnerSCS; 3307 if (!IsStandardConversion(S, From, ToAtomic->getValueType(), 3308 InOverloadResolution, InnerSCS, 3309 CStyle, /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false)) 3310 return false; 3311 3312 SCS.Second = InnerSCS.Second; 3313 SCS.setToType(1, InnerSCS.getToType(1)); 3314 SCS.Third = InnerSCS.Third; 3315 SCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime 3316 = InnerSCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime; 3317 SCS.setToType(2, InnerSCS.getToType(2)); 3318 return true; 3319 } 3320 3321 static bool isFirstArgumentCompatibleWithType(ASTContext &Context, 3322 CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor, 3323 QualType Type) { 3324 const auto *CtorType = Constructor->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 3325 if (CtorType->getNumParams() > 0) { 3326 QualType FirstArg = CtorType->getParamType(0); 3327 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Type, FirstArg.getNonReferenceType())) 3328 return true; 3329 } 3330 return false; 3331 } 3332 3333 static OverloadingResult 3334 IsInitializerListConstructorConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 3335 CXXRecordDecl *To, 3336 UserDefinedConversionSequence &User, 3337 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, 3338 bool AllowExplicit) { 3339 CandidateSet.clear(OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_InitByUserDefinedConversion); 3340 for (auto *D : S.LookupConstructors(To)) { 3341 auto Info = getConstructorInfo(D); 3342 if (!Info) 3343 continue; 3344 3345 bool Usable = !Info.Constructor->isInvalidDecl() && 3346 S.isInitListConstructor(Info.Constructor); 3347 if (Usable) { 3348 // If the first argument is (a reference to) the target type, 3349 // suppress conversions. 3350 bool SuppressUserConversions = isFirstArgumentCompatibleWithType( 3351 S.Context, Info.Constructor, ToType); 3352 if (Info.ConstructorTmpl) 3353 S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(Info.ConstructorTmpl, Info.FoundDecl, 3354 /*ExplicitArgs*/ nullptr, From, 3355 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions, 3356 /*PartialOverloading*/ false, 3357 AllowExplicit); 3358 else 3359 S.AddOverloadCandidate(Info.Constructor, Info.FoundDecl, From, 3360 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions, 3361 /*PartialOverloading*/ false, AllowExplicit); 3362 } 3363 } 3364 3365 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1); 3366 3367 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 3368 switch (auto Result = 3369 CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, From->getBeginLoc(), Best)) { 3370 case OR_Deleted: 3371 case OR_Success: { 3372 // Record the standard conversion we used and the conversion function. 3373 CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Best->Function); 3374 QualType ThisType = Constructor->getThisType(); 3375 // Initializer lists don't have conversions as such. 3376 User.Before.setAsIdentityConversion(); 3377 User.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates; 3378 User.ConversionFunction = Constructor; 3379 User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl; 3380 User.After.setAsIdentityConversion(); 3381 User.After.setFromType(ThisType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()); 3382 User.After.setAllToTypes(ToType); 3383 return Result; 3384 } 3385 3386 case OR_No_Viable_Function: 3387 return OR_No_Viable_Function; 3388 case OR_Ambiguous: 3389 return OR_Ambiguous; 3390 } 3391 3392 llvm_unreachable("Invalid OverloadResult!"); 3393 } 3394 3395 /// Determines whether there is a user-defined conversion sequence 3396 /// (C++ [over.ics.user]) that converts expression From to the type 3397 /// ToType. If such a conversion exists, User will contain the 3398 /// user-defined conversion sequence that performs such a conversion 3399 /// and this routine will return true. Otherwise, this routine returns 3400 /// false and User is unspecified. 3401 /// 3402 /// \param AllowExplicit true if the conversion should consider C++0x 3403 /// "explicit" conversion functions as well as non-explicit conversion 3404 /// functions (C++0x [class.conv.fct]p2). 3405 /// 3406 /// \param AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit true if the conversion should 3407 /// allow an extra Objective-C pointer conversion on uses of explicit 3408 /// constructors. Requires \c AllowExplicit to also be set. 3409 static OverloadingResult 3410 IsUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 3411 UserDefinedConversionSequence &User, 3412 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, 3413 AllowedExplicit AllowExplicit, 3414 bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit) { 3415 assert(AllowExplicit != AllowedExplicit::None || 3416 !AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit); 3417 CandidateSet.clear(OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_InitByUserDefinedConversion); 3418 3419 // Whether we will only visit constructors. 3420 bool ConstructorsOnly = false; 3421 3422 // If the type we are conversion to is a class type, enumerate its 3423 // constructors. 3424 if (const RecordType *ToRecordType = ToType->getAs<RecordType>()) { 3425 // C++ [over.match.ctor]p1: 3426 // When objects of class type are direct-initialized (8.5), or 3427 // copy-initialized from an expression of the same or a 3428 // derived class type (8.5), overload resolution selects the 3429 // constructor. [...] For copy-initialization, the candidate 3430 // functions are all the converting constructors (12.3.1) of 3431 // that class. The argument list is the expression-list within 3432 // the parentheses of the initializer. 3433 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType, From->getType()) || 3434 (From->getType()->getAs<RecordType>() && 3435 S.IsDerivedFrom(From->getBeginLoc(), From->getType(), ToType))) 3436 ConstructorsOnly = true; 3437 3438 if (!S.isCompleteType(From->getExprLoc(), ToType)) { 3439 // We're not going to find any constructors. 3440 } else if (CXXRecordDecl *ToRecordDecl 3441 = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(ToRecordType->getDecl())) { 3442 3443 Expr **Args = &From; 3444 unsigned NumArgs = 1; 3445 bool ListInitializing = false; 3446 if (InitListExpr *InitList = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(From)) { 3447 // But first, see if there is an init-list-constructor that will work. 3448 OverloadingResult Result = IsInitializerListConstructorConversion( 3449 S, From, ToType, ToRecordDecl, User, CandidateSet, 3450 AllowExplicit == AllowedExplicit::All); 3451 if (Result != OR_No_Viable_Function) 3452 return Result; 3453 // Never mind. 3454 CandidateSet.clear( 3455 OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_InitByUserDefinedConversion); 3456 3457 // If we're list-initializing, we pass the individual elements as 3458 // arguments, not the entire list. 3459 Args = InitList->getInits(); 3460 NumArgs = InitList->getNumInits(); 3461 ListInitializing = true; 3462 } 3463 3464 for (auto *D : S.LookupConstructors(ToRecordDecl)) { 3465 auto Info = getConstructorInfo(D); 3466 if (!Info) 3467 continue; 3468 3469 bool Usable = !Info.Constructor->isInvalidDecl(); 3470 if (!ListInitializing) 3471 Usable = Usable && Info.Constructor->isConvertingConstructor( 3472 /*AllowExplicit*/ true); 3473 if (Usable) { 3474 bool SuppressUserConversions = !ConstructorsOnly; 3475 if (SuppressUserConversions && ListInitializing) { 3476 SuppressUserConversions = false; 3477 if (NumArgs == 1) { 3478 // If the first argument is (a reference to) the target type, 3479 // suppress conversions. 3480 SuppressUserConversions = isFirstArgumentCompatibleWithType( 3481 S.Context, Info.Constructor, ToType); 3482 } 3483 } 3484 if (Info.ConstructorTmpl) 3485 S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate( 3486 Info.ConstructorTmpl, Info.FoundDecl, 3487 /*ExplicitArgs*/ nullptr, llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs), 3488 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions, 3489 /*PartialOverloading*/ false, 3490 AllowExplicit == AllowedExplicit::All); 3491 else 3492 // Allow one user-defined conversion when user specifies a 3493 // From->ToType conversion via an static cast (c-style, etc). 3494 S.AddOverloadCandidate(Info.Constructor, Info.FoundDecl, 3495 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs), 3496 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions, 3497 /*PartialOverloading*/ false, 3498 AllowExplicit == AllowedExplicit::All); 3499 } 3500 } 3501 } 3502 } 3503 3504 // Enumerate conversion functions, if we're allowed to. 3505 if (ConstructorsOnly || isa<InitListExpr>(From)) { 3506 } else if (!S.isCompleteType(From->getBeginLoc(), From->getType())) { 3507 // No conversion functions from incomplete types. 3508 } else if (const RecordType *FromRecordType = 3509 From->getType()->getAs<RecordType>()) { 3510 if (CXXRecordDecl *FromRecordDecl 3511 = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FromRecordType->getDecl())) { 3512 // Add all of the conversion functions as candidates. 3513 const auto &Conversions = FromRecordDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions(); 3514 for (auto I = Conversions.begin(), E = Conversions.end(); I != E; ++I) { 3515 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = I.getPair(); 3516 NamedDecl *D = FoundDecl.getDecl(); 3517 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext()); 3518 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D)) 3519 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl(); 3520 3521 CXXConversionDecl *Conv; 3522 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate; 3523 if ((ConvTemplate = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))) 3524 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl()); 3525 else 3526 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D); 3527 3528 if (ConvTemplate) 3529 S.AddTemplateConversionCandidate( 3530 ConvTemplate, FoundDecl, ActingContext, From, ToType, 3531 CandidateSet, AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit, 3532 AllowExplicit != AllowedExplicit::None); 3533 else 3534 S.AddConversionCandidate(Conv, FoundDecl, ActingContext, From, ToType, 3535 CandidateSet, AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit, 3536 AllowExplicit != AllowedExplicit::None); 3537 } 3538 } 3539 } 3540 3541 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1); 3542 3543 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 3544 switch (auto Result = 3545 CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, From->getBeginLoc(), Best)) { 3546 case OR_Success: 3547 case OR_Deleted: 3548 // Record the standard conversion we used and the conversion function. 3549 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor 3550 = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Best->Function)) { 3551 // C++ [over.ics.user]p1: 3552 // If the user-defined conversion is specified by a 3553 // constructor (12.3.1), the initial standard conversion 3554 // sequence converts the source type to the type required by 3555 // the argument of the constructor. 3556 // 3557 QualType ThisType = Constructor->getThisType(); 3558 if (isa<InitListExpr>(From)) { 3559 // Initializer lists don't have conversions as such. 3560 User.Before.setAsIdentityConversion(); 3561 } else { 3562 if (Best->Conversions[0].isEllipsis()) 3563 User.EllipsisConversion = true; 3564 else { 3565 User.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard; 3566 User.EllipsisConversion = false; 3567 } 3568 } 3569 User.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates; 3570 User.ConversionFunction = Constructor; 3571 User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl; 3572 User.After.setAsIdentityConversion(); 3573 User.After.setFromType(ThisType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()); 3574 User.After.setAllToTypes(ToType); 3575 return Result; 3576 } 3577 if (CXXConversionDecl *Conversion 3578 = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Best->Function)) { 3579 // C++ [over.ics.user]p1: 3580 // 3581 // [...] If the user-defined conversion is specified by a 3582 // conversion function (12.3.2), the initial standard 3583 // conversion sequence converts the source type to the 3584 // implicit object parameter of the conversion function. 3585 User.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard; 3586 User.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates; 3587 User.ConversionFunction = Conversion; 3588 User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl; 3589 User.EllipsisConversion = false; 3590 3591 // C++ [over.ics.user]p2: 3592 // The second standard conversion sequence converts the 3593 // result of the user-defined conversion to the target type 3594 // for the sequence. Since an implicit conversion sequence 3595 // is an initialization, the special rules for 3596 // initialization by user-defined conversion apply when 3597 // selecting the best user-defined conversion for a 3598 // user-defined conversion sequence (see 13.3.3 and 3599 // 13.3.3.1). 3600 User.After = Best->FinalConversion; 3601 return Result; 3602 } 3603 llvm_unreachable("Not a constructor or conversion function?"); 3604 3605 case OR_No_Viable_Function: 3606 return OR_No_Viable_Function; 3607 3608 case OR_Ambiguous: 3609 return OR_Ambiguous; 3610 } 3611 3612 llvm_unreachable("Invalid OverloadResult!"); 3613 } 3614 3615 bool 3616 Sema::DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType) { 3617 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS; 3618 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(From->getExprLoc(), 3619 OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal); 3620 OverloadingResult OvResult = 3621 IsUserDefinedConversion(*this, From, ToType, ICS.UserDefined, 3622 CandidateSet, AllowedExplicit::None, false); 3623 3624 if (!(OvResult == OR_Ambiguous || 3625 (OvResult == OR_No_Viable_Function && !CandidateSet.empty()))) 3626 return false; 3627 3628 auto Cands = CandidateSet.CompleteCandidates( 3629 *this, 3630 OvResult == OR_Ambiguous ? OCD_AmbiguousCandidates : OCD_AllCandidates, 3631 From); 3632 if (OvResult == OR_Ambiguous) 3633 Diag(From->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_typecheck_ambiguous_condition) 3634 << From->getType() << ToType << From->getSourceRange(); 3635 else { // OR_No_Viable_Function && !CandidateSet.empty() 3636 if (!RequireCompleteType(From->getBeginLoc(), ToType, 3637 diag::err_typecheck_nonviable_condition_incomplete, 3638 From->getType(), From->getSourceRange())) 3639 Diag(From->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_typecheck_nonviable_condition) 3640 << false << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << ToType; 3641 } 3642 3643 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates( 3644 *this, From, Cands); 3645 return true; 3646 } 3647 3648 /// Compare the user-defined conversion functions or constructors 3649 /// of two user-defined conversion sequences to determine whether any ordering 3650 /// is possible. 3651 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind 3652 compareConversionFunctions(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *Function1, 3653 FunctionDecl *Function2) { 3654 if (!S.getLangOpts().ObjC || !S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) 3655 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3656 3657 // Objective-C++: 3658 // If both conversion functions are implicitly-declared conversions from 3659 // a lambda closure type to a function pointer and a block pointer, 3660 // respectively, always prefer the conversion to a function pointer, 3661 // because the function pointer is more lightweight and is more likely 3662 // to keep code working. 3663 CXXConversionDecl *Conv1 = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXConversionDecl>(Function1); 3664 if (!Conv1) 3665 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3666 3667 CXXConversionDecl *Conv2 = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Function2); 3668 if (!Conv2) 3669 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3670 3671 if (Conv1->getParent()->isLambda() && Conv2->getParent()->isLambda()) { 3672 bool Block1 = Conv1->getConversionType()->isBlockPointerType(); 3673 bool Block2 = Conv2->getConversionType()->isBlockPointerType(); 3674 if (Block1 != Block2) 3675 return Block1 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse 3676 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3677 } 3678 3679 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3680 } 3681 3682 static bool hasDeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtrConversion( 3683 const ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS) { 3684 return (ICS.isStandard() && ICS.Standard.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr) || 3685 (ICS.isUserDefined() && 3686 ICS.UserDefined.Before.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr); 3687 } 3688 3689 /// CompareImplicitConversionSequences - Compare two implicit 3690 /// conversion sequences to determine whether one is better than the 3691 /// other or if they are indistinguishable (C++ 13.3.3.2). 3692 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind 3693 CompareImplicitConversionSequences(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 3694 const ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS1, 3695 const ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS2) 3696 { 3697 // (C++ 13.3.3.2p2): When comparing the basic forms of implicit 3698 // conversion sequences (as defined in 13.3.3.1) 3699 // -- a standard conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.1) is a better 3700 // conversion sequence than a user-defined conversion sequence or 3701 // an ellipsis conversion sequence, and 3702 // -- a user-defined conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.2) is a better 3703 // conversion sequence than an ellipsis conversion sequence 3704 // (13.3.3.1.3). 3705 // 3706 // C++0x [over.best.ics]p10: 3707 // For the purpose of ranking implicit conversion sequences as 3708 // described in 13.3.3.2, the ambiguous conversion sequence is 3709 // treated as a user-defined sequence that is indistinguishable 3710 // from any other user-defined conversion sequence. 3711 3712 // String literal to 'char *' conversion has been deprecated in C++03. It has 3713 // been removed from C++11. We still accept this conversion, if it happens at 3714 // the best viable function. Otherwise, this conversion is considered worse 3715 // than ellipsis conversion. Consider this as an extension; this is not in the 3716 // standard. For example: 3717 // 3718 // int &f(...); // #1 3719 // void f(char*); // #2 3720 // void g() { int &r = f("foo"); } 3721 // 3722 // In C++03, we pick #2 as the best viable function. 3723 // In C++11, we pick #1 as the best viable function, because ellipsis 3724 // conversion is better than string-literal to char* conversion (since there 3725 // is no such conversion in C++11). If there was no #1 at all or #1 couldn't 3726 // convert arguments, #2 would be the best viable function in C++11. 3727 // If the best viable function has this conversion, a warning will be issued 3728 // in C++03, or an ExtWarn (+SFINAE failure) will be issued in C++11. 3729 3730 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && !S.getLangOpts().WritableStrings && 3731 hasDeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtrConversion(ICS1) != 3732 hasDeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtrConversion(ICS2)) 3733 return hasDeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtrConversion(ICS1) 3734 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse 3735 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3736 3737 if (ICS1.getKindRank() < ICS2.getKindRank()) 3738 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3739 if (ICS2.getKindRank() < ICS1.getKindRank()) 3740 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3741 3742 // The following checks require both conversion sequences to be of 3743 // the same kind. 3744 if (ICS1.getKind() != ICS2.getKind()) 3745 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3746 3747 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result = 3748 ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3749 3750 // Two implicit conversion sequences of the same form are 3751 // indistinguishable conversion sequences unless one of the 3752 // following rules apply: (C++ 13.3.3.2p3): 3753 3754 // List-initialization sequence L1 is a better conversion sequence than 3755 // list-initialization sequence L2 if: 3756 // - L1 converts to std::initializer_list<X> for some X and L2 does not, or, 3757 // if not that, 3758 // - L1 converts to type "array of N1 T", L2 converts to type "array of N2 T", 3759 // and N1 is smaller than N2., 3760 // even if one of the other rules in this paragraph would otherwise apply. 3761 if (!ICS1.isBad()) { 3762 if (ICS1.isStdInitializerListElement() && 3763 !ICS2.isStdInitializerListElement()) 3764 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3765 if (!ICS1.isStdInitializerListElement() && 3766 ICS2.isStdInitializerListElement()) 3767 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3768 } 3769 3770 if (ICS1.isStandard()) 3771 // Standard conversion sequence S1 is a better conversion sequence than 3772 // standard conversion sequence S2 if [...] 3773 Result = CompareStandardConversionSequences(S, Loc, 3774 ICS1.Standard, ICS2.Standard); 3775 else if (ICS1.isUserDefined()) { 3776 // User-defined conversion sequence U1 is a better conversion 3777 // sequence than another user-defined conversion sequence U2 if 3778 // they contain the same user-defined conversion function or 3779 // constructor and if the second standard conversion sequence of 3780 // U1 is better than the second standard conversion sequence of 3781 // U2 (C++ 13.3.3.2p3). 3782 if (ICS1.UserDefined.ConversionFunction == 3783 ICS2.UserDefined.ConversionFunction) 3784 Result = CompareStandardConversionSequences(S, Loc, 3785 ICS1.UserDefined.After, 3786 ICS2.UserDefined.After); 3787 else 3788 Result = compareConversionFunctions(S, 3789 ICS1.UserDefined.ConversionFunction, 3790 ICS2.UserDefined.ConversionFunction); 3791 } 3792 3793 return Result; 3794 } 3795 3796 // Per 13.3.3.2p3, compare the given standard conversion sequences to 3797 // determine if one is a proper subset of the other. 3798 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind 3799 compareStandardConversionSubsets(ASTContext &Context, 3800 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1, 3801 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) { 3802 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result 3803 = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3804 3805 // the identity conversion sequence is considered to be a subsequence of 3806 // any non-identity conversion sequence 3807 if (SCS1.isIdentityConversion() && !SCS2.isIdentityConversion()) 3808 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3809 else if (!SCS1.isIdentityConversion() && SCS2.isIdentityConversion()) 3810 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3811 3812 if (SCS1.Second != SCS2.Second) { 3813 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Identity) 3814 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3815 else if (SCS2.Second == ICK_Identity) 3816 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3817 else 3818 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3819 } else if (!Context.hasSimilarType(SCS1.getToType(1), SCS2.getToType(1))) 3820 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3821 3822 if (SCS1.Third == SCS2.Third) { 3823 return Context.hasSameType(SCS1.getToType(2), SCS2.getToType(2))? Result 3824 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3825 } 3826 3827 if (SCS1.Third == ICK_Identity) 3828 return Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse 3829 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable 3830 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3831 3832 if (SCS2.Third == ICK_Identity) 3833 return Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Better 3834 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable 3835 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3836 3837 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3838 } 3839 3840 /// Determine whether one of the given reference bindings is better 3841 /// than the other based on what kind of bindings they are. 3842 static bool 3843 isBetterReferenceBindingKind(const StandardConversionSequence &SCS1, 3844 const StandardConversionSequence &SCS2) { 3845 // C++0x [over.ics.rank]p3b4: 3846 // -- S1 and S2 are reference bindings (8.5.3) and neither refers to an 3847 // implicit object parameter of a non-static member function declared 3848 // without a ref-qualifier, and *either* S1 binds an rvalue reference 3849 // to an rvalue and S2 binds an lvalue reference *or S1 binds an 3850 // lvalue reference to a function lvalue and S2 binds an rvalue 3851 // reference*. 3852 // 3853 // FIXME: Rvalue references. We're going rogue with the above edits, 3854 // because the semantics in the current C++0x working paper (N3225 at the 3855 // time of this writing) break the standard definition of std::forward 3856 // and std::reference_wrapper when dealing with references to functions. 3857 // Proposed wording changes submitted to CWG for consideration. 3858 if (SCS1.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier || 3859 SCS2.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier) 3860 return false; 3861 3862 return (!SCS1.IsLvalueReference && SCS1.BindsToRvalue && 3863 SCS2.IsLvalueReference) || 3864 (SCS1.IsLvalueReference && SCS1.BindsToFunctionLvalue && 3865 !SCS2.IsLvalueReference && SCS2.BindsToFunctionLvalue); 3866 } 3867 3868 enum class FixedEnumPromotion { 3869 None, 3870 ToUnderlyingType, 3871 ToPromotedUnderlyingType 3872 }; 3873 3874 /// Returns kind of fixed enum promotion the \a SCS uses. 3875 static FixedEnumPromotion 3876 getFixedEnumPromtion(Sema &S, const StandardConversionSequence &SCS) { 3877 3878 if (SCS.Second != ICK_Integral_Promotion) 3879 return FixedEnumPromotion::None; 3880 3881 QualType FromType = SCS.getFromType(); 3882 if (!FromType->isEnumeralType()) 3883 return FixedEnumPromotion::None; 3884 3885 EnumDecl *Enum = FromType->getAs<EnumType>()->getDecl(); 3886 if (!Enum->isFixed()) 3887 return FixedEnumPromotion::None; 3888 3889 QualType UnderlyingType = Enum->getIntegerType(); 3890 if (S.Context.hasSameType(SCS.getToType(1), UnderlyingType)) 3891 return FixedEnumPromotion::ToUnderlyingType; 3892 3893 return FixedEnumPromotion::ToPromotedUnderlyingType; 3894 } 3895 3896 /// CompareStandardConversionSequences - Compare two standard 3897 /// conversion sequences to determine whether one is better than the 3898 /// other or if they are indistinguishable (C++ 13.3.3.2p3). 3899 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind 3900 CompareStandardConversionSequences(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 3901 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1, 3902 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) 3903 { 3904 // Standard conversion sequence S1 is a better conversion sequence 3905 // than standard conversion sequence S2 if (C++ 13.3.3.2p3): 3906 3907 // -- S1 is a proper subsequence of S2 (comparing the conversion 3908 // sequences in the canonical form defined by 13.3.3.1.1, 3909 // excluding any Lvalue Transformation; the identity conversion 3910 // sequence is considered to be a subsequence of any 3911 // non-identity conversion sequence) or, if not that, 3912 if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind CK 3913 = compareStandardConversionSubsets(S.Context, SCS1, SCS2)) 3914 return CK; 3915 3916 // -- the rank of S1 is better than the rank of S2 (by the rules 3917 // defined below), or, if not that, 3918 ImplicitConversionRank Rank1 = SCS1.getRank(); 3919 ImplicitConversionRank Rank2 = SCS2.getRank(); 3920 if (Rank1 < Rank2) 3921 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3922 else if (Rank2 < Rank1) 3923 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3924 3925 // (C++ 13.3.3.2p4): Two conversion sequences with the same rank 3926 // are indistinguishable unless one of the following rules 3927 // applies: 3928 3929 // A conversion that is not a conversion of a pointer, or 3930 // pointer to member, to bool is better than another conversion 3931 // that is such a conversion. 3932 if (SCS1.isPointerConversionToBool() != SCS2.isPointerConversionToBool()) 3933 return SCS2.isPointerConversionToBool() 3934 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better 3935 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3936 3937 // C++14 [over.ics.rank]p4b2: 3938 // This is retroactively applied to C++11 by CWG 1601. 3939 // 3940 // A conversion that promotes an enumeration whose underlying type is fixed 3941 // to its underlying type is better than one that promotes to the promoted 3942 // underlying type, if the two are different. 3943 FixedEnumPromotion FEP1 = getFixedEnumPromtion(S, SCS1); 3944 FixedEnumPromotion FEP2 = getFixedEnumPromtion(S, SCS2); 3945 if (FEP1 != FixedEnumPromotion::None && FEP2 != FixedEnumPromotion::None && 3946 FEP1 != FEP2) 3947 return FEP1 == FixedEnumPromotion::ToUnderlyingType 3948 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better 3949 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3950 3951 // C++ [over.ics.rank]p4b2: 3952 // 3953 // If class B is derived directly or indirectly from class A, 3954 // conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of B* to 3955 // void*, and conversion of A* to void* is better than conversion 3956 // of B* to void*. 3957 bool SCS1ConvertsToVoid 3958 = SCS1.isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(S.Context); 3959 bool SCS2ConvertsToVoid 3960 = SCS2.isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(S.Context); 3961 if (SCS1ConvertsToVoid != SCS2ConvertsToVoid) { 3962 // Exactly one of the conversion sequences is a conversion to 3963 // a void pointer; it's the worse conversion. 3964 return SCS2ConvertsToVoid ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better 3965 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3966 } else if (!SCS1ConvertsToVoid && !SCS2ConvertsToVoid) { 3967 // Neither conversion sequence converts to a void pointer; compare 3968 // their derived-to-base conversions. 3969 if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind DerivedCK 3970 = CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(S, Loc, SCS1, SCS2)) 3971 return DerivedCK; 3972 } else if (SCS1ConvertsToVoid && SCS2ConvertsToVoid && 3973 !S.Context.hasSameType(SCS1.getFromType(), SCS2.getFromType())) { 3974 // Both conversion sequences are conversions to void 3975 // pointers. Compare the source types to determine if there's an 3976 // inheritance relationship in their sources. 3977 QualType FromType1 = SCS1.getFromType(); 3978 QualType FromType2 = SCS2.getFromType(); 3979 3980 // Adjust the types we're converting from via the array-to-pointer 3981 // conversion, if we need to. 3982 if (SCS1.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer) 3983 FromType1 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType1); 3984 if (SCS2.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer) 3985 FromType2 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType2); 3986 3987 QualType FromPointee1 = FromType1->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType(); 3988 QualType FromPointee2 = FromType2->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType(); 3989 3990 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromPointee2, FromPointee1)) 3991 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3992 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromPointee1, FromPointee2)) 3993 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3994 3995 // Objective-C++: If one interface is more specific than the 3996 // other, it is the better one. 3997 const ObjCObjectPointerType* FromObjCPtr1 3998 = FromType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 3999 const ObjCObjectPointerType* FromObjCPtr2 4000 = FromType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 4001 if (FromObjCPtr1 && FromObjCPtr2) { 4002 bool AssignLeft = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr1, 4003 FromObjCPtr2); 4004 bool AssignRight = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr2, 4005 FromObjCPtr1); 4006 if (AssignLeft != AssignRight) { 4007 return AssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better 4008 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4009 } 4010 } 4011 } 4012 4013 if (SCS1.ReferenceBinding && SCS2.ReferenceBinding) { 4014 // Check for a better reference binding based on the kind of bindings. 4015 if (isBetterReferenceBindingKind(SCS1, SCS2)) 4016 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4017 else if (isBetterReferenceBindingKind(SCS2, SCS1)) 4018 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4019 } 4020 4021 // Compare based on qualification conversions (C++ 13.3.3.2p3, 4022 // bullet 3). 4023 if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind QualCK 4024 = CompareQualificationConversions(S, SCS1, SCS2)) 4025 return QualCK; 4026 4027 if (SCS1.ReferenceBinding && SCS2.ReferenceBinding) { 4028 // C++ [over.ics.rank]p3b4: 4029 // -- S1 and S2 are reference bindings (8.5.3), and the types to 4030 // which the references refer are the same type except for 4031 // top-level cv-qualifiers, and the type to which the reference 4032 // initialized by S2 refers is more cv-qualified than the type 4033 // to which the reference initialized by S1 refers. 4034 QualType T1 = SCS1.getToType(2); 4035 QualType T2 = SCS2.getToType(2); 4036 T1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T1); 4037 T2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2); 4038 Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals; 4039 QualType UnqualT1 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals); 4040 QualType UnqualT2 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals); 4041 if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2) { 4042 // Objective-C++ ARC: If the references refer to objects with different 4043 // lifetimes, prefer bindings that don't change lifetime. 4044 if (SCS1.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding != 4045 SCS2.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding) { 4046 return SCS1.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding 4047 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse 4048 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4049 } 4050 4051 // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the 4052 // type for comparison. 4053 if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals) 4054 T1 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals); 4055 if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals) 4056 T2 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals); 4057 if (T2.isMoreQualifiedThan(T1)) 4058 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4059 if (T1.isMoreQualifiedThan(T2)) 4060 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4061 } 4062 } 4063 4064 // In Microsoft mode, prefer an integral conversion to a 4065 // floating-to-integral conversion if the integral conversion 4066 // is between types of the same size. 4067 // For example: 4068 // void f(float); 4069 // void f(int); 4070 // int main { 4071 // long a; 4072 // f(a); 4073 // } 4074 // Here, MSVC will call f(int) instead of generating a compile error 4075 // as clang will do in standard mode. 4076 if (S.getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && SCS1.Second == ICK_Integral_Conversion && 4077 SCS2.Second == ICK_Floating_Integral && 4078 S.Context.getTypeSize(SCS1.getFromType()) == 4079 S.Context.getTypeSize(SCS1.getToType(2))) 4080 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4081 4082 // Prefer a compatible vector conversion over a lax vector conversion 4083 // For example: 4084 // 4085 // typedef float __v4sf __attribute__((__vector_size__(16))); 4086 // void f(vector float); 4087 // void f(vector signed int); 4088 // int main() { 4089 // __v4sf a; 4090 // f(a); 4091 // } 4092 // Here, we'd like to choose f(vector float) and not 4093 // report an ambiguous call error 4094 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Vector_Conversion && 4095 SCS2.Second == ICK_Vector_Conversion) { 4096 bool SCS1IsCompatibleVectorConversion = S.Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes( 4097 SCS1.getFromType(), SCS1.getToType(2)); 4098 bool SCS2IsCompatibleVectorConversion = S.Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes( 4099 SCS2.getFromType(), SCS2.getToType(2)); 4100 4101 if (SCS1IsCompatibleVectorConversion != SCS2IsCompatibleVectorConversion) 4102 return SCS1IsCompatibleVectorConversion 4103 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better 4104 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4105 } 4106 4107 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_SVE_Vector_Conversion && 4108 SCS2.Second == ICK_SVE_Vector_Conversion) { 4109 bool SCS1IsCompatibleSVEVectorConversion = 4110 S.Context.areCompatibleSveTypes(SCS1.getFromType(), SCS1.getToType(2)); 4111 bool SCS2IsCompatibleSVEVectorConversion = 4112 S.Context.areCompatibleSveTypes(SCS2.getFromType(), SCS2.getToType(2)); 4113 4114 if (SCS1IsCompatibleSVEVectorConversion != 4115 SCS2IsCompatibleSVEVectorConversion) 4116 return SCS1IsCompatibleSVEVectorConversion 4117 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better 4118 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4119 } 4120 4121 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 4122 } 4123 4124 /// CompareQualificationConversions - Compares two standard conversion 4125 /// sequences to determine whether they can be ranked based on their 4126 /// qualification conversions (C++ 13.3.3.2p3 bullet 3). 4127 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind 4128 CompareQualificationConversions(Sema &S, 4129 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1, 4130 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) { 4131 // C++ 13.3.3.2p3: 4132 // -- S1 and S2 differ only in their qualification conversion and 4133 // yield similar types T1 and T2 (C++ 4.4), respectively, and the 4134 // cv-qualification signature of type T1 is a proper subset of 4135 // the cv-qualification signature of type T2, and S1 is not the 4136 // deprecated string literal array-to-pointer conversion (4.2). 4137 if (SCS1.First != SCS2.First || SCS1.Second != SCS2.Second || 4138 SCS1.Third != SCS2.Third || SCS1.Third != ICK_Qualification) 4139 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 4140 4141 // FIXME: the example in the standard doesn't use a qualification 4142 // conversion (!) 4143 QualType T1 = SCS1.getToType(2); 4144 QualType T2 = SCS2.getToType(2); 4145 T1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T1); 4146 T2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2); 4147 assert(!T1->isReferenceType() && !T2->isReferenceType()); 4148 Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals; 4149 QualType UnqualT1 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals); 4150 QualType UnqualT2 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals); 4151 4152 // If the types are the same, we won't learn anything by unwrapping 4153 // them. 4154 if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2) 4155 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 4156 4157 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result 4158 = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 4159 4160 // Objective-C++ ARC: 4161 // Prefer qualification conversions not involving a change in lifetime 4162 // to qualification conversions that do not change lifetime. 4163 if (SCS1.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime != 4164 SCS2.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime) { 4165 Result = SCS1.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime 4166 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse 4167 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4168 } 4169 4170 while (S.Context.UnwrapSimilarTypes(T1, T2)) { 4171 // Within each iteration of the loop, we check the qualifiers to 4172 // determine if this still looks like a qualification 4173 // conversion. Then, if all is well, we unwrap one more level of 4174 // pointers or pointers-to-members and do it all again 4175 // until there are no more pointers or pointers-to-members left 4176 // to unwrap. This essentially mimics what 4177 // IsQualificationConversion does, but here we're checking for a 4178 // strict subset of qualifiers. 4179 if (T1.getQualifiers().withoutObjCLifetime() == 4180 T2.getQualifiers().withoutObjCLifetime()) 4181 // The qualifiers are the same, so this doesn't tell us anything 4182 // about how the sequences rank. 4183 // ObjC ownership quals are omitted above as they interfere with 4184 // the ARC overload rule. 4185 ; 4186 else if (T2.isMoreQualifiedThan(T1)) { 4187 // T1 has fewer qualifiers, so it could be the better sequence. 4188 if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse) 4189 // Neither has qualifiers that are a subset of the other's 4190 // qualifiers. 4191 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 4192 4193 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4194 } else if (T1.isMoreQualifiedThan(T2)) { 4195 // T2 has fewer qualifiers, so it could be the better sequence. 4196 if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Better) 4197 // Neither has qualifiers that are a subset of the other's 4198 // qualifiers. 4199 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 4200 4201 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4202 } else { 4203 // Qualifiers are disjoint. 4204 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 4205 } 4206 4207 // If the types after this point are equivalent, we're done. 4208 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, T2)) 4209 break; 4210 } 4211 4212 // Check that the winning standard conversion sequence isn't using 4213 // the deprecated string literal array to pointer conversion. 4214 switch (Result) { 4215 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better: 4216 if (SCS1.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr) 4217 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 4218 break; 4219 4220 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable: 4221 break; 4222 4223 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse: 4224 if (SCS2.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr) 4225 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 4226 break; 4227 } 4228 4229 return Result; 4230 } 4231 4232 /// CompareDerivedToBaseConversions - Compares two standard conversion 4233 /// sequences to determine whether they can be ranked based on their 4234 /// various kinds of derived-to-base conversions (C++ 4235 /// [over.ics.rank]p4b3). As part of these checks, we also look at 4236 /// conversions between Objective-C interface types. 4237 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind 4238 CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 4239 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1, 4240 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) { 4241 QualType FromType1 = SCS1.getFromType(); 4242 QualType ToType1 = SCS1.getToType(1); 4243 QualType FromType2 = SCS2.getFromType(); 4244 QualType ToType2 = SCS2.getToType(1); 4245 4246 // Adjust the types we're converting from via the array-to-pointer 4247 // conversion, if we need to. 4248 if (SCS1.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer) 4249 FromType1 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType1); 4250 if (SCS2.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer) 4251 FromType2 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType2); 4252 4253 // Canonicalize all of the types. 4254 FromType1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType1); 4255 ToType1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType1); 4256 FromType2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType2); 4257 ToType2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType2); 4258 4259 // C++ [over.ics.rank]p4b3: 4260 // 4261 // If class B is derived directly or indirectly from class A and 4262 // class C is derived directly or indirectly from B, 4263 // 4264 // Compare based on pointer conversions. 4265 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion && 4266 SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion && 4267 /*FIXME: Remove if Objective-C id conversions get their own rank*/ 4268 FromType1->isPointerType() && FromType2->isPointerType() && 4269 ToType1->isPointerType() && ToType2->isPointerType()) { 4270 QualType FromPointee1 = 4271 FromType1->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType(); 4272 QualType ToPointee1 = 4273 ToType1->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType(); 4274 QualType FromPointee2 = 4275 FromType2->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType(); 4276 QualType ToPointee2 = 4277 ToType2->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType(); 4278 4279 // -- conversion of C* to B* is better than conversion of C* to A*, 4280 if (FromPointee1 == FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 != ToPointee2) { 4281 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, ToPointee1, ToPointee2)) 4282 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4283 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, ToPointee2, ToPointee1)) 4284 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4285 } 4286 4287 // -- conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of C* to A*, 4288 if (FromPointee1 != FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 == ToPointee2) { 4289 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromPointee2, FromPointee1)) 4290 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4291 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromPointee1, FromPointee2)) 4292 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4293 } 4294 } else if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion && 4295 SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion) { 4296 const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtr1 4297 = FromType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 4298 const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtr2 4299 = FromType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 4300 const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtr1 4301 = ToType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 4302 const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtr2 4303 = ToType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 4304 4305 if (FromPtr1 && FromPtr2 && ToPtr1 && ToPtr2) { 4306 // Apply the same conversion ranking rules for Objective-C pointer types 4307 // that we do for C++ pointers to class types. However, we employ the 4308 // Objective-C pseudo-subtyping relationship used for assignment of 4309 // Objective-C pointer types. 4310 bool FromAssignLeft 4311 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromPtr1, FromPtr2); 4312 bool FromAssignRight 4313 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromPtr2, FromPtr1); 4314 bool ToAssignLeft 4315 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToPtr1, ToPtr2); 4316 bool ToAssignRight 4317 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToPtr2, ToPtr1); 4318 4319 // A conversion to an a non-id object pointer type or qualified 'id' 4320 // type is better than a conversion to 'id'. 4321 if (ToPtr1->isObjCIdType() && 4322 (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl())) 4323 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4324 if (ToPtr2->isObjCIdType() && 4325 (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl())) 4326 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4327 4328 // A conversion to a non-id object pointer type is better than a 4329 // conversion to a qualified 'id' type 4330 if (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedIdType() && ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl()) 4331 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4332 if (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedIdType() && ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl()) 4333 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4334 4335 // A conversion to an a non-Class object pointer type or qualified 'Class' 4336 // type is better than a conversion to 'Class'. 4337 if (ToPtr1->isObjCClassType() && 4338 (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedClassType() || ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl())) 4339 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4340 if (ToPtr2->isObjCClassType() && 4341 (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedClassType() || ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl())) 4342 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4343 4344 // A conversion to a non-Class object pointer type is better than a 4345 // conversion to a qualified 'Class' type. 4346 if (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedClassType() && ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl()) 4347 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4348 if (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedClassType() && ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl()) 4349 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4350 4351 // -- "conversion of C* to B* is better than conversion of C* to A*," 4352 if (S.Context.hasSameType(FromType1, FromType2) && 4353 !FromPtr1->isObjCIdType() && !FromPtr1->isObjCClassType() && 4354 (ToAssignLeft != ToAssignRight)) { 4355 if (FromPtr1->isSpecialized()) { 4356 // "conversion of B<A> * to B * is better than conversion of B * to 4357 // C *. 4358 bool IsFirstSame = 4359 FromPtr1->getInterfaceDecl() == ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl(); 4360 bool IsSecondSame = 4361 FromPtr1->getInterfaceDecl() == ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl(); 4362 if (IsFirstSame) { 4363 if (!IsSecondSame) 4364 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4365 } else if (IsSecondSame) 4366 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4367 } 4368 return ToAssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse 4369 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4370 } 4371 4372 // -- "conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of C* to A*," 4373 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2) && 4374 (FromAssignLeft != FromAssignRight)) 4375 return FromAssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better 4376 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4377 } 4378 } 4379 4380 // Ranking of member-pointer types. 4381 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Member && SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Member && 4382 FromType1->isMemberPointerType() && FromType2->isMemberPointerType() && 4383 ToType1->isMemberPointerType() && ToType2->isMemberPointerType()) { 4384 const auto *FromMemPointer1 = FromType1->castAs<MemberPointerType>(); 4385 const auto *ToMemPointer1 = ToType1->castAs<MemberPointerType>(); 4386 const auto *FromMemPointer2 = FromType2->castAs<MemberPointerType>(); 4387 const auto *ToMemPointer2 = ToType2->castAs<MemberPointerType>(); 4388 const Type *FromPointeeType1 = FromMemPointer1->getClass(); 4389 const Type *ToPointeeType1 = ToMemPointer1->getClass(); 4390 const Type *FromPointeeType2 = FromMemPointer2->getClass(); 4391 const Type *ToPointeeType2 = ToMemPointer2->getClass(); 4392 QualType FromPointee1 = QualType(FromPointeeType1, 0).getUnqualifiedType(); 4393 QualType ToPointee1 = QualType(ToPointeeType1, 0).getUnqualifiedType(); 4394 QualType FromPointee2 = QualType(FromPointeeType2, 0).getUnqualifiedType(); 4395 QualType ToPointee2 = QualType(ToPointeeType2, 0).getUnqualifiedType(); 4396 // conversion of A::* to B::* is better than conversion of A::* to C::*, 4397 if (FromPointee1 == FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 != ToPointee2) { 4398 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, ToPointee1, ToPointee2)) 4399 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4400 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, ToPointee2, ToPointee1)) 4401 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4402 } 4403 // conversion of B::* to C::* is better than conversion of A::* to C::* 4404 if (ToPointee1 == ToPointee2 && FromPointee1 != FromPointee2) { 4405 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromPointee1, FromPointee2)) 4406 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4407 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromPointee2, FromPointee1)) 4408 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4409 } 4410 } 4411 4412 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Derived_To_Base) { 4413 // -- conversion of C to B is better than conversion of C to A, 4414 // -- binding of an expression of type C to a reference of type 4415 // B& is better than binding an expression of type C to a 4416 // reference of type A&, 4417 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType1, FromType2) && 4418 !S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2)) { 4419 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, ToType1, ToType2)) 4420 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4421 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, ToType2, ToType1)) 4422 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4423 } 4424 4425 // -- conversion of B to A is better than conversion of C to A. 4426 // -- binding of an expression of type B to a reference of type 4427 // A& is better than binding an expression of type C to a 4428 // reference of type A&, 4429 if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType1, FromType2) && 4430 S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2)) { 4431 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromType2, FromType1)) 4432 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4433 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromType1, FromType2)) 4434 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4435 } 4436 } 4437 4438 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 4439 } 4440 4441 /// Determine whether the given type is valid, e.g., it is not an invalid 4442 /// C++ class. 4443 static bool isTypeValid(QualType T) { 4444 if (CXXRecordDecl *Record = T->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) 4445 return !Record->isInvalidDecl(); 4446 4447 return true; 4448 } 4449 4450 static QualType withoutUnaligned(ASTContext &Ctx, QualType T) { 4451 if (!T.getQualifiers().hasUnaligned()) 4452 return T; 4453 4454 Qualifiers Q; 4455 T = Ctx.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T, Q); 4456 Q.removeUnaligned(); 4457 return Ctx.getQualifiedType(T, Q); 4458 } 4459 4460 /// CompareReferenceRelationship - Compare the two types T1 and T2 to 4461 /// determine whether they are reference-compatible, 4462 /// reference-related, or incompatible, for use in C++ initialization by 4463 /// reference (C++ [dcl.ref.init]p4). Neither type can be a reference 4464 /// type, and the first type (T1) is the pointee type of the reference 4465 /// type being initialized. 4466 Sema::ReferenceCompareResult 4467 Sema::CompareReferenceRelationship(SourceLocation Loc, 4468 QualType OrigT1, QualType OrigT2, 4469 ReferenceConversions *ConvOut) { 4470 assert(!OrigT1->isReferenceType() && 4471 "T1 must be the pointee type of the reference type"); 4472 assert(!OrigT2->isReferenceType() && "T2 cannot be a reference type"); 4473 4474 QualType T1 = Context.getCanonicalType(OrigT1); 4475 QualType T2 = Context.getCanonicalType(OrigT2); 4476 Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals; 4477 QualType UnqualT1 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals); 4478 QualType UnqualT2 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals); 4479 4480 ReferenceConversions ConvTmp; 4481 ReferenceConversions &Conv = ConvOut ? *ConvOut : ConvTmp; 4482 Conv = ReferenceConversions(); 4483 4484 // C++2a [dcl.init.ref]p4: 4485 // Given types "cv1 T1" and "cv2 T2," "cv1 T1" is 4486 // reference-related to "cv2 T2" if T1 is similar to T2, or 4487 // T1 is a base class of T2. 4488 // "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with "cv2 T2" if 4489 // a prvalue of type "pointer to cv2 T2" can be converted to the type 4490 // "pointer to cv1 T1" via a standard conversion sequence. 4491 4492 // Check for standard conversions we can apply to pointers: derived-to-base 4493 // conversions, ObjC pointer conversions, and function pointer conversions. 4494 // (Qualification conversions are checked last.) 4495 QualType ConvertedT2; 4496 if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2) { 4497 // Nothing to do. 4498 } else if (isCompleteType(Loc, OrigT2) && 4499 isTypeValid(UnqualT1) && isTypeValid(UnqualT2) && 4500 IsDerivedFrom(Loc, UnqualT2, UnqualT1)) 4501 Conv |= ReferenceConversions::DerivedToBase; 4502 else if (UnqualT1->isObjCObjectOrInterfaceType() && 4503 UnqualT2->isObjCObjectOrInterfaceType() && 4504 Context.canBindObjCObjectType(UnqualT1, UnqualT2)) 4505 Conv |= ReferenceConversions::ObjC; 4506 else if (UnqualT2->isFunctionType() && 4507 IsFunctionConversion(UnqualT2, UnqualT1, ConvertedT2)) { 4508 Conv |= ReferenceConversions::Function; 4509 // No need to check qualifiers; function types don't have them. 4510 return Ref_Compatible; 4511 } 4512 bool ConvertedReferent = Conv != 0; 4513 4514 // We can have a qualification conversion. Compute whether the types are 4515 // similar at the same time. 4516 bool PreviousToQualsIncludeConst = true; 4517 bool TopLevel = true; 4518 do { 4519 if (T1 == T2) 4520 break; 4521 4522 // We will need a qualification conversion. 4523 Conv |= ReferenceConversions::Qualification; 4524 4525 // Track whether we performed a qualification conversion anywhere other 4526 // than the top level. This matters for ranking reference bindings in 4527 // overload resolution. 4528 if (!TopLevel) 4529 Conv |= ReferenceConversions::NestedQualification; 4530 4531 // MS compiler ignores __unaligned qualifier for references; do the same. 4532 T1 = withoutUnaligned(Context, T1); 4533 T2 = withoutUnaligned(Context, T2); 4534 4535 // If we find a qualifier mismatch, the types are not reference-compatible, 4536 // but are still be reference-related if they're similar. 4537 bool ObjCLifetimeConversion = false; 4538 if (!isQualificationConversionStep(T2, T1, /*CStyle=*/false, TopLevel, 4539 PreviousToQualsIncludeConst, 4540 ObjCLifetimeConversion)) 4541 return (ConvertedReferent || Context.hasSimilarType(T1, T2)) 4542 ? Ref_Related 4543 : Ref_Incompatible; 4544 4545 // FIXME: Should we track this for any level other than the first? 4546 if (ObjCLifetimeConversion) 4547 Conv |= ReferenceConversions::ObjCLifetime; 4548 4549 TopLevel = false; 4550 } while (Context.UnwrapSimilarTypes(T1, T2)); 4551 4552 // At this point, if the types are reference-related, we must either have the 4553 // same inner type (ignoring qualifiers), or must have already worked out how 4554 // to convert the referent. 4555 return (ConvertedReferent || Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, T2)) 4556 ? Ref_Compatible 4557 : Ref_Incompatible; 4558 } 4559 4560 /// Look for a user-defined conversion to a value reference-compatible 4561 /// with DeclType. Return true if something definite is found. 4562 static bool 4563 FindConversionForRefInit(Sema &S, ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS, 4564 QualType DeclType, SourceLocation DeclLoc, 4565 Expr *Init, QualType T2, bool AllowRvalues, 4566 bool AllowExplicit) { 4567 assert(T2->isRecordType() && "Can only find conversions of record types."); 4568 auto *T2RecordDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(T2->castAs<RecordType>()->getDecl()); 4569 4570 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet( 4571 DeclLoc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_InitByUserDefinedConversion); 4572 const auto &Conversions = T2RecordDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions(); 4573 for (auto I = Conversions.begin(), E = Conversions.end(); I != E; ++I) { 4574 NamedDecl *D = *I; 4575 CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext()); 4576 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D)) 4577 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl(); 4578 4579 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate 4580 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D); 4581 CXXConversionDecl *Conv; 4582 if (ConvTemplate) 4583 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl()); 4584 else 4585 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D); 4586 4587 if (AllowRvalues) { 4588 // If we are initializing an rvalue reference, don't permit conversion 4589 // functions that return lvalues. 4590 if (!ConvTemplate && DeclType->isRValueReferenceType()) { 4591 const ReferenceType *RefType 4592 = Conv->getConversionType()->getAs<LValueReferenceType>(); 4593 if (RefType && !RefType->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType()) 4594 continue; 4595 } 4596 4597 if (!ConvTemplate && 4598 S.CompareReferenceRelationship( 4599 DeclLoc, 4600 Conv->getConversionType() 4601 .getNonReferenceType() 4602 .getUnqualifiedType(), 4603 DeclType.getNonReferenceType().getUnqualifiedType()) == 4604 Sema::Ref_Incompatible) 4605 continue; 4606 } else { 4607 // If the conversion function doesn't return a reference type, 4608 // it can't be considered for this conversion. An rvalue reference 4609 // is only acceptable if its referencee is a function type. 4610 4611 const ReferenceType *RefType = 4612 Conv->getConversionType()->getAs<ReferenceType>(); 4613 if (!RefType || 4614 (!RefType->isLValueReferenceType() && 4615 !RefType->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType())) 4616 continue; 4617 } 4618 4619 if (ConvTemplate) 4620 S.AddTemplateConversionCandidate( 4621 ConvTemplate, I.getPair(), ActingDC, Init, DeclType, CandidateSet, 4622 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false, AllowExplicit); 4623 else 4624 S.AddConversionCandidate( 4625 Conv, I.getPair(), ActingDC, Init, DeclType, CandidateSet, 4626 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false, AllowExplicit); 4627 } 4628 4629 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1); 4630 4631 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 4632 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, DeclLoc, Best)) { 4633 case OR_Success: 4634 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p1: 4635 // 4636 // [...] If the parameter binds directly to the result of 4637 // applying a conversion function to the argument 4638 // expression, the implicit conversion sequence is a 4639 // user-defined conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.2), with the 4640 // second standard conversion sequence either an identity 4641 // conversion or, if the conversion function returns an 4642 // entity of a type that is a derived class of the parameter 4643 // type, a derived-to-base Conversion. 4644 if (!Best->FinalConversion.DirectBinding) 4645 return false; 4646 4647 ICS.setUserDefined(); 4648 ICS.UserDefined.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard; 4649 ICS.UserDefined.After = Best->FinalConversion; 4650 ICS.UserDefined.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates; 4651 ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction = Best->Function; 4652 ICS.UserDefined.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl; 4653 ICS.UserDefined.EllipsisConversion = false; 4654 assert(ICS.UserDefined.After.ReferenceBinding && 4655 ICS.UserDefined.After.DirectBinding && 4656 "Expected a direct reference binding!"); 4657 return true; 4658 4659 case OR_Ambiguous: 4660 ICS.setAmbiguous(); 4661 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = CandidateSet.begin(); 4662 Cand != CandidateSet.end(); ++Cand) 4663 if (Cand->Best) 4664 ICS.Ambiguous.addConversion(Cand->FoundDecl, Cand->Function); 4665 return true; 4666 4667 case OR_No_Viable_Function: 4668 case OR_Deleted: 4669 // There was no suitable conversion, or we found a deleted 4670 // conversion; continue with other checks. 4671 return false; 4672 } 4673 4674 llvm_unreachable("Invalid OverloadResult!"); 4675 } 4676 4677 /// Compute an implicit conversion sequence for reference 4678 /// initialization. 4679 static ImplicitConversionSequence 4680 TryReferenceInit(Sema &S, Expr *Init, QualType DeclType, 4681 SourceLocation DeclLoc, 4682 bool SuppressUserConversions, 4683 bool AllowExplicit) { 4684 assert(DeclType->isReferenceType() && "Reference init needs a reference"); 4685 4686 // Most paths end in a failed conversion. 4687 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS; 4688 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, Init, DeclType); 4689 4690 QualType T1 = DeclType->castAs<ReferenceType>()->getPointeeType(); 4691 QualType T2 = Init->getType(); 4692 4693 // If the initializer is the address of an overloaded function, try 4694 // to resolve the overloaded function. If all goes well, T2 is the 4695 // type of the resulting function. 4696 if (S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2) == S.Context.OverloadTy) { 4697 DeclAccessPair Found; 4698 if (FunctionDecl *Fn = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(Init, DeclType, 4699 false, Found)) 4700 T2 = Fn->getType(); 4701 } 4702 4703 // Compute some basic properties of the types and the initializer. 4704 bool isRValRef = DeclType->isRValueReferenceType(); 4705 Expr::Classification InitCategory = Init->Classify(S.Context); 4706 4707 Sema::ReferenceConversions RefConv; 4708 Sema::ReferenceCompareResult RefRelationship = 4709 S.CompareReferenceRelationship(DeclLoc, T1, T2, &RefConv); 4710 4711 auto SetAsReferenceBinding = [&](bool BindsDirectly) { 4712 ICS.setStandard(); 4713 ICS.Standard.First = ICK_Identity; 4714 // FIXME: A reference binding can be a function conversion too. We should 4715 // consider that when ordering reference-to-function bindings. 4716 ICS.Standard.Second = (RefConv & Sema::ReferenceConversions::DerivedToBase) 4717 ? ICK_Derived_To_Base 4718 : (RefConv & Sema::ReferenceConversions::ObjC) 4719 ? ICK_Compatible_Conversion 4720 : ICK_Identity; 4721 // FIXME: As a speculative fix to a defect introduced by CWG2352, we rank 4722 // a reference binding that performs a non-top-level qualification 4723 // conversion as a qualification conversion, not as an identity conversion. 4724 ICS.Standard.Third = (RefConv & 4725 Sema::ReferenceConversions::NestedQualification) 4726 ? ICK_Qualification 4727 : ICK_Identity; 4728 ICS.Standard.setFromType(T2); 4729 ICS.Standard.setToType(0, T2); 4730 ICS.Standard.setToType(1, T1); 4731 ICS.Standard.setToType(2, T1); 4732 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true; 4733 ICS.Standard.DirectBinding = BindsDirectly; 4734 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef; 4735 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType(); 4736 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = InitCategory.isRValue(); 4737 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false; 4738 ICS.Standard.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = 4739 (RefConv & Sema::ReferenceConversions::ObjCLifetime) != 0; 4740 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = nullptr; 4741 ICS.Standard.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = false; 4742 }; 4743 4744 // C++0x [dcl.init.ref]p5: 4745 // A reference to type "cv1 T1" is initialized by an expression 4746 // of type "cv2 T2" as follows: 4747 4748 // -- If reference is an lvalue reference and the initializer expression 4749 if (!isRValRef) { 4750 // -- is an lvalue (but is not a bit-field), and "cv1 T1" is 4751 // reference-compatible with "cv2 T2," or 4752 // 4753 // Per C++ [over.ics.ref]p4, we don't check the bit-field property here. 4754 if (InitCategory.isLValue() && RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Compatible) { 4755 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p1: 4756 // When a parameter of reference type binds directly (8.5.3) 4757 // to an argument expression, the implicit conversion sequence 4758 // is the identity conversion, unless the argument expression 4759 // has a type that is a derived class of the parameter type, 4760 // in which case the implicit conversion sequence is a 4761 // derived-to-base Conversion (13.3.3.1). 4762 SetAsReferenceBinding(/*BindsDirectly=*/true); 4763 4764 // Nothing more to do: the inaccessibility/ambiguity check for 4765 // derived-to-base conversions is suppressed when we're 4766 // computing the implicit conversion sequence (C++ 4767 // [over.best.ics]p2). 4768 return ICS; 4769 } 4770 4771 // -- has a class type (i.e., T2 is a class type), where T1 is 4772 // not reference-related to T2, and can be implicitly 4773 // converted to an lvalue of type "cv3 T3," where "cv1 T1" 4774 // is reference-compatible with "cv3 T3" 92) (this 4775 // conversion is selected by enumerating the applicable 4776 // conversion functions (13.3.1.6) and choosing the best 4777 // one through overload resolution (13.3)), 4778 if (!SuppressUserConversions && T2->isRecordType() && 4779 S.isCompleteType(DeclLoc, T2) && 4780 RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible) { 4781 if (FindConversionForRefInit(S, ICS, DeclType, DeclLoc, 4782 Init, T2, /*AllowRvalues=*/false, 4783 AllowExplicit)) 4784 return ICS; 4785 } 4786 } 4787 4788 // -- Otherwise, the reference shall be an lvalue reference to a 4789 // non-volatile const type (i.e., cv1 shall be const), or the reference 4790 // shall be an rvalue reference. 4791 if (!isRValRef && (!T1.isConstQualified() || T1.isVolatileQualified())) 4792 return ICS; 4793 4794 // -- If the initializer expression 4795 // 4796 // -- is an xvalue, class prvalue, array prvalue or function 4797 // lvalue and "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with "cv2 T2", or 4798 if (RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Compatible && 4799 (InitCategory.isXValue() || 4800 (InitCategory.isPRValue() && 4801 (T2->isRecordType() || T2->isArrayType())) || 4802 (InitCategory.isLValue() && T2->isFunctionType()))) { 4803 // In C++11, this is always a direct binding. In C++98/03, it's a direct 4804 // binding unless we're binding to a class prvalue. 4805 // Note: Although xvalues wouldn't normally show up in C++98/03 code, we 4806 // allow the use of rvalue references in C++98/03 for the benefit of 4807 // standard library implementors; therefore, we need the xvalue check here. 4808 SetAsReferenceBinding(/*BindsDirectly=*/S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 || 4809 !(InitCategory.isPRValue() || T2->isRecordType())); 4810 return ICS; 4811 } 4812 4813 // -- has a class type (i.e., T2 is a class type), where T1 is not 4814 // reference-related to T2, and can be implicitly converted to 4815 // an xvalue, class prvalue, or function lvalue of type 4816 // "cv3 T3", where "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with 4817 // "cv3 T3", 4818 // 4819 // then the reference is bound to the value of the initializer 4820 // expression in the first case and to the result of the conversion 4821 // in the second case (or, in either case, to an appropriate base 4822 // class subobject). 4823 if (!SuppressUserConversions && RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible && 4824 T2->isRecordType() && S.isCompleteType(DeclLoc, T2) && 4825 FindConversionForRefInit(S, ICS, DeclType, DeclLoc, 4826 Init, T2, /*AllowRvalues=*/true, 4827 AllowExplicit)) { 4828 // In the second case, if the reference is an rvalue reference 4829 // and the second standard conversion sequence of the 4830 // user-defined conversion sequence includes an lvalue-to-rvalue 4831 // conversion, the program is ill-formed. 4832 if (ICS.isUserDefined() && isRValRef && 4833 ICS.UserDefined.After.First == ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue) 4834 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, Init, DeclType); 4835 4836 return ICS; 4837 } 4838 4839 // A temporary of function type cannot be created; don't even try. 4840 if (T1->isFunctionType()) 4841 return ICS; 4842 4843 // -- Otherwise, a temporary of type "cv1 T1" is created and 4844 // initialized from the initializer expression using the 4845 // rules for a non-reference copy initialization (8.5). The 4846 // reference is then bound to the temporary. If T1 is 4847 // reference-related to T2, cv1 must be the same 4848 // cv-qualification as, or greater cv-qualification than, 4849 // cv2; otherwise, the program is ill-formed. 4850 if (RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Related) { 4851 // If cv1 == cv2 or cv1 is a greater cv-qualified than cv2, then 4852 // we would be reference-compatible or reference-compatible with 4853 // added qualification. But that wasn't the case, so the reference 4854 // initialization fails. 4855 // 4856 // Note that we only want to check address spaces and cvr-qualifiers here. 4857 // ObjC GC, lifetime and unaligned qualifiers aren't important. 4858 Qualifiers T1Quals = T1.getQualifiers(); 4859 Qualifiers T2Quals = T2.getQualifiers(); 4860 T1Quals.removeObjCGCAttr(); 4861 T1Quals.removeObjCLifetime(); 4862 T2Quals.removeObjCGCAttr(); 4863 T2Quals.removeObjCLifetime(); 4864 // MS compiler ignores __unaligned qualifier for references; do the same. 4865 T1Quals.removeUnaligned(); 4866 T2Quals.removeUnaligned(); 4867 if (!T1Quals.compatiblyIncludes(T2Quals)) 4868 return ICS; 4869 } 4870 4871 // If at least one of the types is a class type, the types are not 4872 // related, and we aren't allowed any user conversions, the 4873 // reference binding fails. This case is important for breaking 4874 // recursion, since TryImplicitConversion below will attempt to 4875 // create a temporary through the use of a copy constructor. 4876 if (SuppressUserConversions && RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible && 4877 (T1->isRecordType() || T2->isRecordType())) 4878 return ICS; 4879 4880 // If T1 is reference-related to T2 and the reference is an rvalue 4881 // reference, the initializer expression shall not be an lvalue. 4882 if (RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Related && 4883 isRValRef && Init->Classify(S.Context).isLValue()) 4884 return ICS; 4885 4886 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p2: 4887 // When a parameter of reference type is not bound directly to 4888 // an argument expression, the conversion sequence is the one 4889 // required to convert the argument expression to the 4890 // underlying type of the reference according to 4891 // 13.3.3.1. Conceptually, this conversion sequence corresponds 4892 // to copy-initializing a temporary of the underlying type with 4893 // the argument expression. Any difference in top-level 4894 // cv-qualification is subsumed by the initialization itself 4895 // and does not constitute a conversion. 4896 ICS = TryImplicitConversion(S, Init, T1, SuppressUserConversions, 4897 AllowedExplicit::None, 4898 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, 4899 /*CStyle=*/false, 4900 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false, 4901 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false); 4902 4903 // Of course, that's still a reference binding. 4904 if (ICS.isStandard()) { 4905 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true; 4906 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef; 4907 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false; 4908 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = true; 4909 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false; 4910 ICS.Standard.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false; 4911 } else if (ICS.isUserDefined()) { 4912 const ReferenceType *LValRefType = 4913 ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction->getReturnType() 4914 ->getAs<LValueReferenceType>(); 4915 4916 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p3: 4917 // Except for an implicit object parameter, for which see 13.3.1, a 4918 // standard conversion sequence cannot be formed if it requires [...] 4919 // binding an rvalue reference to an lvalue other than a function 4920 // lvalue. 4921 // Note that the function case is not possible here. 4922 if (DeclType->isRValueReferenceType() && LValRefType) { 4923 // FIXME: This is the wrong BadConversionSequence. The problem is binding 4924 // an rvalue reference to a (non-function) lvalue, not binding an lvalue 4925 // reference to an rvalue! 4926 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue, Init, DeclType); 4927 return ICS; 4928 } 4929 4930 ICS.UserDefined.After.ReferenceBinding = true; 4931 ICS.UserDefined.After.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef; 4932 ICS.UserDefined.After.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false; 4933 ICS.UserDefined.After.BindsToRvalue = !LValRefType; 4934 ICS.UserDefined.After.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false; 4935 ICS.UserDefined.After.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false; 4936 } 4937 4938 return ICS; 4939 } 4940 4941 static ImplicitConversionSequence 4942 TryCopyInitialization(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 4943 bool SuppressUserConversions, 4944 bool InOverloadResolution, 4945 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion, 4946 bool AllowExplicit = false); 4947 4948 /// TryListConversion - Try to copy-initialize a value of type ToType from the 4949 /// initializer list From. 4950 static ImplicitConversionSequence 4951 TryListConversion(Sema &S, InitListExpr *From, QualType ToType, 4952 bool SuppressUserConversions, 4953 bool InOverloadResolution, 4954 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) { 4955 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p1: 4956 // When an argument is an initializer list, it is not an expression and 4957 // special rules apply for converting it to a parameter type. 4958 4959 ImplicitConversionSequence Result; 4960 Result.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType); 4961 4962 // We need a complete type for what follows. Incomplete types can never be 4963 // initialized from init lists. 4964 if (!S.isCompleteType(From->getBeginLoc(), ToType)) 4965 return Result; 4966 4967 // Per DR1467: 4968 // If the parameter type is a class X and the initializer list has a single 4969 // element of type cv U, where U is X or a class derived from X, the 4970 // implicit conversion sequence is the one required to convert the element 4971 // to the parameter type. 4972 // 4973 // Otherwise, if the parameter type is a character array [... ] 4974 // and the initializer list has a single element that is an 4975 // appropriately-typed string literal (8.5.2 [dcl.init.string]), the 4976 // implicit conversion sequence is the identity conversion. 4977 if (From->getNumInits() == 1) { 4978 if (ToType->isRecordType()) { 4979 QualType InitType = From->getInit(0)->getType(); 4980 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(InitType, ToType) || 4981 S.IsDerivedFrom(From->getBeginLoc(), InitType, ToType)) 4982 return TryCopyInitialization(S, From->getInit(0), ToType, 4983 SuppressUserConversions, 4984 InOverloadResolution, 4985 AllowObjCWritebackConversion); 4986 } 4987 // FIXME: Check the other conditions here: array of character type, 4988 // initializer is a string literal. 4989 if (ToType->isArrayType()) { 4990 InitializedEntity Entity = 4991 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(S.Context, ToType, 4992 /*Consumed=*/false); 4993 if (S.CanPerformCopyInitialization(Entity, From)) { 4994 Result.setStandard(); 4995 Result.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion(); 4996 Result.Standard.setFromType(ToType); 4997 Result.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType); 4998 return Result; 4999 } 5000 } 5001 } 5002 5003 // C++14 [over.ics.list]p2: Otherwise, if the parameter type [...] (below). 5004 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p2: 5005 // If the parameter type is std::initializer_list<X> or "array of X" and 5006 // all the elements can be implicitly converted to X, the implicit 5007 // conversion sequence is the worst conversion necessary to convert an 5008 // element of the list to X. 5009 // 5010 // C++14 [over.ics.list]p3: 5011 // Otherwise, if the parameter type is "array of N X", if the initializer 5012 // list has exactly N elements or if it has fewer than N elements and X is 5013 // default-constructible, and if all the elements of the initializer list 5014 // can be implicitly converted to X, the implicit conversion sequence is 5015 // the worst conversion necessary to convert an element of the list to X. 5016 // 5017 // FIXME: We're missing a lot of these checks. 5018 bool toStdInitializerList = false; 5019 QualType X; 5020 if (ToType->isArrayType()) 5021 X = S.Context.getAsArrayType(ToType)->getElementType(); 5022 else 5023 toStdInitializerList = S.isStdInitializerList(ToType, &X); 5024 if (!X.isNull()) { 5025 for (unsigned i = 0, e = From->getNumInits(); i < e; ++i) { 5026 Expr *Init = From->getInit(i); 5027 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = 5028 TryCopyInitialization(S, Init, X, SuppressUserConversions, 5029 InOverloadResolution, 5030 AllowObjCWritebackConversion); 5031 // If a single element isn't convertible, fail. 5032 if (ICS.isBad()) { 5033 Result = ICS; 5034 break; 5035 } 5036 // Otherwise, look for the worst conversion. 5037 if (Result.isBad() || CompareImplicitConversionSequences( 5038 S, From->getBeginLoc(), ICS, Result) == 5039 ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse) 5040 Result = ICS; 5041 } 5042 5043 // For an empty list, we won't have computed any conversion sequence. 5044 // Introduce the identity conversion sequence. 5045 if (From->getNumInits() == 0) { 5046 Result.setStandard(); 5047 Result.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion(); 5048 Result.Standard.setFromType(ToType); 5049 Result.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType); 5050 } 5051 5052 Result.setStdInitializerListElement(toStdInitializerList); 5053 return Result; 5054 } 5055 5056 // C++14 [over.ics.list]p4: 5057 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p3: 5058 // Otherwise, if the parameter is a non-aggregate class X and overload 5059 // resolution chooses a single best constructor [...] the implicit 5060 // conversion sequence is a user-defined conversion sequence. If multiple 5061 // constructors are viable but none is better than the others, the 5062 // implicit conversion sequence is a user-defined conversion sequence. 5063 if (ToType->isRecordType() && !ToType->isAggregateType()) { 5064 // This function can deal with initializer lists. 5065 return TryUserDefinedConversion(S, From, ToType, SuppressUserConversions, 5066 AllowedExplicit::None, 5067 InOverloadResolution, /*CStyle=*/false, 5068 AllowObjCWritebackConversion, 5069 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false); 5070 } 5071 5072 // C++14 [over.ics.list]p5: 5073 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p4: 5074 // Otherwise, if the parameter has an aggregate type which can be 5075 // initialized from the initializer list [...] the implicit conversion 5076 // sequence is a user-defined conversion sequence. 5077 if (ToType->isAggregateType()) { 5078 // Type is an aggregate, argument is an init list. At this point it comes 5079 // down to checking whether the initialization works. 5080 // FIXME: Find out whether this parameter is consumed or not. 5081 InitializedEntity Entity = 5082 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(S.Context, ToType, 5083 /*Consumed=*/false); 5084 if (S.CanPerformAggregateInitializationForOverloadResolution(Entity, 5085 From)) { 5086 Result.setUserDefined(); 5087 Result.UserDefined.Before.setAsIdentityConversion(); 5088 // Initializer lists don't have a type. 5089 Result.UserDefined.Before.setFromType(QualType()); 5090 Result.UserDefined.Before.setAllToTypes(QualType()); 5091 5092 Result.UserDefined.After.setAsIdentityConversion(); 5093 Result.UserDefined.After.setFromType(ToType); 5094 Result.UserDefined.After.setAllToTypes(ToType); 5095 Result.UserDefined.ConversionFunction = nullptr; 5096 } 5097 return Result; 5098 } 5099 5100 // C++14 [over.ics.list]p6: 5101 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p5: 5102 // Otherwise, if the parameter is a reference, see 13.3.3.1.4. 5103 if (ToType->isReferenceType()) { 5104 // The standard is notoriously unclear here, since 13.3.3.1.4 doesn't 5105 // mention initializer lists in any way. So we go by what list- 5106 // initialization would do and try to extrapolate from that. 5107 5108 QualType T1 = ToType->castAs<ReferenceType>()->getPointeeType(); 5109 5110 // If the initializer list has a single element that is reference-related 5111 // to the parameter type, we initialize the reference from that. 5112 if (From->getNumInits() == 1) { 5113 Expr *Init = From->getInit(0); 5114 5115 QualType T2 = Init->getType(); 5116 5117 // If the initializer is the address of an overloaded function, try 5118 // to resolve the overloaded function. If all goes well, T2 is the 5119 // type of the resulting function. 5120 if (S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2) == S.Context.OverloadTy) { 5121 DeclAccessPair Found; 5122 if (FunctionDecl *Fn = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction( 5123 Init, ToType, false, Found)) 5124 T2 = Fn->getType(); 5125 } 5126 5127 // Compute some basic properties of the types and the initializer. 5128 Sema::ReferenceCompareResult RefRelationship = 5129 S.CompareReferenceRelationship(From->getBeginLoc(), T1, T2); 5130 5131 if (RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Related) { 5132 return TryReferenceInit(S, Init, ToType, /*FIXME*/ From->getBeginLoc(), 5133 SuppressUserConversions, 5134 /*AllowExplicit=*/false); 5135 } 5136 } 5137 5138 // Otherwise, we bind the reference to a temporary created from the 5139 // initializer list. 5140 Result = TryListConversion(S, From, T1, SuppressUserConversions, 5141 InOverloadResolution, 5142 AllowObjCWritebackConversion); 5143 if (Result.isFailure()) 5144 return Result; 5145 assert(!Result.isEllipsis() && 5146 "Sub-initialization cannot result in ellipsis conversion."); 5147 5148 // Can we even bind to a temporary? 5149 if (ToType->isRValueReferenceType() || 5150 (T1.isConstQualified() && !T1.isVolatileQualified())) { 5151 StandardConversionSequence &SCS = Result.isStandard() ? Result.Standard : 5152 Result.UserDefined.After; 5153 SCS.ReferenceBinding = true; 5154 SCS.IsLvalueReference = ToType->isLValueReferenceType(); 5155 SCS.BindsToRvalue = true; 5156 SCS.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false; 5157 SCS.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false; 5158 SCS.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false; 5159 } else 5160 Result.setBad(BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue, 5161 From, ToType); 5162 return Result; 5163 } 5164 5165 // C++14 [over.ics.list]p7: 5166 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p6: 5167 // Otherwise, if the parameter type is not a class: 5168 if (!ToType->isRecordType()) { 5169 // - if the initializer list has one element that is not itself an 5170 // initializer list, the implicit conversion sequence is the one 5171 // required to convert the element to the parameter type. 5172 unsigned NumInits = From->getNumInits(); 5173 if (NumInits == 1 && !isa<InitListExpr>(From->getInit(0))) 5174 Result = TryCopyInitialization(S, From->getInit(0), ToType, 5175 SuppressUserConversions, 5176 InOverloadResolution, 5177 AllowObjCWritebackConversion); 5178 // - if the initializer list has no elements, the implicit conversion 5179 // sequence is the identity conversion. 5180 else if (NumInits == 0) { 5181 Result.setStandard(); 5182 Result.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion(); 5183 Result.Standard.setFromType(ToType); 5184 Result.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType); 5185 } 5186 return Result; 5187 } 5188 5189 // C++14 [over.ics.list]p8: 5190 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p7: 5191 // In all cases other than those enumerated above, no conversion is possible 5192 return Result; 5193 } 5194 5195 /// TryCopyInitialization - Try to copy-initialize a value of type 5196 /// ToType from the expression From. Return the implicit conversion 5197 /// sequence required to pass this argument, which may be a bad 5198 /// conversion sequence (meaning that the argument cannot be passed to 5199 /// a parameter of this type). If @p SuppressUserConversions, then we 5200 /// do not permit any user-defined conversion sequences. 5201 static ImplicitConversionSequence 5202 TryCopyInitialization(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 5203 bool SuppressUserConversions, 5204 bool InOverloadResolution, 5205 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion, 5206 bool AllowExplicit) { 5207 if (InitListExpr *FromInitList = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(From)) 5208 return TryListConversion(S, FromInitList, ToType, SuppressUserConversions, 5209 InOverloadResolution,AllowObjCWritebackConversion); 5210 5211 if (ToType->isReferenceType()) 5212 return TryReferenceInit(S, From, ToType, 5213 /*FIXME:*/ From->getBeginLoc(), 5214 SuppressUserConversions, AllowExplicit); 5215 5216 return TryImplicitConversion(S, From, ToType, 5217 SuppressUserConversions, 5218 AllowedExplicit::None, 5219 InOverloadResolution, 5220 /*CStyle=*/false, 5221 AllowObjCWritebackConversion, 5222 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false); 5223 } 5224 5225 static bool TryCopyInitialization(const CanQualType FromQTy, 5226 const CanQualType ToQTy, 5227 Sema &S, 5228 SourceLocation Loc, 5229 ExprValueKind FromVK) { 5230 OpaqueValueExpr TmpExpr(Loc, FromQTy, FromVK); 5231 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = 5232 TryCopyInitialization(S, &TmpExpr, ToQTy, true, true, false); 5233 5234 return !ICS.isBad(); 5235 } 5236 5237 /// TryObjectArgumentInitialization - Try to initialize the object 5238 /// parameter of the given member function (@c Method) from the 5239 /// expression @p From. 5240 static ImplicitConversionSequence 5241 TryObjectArgumentInitialization(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType FromType, 5242 Expr::Classification FromClassification, 5243 CXXMethodDecl *Method, 5244 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext) { 5245 QualType ClassType = S.Context.getTypeDeclType(ActingContext); 5246 // [class.dtor]p2: A destructor can be invoked for a const, volatile or 5247 // const volatile object. 5248 Qualifiers Quals = Method->getMethodQualifiers(); 5249 if (isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(Method)) { 5250 Quals.addConst(); 5251 Quals.addVolatile(); 5252 } 5253 5254 QualType ImplicitParamType = S.Context.getQualifiedType(ClassType, Quals); 5255 5256 // Set up the conversion sequence as a "bad" conversion, to allow us 5257 // to exit early. 5258 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS; 5259 5260 // We need to have an object of class type. 5261 if (const PointerType *PT = FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) { 5262 FromType = PT->getPointeeType(); 5263 5264 // When we had a pointer, it's implicitly dereferenced, so we 5265 // better have an lvalue. 5266 assert(FromClassification.isLValue()); 5267 } 5268 5269 assert(FromType->isRecordType()); 5270 5271 // C++0x [over.match.funcs]p4: 5272 // For non-static member functions, the type of the implicit object 5273 // parameter is 5274 // 5275 // - "lvalue reference to cv X" for functions declared without a 5276 // ref-qualifier or with the & ref-qualifier 5277 // - "rvalue reference to cv X" for functions declared with the && 5278 // ref-qualifier 5279 // 5280 // where X is the class of which the function is a member and cv is the 5281 // cv-qualification on the member function declaration. 5282 // 5283 // However, when finding an implicit conversion sequence for the argument, we 5284 // are not allowed to perform user-defined conversions 5285 // (C++ [over.match.funcs]p5). We perform a simplified version of 5286 // reference binding here, that allows class rvalues to bind to 5287 // non-constant references. 5288 5289 // First check the qualifiers. 5290 QualType FromTypeCanon = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType); 5291 if (ImplicitParamType.getCVRQualifiers() 5292 != FromTypeCanon.getLocalCVRQualifiers() && 5293 !ImplicitParamType.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(FromTypeCanon)) { 5294 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::bad_qualifiers, 5295 FromType, ImplicitParamType); 5296 return ICS; 5297 } 5298 5299 if (FromTypeCanon.hasAddressSpace()) { 5300 Qualifiers QualsImplicitParamType = ImplicitParamType.getQualifiers(); 5301 Qualifiers QualsFromType = FromTypeCanon.getQualifiers(); 5302 if (!QualsImplicitParamType.isAddressSpaceSupersetOf(QualsFromType)) { 5303 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::bad_qualifiers, 5304 FromType, ImplicitParamType); 5305 return ICS; 5306 } 5307 } 5308 5309 // Check that we have either the same type or a derived type. It 5310 // affects the conversion rank. 5311 QualType ClassTypeCanon = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ClassType); 5312 ImplicitConversionKind SecondKind; 5313 if (ClassTypeCanon == FromTypeCanon.getLocalUnqualifiedType()) { 5314 SecondKind = ICK_Identity; 5315 } else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromType, ClassType)) 5316 SecondKind = ICK_Derived_To_Base; 5317 else { 5318 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::unrelated_class, 5319 FromType, ImplicitParamType); 5320 return ICS; 5321 } 5322 5323 // Check the ref-qualifier. 5324 switch (Method->getRefQualifier()) { 5325 case RQ_None: 5326 // Do nothing; we don't care about lvalueness or rvalueness. 5327 break; 5328 5329 case RQ_LValue: 5330 if (!FromClassification.isLValue() && !Quals.hasOnlyConst()) { 5331 // non-const lvalue reference cannot bind to an rvalue 5332 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue, FromType, 5333 ImplicitParamType); 5334 return ICS; 5335 } 5336 break; 5337 5338 case RQ_RValue: 5339 if (!FromClassification.isRValue()) { 5340 // rvalue reference cannot bind to an lvalue 5341 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::rvalue_ref_to_lvalue, FromType, 5342 ImplicitParamType); 5343 return ICS; 5344 } 5345 break; 5346 } 5347 5348 // Success. Mark this as a reference binding. 5349 ICS.setStandard(); 5350 ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion(); 5351 ICS.Standard.Second = SecondKind; 5352 ICS.Standard.setFromType(FromType); 5353 ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ImplicitParamType); 5354 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true; 5355 ICS.Standard.DirectBinding = true; 5356 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = Method->getRefQualifier() != RQ_RValue; 5357 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false; 5358 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = FromClassification.isRValue(); 5359 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier 5360 = (Method->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None); 5361 return ICS; 5362 } 5363 5364 /// PerformObjectArgumentInitialization - Perform initialization of 5365 /// the implicit object parameter for the given Method with the given 5366 /// expression. 5367 ExprResult 5368 Sema::PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Expr *From, 5369 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier, 5370 NamedDecl *FoundDecl, 5371 CXXMethodDecl *Method) { 5372 QualType FromRecordType, DestType; 5373 QualType ImplicitParamRecordType = 5374 Method->getThisType()->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 5375 5376 Expr::Classification FromClassification; 5377 if (const PointerType *PT = From->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) { 5378 FromRecordType = PT->getPointeeType(); 5379 DestType = Method->getThisType(); 5380 FromClassification = Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue(); 5381 } else { 5382 FromRecordType = From->getType(); 5383 DestType = ImplicitParamRecordType; 5384 FromClassification = From->Classify(Context); 5385 5386 // When performing member access on an rvalue, materialize a temporary. 5387 if (From->isRValue()) { 5388 From = CreateMaterializeTemporaryExpr(FromRecordType, From, 5389 Method->getRefQualifier() != 5390 RefQualifierKind::RQ_RValue); 5391 } 5392 } 5393 5394 // Note that we always use the true parent context when performing 5395 // the actual argument initialization. 5396 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = TryObjectArgumentInitialization( 5397 *this, From->getBeginLoc(), From->getType(), FromClassification, Method, 5398 Method->getParent()); 5399 if (ICS.isBad()) { 5400 switch (ICS.Bad.Kind) { 5401 case BadConversionSequence::bad_qualifiers: { 5402 Qualifiers FromQs = FromRecordType.getQualifiers(); 5403 Qualifiers ToQs = DestType.getQualifiers(); 5404 unsigned CVR = FromQs.getCVRQualifiers() & ~ToQs.getCVRQualifiers(); 5405 if (CVR) { 5406 Diag(From->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_member_function_call_bad_cvr) 5407 << Method->getDeclName() << FromRecordType << (CVR - 1) 5408 << From->getSourceRange(); 5409 Diag(Method->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) 5410 << Method->getDeclName(); 5411 return ExprError(); 5412 } 5413 break; 5414 } 5415 5416 case BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue: 5417 case BadConversionSequence::rvalue_ref_to_lvalue: { 5418 bool IsRValueQualified = 5419 Method->getRefQualifier() == RefQualifierKind::RQ_RValue; 5420 Diag(From->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_member_function_call_bad_ref) 5421 << Method->getDeclName() << FromClassification.isRValue() 5422 << IsRValueQualified; 5423 Diag(Method->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) 5424 << Method->getDeclName(); 5425 return ExprError(); 5426 } 5427 5428 case BadConversionSequence::no_conversion: 5429 case BadConversionSequence::unrelated_class: 5430 break; 5431 } 5432 5433 return Diag(From->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_member_function_call_bad_type) 5434 << ImplicitParamRecordType << FromRecordType 5435 << From->getSourceRange(); 5436 } 5437 5438 if (ICS.Standard.Second == ICK_Derived_To_Base) { 5439 ExprResult FromRes = 5440 PerformObjectMemberConversion(From, Qualifier, FoundDecl, Method); 5441 if (FromRes.isInvalid()) 5442 return ExprError(); 5443 From = FromRes.get(); 5444 } 5445 5446 if (!Context.hasSameType(From->getType(), DestType)) { 5447 CastKind CK; 5448 QualType PteeTy = DestType->getPointeeType(); 5449 LangAS DestAS = 5450 PteeTy.isNull() ? DestType.getAddressSpace() : PteeTy.getAddressSpace(); 5451 if (FromRecordType.getAddressSpace() != DestAS) 5452 CK = CK_AddressSpaceConversion; 5453 else 5454 CK = CK_NoOp; 5455 From = ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CK, From->getValueKind()).get(); 5456 } 5457 return From; 5458 } 5459 5460 /// TryContextuallyConvertToBool - Attempt to contextually convert the 5461 /// expression From to bool (C++0x [conv]p3). 5462 static ImplicitConversionSequence 5463 TryContextuallyConvertToBool(Sema &S, Expr *From) { 5464 // C++ [dcl.init]/17.8: 5465 // - Otherwise, if the initialization is direct-initialization, the source 5466 // type is std::nullptr_t, and the destination type is bool, the initial 5467 // value of the object being initialized is false. 5468 if (From->getType()->isNullPtrType()) 5469 return ImplicitConversionSequence::getNullptrToBool(From->getType(), 5470 S.Context.BoolTy, 5471 From->isGLValue()); 5472 5473 // All other direct-initialization of bool is equivalent to an implicit 5474 // conversion to bool in which explicit conversions are permitted. 5475 return TryImplicitConversion(S, From, S.Context.BoolTy, 5476 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, 5477 AllowedExplicit::Conversions, 5478 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, 5479 /*CStyle=*/false, 5480 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false, 5481 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false); 5482 } 5483 5484 /// PerformContextuallyConvertToBool - Perform a contextual conversion 5485 /// of the expression From to bool (C++0x [conv]p3). 5486 ExprResult Sema::PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(Expr *From) { 5487 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From)) 5488 return ExprError(); 5489 5490 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = TryContextuallyConvertToBool(*this, From); 5491 if (!ICS.isBad()) 5492 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, Context.BoolTy, ICS, AA_Converting); 5493 5494 if (!DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(From, Context.BoolTy)) 5495 return Diag(From->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_typecheck_bool_condition) 5496 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange(); 5497 return ExprError(); 5498 } 5499 5500 /// Check that the specified conversion is permitted in a converted constant 5501 /// expression, according to C++11 [expr.const]p3. Return true if the conversion 5502 /// is acceptable. 5503 static bool CheckConvertedConstantConversions(Sema &S, 5504 StandardConversionSequence &SCS) { 5505 // Since we know that the target type is an integral or unscoped enumeration 5506 // type, most conversion kinds are impossible. All possible First and Third 5507 // conversions are fine. 5508 switch (SCS.Second) { 5509 case ICK_Identity: 5510 case ICK_Integral_Promotion: 5511 case ICK_Integral_Conversion: // Narrowing conversions are checked elsewhere. 5512 case ICK_Zero_Queue_Conversion: 5513 return true; 5514 5515 case ICK_Boolean_Conversion: 5516 // Conversion from an integral or unscoped enumeration type to bool is 5517 // classified as ICK_Boolean_Conversion, but it's also arguably an integral 5518 // conversion, so we allow it in a converted constant expression. 5519 // 5520 // FIXME: Per core issue 1407, we should not allow this, but that breaks 5521 // a lot of popular code. We should at least add a warning for this 5522 // (non-conforming) extension. 5523 return SCS.getFromType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() && 5524 SCS.getToType(2)->isBooleanType(); 5525 5526 case ICK_Pointer_Conversion: 5527 case ICK_Pointer_Member: 5528 // C++1z: null pointer conversions and null member pointer conversions are 5529 // only permitted if the source type is std::nullptr_t. 5530 return SCS.getFromType()->isNullPtrType(); 5531 5532 case ICK_Floating_Promotion: 5533 case ICK_Complex_Promotion: 5534 case ICK_Floating_Conversion: 5535 case ICK_Complex_Conversion: 5536 case ICK_Floating_Integral: 5537 case ICK_Compatible_Conversion: 5538 case ICK_Derived_To_Base: 5539 case ICK_Vector_Conversion: 5540 case ICK_SVE_Vector_Conversion: 5541 case ICK_Vector_Splat: 5542 case ICK_Complex_Real: 5543 case ICK_Block_Pointer_Conversion: 5544 case ICK_TransparentUnionConversion: 5545 case ICK_Writeback_Conversion: 5546 case ICK_Zero_Event_Conversion: 5547 case ICK_C_Only_Conversion: 5548 case ICK_Incompatible_Pointer_Conversion: 5549 return false; 5550 5551 case ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue: 5552 case ICK_Array_To_Pointer: 5553 case ICK_Function_To_Pointer: 5554 llvm_unreachable("found a first conversion kind in Second"); 5555 5556 case ICK_Function_Conversion: 5557 case ICK_Qualification: 5558 llvm_unreachable("found a third conversion kind in Second"); 5559 5560 case ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds: 5561 break; 5562 } 5563 5564 llvm_unreachable("unknown conversion kind"); 5565 } 5566 5567 /// CheckConvertedConstantExpression - Check that the expression From is a 5568 /// converted constant expression of type T, perform the conversion and produce 5569 /// the converted expression, per C++11 [expr.const]p3. 5570 static ExprResult CheckConvertedConstantExpression(Sema &S, Expr *From, 5571 QualType T, APValue &Value, 5572 Sema::CCEKind CCE, 5573 bool RequireInt) { 5574 assert(S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && 5575 "converted constant expression outside C++11"); 5576 5577 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(S, From)) 5578 return ExprError(); 5579 5580 // C++1z [expr.const]p3: 5581 // A converted constant expression of type T is an expression, 5582 // implicitly converted to type T, where the converted 5583 // expression is a constant expression and the implicit conversion 5584 // sequence contains only [... list of conversions ...]. 5585 // C++1z [stmt.if]p2: 5586 // If the if statement is of the form if constexpr, the value of the 5587 // condition shall be a contextually converted constant expression of type 5588 // bool. 5589 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = 5590 CCE == Sema::CCEK_ConstexprIf || CCE == Sema::CCEK_ExplicitBool 5591 ? TryContextuallyConvertToBool(S, From) 5592 : TryCopyInitialization(S, From, T, 5593 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, 5594 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, 5595 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false, 5596 /*AllowExplicit=*/false); 5597 StandardConversionSequence *SCS = nullptr; 5598 switch (ICS.getKind()) { 5599 case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion: 5600 SCS = &ICS.Standard; 5601 break; 5602 case ImplicitConversionSequence::UserDefinedConversion: 5603 // We are converting to a non-class type, so the Before sequence 5604 // must be trivial. 5605 SCS = &ICS.UserDefined.After; 5606 break; 5607 case ImplicitConversionSequence::AmbiguousConversion: 5608 case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion: 5609 if (!S.DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(From, T)) 5610 return S.Diag(From->getBeginLoc(), 5611 diag::err_typecheck_converted_constant_expression) 5612 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << T; 5613 return ExprError(); 5614 5615 case ImplicitConversionSequence::EllipsisConversion: 5616 llvm_unreachable("ellipsis conversion in converted constant expression"); 5617 } 5618 5619 // Check that we would only use permitted conversions. 5620 if (!CheckConvertedConstantConversions(S, *SCS)) { 5621 return S.Diag(From->getBeginLoc(), 5622 diag::err_typecheck_converted_constant_expression_disallowed) 5623 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << T; 5624 } 5625 // [...] and where the reference binding (if any) binds directly. 5626 if (SCS->ReferenceBinding && !SCS->DirectBinding) { 5627 return S.Diag(From->getBeginLoc(), 5628 diag::err_typecheck_converted_constant_expression_indirect) 5629 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << T; 5630 } 5631 5632 ExprResult Result = 5633 S.PerformImplicitConversion(From, T, ICS, Sema::AA_Converting); 5634 if (Result.isInvalid()) 5635 return Result; 5636 5637 // C++2a [intro.execution]p5: 5638 // A full-expression is [...] a constant-expression [...] 5639 Result = 5640 S.ActOnFinishFullExpr(Result.get(), From->getExprLoc(), 5641 /*DiscardedValue=*/false, /*IsConstexpr=*/true); 5642 if (Result.isInvalid()) 5643 return Result; 5644 5645 // Check for a narrowing implicit conversion. 5646 bool ReturnPreNarrowingValue = false; 5647 APValue PreNarrowingValue; 5648 QualType PreNarrowingType; 5649 switch (SCS->getNarrowingKind(S.Context, Result.get(), PreNarrowingValue, 5650 PreNarrowingType)) { 5651 case NK_Dependent_Narrowing: 5652 // Implicit conversion to a narrower type, but the expression is 5653 // value-dependent so we can't tell whether it's actually narrowing. 5654 case NK_Variable_Narrowing: 5655 // Implicit conversion to a narrower type, and the value is not a constant 5656 // expression. We'll diagnose this in a moment. 5657 case NK_Not_Narrowing: 5658 break; 5659 5660 case NK_Constant_Narrowing: 5661 if (CCE == Sema::CCEK_ArrayBound && 5662 PreNarrowingType->isIntegralOrEnumerationType() && 5663 PreNarrowingValue.isInt()) { 5664 // Don't diagnose array bound narrowing here; we produce more precise 5665 // errors by allowing the un-narrowed value through. 5666 ReturnPreNarrowingValue = true; 5667 break; 5668 } 5669 S.Diag(From->getBeginLoc(), diag::ext_cce_narrowing) 5670 << CCE << /*Constant*/ 1 5671 << PreNarrowingValue.getAsString(S.Context, PreNarrowingType) << T; 5672 break; 5673 5674 case NK_Type_Narrowing: 5675 // FIXME: It would be better to diagnose that the expression is not a 5676 // constant expression. 5677 S.Diag(From->getBeginLoc(), diag::ext_cce_narrowing) 5678 << CCE << /*Constant*/ 0 << From->getType() << T; 5679 break; 5680 } 5681 5682 if (Result.get()->isValueDependent()) { 5683 Value = APValue(); 5684 return Result; 5685 } 5686 5687 // Check the expression is a constant expression. 5688 SmallVector<PartialDiagnosticAt, 8> Notes; 5689 Expr::EvalResult Eval; 5690 Eval.Diag = &Notes; 5691 Expr::ConstExprUsage Usage = CCE == Sema::CCEK_TemplateArg 5692 ? Expr::EvaluateForMangling 5693 : Expr::EvaluateForCodeGen; 5694 5695 if (!Result.get()->EvaluateAsConstantExpr(Eval, Usage, S.Context) || 5696 (RequireInt && !Eval.Val.isInt())) { 5697 // The expression can't be folded, so we can't keep it at this position in 5698 // the AST. 5699 Result = ExprError(); 5700 } else { 5701 Value = Eval.Val; 5702 5703 if (Notes.empty()) { 5704 // It's a constant expression. 5705 Expr *E = ConstantExpr::Create(S.Context, Result.get(), Value); 5706 if (ReturnPreNarrowingValue) 5707 Value = std::move(PreNarrowingValue); 5708 return E; 5709 } 5710 } 5711 5712 // It's not a constant expression. Produce an appropriate diagnostic. 5713 if (Notes.size() == 1 && 5714 Notes[0].second.getDiagID() == diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_const_expr) 5715 S.Diag(Notes[0].first, diag::err_expr_not_cce) << CCE; 5716 else { 5717 S.Diag(From->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_expr_not_cce) 5718 << CCE << From->getSourceRange(); 5719 for (unsigned I = 0; I < Notes.size(); ++I) 5720 S.Diag(Notes[I].first, Notes[I].second); 5721 } 5722 return ExprError(); 5723 } 5724 5725 ExprResult Sema::CheckConvertedConstantExpression(Expr *From, QualType T, 5726 APValue &Value, CCEKind CCE) { 5727 return ::CheckConvertedConstantExpression(*this, From, T, Value, CCE, false); 5728 } 5729 5730 ExprResult Sema::CheckConvertedConstantExpression(Expr *From, QualType T, 5731 llvm::APSInt &Value, 5732 CCEKind CCE) { 5733 assert(T->isIntegralOrEnumerationType() && "unexpected converted const type"); 5734 5735 APValue V; 5736 auto R = ::CheckConvertedConstantExpression(*this, From, T, V, CCE, true); 5737 if (!R.isInvalid() && !R.get()->isValueDependent()) 5738 Value = V.getInt(); 5739 return R; 5740 } 5741 5742 5743 /// dropPointerConversions - If the given standard conversion sequence 5744 /// involves any pointer conversions, remove them. This may change 5745 /// the result type of the conversion sequence. 5746 static void dropPointerConversion(StandardConversionSequence &SCS) { 5747 if (SCS.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion) { 5748 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity; 5749 SCS.Third = ICK_Identity; 5750 SCS.ToTypePtrs[2] = SCS.ToTypePtrs[1] = SCS.ToTypePtrs[0]; 5751 } 5752 } 5753 5754 /// TryContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer - Attempt to contextually 5755 /// convert the expression From to an Objective-C pointer type. 5756 static ImplicitConversionSequence 5757 TryContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer(Sema &S, Expr *From) { 5758 // Do an implicit conversion to 'id'. 5759 QualType Ty = S.Context.getObjCIdType(); 5760 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS 5761 = TryImplicitConversion(S, From, Ty, 5762 // FIXME: Are these flags correct? 5763 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, 5764 AllowedExplicit::Conversions, 5765 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, 5766 /*CStyle=*/false, 5767 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false, 5768 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/true); 5769 5770 // Strip off any final conversions to 'id'. 5771 switch (ICS.getKind()) { 5772 case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion: 5773 case ImplicitConversionSequence::AmbiguousConversion: 5774 case ImplicitConversionSequence::EllipsisConversion: 5775 break; 5776 5777 case ImplicitConversionSequence::UserDefinedConversion: 5778 dropPointerConversion(ICS.UserDefined.After); 5779 break; 5780 5781 case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion: 5782 dropPointerConversion(ICS.Standard); 5783 break; 5784 } 5785 5786 return ICS; 5787 } 5788 5789 /// PerformContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer - Perform a contextual 5790 /// conversion of the expression From to an Objective-C pointer type. 5791 /// Returns a valid but null ExprResult if no conversion sequence exists. 5792 ExprResult Sema::PerformContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer(Expr *From) { 5793 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From)) 5794 return ExprError(); 5795 5796 QualType Ty = Context.getObjCIdType(); 5797 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = 5798 TryContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer(*this, From); 5799 if (!ICS.isBad()) 5800 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, Ty, ICS, AA_Converting); 5801 return ExprResult(); 5802 } 5803 5804 /// Determine whether the provided type is an integral type, or an enumeration 5805 /// type of a permitted flavor. 5806 bool Sema::ICEConvertDiagnoser::match(QualType T) { 5807 return AllowScopedEnumerations ? T->isIntegralOrEnumerationType() 5808 : T->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType(); 5809 } 5810 5811 static ExprResult 5812 diagnoseAmbiguousConversion(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc, Expr *From, 5813 Sema::ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter, 5814 QualType T, UnresolvedSetImpl &ViableConversions) { 5815 5816 if (Converter.Suppress) 5817 return ExprError(); 5818 5819 Converter.diagnoseAmbiguous(SemaRef, Loc, T) << From->getSourceRange(); 5820 for (unsigned I = 0, N = ViableConversions.size(); I != N; ++I) { 5821 CXXConversionDecl *Conv = 5822 cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ViableConversions[I]->getUnderlyingDecl()); 5823 QualType ConvTy = Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType(); 5824 Converter.noteAmbiguous(SemaRef, Conv, ConvTy); 5825 } 5826 return From; 5827 } 5828 5829 static bool 5830 diagnoseNoViableConversion(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&From, 5831 Sema::ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter, 5832 QualType T, bool HadMultipleCandidates, 5833 UnresolvedSetImpl &ExplicitConversions) { 5834 if (ExplicitConversions.size() == 1 && !Converter.Suppress) { 5835 DeclAccessPair Found = ExplicitConversions[0]; 5836 CXXConversionDecl *Conversion = 5837 cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl()); 5838 5839 // The user probably meant to invoke the given explicit 5840 // conversion; use it. 5841 QualType ConvTy = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType(); 5842 std::string TypeStr; 5843 ConvTy.getAsStringInternal(TypeStr, SemaRef.getPrintingPolicy()); 5844 5845 Converter.diagnoseExplicitConv(SemaRef, Loc, T, ConvTy) 5846 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(From->getBeginLoc(), 5847 "static_cast<" + TypeStr + ">(") 5848 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion( 5849 SemaRef.getLocForEndOfToken(From->getEndLoc()), ")"); 5850 Converter.noteExplicitConv(SemaRef, Conversion, ConvTy); 5851 5852 // If we aren't in a SFINAE context, build a call to the 5853 // explicit conversion function. 5854 if (SemaRef.isSFINAEContext()) 5855 return true; 5856 5857 SemaRef.CheckMemberOperatorAccess(From->getExprLoc(), From, nullptr, Found); 5858 ExprResult Result = SemaRef.BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(From, Found, Conversion, 5859 HadMultipleCandidates); 5860 if (Result.isInvalid()) 5861 return true; 5862 // Record usage of conversion in an implicit cast. 5863 From = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(SemaRef.Context, Result.get()->getType(), 5864 CK_UserDefinedConversion, Result.get(), 5865 nullptr, Result.get()->getValueKind(), 5866 SemaRef.CurFPFeatureOverrides()); 5867 } 5868 return false; 5869 } 5870 5871 static bool recordConversion(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&From, 5872 Sema::ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter, 5873 QualType T, bool HadMultipleCandidates, 5874 DeclAccessPair &Found) { 5875 CXXConversionDecl *Conversion = 5876 cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl()); 5877 SemaRef.CheckMemberOperatorAccess(From->getExprLoc(), From, nullptr, Found); 5878 5879 QualType ToType = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType(); 5880 if (!Converter.SuppressConversion) { 5881 if (SemaRef.isSFINAEContext()) 5882 return true; 5883 5884 Converter.diagnoseConversion(SemaRef, Loc, T, ToType) 5885 << From->getSourceRange(); 5886 } 5887 5888 ExprResult Result = SemaRef.BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(From, Found, Conversion, 5889 HadMultipleCandidates); 5890 if (Result.isInvalid()) 5891 return true; 5892 // Record usage of conversion in an implicit cast. 5893 From = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(SemaRef.Context, Result.get()->getType(), 5894 CK_UserDefinedConversion, Result.get(), 5895 nullptr, Result.get()->getValueKind(), 5896 SemaRef.CurFPFeatureOverrides()); 5897 return false; 5898 } 5899 5900 static ExprResult finishContextualImplicitConversion( 5901 Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc, Expr *From, 5902 Sema::ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter) { 5903 if (!Converter.match(From->getType()) && !Converter.Suppress) 5904 Converter.diagnoseNoMatch(SemaRef, Loc, From->getType()) 5905 << From->getSourceRange(); 5906 5907 return SemaRef.DefaultLvalueConversion(From); 5908 } 5909 5910 static void 5911 collectViableConversionCandidates(Sema &SemaRef, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 5912 UnresolvedSetImpl &ViableConversions, 5913 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) { 5914 for (unsigned I = 0, N = ViableConversions.size(); I != N; ++I) { 5915 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = ViableConversions[I]; 5916 NamedDecl *D = FoundDecl.getDecl(); 5917 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext()); 5918 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D)) 5919 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl(); 5920 5921 CXXConversionDecl *Conv; 5922 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate; 5923 if ((ConvTemplate = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))) 5924 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl()); 5925 else 5926 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D); 5927 5928 if (ConvTemplate) 5929 SemaRef.AddTemplateConversionCandidate( 5930 ConvTemplate, FoundDecl, ActingContext, From, ToType, CandidateSet, 5931 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false, /*AllowExplicit*/ true); 5932 else 5933 SemaRef.AddConversionCandidate(Conv, FoundDecl, ActingContext, From, 5934 ToType, CandidateSet, 5935 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false, 5936 /*AllowExplicit*/ true); 5937 } 5938 } 5939 5940 /// Attempt to convert the given expression to a type which is accepted 5941 /// by the given converter. 5942 /// 5943 /// This routine will attempt to convert an expression of class type to a 5944 /// type accepted by the specified converter. In C++11 and before, the class 5945 /// must have a single non-explicit conversion function converting to a matching 5946 /// type. In C++1y, there can be multiple such conversion functions, but only 5947 /// one target type. 5948 /// 5949 /// \param Loc The source location of the construct that requires the 5950 /// conversion. 5951 /// 5952 /// \param From The expression we're converting from. 5953 /// 5954 /// \param Converter Used to control and diagnose the conversion process. 5955 /// 5956 /// \returns The expression, converted to an integral or enumeration type if 5957 /// successful. 5958 ExprResult Sema::PerformContextualImplicitConversion( 5959 SourceLocation Loc, Expr *From, ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter) { 5960 // We can't perform any more checking for type-dependent expressions. 5961 if (From->isTypeDependent()) 5962 return From; 5963 5964 // Process placeholders immediately. 5965 if (From->hasPlaceholderType()) { 5966 ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(From); 5967 if (result.isInvalid()) 5968 return result; 5969 From = result.get(); 5970 } 5971 5972 // If the expression already has a matching type, we're golden. 5973 QualType T = From->getType(); 5974 if (Converter.match(T)) 5975 return DefaultLvalueConversion(From); 5976 5977 // FIXME: Check for missing '()' if T is a function type? 5978 5979 // We can only perform contextual implicit conversions on objects of class 5980 // type. 5981 const RecordType *RecordTy = T->getAs<RecordType>(); 5982 if (!RecordTy || !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 5983 if (!Converter.Suppress) 5984 Converter.diagnoseNoMatch(*this, Loc, T) << From->getSourceRange(); 5985 return From; 5986 } 5987 5988 // We must have a complete class type. 5989 struct TypeDiagnoserPartialDiag : TypeDiagnoser { 5990 ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter; 5991 Expr *From; 5992 5993 TypeDiagnoserPartialDiag(ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter, Expr *From) 5994 : Converter(Converter), From(From) {} 5995 5996 void diagnose(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) override { 5997 Converter.diagnoseIncomplete(S, Loc, T) << From->getSourceRange(); 5998 } 5999 } IncompleteDiagnoser(Converter, From); 6000 6001 if (Converter.Suppress ? !isCompleteType(Loc, T) 6002 : RequireCompleteType(Loc, T, IncompleteDiagnoser)) 6003 return From; 6004 6005 // Look for a conversion to an integral or enumeration type. 6006 UnresolvedSet<4> 6007 ViableConversions; // These are *potentially* viable in C++1y. 6008 UnresolvedSet<4> ExplicitConversions; 6009 const auto &Conversions = 6010 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RecordTy->getDecl())->getVisibleConversionFunctions(); 6011 6012 bool HadMultipleCandidates = 6013 (std::distance(Conversions.begin(), Conversions.end()) > 1); 6014 6015 // To check that there is only one target type, in C++1y: 6016 QualType ToType; 6017 bool HasUniqueTargetType = true; 6018 6019 // Collect explicit or viable (potentially in C++1y) conversions. 6020 for (auto I = Conversions.begin(), E = Conversions.end(); I != E; ++I) { 6021 NamedDecl *D = (*I)->getUnderlyingDecl(); 6022 CXXConversionDecl *Conversion; 6023 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D); 6024 if (ConvTemplate) { 6025 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14) 6026 Conversion = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl()); 6027 else 6028 continue; // C++11 does not consider conversion operator templates(?). 6029 } else 6030 Conversion = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D); 6031 6032 assert((!ConvTemplate || getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14) && 6033 "Conversion operator templates are considered potentially " 6034 "viable in C++1y"); 6035 6036 QualType CurToType = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType(); 6037 if (Converter.match(CurToType) || ConvTemplate) { 6038 6039 if (Conversion->isExplicit()) { 6040 // FIXME: For C++1y, do we need this restriction? 6041 // cf. diagnoseNoViableConversion() 6042 if (!ConvTemplate) 6043 ExplicitConversions.addDecl(I.getDecl(), I.getAccess()); 6044 } else { 6045 if (!ConvTemplate && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14) { 6046 if (ToType.isNull()) 6047 ToType = CurToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 6048 else if (HasUniqueTargetType && 6049 (CurToType.getUnqualifiedType() != ToType)) 6050 HasUniqueTargetType = false; 6051 } 6052 ViableConversions.addDecl(I.getDecl(), I.getAccess()); 6053 } 6054 } 6055 } 6056 6057 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14) { 6058 // C++1y [conv]p6: 6059 // ... An expression e of class type E appearing in such a context 6060 // is said to be contextually implicitly converted to a specified 6061 // type T and is well-formed if and only if e can be implicitly 6062 // converted to a type T that is determined as follows: E is searched 6063 // for conversion functions whose return type is cv T or reference to 6064 // cv T such that T is allowed by the context. There shall be 6065 // exactly one such T. 6066 6067 // If no unique T is found: 6068 if (ToType.isNull()) { 6069 if (diagnoseNoViableConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T, 6070 HadMultipleCandidates, 6071 ExplicitConversions)) 6072 return ExprError(); 6073 return finishContextualImplicitConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter); 6074 } 6075 6076 // If more than one unique Ts are found: 6077 if (!HasUniqueTargetType) 6078 return diagnoseAmbiguousConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T, 6079 ViableConversions); 6080 6081 // If one unique T is found: 6082 // First, build a candidate set from the previously recorded 6083 // potentially viable conversions. 6084 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Loc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal); 6085 collectViableConversionCandidates(*this, From, ToType, ViableConversions, 6086 CandidateSet); 6087 6088 // Then, perform overload resolution over the candidate set. 6089 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 6090 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, Loc, Best)) { 6091 case OR_Success: { 6092 // Apply this conversion. 6093 DeclAccessPair Found = 6094 DeclAccessPair::make(Best->Function, Best->FoundDecl.getAccess()); 6095 if (recordConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T, 6096 HadMultipleCandidates, Found)) 6097 return ExprError(); 6098 break; 6099 } 6100 case OR_Ambiguous: 6101 return diagnoseAmbiguousConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T, 6102 ViableConversions); 6103 case OR_No_Viable_Function: 6104 if (diagnoseNoViableConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T, 6105 HadMultipleCandidates, 6106 ExplicitConversions)) 6107 return ExprError(); 6108 LLVM_FALLTHROUGH; 6109 case OR_Deleted: 6110 // We'll complain below about a non-integral condition type. 6111 break; 6112 } 6113 } else { 6114 switch (ViableConversions.size()) { 6115 case 0: { 6116 if (diagnoseNoViableConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T, 6117 HadMultipleCandidates, 6118 ExplicitConversions)) 6119 return ExprError(); 6120 6121 // We'll complain below about a non-integral condition type. 6122 break; 6123 } 6124 case 1: { 6125 // Apply this conversion. 6126 DeclAccessPair Found = ViableConversions[0]; 6127 if (recordConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T, 6128 HadMultipleCandidates, Found)) 6129 return ExprError(); 6130 break; 6131 } 6132 default: 6133 return diagnoseAmbiguousConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T, 6134 ViableConversions); 6135 } 6136 } 6137 6138 return finishContextualImplicitConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter); 6139 } 6140 6141 /// IsAcceptableNonMemberOperatorCandidate - Determine whether Fn is 6142 /// an acceptable non-member overloaded operator for a call whose 6143 /// arguments have types T1 (and, if non-empty, T2). This routine 6144 /// implements the check in C++ [over.match.oper]p3b2 concerning 6145 /// enumeration types. 6146 static bool IsAcceptableNonMemberOperatorCandidate(ASTContext &Context, 6147 FunctionDecl *Fn, 6148 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args) { 6149 QualType T1 = Args[0]->getType(); 6150 QualType T2 = Args.size() > 1 ? Args[1]->getType() : QualType(); 6151 6152 if (T1->isDependentType() || (!T2.isNull() && T2->isDependentType())) 6153 return true; 6154 6155 if (T1->isRecordType() || (!T2.isNull() && T2->isRecordType())) 6156 return true; 6157 6158 const auto *Proto = Fn->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 6159 if (Proto->getNumParams() < 1) 6160 return false; 6161 6162 if (T1->isEnumeralType()) { 6163 QualType ArgType = Proto->getParamType(0).getNonReferenceType(); 6164 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, ArgType)) 6165 return true; 6166 } 6167 6168 if (Proto->getNumParams() < 2) 6169 return false; 6170 6171 if (!T2.isNull() && T2->isEnumeralType()) { 6172 QualType ArgType = Proto->getParamType(1).getNonReferenceType(); 6173 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T2, ArgType)) 6174 return true; 6175 } 6176 6177 return false; 6178 } 6179 6180 /// AddOverloadCandidate - Adds the given function to the set of 6181 /// candidate functions, using the given function call arguments. If 6182 /// @p SuppressUserConversions, then don't allow user-defined 6183 /// conversions via constructors or conversion operators. 6184 /// 6185 /// \param PartialOverloading true if we are performing "partial" overloading 6186 /// based on an incomplete set of function arguments. This feature is used by 6187 /// code completion. 6188 void Sema::AddOverloadCandidate( 6189 FunctionDecl *Function, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 6190 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, bool SuppressUserConversions, 6191 bool PartialOverloading, bool AllowExplicit, bool AllowExplicitConversions, 6192 ADLCallKind IsADLCandidate, ConversionSequenceList EarlyConversions, 6193 OverloadCandidateParamOrder PO) { 6194 const FunctionProtoType *Proto 6195 = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Function->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>()); 6196 assert(Proto && "Functions without a prototype cannot be overloaded"); 6197 assert(!Function->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() && 6198 "Use AddTemplateOverloadCandidate for function templates"); 6199 6200 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Function)) { 6201 if (!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method)) { 6202 // If we get here, it's because we're calling a member function 6203 // that is named without a member access expression (e.g., 6204 // "this->f") that was either written explicitly or created 6205 // implicitly. This can happen with a qualified call to a member 6206 // function, e.g., X::f(). We use an empty type for the implied 6207 // object argument (C++ [over.call.func]p3), and the acting context 6208 // is irrelevant. 6209 AddMethodCandidate(Method, FoundDecl, Method->getParent(), QualType(), 6210 Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue(), Args, 6211 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions, 6212 PartialOverloading, EarlyConversions, PO); 6213 return; 6214 } 6215 // We treat a constructor like a non-member function, since its object 6216 // argument doesn't participate in overload resolution. 6217 } 6218 6219 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Function, PO)) 6220 return; 6221 6222 // C++11 [class.copy]p11: [DR1402] 6223 // A defaulted move constructor that is defined as deleted is ignored by 6224 // overload resolution. 6225 CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Function); 6226 if (Constructor && Constructor->isDefaulted() && Constructor->isDeleted() && 6227 Constructor->isMoveConstructor()) 6228 return; 6229 6230 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context. 6231 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated( 6232 *this, Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::Unevaluated); 6233 6234 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3: 6235 // if no operand has a class type, only those non-member functions in the 6236 // lookup set that have a first parameter of type T1 or "reference to 6237 // (possibly cv-qualified) T1", when T1 is an enumeration type, or (if there 6238 // is a right operand) a second parameter of type T2 or "reference to 6239 // (possibly cv-qualified) T2", when T2 is an enumeration type, are 6240 // candidate functions. 6241 if (CandidateSet.getKind() == OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator && 6242 !IsAcceptableNonMemberOperatorCandidate(Context, Function, Args)) 6243 return; 6244 6245 // Add this candidate 6246 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = 6247 CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size(), EarlyConversions); 6248 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl; 6249 Candidate.Function = Function; 6250 Candidate.Viable = true; 6251 Candidate.RewriteKind = 6252 CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().getRewriteKind(Function, PO); 6253 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false; 6254 Candidate.IsADLCandidate = IsADLCandidate; 6255 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false; 6256 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size(); 6257 6258 // Explicit functions are not actually candidates at all if we're not 6259 // allowing them in this context, but keep them around so we can point 6260 // to them in diagnostics. 6261 if (!AllowExplicit && ExplicitSpecifier::getFromDecl(Function).isExplicit()) { 6262 Candidate.Viable = false; 6263 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_explicit; 6264 return; 6265 } 6266 6267 if (Function->isMultiVersion() && Function->hasAttr<TargetAttr>() && 6268 !Function->getAttr<TargetAttr>()->isDefaultVersion()) { 6269 Candidate.Viable = false; 6270 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_non_default_multiversion_function; 6271 return; 6272 } 6273 6274 if (Constructor) { 6275 // C++ [class.copy]p3: 6276 // A member function template is never instantiated to perform the copy 6277 // of a class object to an object of its class type. 6278 QualType ClassType = Context.getTypeDeclType(Constructor->getParent()); 6279 if (Args.size() == 1 && Constructor->isSpecializationCopyingObject() && 6280 (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ClassType, Args[0]->getType()) || 6281 IsDerivedFrom(Args[0]->getBeginLoc(), Args[0]->getType(), 6282 ClassType))) { 6283 Candidate.Viable = false; 6284 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_illegal_constructor; 6285 return; 6286 } 6287 6288 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p8: (proposed DR resolution) 6289 // A constructor inherited from class type C that has a first parameter 6290 // of type "reference to P" (including such a constructor instantiated 6291 // from a template) is excluded from the set of candidate functions when 6292 // constructing an object of type cv D if the argument list has exactly 6293 // one argument and D is reference-related to P and P is reference-related 6294 // to C. 6295 auto *Shadow = dyn_cast<ConstructorUsingShadowDecl>(FoundDecl.getDecl()); 6296 if (Shadow && Args.size() == 1 && Constructor->getNumParams() >= 1 && 6297 Constructor->getParamDecl(0)->getType()->isReferenceType()) { 6298 QualType P = Constructor->getParamDecl(0)->getType()->getPointeeType(); 6299 QualType C = Context.getRecordType(Constructor->getParent()); 6300 QualType D = Context.getRecordType(Shadow->getParent()); 6301 SourceLocation Loc = Args.front()->getExprLoc(); 6302 if ((Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(P, C) || IsDerivedFrom(Loc, P, C)) && 6303 (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(D, P) || IsDerivedFrom(Loc, D, P))) { 6304 Candidate.Viable = false; 6305 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_inhctor_slice; 6306 return; 6307 } 6308 } 6309 6310 // Check that the constructor is capable of constructing an object in the 6311 // destination address space. 6312 if (!Qualifiers::isAddressSpaceSupersetOf( 6313 Constructor->getMethodQualifiers().getAddressSpace(), 6314 CandidateSet.getDestAS())) { 6315 Candidate.Viable = false; 6316 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_object_addrspace_mismatch; 6317 } 6318 } 6319 6320 unsigned NumParams = Proto->getNumParams(); 6321 6322 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m 6323 // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter 6324 // list (8.3.5). 6325 if (TooManyArguments(NumParams, Args.size(), PartialOverloading) && 6326 !Proto->isVariadic()) { 6327 Candidate.Viable = false; 6328 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments; 6329 return; 6330 } 6331 6332 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having more than m parameters 6333 // is viable only if the (m+1)st parameter has a default argument 6334 // (8.3.6). For the purposes of overload resolution, the 6335 // parameter list is truncated on the right, so that there are 6336 // exactly m parameters. 6337 unsigned MinRequiredArgs = Function->getMinRequiredArguments(); 6338 if (Args.size() < MinRequiredArgs && !PartialOverloading) { 6339 // Not enough arguments. 6340 Candidate.Viable = false; 6341 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments; 6342 return; 6343 } 6344 6345 // (CUDA B.1): Check for invalid calls between targets. 6346 if (getLangOpts().CUDA) 6347 if (const FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(CurContext)) 6348 // Skip the check for callers that are implicit members, because in this 6349 // case we may not yet know what the member's target is; the target is 6350 // inferred for the member automatically, based on the bases and fields of 6351 // the class. 6352 if (!Caller->isImplicit() && !IsAllowedCUDACall(Caller, Function)) { 6353 Candidate.Viable = false; 6354 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_target; 6355 return; 6356 } 6357 6358 if (Function->getTrailingRequiresClause()) { 6359 ConstraintSatisfaction Satisfaction; 6360 if (CheckFunctionConstraints(Function, Satisfaction) || 6361 !Satisfaction.IsSatisfied) { 6362 Candidate.Viable = false; 6363 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_constraints_not_satisfied; 6364 return; 6365 } 6366 } 6367 6368 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the 6369 // arguments. 6370 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < Args.size(); ++ArgIdx) { 6371 unsigned ConvIdx = 6372 PO == OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed ? 1 - ArgIdx : ArgIdx; 6373 if (Candidate.Conversions[ConvIdx].isInitialized()) { 6374 // We already formed a conversion sequence for this parameter during 6375 // template argument deduction. 6376 } else if (ArgIdx < NumParams) { 6377 // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall 6378 // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence 6379 // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding 6380 // parameter of F. 6381 QualType ParamType = Proto->getParamType(ArgIdx); 6382 Candidate.Conversions[ConvIdx] = TryCopyInitialization( 6383 *this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType, SuppressUserConversions, 6384 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true, 6385 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/ 6386 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount, AllowExplicitConversions); 6387 if (Candidate.Conversions[ConvIdx].isBad()) { 6388 Candidate.Viable = false; 6389 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion; 6390 return; 6391 } 6392 } else { 6393 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any 6394 // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is 6395 // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3). 6396 Candidate.Conversions[ConvIdx].setEllipsis(); 6397 } 6398 } 6399 6400 if (EnableIfAttr *FailedAttr = 6401 CheckEnableIf(Function, CandidateSet.getLocation(), Args)) { 6402 Candidate.Viable = false; 6403 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_enable_if; 6404 Candidate.DeductionFailure.Data = FailedAttr; 6405 return; 6406 } 6407 6408 if (LangOpts.OpenCL && isOpenCLDisabledDecl(Function)) { 6409 Candidate.Viable = false; 6410 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_ext_disabled; 6411 return; 6412 } 6413 } 6414 6415 ObjCMethodDecl * 6416 Sema::SelectBestMethod(Selector Sel, MultiExprArg Args, bool IsInstance, 6417 SmallVectorImpl<ObjCMethodDecl *> &Methods) { 6418 if (Methods.size() <= 1) 6419 return nullptr; 6420 6421 for (unsigned b = 0, e = Methods.size(); b < e; b++) { 6422 bool Match = true; 6423 ObjCMethodDecl *Method = Methods[b]; 6424 unsigned NumNamedArgs = Sel.getNumArgs(); 6425 // Method might have more arguments than selector indicates. This is due 6426 // to addition of c-style arguments in method. 6427 if (Method->param_size() > NumNamedArgs) 6428 NumNamedArgs = Method->param_size(); 6429 if (Args.size() < NumNamedArgs) 6430 continue; 6431 6432 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumNamedArgs; i++) { 6433 // We can't do any type-checking on a type-dependent argument. 6434 if (Args[i]->isTypeDependent()) { 6435 Match = false; 6436 break; 6437 } 6438 6439 ParmVarDecl *param = Method->parameters()[i]; 6440 Expr *argExpr = Args[i]; 6441 assert(argExpr && "SelectBestMethod(): missing expression"); 6442 6443 // Strip the unbridged-cast placeholder expression off unless it's 6444 // a consumed argument. 6445 if (argExpr->hasPlaceholderType(BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast) && 6446 !param->hasAttr<CFConsumedAttr>()) 6447 argExpr = stripARCUnbridgedCast(argExpr); 6448 6449 // If the parameter is __unknown_anytype, move on to the next method. 6450 if (param->getType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy) { 6451 Match = false; 6452 break; 6453 } 6454 6455 ImplicitConversionSequence ConversionState 6456 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, argExpr, param->getType(), 6457 /*SuppressUserConversions*/false, 6458 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true, 6459 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/ 6460 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount, 6461 /*AllowExplicit*/false); 6462 // This function looks for a reasonably-exact match, so we consider 6463 // incompatible pointer conversions to be a failure here. 6464 if (ConversionState.isBad() || 6465 (ConversionState.isStandard() && 6466 ConversionState.Standard.Second == 6467 ICK_Incompatible_Pointer_Conversion)) { 6468 Match = false; 6469 break; 6470 } 6471 } 6472 // Promote additional arguments to variadic methods. 6473 if (Match && Method->isVariadic()) { 6474 for (unsigned i = NumNamedArgs, e = Args.size(); i < e; ++i) { 6475 if (Args[i]->isTypeDependent()) { 6476 Match = false; 6477 break; 6478 } 6479 ExprResult Arg = DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Args[i], VariadicMethod, 6480 nullptr); 6481 if (Arg.isInvalid()) { 6482 Match = false; 6483 break; 6484 } 6485 } 6486 } else { 6487 // Check for extra arguments to non-variadic methods. 6488 if (Args.size() != NumNamedArgs) 6489 Match = false; 6490 else if (Match && NumNamedArgs == 0 && Methods.size() > 1) { 6491 // Special case when selectors have no argument. In this case, select 6492 // one with the most general result type of 'id'. 6493 for (unsigned b = 0, e = Methods.size(); b < e; b++) { 6494 QualType ReturnT = Methods[b]->getReturnType(); 6495 if (ReturnT->isObjCIdType()) 6496 return Methods[b]; 6497 } 6498 } 6499 } 6500 6501 if (Match) 6502 return Method; 6503 } 6504 return nullptr; 6505 } 6506 6507 static bool convertArgsForAvailabilityChecks( 6508 Sema &S, FunctionDecl *Function, Expr *ThisArg, SourceLocation CallLoc, 6509 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, Sema::SFINAETrap &Trap, bool MissingImplicitThis, 6510 Expr *&ConvertedThis, SmallVectorImpl<Expr *> &ConvertedArgs) { 6511 if (ThisArg) { 6512 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Function); 6513 assert(!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method) && 6514 "Shouldn't have `this` for ctors!"); 6515 assert(!Method->isStatic() && "Shouldn't have `this` for static methods!"); 6516 ExprResult R = S.PerformObjectArgumentInitialization( 6517 ThisArg, /*Qualifier=*/nullptr, Method, Method); 6518 if (R.isInvalid()) 6519 return false; 6520 ConvertedThis = R.get(); 6521 } else { 6522 if (auto *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Function)) { 6523 (void)MD; 6524 assert((MissingImplicitThis || MD->isStatic() || 6525 isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(MD)) && 6526 "Expected `this` for non-ctor instance methods"); 6527 } 6528 ConvertedThis = nullptr; 6529 } 6530 6531 // Ignore any variadic arguments. Converting them is pointless, since the 6532 // user can't refer to them in the function condition. 6533 unsigned ArgSizeNoVarargs = std::min(Function->param_size(), Args.size()); 6534 6535 // Convert the arguments. 6536 for (unsigned I = 0; I != ArgSizeNoVarargs; ++I) { 6537 ExprResult R; 6538 R = S.PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter( 6539 S.Context, Function->getParamDecl(I)), 6540 SourceLocation(), Args[I]); 6541 6542 if (R.isInvalid()) 6543 return false; 6544 6545 ConvertedArgs.push_back(R.get()); 6546 } 6547 6548 if (Trap.hasErrorOccurred()) 6549 return false; 6550 6551 // Push default arguments if needed. 6552 if (!Function->isVariadic() && Args.size() < Function->getNumParams()) { 6553 for (unsigned i = Args.size(), e = Function->getNumParams(); i != e; ++i) { 6554 ParmVarDecl *P = Function->getParamDecl(i); 6555 if (!P->hasDefaultArg()) 6556 return false; 6557 ExprResult R = S.BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(CallLoc, Function, P); 6558 if (R.isInvalid()) 6559 return false; 6560 ConvertedArgs.push_back(R.get()); 6561 } 6562 6563 if (Trap.hasErrorOccurred()) 6564 return false; 6565 } 6566 return true; 6567 } 6568 6569 EnableIfAttr *Sema::CheckEnableIf(FunctionDecl *Function, 6570 SourceLocation CallLoc, 6571 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 6572 bool MissingImplicitThis) { 6573 auto EnableIfAttrs = Function->specific_attrs<EnableIfAttr>(); 6574 if (EnableIfAttrs.begin() == EnableIfAttrs.end()) 6575 return nullptr; 6576 6577 SFINAETrap Trap(*this); 6578 SmallVector<Expr *, 16> ConvertedArgs; 6579 // FIXME: We should look into making enable_if late-parsed. 6580 Expr *DiscardedThis; 6581 if (!convertArgsForAvailabilityChecks( 6582 *this, Function, /*ThisArg=*/nullptr, CallLoc, Args, Trap, 6583 /*MissingImplicitThis=*/true, DiscardedThis, ConvertedArgs)) 6584 return *EnableIfAttrs.begin(); 6585 6586 for (auto *EIA : EnableIfAttrs) { 6587 APValue Result; 6588 // FIXME: This doesn't consider value-dependent cases, because doing so is 6589 // very difficult. Ideally, we should handle them more gracefully. 6590 if (EIA->getCond()->isValueDependent() || 6591 !EIA->getCond()->EvaluateWithSubstitution( 6592 Result, Context, Function, llvm::makeArrayRef(ConvertedArgs))) 6593 return EIA; 6594 6595 if (!Result.isInt() || !Result.getInt().getBoolValue()) 6596 return EIA; 6597 } 6598 return nullptr; 6599 } 6600 6601 template <typename CheckFn> 6602 static bool diagnoseDiagnoseIfAttrsWith(Sema &S, const NamedDecl *ND, 6603 bool ArgDependent, SourceLocation Loc, 6604 CheckFn &&IsSuccessful) { 6605 SmallVector<const DiagnoseIfAttr *, 8> Attrs; 6606 for (const auto *DIA : ND->specific_attrs<DiagnoseIfAttr>()) { 6607 if (ArgDependent == DIA->getArgDependent()) 6608 Attrs.push_back(DIA); 6609 } 6610 6611 // Common case: No diagnose_if attributes, so we can quit early. 6612 if (Attrs.empty()) 6613 return false; 6614 6615 auto WarningBegin = std::stable_partition( 6616 Attrs.begin(), Attrs.end(), 6617 [](const DiagnoseIfAttr *DIA) { return DIA->isError(); }); 6618 6619 // Note that diagnose_if attributes are late-parsed, so they appear in the 6620 // correct order (unlike enable_if attributes). 6621 auto ErrAttr = llvm::find_if(llvm::make_range(Attrs.begin(), WarningBegin), 6622 IsSuccessful); 6623 if (ErrAttr != WarningBegin) { 6624 const DiagnoseIfAttr *DIA = *ErrAttr; 6625 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_diagnose_if_succeeded) << DIA->getMessage(); 6626 S.Diag(DIA->getLocation(), diag::note_from_diagnose_if) 6627 << DIA->getParent() << DIA->getCond()->getSourceRange(); 6628 return true; 6629 } 6630 6631 for (const auto *DIA : llvm::make_range(WarningBegin, Attrs.end())) 6632 if (IsSuccessful(DIA)) { 6633 S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_diagnose_if_succeeded) << DIA->getMessage(); 6634 S.Diag(DIA->getLocation(), diag::note_from_diagnose_if) 6635 << DIA->getParent() << DIA->getCond()->getSourceRange(); 6636 } 6637 6638 return false; 6639 } 6640 6641 bool Sema::diagnoseArgDependentDiagnoseIfAttrs(const FunctionDecl *Function, 6642 const Expr *ThisArg, 6643 ArrayRef<const Expr *> Args, 6644 SourceLocation Loc) { 6645 return diagnoseDiagnoseIfAttrsWith( 6646 *this, Function, /*ArgDependent=*/true, Loc, 6647 [&](const DiagnoseIfAttr *DIA) { 6648 APValue Result; 6649 // It's sane to use the same Args for any redecl of this function, since 6650 // EvaluateWithSubstitution only cares about the position of each 6651 // argument in the arg list, not the ParmVarDecl* it maps to. 6652 if (!DIA->getCond()->EvaluateWithSubstitution( 6653 Result, Context, cast<FunctionDecl>(DIA->getParent()), Args, ThisArg)) 6654 return false; 6655 return Result.isInt() && Result.getInt().getBoolValue(); 6656 }); 6657 } 6658 6659 bool Sema::diagnoseArgIndependentDiagnoseIfAttrs(const NamedDecl *ND, 6660 SourceLocation Loc) { 6661 return diagnoseDiagnoseIfAttrsWith( 6662 *this, ND, /*ArgDependent=*/false, Loc, 6663 [&](const DiagnoseIfAttr *DIA) { 6664 bool Result; 6665 return DIA->getCond()->EvaluateAsBooleanCondition(Result, Context) && 6666 Result; 6667 }); 6668 } 6669 6670 /// Add all of the function declarations in the given function set to 6671 /// the overload candidate set. 6672 void Sema::AddFunctionCandidates(const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns, 6673 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 6674 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, 6675 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs, 6676 bool SuppressUserConversions, 6677 bool PartialOverloading, 6678 bool FirstArgumentIsBase) { 6679 for (UnresolvedSetIterator F = Fns.begin(), E = Fns.end(); F != E; ++F) { 6680 NamedDecl *D = F.getDecl()->getUnderlyingDecl(); 6681 ArrayRef<Expr *> FunctionArgs = Args; 6682 6683 FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D); 6684 FunctionDecl *FD = 6685 FunTmpl ? FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl() : cast<FunctionDecl>(D); 6686 6687 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FD) && !cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->isStatic()) { 6688 QualType ObjectType; 6689 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification; 6690 if (Args.size() > 0) { 6691 if (Expr *E = Args[0]) { 6692 // Use the explicit base to restrict the lookup: 6693 ObjectType = E->getType(); 6694 // Pointers in the object arguments are implicitly dereferenced, so we 6695 // always classify them as l-values. 6696 if (!ObjectType.isNull() && ObjectType->isPointerType()) 6697 ObjectClassification = Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue(); 6698 else 6699 ObjectClassification = E->Classify(Context); 6700 } // .. else there is an implicit base. 6701 FunctionArgs = Args.slice(1); 6702 } 6703 if (FunTmpl) { 6704 AddMethodTemplateCandidate( 6705 FunTmpl, F.getPair(), 6706 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FunTmpl->getDeclContext()), 6707 ExplicitTemplateArgs, ObjectType, ObjectClassification, 6708 FunctionArgs, CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions, 6709 PartialOverloading); 6710 } else { 6711 AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD), F.getPair(), 6712 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->getParent(), ObjectType, 6713 ObjectClassification, FunctionArgs, CandidateSet, 6714 SuppressUserConversions, PartialOverloading); 6715 } 6716 } else { 6717 // This branch handles both standalone functions and static methods. 6718 6719 // Slice the first argument (which is the base) when we access 6720 // static method as non-static. 6721 if (Args.size() > 0 && 6722 (!Args[0] || (FirstArgumentIsBase && isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FD) && 6723 !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(FD)))) { 6724 assert(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->isStatic()); 6725 FunctionArgs = Args.slice(1); 6726 } 6727 if (FunTmpl) { 6728 AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FunTmpl, F.getPair(), 6729 ExplicitTemplateArgs, FunctionArgs, 6730 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions, 6731 PartialOverloading); 6732 } else { 6733 AddOverloadCandidate(FD, F.getPair(), FunctionArgs, CandidateSet, 6734 SuppressUserConversions, PartialOverloading); 6735 } 6736 } 6737 } 6738 } 6739 6740 /// AddMethodCandidate - Adds a named decl (which is some kind of 6741 /// method) as a method candidate to the given overload set. 6742 void Sema::AddMethodCandidate(DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, QualType ObjectType, 6743 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification, 6744 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 6745 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, 6746 bool SuppressUserConversions, 6747 OverloadCandidateParamOrder PO) { 6748 NamedDecl *Decl = FoundDecl.getDecl(); 6749 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Decl->getDeclContext()); 6750 6751 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Decl)) 6752 Decl = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Decl)->getTargetDecl(); 6753 6754 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *TD = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Decl)) { 6755 assert(isa<CXXMethodDecl>(TD->getTemplatedDecl()) && 6756 "Expected a member function template"); 6757 AddMethodTemplateCandidate(TD, FoundDecl, ActingContext, 6758 /*ExplicitArgs*/ nullptr, ObjectType, 6759 ObjectClassification, Args, CandidateSet, 6760 SuppressUserConversions, false, PO); 6761 } else { 6762 AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Decl), FoundDecl, ActingContext, 6763 ObjectType, ObjectClassification, Args, CandidateSet, 6764 SuppressUserConversions, false, None, PO); 6765 } 6766 } 6767 6768 /// AddMethodCandidate - Adds the given C++ member function to the set 6769 /// of candidate functions, using the given function call arguments 6770 /// and the object argument (@c Object). For example, in a call 6771 /// @c o.f(a1,a2), @c Object will contain @c o and @c Args will contain 6772 /// both @c a1 and @c a2. If @p SuppressUserConversions, then don't 6773 /// allow user-defined conversions via constructors or conversion 6774 /// operators. 6775 void 6776 Sema::AddMethodCandidate(CXXMethodDecl *Method, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, 6777 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext, QualType ObjectType, 6778 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification, 6779 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 6780 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, 6781 bool SuppressUserConversions, 6782 bool PartialOverloading, 6783 ConversionSequenceList EarlyConversions, 6784 OverloadCandidateParamOrder PO) { 6785 const FunctionProtoType *Proto 6786 = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>()); 6787 assert(Proto && "Methods without a prototype cannot be overloaded"); 6788 assert(!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method) && 6789 "Use AddOverloadCandidate for constructors"); 6790 6791 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Method, PO)) 6792 return; 6793 6794 // C++11 [class.copy]p23: [DR1402] 6795 // A defaulted move assignment operator that is defined as deleted is 6796 // ignored by overload resolution. 6797 if (Method->isDefaulted() && Method->isDeleted() && 6798 Method->isMoveAssignmentOperator()) 6799 return; 6800 6801 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context. 6802 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated( 6803 *this, Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::Unevaluated); 6804 6805 // Add this candidate 6806 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = 6807 CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size() + 1, EarlyConversions); 6808 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl; 6809 Candidate.Function = Method; 6810 Candidate.RewriteKind = 6811 CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().getRewriteKind(Method, PO); 6812 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false; 6813 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false; 6814 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size(); 6815 6816 unsigned NumParams = Proto->getNumParams(); 6817 6818 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m 6819 // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter 6820 // list (8.3.5). 6821 if (TooManyArguments(NumParams, Args.size(), PartialOverloading) && 6822 !Proto->isVariadic()) { 6823 Candidate.Viable = false; 6824 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments; 6825 return; 6826 } 6827 6828 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having more than m parameters 6829 // is viable only if the (m+1)st parameter has a default argument 6830 // (8.3.6). For the purposes of overload resolution, the 6831 // parameter list is truncated on the right, so that there are 6832 // exactly m parameters. 6833 unsigned MinRequiredArgs = Method->getMinRequiredArguments(); 6834 if (Args.size() < MinRequiredArgs && !PartialOverloading) { 6835 // Not enough arguments. 6836 Candidate.Viable = false; 6837 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments; 6838 return; 6839 } 6840 6841 Candidate.Viable = true; 6842 6843 if (Method->isStatic() || ObjectType.isNull()) 6844 // The implicit object argument is ignored. 6845 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = true; 6846 else { 6847 unsigned ConvIdx = PO == OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed ? 1 : 0; 6848 // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the object 6849 // parameter. 6850 Candidate.Conversions[ConvIdx] = TryObjectArgumentInitialization( 6851 *this, CandidateSet.getLocation(), ObjectType, ObjectClassification, 6852 Method, ActingContext); 6853 if (Candidate.Conversions[ConvIdx].isBad()) { 6854 Candidate.Viable = false; 6855 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion; 6856 return; 6857 } 6858 } 6859 6860 // (CUDA B.1): Check for invalid calls between targets. 6861 if (getLangOpts().CUDA) 6862 if (const FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(CurContext)) 6863 if (!IsAllowedCUDACall(Caller, Method)) { 6864 Candidate.Viable = false; 6865 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_target; 6866 return; 6867 } 6868 6869 if (Method->getTrailingRequiresClause()) { 6870 ConstraintSatisfaction Satisfaction; 6871 if (CheckFunctionConstraints(Method, Satisfaction) || 6872 !Satisfaction.IsSatisfied) { 6873 Candidate.Viable = false; 6874 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_constraints_not_satisfied; 6875 return; 6876 } 6877 } 6878 6879 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the 6880 // arguments. 6881 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < Args.size(); ++ArgIdx) { 6882 unsigned ConvIdx = 6883 PO == OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed ? 0 : (ArgIdx + 1); 6884 if (Candidate.Conversions[ConvIdx].isInitialized()) { 6885 // We already formed a conversion sequence for this parameter during 6886 // template argument deduction. 6887 } else if (ArgIdx < NumParams) { 6888 // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall 6889 // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence 6890 // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding 6891 // parameter of F. 6892 QualType ParamType = Proto->getParamType(ArgIdx); 6893 Candidate.Conversions[ConvIdx] 6894 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType, 6895 SuppressUserConversions, 6896 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true, 6897 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/ 6898 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount); 6899 if (Candidate.Conversions[ConvIdx].isBad()) { 6900 Candidate.Viable = false; 6901 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion; 6902 return; 6903 } 6904 } else { 6905 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any 6906 // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is 6907 // considered to "match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3). 6908 Candidate.Conversions[ConvIdx].setEllipsis(); 6909 } 6910 } 6911 6912 if (EnableIfAttr *FailedAttr = 6913 CheckEnableIf(Method, CandidateSet.getLocation(), Args, true)) { 6914 Candidate.Viable = false; 6915 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_enable_if; 6916 Candidate.DeductionFailure.Data = FailedAttr; 6917 return; 6918 } 6919 6920 if (Method->isMultiVersion() && Method->hasAttr<TargetAttr>() && 6921 !Method->getAttr<TargetAttr>()->isDefaultVersion()) { 6922 Candidate.Viable = false; 6923 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_non_default_multiversion_function; 6924 } 6925 } 6926 6927 /// Add a C++ member function template as a candidate to the candidate 6928 /// set, using template argument deduction to produce an appropriate member 6929 /// function template specialization. 6930 void Sema::AddMethodTemplateCandidate( 6931 FunctionTemplateDecl *MethodTmpl, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, 6932 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext, 6933 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs, QualType ObjectType, 6934 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 6935 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, bool SuppressUserConversions, 6936 bool PartialOverloading, OverloadCandidateParamOrder PO) { 6937 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(MethodTmpl, PO)) 6938 return; 6939 6940 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p7: 6941 // In each case where a candidate is a function template, candidate 6942 // function template specializations are generated using template argument 6943 // deduction (14.8.3, 14.8.2). Those candidates are then handled as 6944 // candidate functions in the usual way.113) A given name can refer to one 6945 // or more function templates and also to a set of overloaded non-template 6946 // functions. In such a case, the candidate functions generated from each 6947 // function template are combined with the set of non-template candidate 6948 // functions. 6949 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(CandidateSet.getLocation()); 6950 FunctionDecl *Specialization = nullptr; 6951 ConversionSequenceList Conversions; 6952 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result = DeduceTemplateArguments( 6953 MethodTmpl, ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, Specialization, Info, 6954 PartialOverloading, [&](ArrayRef<QualType> ParamTypes) { 6955 return CheckNonDependentConversions( 6956 MethodTmpl, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, Conversions, 6957 SuppressUserConversions, ActingContext, ObjectType, 6958 ObjectClassification, PO); 6959 })) { 6960 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = 6961 CandidateSet.addCandidate(Conversions.size(), Conversions); 6962 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl; 6963 Candidate.Function = MethodTmpl->getTemplatedDecl(); 6964 Candidate.Viable = false; 6965 Candidate.RewriteKind = 6966 CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().getRewriteKind(Candidate.Function, PO); 6967 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false; 6968 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = 6969 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Candidate.Function)->isStatic() || 6970 ObjectType.isNull(); 6971 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size(); 6972 if (Result == TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure) 6973 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion; 6974 else { 6975 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction; 6976 Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result, 6977 Info); 6978 } 6979 return; 6980 } 6981 6982 // Add the function template specialization produced by template argument 6983 // deduction as a candidate. 6984 assert(Specialization && "Missing member function template specialization?"); 6985 assert(isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Specialization) && 6986 "Specialization is not a member function?"); 6987 AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Specialization), FoundDecl, 6988 ActingContext, ObjectType, ObjectClassification, Args, 6989 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions, PartialOverloading, 6990 Conversions, PO); 6991 } 6992 6993 /// Determine whether a given function template has a simple explicit specifier 6994 /// or a non-value-dependent explicit-specification that evaluates to true. 6995 static bool isNonDependentlyExplicit(FunctionTemplateDecl *FTD) { 6996 return ExplicitSpecifier::getFromDecl(FTD->getTemplatedDecl()).isExplicit(); 6997 } 6998 6999 /// Add a C++ function template specialization as a candidate 7000 /// in the candidate set, using template argument deduction to produce 7001 /// an appropriate function template specialization. 7002 void Sema::AddTemplateOverloadCandidate( 7003 FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, 7004 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 7005 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, bool SuppressUserConversions, 7006 bool PartialOverloading, bool AllowExplicit, ADLCallKind IsADLCandidate, 7007 OverloadCandidateParamOrder PO) { 7008 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(FunctionTemplate, PO)) 7009 return; 7010 7011 // If the function template has a non-dependent explicit specification, 7012 // exclude it now if appropriate; we are not permitted to perform deduction 7013 // and substitution in this case. 7014 if (!AllowExplicit && isNonDependentlyExplicit(FunctionTemplate)) { 7015 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(); 7016 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl; 7017 Candidate.Function = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl(); 7018 Candidate.Viable = false; 7019 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_explicit; 7020 return; 7021 } 7022 7023 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p7: 7024 // In each case where a candidate is a function template, candidate 7025 // function template specializations are generated using template argument 7026 // deduction (14.8.3, 14.8.2). Those candidates are then handled as 7027 // candidate functions in the usual way.113) A given name can refer to one 7028 // or more function templates and also to a set of overloaded non-template 7029 // functions. In such a case, the candidate functions generated from each 7030 // function template are combined with the set of non-template candidate 7031 // functions. 7032 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(CandidateSet.getLocation()); 7033 FunctionDecl *Specialization = nullptr; 7034 ConversionSequenceList Conversions; 7035 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result = DeduceTemplateArguments( 7036 FunctionTemplate, ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, Specialization, Info, 7037 PartialOverloading, [&](ArrayRef<QualType> ParamTypes) { 7038 return CheckNonDependentConversions( 7039 FunctionTemplate, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, Conversions, 7040 SuppressUserConversions, nullptr, QualType(), {}, PO); 7041 })) { 7042 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = 7043 CandidateSet.addCandidate(Conversions.size(), Conversions); 7044 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl; 7045 Candidate.Function = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl(); 7046 Candidate.Viable = false; 7047 Candidate.RewriteKind = 7048 CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().getRewriteKind(Candidate.Function, PO); 7049 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false; 7050 Candidate.IsADLCandidate = IsADLCandidate; 7051 // Ignore the object argument if there is one, since we don't have an object 7052 // type. 7053 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = 7054 isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Candidate.Function) && 7055 !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Candidate.Function); 7056 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size(); 7057 if (Result == TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure) 7058 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion; 7059 else { 7060 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction; 7061 Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result, 7062 Info); 7063 } 7064 return; 7065 } 7066 7067 // Add the function template specialization produced by template argument 7068 // deduction as a candidate. 7069 assert(Specialization && "Missing function template specialization?"); 7070 AddOverloadCandidate( 7071 Specialization, FoundDecl, Args, CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions, 7072 PartialOverloading, AllowExplicit, 7073 /*AllowExplicitConversions*/ false, IsADLCandidate, Conversions, PO); 7074 } 7075 7076 /// Check that implicit conversion sequences can be formed for each argument 7077 /// whose corresponding parameter has a non-dependent type, per DR1391's 7078 /// [temp.deduct.call]p10. 7079 bool Sema::CheckNonDependentConversions( 7080 FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate, ArrayRef<QualType> ParamTypes, 7081 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, 7082 ConversionSequenceList &Conversions, bool SuppressUserConversions, 7083 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext, QualType ObjectType, 7084 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification, OverloadCandidateParamOrder PO) { 7085 // FIXME: The cases in which we allow explicit conversions for constructor 7086 // arguments never consider calling a constructor template. It's not clear 7087 // that is correct. 7088 const bool AllowExplicit = false; 7089 7090 auto *FD = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl(); 7091 auto *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD); 7092 bool HasThisConversion = Method && !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method); 7093 unsigned ThisConversions = HasThisConversion ? 1 : 0; 7094 7095 Conversions = 7096 CandidateSet.allocateConversionSequences(ThisConversions + Args.size()); 7097 7098 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context. 7099 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated( 7100 *this, Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::Unevaluated); 7101 7102 // For a method call, check the 'this' conversion here too. DR1391 doesn't 7103 // require that, but this check should never result in a hard error, and 7104 // overload resolution is permitted to sidestep instantiations. 7105 if (HasThisConversion && !cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->isStatic() && 7106 !ObjectType.isNull()) { 7107 unsigned ConvIdx = PO == OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed ? 1 : 0; 7108 Conversions[ConvIdx] = TryObjectArgumentInitialization( 7109 *this, CandidateSet.getLocation(), ObjectType, ObjectClassification, 7110 Method, ActingContext); 7111 if (Conversions[ConvIdx].isBad()) 7112 return true; 7113 } 7114 7115 for (unsigned I = 0, N = std::min(ParamTypes.size(), Args.size()); I != N; 7116 ++I) { 7117 QualType ParamType = ParamTypes[I]; 7118 if (!ParamType->isDependentType()) { 7119 unsigned ConvIdx = PO == OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed 7120 ? 0 7121 : (ThisConversions + I); 7122 Conversions[ConvIdx] 7123 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[I], ParamType, 7124 SuppressUserConversions, 7125 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true, 7126 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/ 7127 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount, 7128 AllowExplicit); 7129 if (Conversions[ConvIdx].isBad()) 7130 return true; 7131 } 7132 } 7133 7134 return false; 7135 } 7136 7137 /// Determine whether this is an allowable conversion from the result 7138 /// of an explicit conversion operator to the expected type, per C++ 7139 /// [over.match.conv]p1 and [over.match.ref]p1. 7140 /// 7141 /// \param ConvType The return type of the conversion function. 7142 /// 7143 /// \param ToType The type we are converting to. 7144 /// 7145 /// \param AllowObjCPointerConversion Allow a conversion from one 7146 /// Objective-C pointer to another. 7147 /// 7148 /// \returns true if the conversion is allowable, false otherwise. 7149 static bool isAllowableExplicitConversion(Sema &S, 7150 QualType ConvType, QualType ToType, 7151 bool AllowObjCPointerConversion) { 7152 QualType ToNonRefType = ToType.getNonReferenceType(); 7153 7154 // Easy case: the types are the same. 7155 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ConvType, ToNonRefType)) 7156 return true; 7157 7158 // Allow qualification conversions. 7159 bool ObjCLifetimeConversion; 7160 if (S.IsQualificationConversion(ConvType, ToNonRefType, /*CStyle*/false, 7161 ObjCLifetimeConversion)) 7162 return true; 7163 7164 // If we're not allowed to consider Objective-C pointer conversions, 7165 // we're done. 7166 if (!AllowObjCPointerConversion) 7167 return false; 7168 7169 // Is this an Objective-C pointer conversion? 7170 bool IncompatibleObjC = false; 7171 QualType ConvertedType; 7172 return S.isObjCPointerConversion(ConvType, ToNonRefType, ConvertedType, 7173 IncompatibleObjC); 7174 } 7175 7176 /// AddConversionCandidate - Add a C++ conversion function as a 7177 /// candidate in the candidate set (C++ [over.match.conv], 7178 /// C++ [over.match.copy]). From is the expression we're converting from, 7179 /// and ToType is the type that we're eventually trying to convert to 7180 /// (which may or may not be the same type as the type that the 7181 /// conversion function produces). 7182 void Sema::AddConversionCandidate( 7183 CXXConversionDecl *Conversion, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, 7184 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 7185 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit, 7186 bool AllowExplicit, bool AllowResultConversion) { 7187 assert(!Conversion->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() && 7188 "Conversion function templates use AddTemplateConversionCandidate"); 7189 QualType ConvType = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType(); 7190 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Conversion)) 7191 return; 7192 7193 // If the conversion function has an undeduced return type, trigger its 7194 // deduction now. 7195 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 && ConvType->isUndeducedType()) { 7196 if (DeduceReturnType(Conversion, From->getExprLoc())) 7197 return; 7198 ConvType = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType(); 7199 } 7200 7201 // If we don't allow any conversion of the result type, ignore conversion 7202 // functions that don't convert to exactly (possibly cv-qualified) T. 7203 if (!AllowResultConversion && 7204 !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Conversion->getConversionType(), ToType)) 7205 return; 7206 7207 // Per C++ [over.match.conv]p1, [over.match.ref]p1, an explicit conversion 7208 // operator is only a candidate if its return type is the target type or 7209 // can be converted to the target type with a qualification conversion. 7210 // 7211 // FIXME: Include such functions in the candidate list and explain why we 7212 // can't select them. 7213 if (Conversion->isExplicit() && 7214 !isAllowableExplicitConversion(*this, ConvType, ToType, 7215 AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit)) 7216 return; 7217 7218 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context. 7219 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated( 7220 *this, Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::Unevaluated); 7221 7222 // Add this candidate 7223 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(1); 7224 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl; 7225 Candidate.Function = Conversion; 7226 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false; 7227 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false; 7228 Candidate.FinalConversion.setAsIdentityConversion(); 7229 Candidate.FinalConversion.setFromType(ConvType); 7230 Candidate.FinalConversion.setAllToTypes(ToType); 7231 Candidate.Viable = true; 7232 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = 1; 7233 7234 // Explicit functions are not actually candidates at all if we're not 7235 // allowing them in this context, but keep them around so we can point 7236 // to them in diagnostics. 7237 if (!AllowExplicit && Conversion->isExplicit()) { 7238 Candidate.Viable = false; 7239 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_explicit; 7240 return; 7241 } 7242 7243 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p4: 7244 // For conversion functions, the function is considered to be a member of 7245 // the class of the implicit implied object argument for the purpose of 7246 // defining the type of the implicit object parameter. 7247 // 7248 // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the implicit 7249 // object parameter. 7250 QualType ImplicitParamType = From->getType(); 7251 if (const PointerType *FromPtrType = ImplicitParamType->getAs<PointerType>()) 7252 ImplicitParamType = FromPtrType->getPointeeType(); 7253 CXXRecordDecl *ConversionContext 7254 = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(ImplicitParamType->castAs<RecordType>()->getDecl()); 7255 7256 Candidate.Conversions[0] = TryObjectArgumentInitialization( 7257 *this, CandidateSet.getLocation(), From->getType(), 7258 From->Classify(Context), Conversion, ConversionContext); 7259 7260 if (Candidate.Conversions[0].isBad()) { 7261 Candidate.Viable = false; 7262 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion; 7263 return; 7264 } 7265 7266 if (Conversion->getTrailingRequiresClause()) { 7267 ConstraintSatisfaction Satisfaction; 7268 if (CheckFunctionConstraints(Conversion, Satisfaction) || 7269 !Satisfaction.IsSatisfied) { 7270 Candidate.Viable = false; 7271 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_constraints_not_satisfied; 7272 return; 7273 } 7274 } 7275 7276 // We won't go through a user-defined type conversion function to convert a 7277 // derived to base as such conversions are given Conversion Rank. They only 7278 // go through a copy constructor. 13.3.3.1.2-p4 [over.ics.user] 7279 QualType FromCanon 7280 = Context.getCanonicalType(From->getType().getUnqualifiedType()); 7281 QualType ToCanon = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType).getUnqualifiedType(); 7282 if (FromCanon == ToCanon || 7283 IsDerivedFrom(CandidateSet.getLocation(), FromCanon, ToCanon)) { 7284 Candidate.Viable = false; 7285 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_trivial_conversion; 7286 return; 7287 } 7288 7289 // To determine what the conversion from the result of calling the 7290 // conversion function to the type we're eventually trying to 7291 // convert to (ToType), we need to synthesize a call to the 7292 // conversion function and attempt copy initialization from it. This 7293 // makes sure that we get the right semantics with respect to 7294 // lvalues/rvalues and the type. Fortunately, we can allocate this 7295 // call on the stack and we don't need its arguments to be 7296 // well-formed. 7297 DeclRefExpr ConversionRef(Context, Conversion, false, Conversion->getType(), 7298 VK_LValue, From->getBeginLoc()); 7299 ImplicitCastExpr ConversionFn(ImplicitCastExpr::OnStack, 7300 Context.getPointerType(Conversion->getType()), 7301 CK_FunctionToPointerDecay, &ConversionRef, 7302 VK_RValue, FPOptionsOverride()); 7303 7304 QualType ConversionType = Conversion->getConversionType(); 7305 if (!isCompleteType(From->getBeginLoc(), ConversionType)) { 7306 Candidate.Viable = false; 7307 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion; 7308 return; 7309 } 7310 7311 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ConversionType); 7312 7313 // Note that it is safe to allocate CallExpr on the stack here because 7314 // there are 0 arguments (i.e., nothing is allocated using ASTContext's 7315 // allocator). 7316 QualType CallResultType = ConversionType.getNonLValueExprType(Context); 7317 7318 alignas(CallExpr) char Buffer[sizeof(CallExpr) + sizeof(Stmt *)]; 7319 CallExpr *TheTemporaryCall = CallExpr::CreateTemporary( 7320 Buffer, &ConversionFn, CallResultType, VK, From->getBeginLoc()); 7321 7322 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = 7323 TryCopyInitialization(*this, TheTemporaryCall, ToType, 7324 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/true, 7325 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, 7326 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false); 7327 7328 switch (ICS.getKind()) { 7329 case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion: 7330 Candidate.FinalConversion = ICS.Standard; 7331 7332 // C++ [over.ics.user]p3: 7333 // If the user-defined conversion is specified by a specialization of a 7334 // conversion function template, the second standard conversion sequence 7335 // shall have exact match rank. 7336 if (Conversion->getPrimaryTemplate() && 7337 GetConversionRank(ICS.Standard.Second) != ICR_Exact_Match) { 7338 Candidate.Viable = false; 7339 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_final_conversion_not_exact; 7340 return; 7341 } 7342 7343 // C++0x [dcl.init.ref]p5: 7344 // In the second case, if the reference is an rvalue reference and 7345 // the second standard conversion sequence of the user-defined 7346 // conversion sequence includes an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion, the 7347 // program is ill-formed. 7348 if (ToType->isRValueReferenceType() && 7349 ICS.Standard.First == ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue) { 7350 Candidate.Viable = false; 7351 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion; 7352 return; 7353 } 7354 break; 7355 7356 case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion: 7357 Candidate.Viable = false; 7358 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion; 7359 return; 7360 7361 default: 7362 llvm_unreachable( 7363 "Can only end up with a standard conversion sequence or failure"); 7364 } 7365 7366 if (EnableIfAttr *FailedAttr = 7367 CheckEnableIf(Conversion, CandidateSet.getLocation(), None)) { 7368 Candidate.Viable = false; 7369 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_enable_if; 7370 Candidate.DeductionFailure.Data = FailedAttr; 7371 return; 7372 } 7373 7374 if (Conversion->isMultiVersion() && Conversion->hasAttr<TargetAttr>() && 7375 !Conversion->getAttr<TargetAttr>()->isDefaultVersion()) { 7376 Candidate.Viable = false; 7377 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_non_default_multiversion_function; 7378 } 7379 } 7380 7381 /// Adds a conversion function template specialization 7382 /// candidate to the overload set, using template argument deduction 7383 /// to deduce the template arguments of the conversion function 7384 /// template from the type that we are converting to (C++ 7385 /// [temp.deduct.conv]). 7386 void Sema::AddTemplateConversionCandidate( 7387 FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, 7388 CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 7389 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit, 7390 bool AllowExplicit, bool AllowResultConversion) { 7391 assert(isa<CXXConversionDecl>(FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl()) && 7392 "Only conversion function templates permitted here"); 7393 7394 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(FunctionTemplate)) 7395 return; 7396 7397 // If the function template has a non-dependent explicit specification, 7398 // exclude it now if appropriate; we are not permitted to perform deduction 7399 // and substitution in this case. 7400 if (!AllowExplicit && isNonDependentlyExplicit(FunctionTemplate)) { 7401 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(); 7402 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl; 7403 Candidate.Function = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl(); 7404 Candidate.Viable = false; 7405 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_explicit; 7406 return; 7407 } 7408 7409 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(CandidateSet.getLocation()); 7410 CXXConversionDecl *Specialization = nullptr; 7411 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result 7412 = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, ToType, 7413 Specialization, Info)) { 7414 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(); 7415 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl; 7416 Candidate.Function = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl(); 7417 Candidate.Viable = false; 7418 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction; 7419 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false; 7420 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false; 7421 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = 1; 7422 Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result, 7423 Info); 7424 return; 7425 } 7426 7427 // Add the conversion function template specialization produced by 7428 // template argument deduction as a candidate. 7429 assert(Specialization && "Missing function template specialization?"); 7430 AddConversionCandidate(Specialization, FoundDecl, ActingDC, From, ToType, 7431 CandidateSet, AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit, 7432 AllowExplicit, AllowResultConversion); 7433 } 7434 7435 /// AddSurrogateCandidate - Adds a "surrogate" candidate function that 7436 /// converts the given @c Object to a function pointer via the 7437 /// conversion function @c Conversion, and then attempts to call it 7438 /// with the given arguments (C++ [over.call.object]p2-4). Proto is 7439 /// the type of function that we'll eventually be calling. 7440 void Sema::AddSurrogateCandidate(CXXConversionDecl *Conversion, 7441 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, 7442 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext, 7443 const FunctionProtoType *Proto, 7444 Expr *Object, 7445 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 7446 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet) { 7447 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Conversion)) 7448 return; 7449 7450 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context. 7451 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated( 7452 *this, Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::Unevaluated); 7453 7454 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size() + 1); 7455 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl; 7456 Candidate.Function = nullptr; 7457 Candidate.Surrogate = Conversion; 7458 Candidate.Viable = true; 7459 Candidate.IsSurrogate = true; 7460 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false; 7461 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size(); 7462 7463 // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the implicit 7464 // object parameter. 7465 ImplicitConversionSequence ObjectInit = TryObjectArgumentInitialization( 7466 *this, CandidateSet.getLocation(), Object->getType(), 7467 Object->Classify(Context), Conversion, ActingContext); 7468 if (ObjectInit.isBad()) { 7469 Candidate.Viable = false; 7470 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion; 7471 Candidate.Conversions[0] = ObjectInit; 7472 return; 7473 } 7474 7475 // The first conversion is actually a user-defined conversion whose 7476 // first conversion is ObjectInit's standard conversion (which is 7477 // effectively a reference binding). Record it as such. 7478 Candidate.Conversions[0].setUserDefined(); 7479 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.Before = ObjectInit.Standard; 7480 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.EllipsisConversion = false; 7481 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.HadMultipleCandidates = false; 7482 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.ConversionFunction = Conversion; 7483 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.FoundConversionFunction = FoundDecl; 7484 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.After 7485 = Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.Before; 7486 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.After.setAsIdentityConversion(); 7487 7488 // Find the 7489 unsigned NumParams = Proto->getNumParams(); 7490 7491 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m 7492 // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter 7493 // list (8.3.5). 7494 if (Args.size() > NumParams && !Proto->isVariadic()) { 7495 Candidate.Viable = false; 7496 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments; 7497 return; 7498 } 7499 7500 // Function types don't have any default arguments, so just check if 7501 // we have enough arguments. 7502 if (Args.size() < NumParams) { 7503 // Not enough arguments. 7504 Candidate.Viable = false; 7505 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments; 7506 return; 7507 } 7508 7509 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the 7510 // arguments. 7511 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) { 7512 if (ArgIdx < NumParams) { 7513 // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall 7514 // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence 7515 // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding 7516 // parameter of F. 7517 QualType ParamType = Proto->getParamType(ArgIdx); 7518 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1] 7519 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType, 7520 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, 7521 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, 7522 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/ 7523 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount); 7524 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].isBad()) { 7525 Candidate.Viable = false; 7526 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion; 7527 return; 7528 } 7529 } else { 7530 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any 7531 // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is 7532 // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3). 7533 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].setEllipsis(); 7534 } 7535 } 7536 7537 if (EnableIfAttr *FailedAttr = 7538 CheckEnableIf(Conversion, CandidateSet.getLocation(), None)) { 7539 Candidate.Viable = false; 7540 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_enable_if; 7541 Candidate.DeductionFailure.Data = FailedAttr; 7542 return; 7543 } 7544 } 7545 7546 /// Add all of the non-member operator function declarations in the given 7547 /// function set to the overload candidate set. 7548 void Sema::AddNonMemberOperatorCandidates( 7549 const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 7550 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, 7551 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs) { 7552 for (UnresolvedSetIterator F = Fns.begin(), E = Fns.end(); F != E; ++F) { 7553 NamedDecl *D = F.getDecl()->getUnderlyingDecl(); 7554 ArrayRef<Expr *> FunctionArgs = Args; 7555 7556 FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D); 7557 FunctionDecl *FD = 7558 FunTmpl ? FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl() : cast<FunctionDecl>(D); 7559 7560 // Don't consider rewritten functions if we're not rewriting. 7561 if (!CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().isAcceptableCandidate(FD)) 7562 continue; 7563 7564 assert(!isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FD) && 7565 "unqualified operator lookup found a member function"); 7566 7567 if (FunTmpl) { 7568 AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FunTmpl, F.getPair(), ExplicitTemplateArgs, 7569 FunctionArgs, CandidateSet); 7570 if (CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().shouldAddReversed(Context, FD)) 7571 AddTemplateOverloadCandidate( 7572 FunTmpl, F.getPair(), ExplicitTemplateArgs, 7573 {FunctionArgs[1], FunctionArgs[0]}, CandidateSet, false, false, 7574 true, ADLCallKind::NotADL, OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed); 7575 } else { 7576 if (ExplicitTemplateArgs) 7577 continue; 7578 AddOverloadCandidate(FD, F.getPair(), FunctionArgs, CandidateSet); 7579 if (CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().shouldAddReversed(Context, FD)) 7580 AddOverloadCandidate(FD, F.getPair(), 7581 {FunctionArgs[1], FunctionArgs[0]}, CandidateSet, 7582 false, false, true, false, ADLCallKind::NotADL, 7583 None, OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed); 7584 } 7585 } 7586 } 7587 7588 /// Add overload candidates for overloaded operators that are 7589 /// member functions. 7590 /// 7591 /// Add the overloaded operator candidates that are member functions 7592 /// for the operator Op that was used in an operator expression such 7593 /// as "x Op y". , Args/NumArgs provides the operator arguments, and 7594 /// CandidateSet will store the added overload candidates. (C++ 7595 /// [over.match.oper]). 7596 void Sema::AddMemberOperatorCandidates(OverloadedOperatorKind Op, 7597 SourceLocation OpLoc, 7598 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 7599 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, 7600 OverloadCandidateParamOrder PO) { 7601 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op); 7602 7603 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3: 7604 // For a unary operator @ with an operand of a type whose 7605 // cv-unqualified version is T1, and for a binary operator @ with 7606 // a left operand of a type whose cv-unqualified version is T1 and 7607 // a right operand of a type whose cv-unqualified version is T2, 7608 // three sets of candidate functions, designated member 7609 // candidates, non-member candidates and built-in candidates, are 7610 // constructed as follows: 7611 QualType T1 = Args[0]->getType(); 7612 7613 // -- If T1 is a complete class type or a class currently being 7614 // defined, the set of member candidates is the result of the 7615 // qualified lookup of T1::operator@ (13.3.1.1.1); otherwise, 7616 // the set of member candidates is empty. 7617 if (const RecordType *T1Rec = T1->getAs<RecordType>()) { 7618 // Complete the type if it can be completed. 7619 if (!isCompleteType(OpLoc, T1) && !T1Rec->isBeingDefined()) 7620 return; 7621 // If the type is neither complete nor being defined, bail out now. 7622 if (!T1Rec->getDecl()->getDefinition()) 7623 return; 7624 7625 LookupResult Operators(*this, OpName, OpLoc, LookupOrdinaryName); 7626 LookupQualifiedName(Operators, T1Rec->getDecl()); 7627 Operators.suppressDiagnostics(); 7628 7629 for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = Operators.begin(), 7630 OperEnd = Operators.end(); 7631 Oper != OperEnd; 7632 ++Oper) 7633 AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Args[0]->getType(), 7634 Args[0]->Classify(Context), Args.slice(1), 7635 CandidateSet, /*SuppressUserConversion=*/false, PO); 7636 } 7637 } 7638 7639 /// AddBuiltinCandidate - Add a candidate for a built-in 7640 /// operator. ResultTy and ParamTys are the result and parameter types 7641 /// of the built-in candidate, respectively. Args and NumArgs are the 7642 /// arguments being passed to the candidate. IsAssignmentOperator 7643 /// should be true when this built-in candidate is an assignment 7644 /// operator. NumContextualBoolArguments is the number of arguments 7645 /// (at the beginning of the argument list) that will be contextually 7646 /// converted to bool. 7647 void Sema::AddBuiltinCandidate(QualType *ParamTys, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 7648 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet, 7649 bool IsAssignmentOperator, 7650 unsigned NumContextualBoolArguments) { 7651 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context. 7652 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated( 7653 *this, Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::Unevaluated); 7654 7655 // Add this candidate 7656 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size()); 7657 Candidate.FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(nullptr, AS_none); 7658 Candidate.Function = nullptr; 7659 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false; 7660 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false; 7661 std::copy(ParamTys, ParamTys + Args.size(), Candidate.BuiltinParamTypes); 7662 7663 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the 7664 // arguments. 7665 Candidate.Viable = true; 7666 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size(); 7667 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) { 7668 // C++ [over.match.oper]p4: 7669 // For the built-in assignment operators, conversions of the 7670 // left operand are restricted as follows: 7671 // -- no temporaries are introduced to hold the left operand, and 7672 // -- no user-defined conversions are applied to the left 7673 // operand to achieve a type match with the left-most 7674 // parameter of a built-in candidate. 7675 // 7676 // We block these conversions by turning off user-defined 7677 // conversions, since that is the only way that initialization of 7678 // a reference to a non-class type can occur from something that 7679 // is not of the same type. 7680 if (ArgIdx < NumContextualBoolArguments) { 7681 assert(ParamTys[ArgIdx] == Context.BoolTy && 7682 "Contextual conversion to bool requires bool type"); 7683 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx] 7684 = TryContextuallyConvertToBool(*this, Args[ArgIdx]); 7685 } else { 7686 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx] 7687 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamTys[ArgIdx], 7688 ArgIdx == 0 && IsAssignmentOperator, 7689 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, 7690 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/ 7691 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount); 7692 } 7693 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].isBad()) { 7694 Candidate.Viable = false; 7695 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion; 7696 break; 7697 } 7698 } 7699 } 7700 7701 namespace { 7702 7703 /// BuiltinCandidateTypeSet - A set of types that will be used for the 7704 /// candidate operator functions for built-in operators (C++ 7705 /// [over.built]). The types are separated into pointer types and 7706 /// enumeration types. 7707 class BuiltinCandidateTypeSet { 7708 /// TypeSet - A set of types. 7709 typedef llvm::SetVector<QualType, SmallVector<QualType, 8>, 7710 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8>> TypeSet; 7711 7712 /// PointerTypes - The set of pointer types that will be used in the 7713 /// built-in candidates. 7714 TypeSet PointerTypes; 7715 7716 /// MemberPointerTypes - The set of member pointer types that will be 7717 /// used in the built-in candidates. 7718 TypeSet MemberPointerTypes; 7719 7720 /// EnumerationTypes - The set of enumeration types that will be 7721 /// used in the built-in candidates. 7722 TypeSet EnumerationTypes; 7723 7724 /// The set of vector types that will be used in the built-in 7725 /// candidates. 7726 TypeSet VectorTypes; 7727 7728 /// The set of matrix types that will be used in the built-in 7729 /// candidates. 7730 TypeSet MatrixTypes; 7731 7732 /// A flag indicating non-record types are viable candidates 7733 bool HasNonRecordTypes; 7734 7735 /// A flag indicating whether either arithmetic or enumeration types 7736 /// were present in the candidate set. 7737 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes; 7738 7739 /// A flag indicating whether the nullptr type was present in the 7740 /// candidate set. 7741 bool HasNullPtrType; 7742 7743 /// Sema - The semantic analysis instance where we are building the 7744 /// candidate type set. 7745 Sema &SemaRef; 7746 7747 /// Context - The AST context in which we will build the type sets. 7748 ASTContext &Context; 7749 7750 bool AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty, 7751 const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals); 7752 bool AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty); 7753 7754 public: 7755 /// iterator - Iterates through the types that are part of the set. 7756 typedef TypeSet::iterator iterator; 7757 7758 BuiltinCandidateTypeSet(Sema &SemaRef) 7759 : HasNonRecordTypes(false), 7760 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes(false), 7761 HasNullPtrType(false), 7762 SemaRef(SemaRef), 7763 Context(SemaRef.Context) { } 7764 7765 void AddTypesConvertedFrom(QualType Ty, 7766 SourceLocation Loc, 7767 bool AllowUserConversions, 7768 bool AllowExplicitConversions, 7769 const Qualifiers &VisibleTypeConversionsQuals); 7770 7771 /// pointer_begin - First pointer type found; 7772 iterator pointer_begin() { return PointerTypes.begin(); } 7773 7774 /// pointer_end - Past the last pointer type found; 7775 iterator pointer_end() { return PointerTypes.end(); } 7776 7777 /// member_pointer_begin - First member pointer type found; 7778 iterator member_pointer_begin() { return MemberPointerTypes.begin(); } 7779 7780 /// member_pointer_end - Past the last member pointer type found; 7781 iterator member_pointer_end() { return MemberPointerTypes.end(); } 7782 7783 /// enumeration_begin - First enumeration type found; 7784 iterator enumeration_begin() { return EnumerationTypes.begin(); } 7785 7786 /// enumeration_end - Past the last enumeration type found; 7787 iterator enumeration_end() { return EnumerationTypes.end(); } 7788 7789 llvm::iterator_range<iterator> vector_types() { return VectorTypes; } 7790 7791 llvm::iterator_range<iterator> matrix_types() { return MatrixTypes; } 7792 7793 bool containsMatrixType(QualType Ty) const { return MatrixTypes.count(Ty); } 7794 bool hasNonRecordTypes() { return HasNonRecordTypes; } 7795 bool hasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes() { return HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes; } 7796 bool hasNullPtrType() const { return HasNullPtrType; } 7797 }; 7798 7799 } // end anonymous namespace 7800 7801 /// AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants - Add the pointer type @p Ty to 7802 /// the set of pointer types along with any more-qualified variants of 7803 /// that type. For example, if @p Ty is "int const *", this routine 7804 /// will add "int const *", "int const volatile *", "int const 7805 /// restrict *", and "int const volatile restrict *" to the set of 7806 /// pointer types. Returns true if the add of @p Ty itself succeeded, 7807 /// false otherwise. 7808 /// 7809 /// FIXME: what to do about extended qualifiers? 7810 bool 7811 BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty, 7812 const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals) { 7813 7814 // Insert this type. 7815 if (!PointerTypes.insert(Ty)) 7816 return false; 7817 7818 QualType PointeeTy; 7819 const PointerType *PointerTy = Ty->getAs<PointerType>(); 7820 bool buildObjCPtr = false; 7821 if (!PointerTy) { 7822 const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy = Ty->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 7823 PointeeTy = PTy->getPointeeType(); 7824 buildObjCPtr = true; 7825 } else { 7826 PointeeTy = PointerTy->getPointeeType(); 7827 } 7828 7829 // Don't add qualified variants of arrays. For one, they're not allowed 7830 // (the qualifier would sink to the element type), and for another, the 7831 // only overload situation where it matters is subscript or pointer +- int, 7832 // and those shouldn't have qualifier variants anyway. 7833 if (PointeeTy->isArrayType()) 7834 return true; 7835 7836 unsigned BaseCVR = PointeeTy.getCVRQualifiers(); 7837 bool hasVolatile = VisibleQuals.hasVolatile(); 7838 bool hasRestrict = VisibleQuals.hasRestrict(); 7839 7840 // Iterate through all strict supersets of BaseCVR. 7841 for (unsigned CVR = BaseCVR+1; CVR <= Qualifiers::CVRMask; ++CVR) { 7842 if ((CVR | BaseCVR) != CVR) continue; 7843 // Skip over volatile if no volatile found anywhere in the types. 7844 if ((CVR & Qualifiers::Volatile) && !hasVolatile) continue; 7845 7846 // Skip over restrict if no restrict found anywhere in the types, or if 7847 // the type cannot be restrict-qualified. 7848 if ((CVR & Qualifiers::Restrict) && 7849 (!hasRestrict || 7850 (!(PointeeTy->isAnyPointerType() || PointeeTy->isReferenceType())))) 7851 continue; 7852 7853 // Build qualified pointee type. 7854 QualType QPointeeTy = Context.getCVRQualifiedType(PointeeTy, CVR); 7855 7856 // Build qualified pointer type. 7857 QualType QPointerTy; 7858 if (!buildObjCPtr) 7859 QPointerTy = Context.getPointerType(QPointeeTy); 7860 else 7861 QPointerTy = Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(QPointeeTy); 7862 7863 // Insert qualified pointer type. 7864 PointerTypes.insert(QPointerTy); 7865 } 7866 7867 return true; 7868 } 7869 7870 /// AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants - Add the pointer type @p Ty 7871 /// to the set of pointer types along with any more-qualified variants of 7872 /// that type. For example, if @p Ty is "int const *", this routine 7873 /// will add "int const *", "int const volatile *", "int const 7874 /// restrict *", and "int const volatile restrict *" to the set of 7875 /// pointer types. Returns true if the add of @p Ty itself succeeded, 7876 /// false otherwise. 7877 /// 7878 /// FIXME: what to do about extended qualifiers? 7879 bool 7880 BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants( 7881 QualType Ty) { 7882 // Insert this type. 7883 if (!MemberPointerTypes.insert(Ty)) 7884 return false; 7885 7886 const MemberPointerType *PointerTy = Ty->getAs<MemberPointerType>(); 7887 assert(PointerTy && "type was not a member pointer type!"); 7888 7889 QualType PointeeTy = PointerTy->getPointeeType(); 7890 // Don't add qualified variants of arrays. For one, they're not allowed 7891 // (the qualifier would sink to the element type), and for another, the 7892 // only overload situation where it matters is subscript or pointer +- int, 7893 // and those shouldn't have qualifier variants anyway. 7894 if (PointeeTy->isArrayType()) 7895 return true; 7896 const Type *ClassTy = PointerTy->getClass(); 7897 7898 // Iterate through all strict supersets of the pointee type's CVR 7899 // qualifiers. 7900 unsigned BaseCVR = PointeeTy.getCVRQualifiers(); 7901 for (unsigned CVR = BaseCVR+1; CVR <= Qualifiers::CVRMask; ++CVR) { 7902 if ((CVR | BaseCVR) != CVR) continue; 7903 7904 QualType QPointeeTy = Context.getCVRQualifiedType(PointeeTy, CVR); 7905 MemberPointerTypes.insert( 7906 Context.getMemberPointerType(QPointeeTy, ClassTy)); 7907 } 7908 7909 return true; 7910 } 7911 7912 /// AddTypesConvertedFrom - Add each of the types to which the type @p 7913 /// Ty can be implicit converted to the given set of @p Types. We're 7914 /// primarily interested in pointer types and enumeration types. We also 7915 /// take member pointer types, for the conditional operator. 7916 /// AllowUserConversions is true if we should look at the conversion 7917 /// functions of a class type, and AllowExplicitConversions if we 7918 /// should also include the explicit conversion functions of a class 7919 /// type. 7920 void 7921 BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddTypesConvertedFrom(QualType Ty, 7922 SourceLocation Loc, 7923 bool AllowUserConversions, 7924 bool AllowExplicitConversions, 7925 const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals) { 7926 // Only deal with canonical types. 7927 Ty = Context.getCanonicalType(Ty); 7928 7929 // Look through reference types; they aren't part of the type of an 7930 // expression for the purposes of conversions. 7931 if (const ReferenceType *RefTy = Ty->getAs<ReferenceType>()) 7932 Ty = RefTy->getPointeeType(); 7933 7934 // If we're dealing with an array type, decay to the pointer. 7935 if (Ty->isArrayType()) 7936 Ty = SemaRef.Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty); 7937 7938 // Otherwise, we don't care about qualifiers on the type. 7939 Ty = Ty.getLocalUnqualifiedType(); 7940 7941 // Flag if we ever add a non-record type. 7942 const RecordType *TyRec = Ty->getAs<RecordType>(); 7943 HasNonRecordTypes = HasNonRecordTypes || !TyRec; 7944 7945 // Flag if we encounter an arithmetic type. 7946 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes = 7947 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes || Ty->isArithmeticType(); 7948 7949 if (Ty->isObjCIdType() || Ty->isObjCClassType()) 7950 PointerTypes.insert(Ty); 7951 else if (Ty->getAs<PointerType>() || Ty->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) { 7952 // Insert our type, and its more-qualified variants, into the set 7953 // of types. 7954 if (!AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(Ty, VisibleQuals)) 7955 return; 7956 } else if (Ty->isMemberPointerType()) { 7957 // Member pointers are far easier, since the pointee can't be converted. 7958 if (!AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(Ty)) 7959 return; 7960 } else if (Ty->isEnumeralType()) { 7961 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes = true; 7962 EnumerationTypes.insert(Ty); 7963 } else if (Ty->isVectorType()) { 7964 // We treat vector types as arithmetic types in many contexts as an 7965 // extension. 7966 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes = true; 7967 VectorTypes.insert(Ty); 7968 } else if (Ty->isMatrixType()) { 7969 // Similar to vector types, we treat vector types as arithmetic types in 7970 // many contexts as an extension. 7971 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes = true; 7972 MatrixTypes.insert(Ty); 7973 } else if (Ty->isNullPtrType()) { 7974 HasNullPtrType = true; 7975 } else if (AllowUserConversions && TyRec) { 7976 // No conversion functions in incomplete types. 7977 if (!SemaRef.isCompleteType(Loc, Ty)) 7978 return; 7979 7980 CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TyRec->getDecl()); 7981 for (NamedDecl *D : ClassDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions()) { 7982 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D)) 7983 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl(); 7984 7985 // Skip conversion function templates; they don't tell us anything 7986 // about which builtin types we can convert to. 7987 if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D)) 7988 continue; 7989 7990 CXXConversionDecl *Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D); 7991 if (AllowExplicitConversions || !Conv->isExplicit()) { 7992 AddTypesConvertedFrom(Conv->getConversionType(), Loc, false, false, 7993 VisibleQuals); 7994 } 7995 } 7996 } 7997 } 7998 /// Helper function for adjusting address spaces for the pointer or reference 7999 /// operands of builtin operators depending on the argument. 8000 static QualType AdjustAddressSpaceForBuiltinOperandType(Sema &S, QualType T, 8001 Expr *Arg) { 8002 return S.Context.getAddrSpaceQualType(T, Arg->getType().getAddressSpace()); 8003 } 8004 8005 /// Helper function for AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates() that adds 8006 /// the volatile- and non-volatile-qualified assignment operators for the 8007 /// given type to the candidate set. 8008 static void AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(Sema &S, 8009 QualType T, 8010 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 8011 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) { 8012 QualType ParamTypes[2]; 8013 8014 // T& operator=(T&, T) 8015 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType( 8016 AdjustAddressSpaceForBuiltinOperandType(S, T, Args[0])); 8017 ParamTypes[1] = T; 8018 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 8019 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true); 8020 8021 if (!S.Context.getCanonicalType(T).isVolatileQualified()) { 8022 // volatile T& operator=(volatile T&, T) 8023 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType( 8024 AdjustAddressSpaceForBuiltinOperandType(S, S.Context.getVolatileType(T), 8025 Args[0])); 8026 ParamTypes[1] = T; 8027 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 8028 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true); 8029 } 8030 } 8031 8032 /// CollectVRQualifiers - This routine returns Volatile/Restrict qualifiers, 8033 /// if any, found in visible type conversion functions found in ArgExpr's type. 8034 static Qualifiers CollectVRQualifiers(ASTContext &Context, Expr* ArgExpr) { 8035 Qualifiers VRQuals; 8036 const RecordType *TyRec; 8037 if (const MemberPointerType *RHSMPType = 8038 ArgExpr->getType()->getAs<MemberPointerType>()) 8039 TyRec = RHSMPType->getClass()->getAs<RecordType>(); 8040 else 8041 TyRec = ArgExpr->getType()->getAs<RecordType>(); 8042 if (!TyRec) { 8043 // Just to be safe, assume the worst case. 8044 VRQuals.addVolatile(); 8045 VRQuals.addRestrict(); 8046 return VRQuals; 8047 } 8048 8049 CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TyRec->getDecl()); 8050 if (!ClassDecl->hasDefinition()) 8051 return VRQuals; 8052 8053 for (NamedDecl *D : ClassDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions()) { 8054 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D)) 8055 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl(); 8056 if (CXXConversionDecl *Conv = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D)) { 8057 QualType CanTy = Context.getCanonicalType(Conv->getConversionType()); 8058 if (const ReferenceType *ResTypeRef = CanTy->getAs<ReferenceType>()) 8059 CanTy = ResTypeRef->getPointeeType(); 8060 // Need to go down the pointer/mempointer chain and add qualifiers 8061 // as see them. 8062 bool done = false; 8063 while (!done) { 8064 if (CanTy.isRestrictQualified()) 8065 VRQuals.addRestrict(); 8066 if (const PointerType *ResTypePtr = CanTy->getAs<PointerType>()) 8067 CanTy = ResTypePtr->getPointeeType(); 8068 else if (const MemberPointerType *ResTypeMPtr = 8069 CanTy->getAs<MemberPointerType>()) 8070 CanTy = ResTypeMPtr->getPointeeType(); 8071 else 8072 done = true; 8073 if (CanTy.isVolatileQualified()) 8074 VRQuals.addVolatile(); 8075 if (VRQuals.hasRestrict() && VRQuals.hasVolatile()) 8076 return VRQuals; 8077 } 8078 } 8079 } 8080 return VRQuals; 8081 } 8082 8083 namespace { 8084 8085 /// Helper class to manage the addition of builtin operator overload 8086 /// candidates. It provides shared state and utility methods used throughout 8087 /// the process, as well as a helper method to add each group of builtin 8088 /// operator overloads from the standard to a candidate set. 8089 class BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder { 8090 // Common instance state available to all overload candidate addition methods. 8091 Sema &S; 8092 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args; 8093 Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals; 8094 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType; 8095 SmallVectorImpl<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet> &CandidateTypes; 8096 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet; 8097 8098 static constexpr int ArithmeticTypesCap = 24; 8099 SmallVector<CanQualType, ArithmeticTypesCap> ArithmeticTypes; 8100 8101 // Define some indices used to iterate over the arithmetic types in 8102 // ArithmeticTypes. The "promoted arithmetic types" are the arithmetic 8103 // types are that preserved by promotion (C++ [over.built]p2). 8104 unsigned FirstIntegralType, 8105 LastIntegralType; 8106 unsigned FirstPromotedIntegralType, 8107 LastPromotedIntegralType; 8108 unsigned FirstPromotedArithmeticType, 8109 LastPromotedArithmeticType; 8110 unsigned NumArithmeticTypes; 8111 8112 void InitArithmeticTypes() { 8113 // Start of promoted types. 8114 FirstPromotedArithmeticType = 0; 8115 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.FloatTy); 8116 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.DoubleTy); 8117 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.LongDoubleTy); 8118 if (S.Context.getTargetInfo().hasFloat128Type()) 8119 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.Float128Ty); 8120 8121 // Start of integral types. 8122 FirstIntegralType = ArithmeticTypes.size(); 8123 FirstPromotedIntegralType = ArithmeticTypes.size(); 8124 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.IntTy); 8125 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.LongTy); 8126 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.LongLongTy); 8127 if (S.Context.getTargetInfo().hasInt128Type()) 8128 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.Int128Ty); 8129 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.UnsignedIntTy); 8130 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.UnsignedLongTy); 8131 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.UnsignedLongLongTy); 8132 if (S.Context.getTargetInfo().hasInt128Type()) 8133 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.UnsignedInt128Ty); 8134 LastPromotedIntegralType = ArithmeticTypes.size(); 8135 LastPromotedArithmeticType = ArithmeticTypes.size(); 8136 // End of promoted types. 8137 8138 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.BoolTy); 8139 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.CharTy); 8140 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.WCharTy); 8141 if (S.Context.getLangOpts().Char8) 8142 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.Char8Ty); 8143 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.Char16Ty); 8144 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.Char32Ty); 8145 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.SignedCharTy); 8146 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.ShortTy); 8147 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.UnsignedCharTy); 8148 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.UnsignedShortTy); 8149 LastIntegralType = ArithmeticTypes.size(); 8150 NumArithmeticTypes = ArithmeticTypes.size(); 8151 // End of integral types. 8152 // FIXME: What about complex? What about half? 8153 8154 assert(ArithmeticTypes.size() <= ArithmeticTypesCap && 8155 "Enough inline storage for all arithmetic types."); 8156 } 8157 8158 /// Helper method to factor out the common pattern of adding overloads 8159 /// for '++' and '--' builtin operators. 8160 void addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(QualType CandidateTy, 8161 bool HasVolatile, 8162 bool HasRestrict) { 8163 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { 8164 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(CandidateTy), 8165 S.Context.IntTy 8166 }; 8167 8168 // Non-volatile version. 8169 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 8170 8171 // Use a heuristic to reduce number of builtin candidates in the set: 8172 // add volatile version only if there are conversions to a volatile type. 8173 if (HasVolatile) { 8174 ParamTypes[0] = 8175 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType( 8176 S.Context.getVolatileType(CandidateTy)); 8177 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 8178 } 8179 8180 // Add restrict version only if there are conversions to a restrict type 8181 // and our candidate type is a non-restrict-qualified pointer. 8182 if (HasRestrict && CandidateTy->isAnyPointerType() && 8183 !CandidateTy.isRestrictQualified()) { 8184 ParamTypes[0] 8185 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType( 8186 S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(CandidateTy, Qualifiers::Restrict)); 8187 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 8188 8189 if (HasVolatile) { 8190 ParamTypes[0] 8191 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType( 8192 S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(CandidateTy, 8193 (Qualifiers::Volatile | 8194 Qualifiers::Restrict))); 8195 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 8196 } 8197 } 8198 8199 } 8200 8201 /// Helper to add an overload candidate for a binary builtin with types \p L 8202 /// and \p R. 8203 void AddCandidate(QualType L, QualType R) { 8204 QualType LandR[2] = {L, R}; 8205 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(LandR, Args, CandidateSet); 8206 } 8207 8208 public: 8209 BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder( 8210 Sema &S, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 8211 Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals, 8212 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType, 8213 SmallVectorImpl<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet> &CandidateTypes, 8214 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) 8215 : S(S), Args(Args), 8216 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals(VisibleTypeConversionsQuals), 8217 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType( 8218 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType), 8219 CandidateTypes(CandidateTypes), 8220 CandidateSet(CandidateSet) { 8221 8222 InitArithmeticTypes(); 8223 } 8224 8225 // Increment is deprecated for bool since C++17. 8226 // 8227 // C++ [over.built]p3: 8228 // 8229 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an arithmetic type other 8230 // than bool, and VQ is either volatile or empty, there exist 8231 // candidate operator functions of the form 8232 // 8233 // VQ T& operator++(VQ T&); 8234 // T operator++(VQ T&, int); 8235 // 8236 // C++ [over.built]p4: 8237 // 8238 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an arithmetic type other 8239 // than bool, and VQ is either volatile or empty, there exist 8240 // candidate operator functions of the form 8241 // 8242 // VQ T& operator--(VQ T&); 8243 // T operator--(VQ T&, int); 8244 void addPlusPlusMinusMinusArithmeticOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) { 8245 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType) 8246 return; 8247 8248 for (unsigned Arith = 0; Arith < NumArithmeticTypes; ++Arith) { 8249 const auto TypeOfT = ArithmeticTypes[Arith]; 8250 if (TypeOfT == S.Context.BoolTy) { 8251 if (Op == OO_MinusMinus) 8252 continue; 8253 if (Op == OO_PlusPlus && S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17) 8254 continue; 8255 } 8256 addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads( 8257 TypeOfT, 8258 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile(), 8259 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict()); 8260 } 8261 } 8262 8263 // C++ [over.built]p5: 8264 // 8265 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is a cv-qualified or 8266 // cv-unqualified object type, and VQ is either volatile or 8267 // empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form 8268 // 8269 // T*VQ& operator++(T*VQ&); 8270 // T*VQ& operator--(T*VQ&); 8271 // T* operator++(T*VQ&, int); 8272 // T* operator--(T*VQ&, int); 8273 void addPlusPlusMinusMinusPointerOverloads() { 8274 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 8275 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(), 8276 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end(); 8277 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 8278 // Skip pointer types that aren't pointers to object types. 8279 if (!(*Ptr)->getPointeeType()->isObjectType()) 8280 continue; 8281 8282 addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(*Ptr, 8283 (!(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() && 8284 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()), 8285 (!(*Ptr).isRestrictQualified() && 8286 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict())); 8287 } 8288 } 8289 8290 // C++ [over.built]p6: 8291 // For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T, there 8292 // exist candidate operator functions of the form 8293 // 8294 // T& operator*(T*); 8295 // 8296 // C++ [over.built]p7: 8297 // For every function type T that does not have cv-qualifiers or a 8298 // ref-qualifier, there exist candidate operator functions of the form 8299 // T& operator*(T*); 8300 void addUnaryStarPointerOverloads() { 8301 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 8302 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(), 8303 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end(); 8304 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 8305 QualType ParamTy = *Ptr; 8306 QualType PointeeTy = ParamTy->getPointeeType(); 8307 if (!PointeeTy->isObjectType() && !PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) 8308 continue; 8309 8310 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto =PointeeTy->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) 8311 if (Proto->getMethodQuals() || Proto->getRefQualifier()) 8312 continue; 8313 8314 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(&ParamTy, Args, CandidateSet); 8315 } 8316 } 8317 8318 // C++ [over.built]p9: 8319 // For every promoted arithmetic type T, there exist candidate 8320 // operator functions of the form 8321 // 8322 // T operator+(T); 8323 // T operator-(T); 8324 void addUnaryPlusOrMinusArithmeticOverloads() { 8325 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType) 8326 return; 8327 8328 for (unsigned Arith = FirstPromotedArithmeticType; 8329 Arith < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Arith) { 8330 QualType ArithTy = ArithmeticTypes[Arith]; 8331 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(&ArithTy, Args, CandidateSet); 8332 } 8333 8334 // Extension: We also add these operators for vector types. 8335 for (QualType VecTy : CandidateTypes[0].vector_types()) 8336 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(&VecTy, Args, CandidateSet); 8337 } 8338 8339 // C++ [over.built]p8: 8340 // For every type T, there exist candidate operator functions of 8341 // the form 8342 // 8343 // T* operator+(T*); 8344 void addUnaryPlusPointerOverloads() { 8345 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 8346 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(), 8347 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end(); 8348 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 8349 QualType ParamTy = *Ptr; 8350 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(&ParamTy, Args, CandidateSet); 8351 } 8352 } 8353 8354 // C++ [over.built]p10: 8355 // For every promoted integral type T, there exist candidate 8356 // operator functions of the form 8357 // 8358 // T operator~(T); 8359 void addUnaryTildePromotedIntegralOverloads() { 8360 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType) 8361 return; 8362 8363 for (unsigned Int = FirstPromotedIntegralType; 8364 Int < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Int) { 8365 QualType IntTy = ArithmeticTypes[Int]; 8366 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(&IntTy, Args, CandidateSet); 8367 } 8368 8369 // Extension: We also add this operator for vector types. 8370 for (QualType VecTy : CandidateTypes[0].vector_types()) 8371 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(&VecTy, Args, CandidateSet); 8372 } 8373 8374 // C++ [over.match.oper]p16: 8375 // For every pointer to member type T or type std::nullptr_t, there 8376 // exist candidate operator functions of the form 8377 // 8378 // bool operator==(T,T); 8379 // bool operator!=(T,T); 8380 void addEqualEqualOrNotEqualMemberPointerOrNullptrOverloads() { 8381 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled. 8382 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes; 8383 8384 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) { 8385 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 8386 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(), 8387 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end(); 8388 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; 8389 ++MemPtr) { 8390 // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice. 8391 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr)).second) 8392 continue; 8393 8394 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *MemPtr, *MemPtr }; 8395 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 8396 } 8397 8398 if (CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasNullPtrType()) { 8399 CanQualType NullPtrTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(S.Context.NullPtrTy); 8400 if (AddedTypes.insert(NullPtrTy).second) { 8401 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { NullPtrTy, NullPtrTy }; 8402 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 8403 } 8404 } 8405 } 8406 } 8407 8408 // C++ [over.built]p15: 8409 // 8410 // For every T, where T is an enumeration type or a pointer type, 8411 // there exist candidate operator functions of the form 8412 // 8413 // bool operator<(T, T); 8414 // bool operator>(T, T); 8415 // bool operator<=(T, T); 8416 // bool operator>=(T, T); 8417 // bool operator==(T, T); 8418 // bool operator!=(T, T); 8419 // R operator<=>(T, T) 8420 void addGenericBinaryPointerOrEnumeralOverloads() { 8421 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3: 8422 // [...]the built-in candidates include all of the candidate operator 8423 // functions defined in 13.6 that, compared to the given operator, [...] 8424 // do not have the same parameter-type-list as any non-template non-member 8425 // candidate. 8426 // 8427 // Note that in practice, this only affects enumeration types because there 8428 // aren't any built-in candidates of record type, and a user-defined operator 8429 // must have an operand of record or enumeration type. Also, the only other 8430 // overloaded operator with enumeration arguments, operator=, 8431 // cannot be overloaded for enumeration types, so this is the only place 8432 // where we must suppress candidates like this. 8433 llvm::DenseSet<std::pair<CanQualType, CanQualType> > 8434 UserDefinedBinaryOperators; 8435 8436 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) { 8437 if (CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin() != 8438 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end()) { 8439 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator C = CandidateSet.begin(), 8440 CEnd = CandidateSet.end(); 8441 C != CEnd; ++C) { 8442 if (!C->Viable || !C->Function || C->Function->getNumParams() != 2) 8443 continue; 8444 8445 if (C->Function->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization()) 8446 continue; 8447 8448 // We interpret "same parameter-type-list" as applying to the 8449 // "synthesized candidate, with the order of the two parameters 8450 // reversed", not to the original function. 8451 bool Reversed = C->isReversed(); 8452 QualType FirstParamType = C->Function->getParamDecl(Reversed ? 1 : 0) 8453 ->getType() 8454 .getUnqualifiedType(); 8455 QualType SecondParamType = C->Function->getParamDecl(Reversed ? 0 : 1) 8456 ->getType() 8457 .getUnqualifiedType(); 8458 8459 // Skip if either parameter isn't of enumeral type. 8460 if (!FirstParamType->isEnumeralType() || 8461 !SecondParamType->isEnumeralType()) 8462 continue; 8463 8464 // Add this operator to the set of known user-defined operators. 8465 UserDefinedBinaryOperators.insert( 8466 std::make_pair(S.Context.getCanonicalType(FirstParamType), 8467 S.Context.getCanonicalType(SecondParamType))); 8468 } 8469 } 8470 } 8471 8472 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled. 8473 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes; 8474 8475 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) { 8476 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 8477 Ptr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_begin(), 8478 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_end(); 8479 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 8480 // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice. 8481 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)).second) 8482 continue; 8483 8484 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr }; 8485 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 8486 } 8487 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 8488 Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(), 8489 EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end(); 8490 Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) { 8491 CanQualType CanonType = S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum); 8492 8493 // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice, or if a user defined 8494 // candidate exists. 8495 if (!AddedTypes.insert(CanonType).second || 8496 UserDefinedBinaryOperators.count(std::make_pair(CanonType, 8497 CanonType))) 8498 continue; 8499 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Enum, *Enum }; 8500 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 8501 } 8502 } 8503 } 8504 8505 // C++ [over.built]p13: 8506 // 8507 // For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T 8508 // there exist candidate operator functions of the form 8509 // 8510 // T* operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t); 8511 // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t); [BELOW] 8512 // T* operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t); 8513 // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*); 8514 // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*); [BELOW] 8515 // 8516 // C++ [over.built]p14: 8517 // 8518 // For every T, where T is a pointer to object type, there 8519 // exist candidate operator functions of the form 8520 // 8521 // ptrdiff_t operator-(T, T); 8522 void addBinaryPlusOrMinusPointerOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) { 8523 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled. 8524 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes; 8525 8526 for (int Arg = 0; Arg < 2; ++Arg) { 8527 QualType AsymmetricParamTypes[2] = { 8528 S.Context.getPointerDiffType(), 8529 S.Context.getPointerDiffType(), 8530 }; 8531 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 8532 Ptr = CandidateTypes[Arg].pointer_begin(), 8533 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[Arg].pointer_end(); 8534 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 8535 QualType PointeeTy = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType(); 8536 if (!PointeeTy->isObjectType()) 8537 continue; 8538 8539 AsymmetricParamTypes[Arg] = *Ptr; 8540 if (Arg == 0 || Op == OO_Plus) { 8541 // operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t) or operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t) 8542 // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*); 8543 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(AsymmetricParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 8544 } 8545 if (Op == OO_Minus) { 8546 // ptrdiff_t operator-(T, T); 8547 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)).second) 8548 continue; 8549 8550 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr }; 8551 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 8552 } 8553 } 8554 } 8555 } 8556 8557 // C++ [over.built]p12: 8558 // 8559 // For every pair of promoted arithmetic types L and R, there 8560 // exist candidate operator functions of the form 8561 // 8562 // LR operator*(L, R); 8563 // LR operator/(L, R); 8564 // LR operator+(L, R); 8565 // LR operator-(L, R); 8566 // bool operator<(L, R); 8567 // bool operator>(L, R); 8568 // bool operator<=(L, R); 8569 // bool operator>=(L, R); 8570 // bool operator==(L, R); 8571 // bool operator!=(L, R); 8572 // 8573 // where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions 8574 // between types L and R. 8575 // 8576 // C++ [over.built]p24: 8577 // 8578 // For every pair of promoted arithmetic types L and R, there exist 8579 // candidate operator functions of the form 8580 // 8581 // LR operator?(bool, L, R); 8582 // 8583 // where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions 8584 // between types L and R. 8585 // Our candidates ignore the first parameter. 8586 void addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads() { 8587 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType) 8588 return; 8589 8590 for (unsigned Left = FirstPromotedArithmeticType; 8591 Left < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Left) { 8592 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedArithmeticType; 8593 Right < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Right) { 8594 QualType LandR[2] = { ArithmeticTypes[Left], 8595 ArithmeticTypes[Right] }; 8596 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(LandR, Args, CandidateSet); 8597 } 8598 } 8599 8600 // Extension: Add the binary operators ==, !=, <, <=, >=, >, *, /, and the 8601 // conditional operator for vector types. 8602 for (QualType Vec1Ty : CandidateTypes[0].vector_types()) 8603 for (QualType Vec2Ty : CandidateTypes[1].vector_types()) { 8604 QualType LandR[2] = {Vec1Ty, Vec2Ty}; 8605 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(LandR, Args, CandidateSet); 8606 } 8607 } 8608 8609 /// Add binary operator overloads for each candidate matrix type M1, M2: 8610 /// * (M1, M1) -> M1 8611 /// * (M1, M1.getElementType()) -> M1 8612 /// * (M2.getElementType(), M2) -> M2 8613 /// * (M2, M2) -> M2 // Only if M2 is not part of CandidateTypes[0]. 8614 void addMatrixBinaryArithmeticOverloads() { 8615 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType) 8616 return; 8617 8618 for (QualType M1 : CandidateTypes[0].matrix_types()) { 8619 AddCandidate(M1, cast<MatrixType>(M1)->getElementType()); 8620 AddCandidate(M1, M1); 8621 } 8622 8623 for (QualType M2 : CandidateTypes[1].matrix_types()) { 8624 AddCandidate(cast<MatrixType>(M2)->getElementType(), M2); 8625 if (!CandidateTypes[0].containsMatrixType(M2)) 8626 AddCandidate(M2, M2); 8627 } 8628 } 8629 8630 // C++2a [over.built]p14: 8631 // 8632 // For every integral type T there exists a candidate operator function 8633 // of the form 8634 // 8635 // std::strong_ordering operator<=>(T, T) 8636 // 8637 // C++2a [over.built]p15: 8638 // 8639 // For every pair of floating-point types L and R, there exists a candidate 8640 // operator function of the form 8641 // 8642 // std::partial_ordering operator<=>(L, R); 8643 // 8644 // FIXME: The current specification for integral types doesn't play nice with 8645 // the direction of p0946r0, which allows mixed integral and unscoped-enum 8646 // comparisons. Under the current spec this can lead to ambiguity during 8647 // overload resolution. For example: 8648 // 8649 // enum A : int {a}; 8650 // auto x = (a <=> (long)42); 8651 // 8652 // error: call is ambiguous for arguments 'A' and 'long'. 8653 // note: candidate operator<=>(int, int) 8654 // note: candidate operator<=>(long, long) 8655 // 8656 // To avoid this error, this function deviates from the specification and adds 8657 // the mixed overloads `operator<=>(L, R)` where L and R are promoted 8658 // arithmetic types (the same as the generic relational overloads). 8659 // 8660 // For now this function acts as a placeholder. 8661 void addThreeWayArithmeticOverloads() { 8662 addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(); 8663 } 8664 8665 // C++ [over.built]p17: 8666 // 8667 // For every pair of promoted integral types L and R, there 8668 // exist candidate operator functions of the form 8669 // 8670 // LR operator%(L, R); 8671 // LR operator&(L, R); 8672 // LR operator^(L, R); 8673 // LR operator|(L, R); 8674 // L operator<<(L, R); 8675 // L operator>>(L, R); 8676 // 8677 // where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions 8678 // between types L and R. 8679 void addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) { 8680 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType) 8681 return; 8682 8683 for (unsigned Left = FirstPromotedIntegralType; 8684 Left < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Left) { 8685 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedIntegralType; 8686 Right < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Right) { 8687 QualType LandR[2] = { ArithmeticTypes[Left], 8688 ArithmeticTypes[Right] }; 8689 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(LandR, Args, CandidateSet); 8690 } 8691 } 8692 } 8693 8694 // C++ [over.built]p20: 8695 // 8696 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an enumeration or 8697 // pointer to member type and VQ is either volatile or 8698 // empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form 8699 // 8700 // VQ T& operator=(VQ T&, T); 8701 void addAssignmentMemberPointerOrEnumeralOverloads() { 8702 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled. 8703 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes; 8704 8705 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < 2; ++ArgIdx) { 8706 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 8707 Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(), 8708 EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end(); 8709 Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) { 8710 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum)).second) 8711 continue; 8712 8713 AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(S, *Enum, Args, CandidateSet); 8714 } 8715 8716 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 8717 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(), 8718 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end(); 8719 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) { 8720 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr)).second) 8721 continue; 8722 8723 AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(S, *MemPtr, Args, CandidateSet); 8724 } 8725 } 8726 } 8727 8728 // C++ [over.built]p19: 8729 // 8730 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is any type and VQ is either 8731 // volatile or empty, there exist candidate operator functions 8732 // of the form 8733 // 8734 // T*VQ& operator=(T*VQ&, T*); 8735 // 8736 // C++ [over.built]p21: 8737 // 8738 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is a cv-qualified or 8739 // cv-unqualified object type and VQ is either volatile or 8740 // empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form 8741 // 8742 // T*VQ& operator+=(T*VQ&, ptrdiff_t); 8743 // T*VQ& operator-=(T*VQ&, ptrdiff_t); 8744 void addAssignmentPointerOverloads(bool isEqualOp) { 8745 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled. 8746 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes; 8747 8748 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 8749 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(), 8750 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end(); 8751 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 8752 // If this is operator=, keep track of the builtin candidates we added. 8753 if (isEqualOp) 8754 AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)); 8755 else if (!(*Ptr)->getPointeeType()->isObjectType()) 8756 continue; 8757 8758 // non-volatile version 8759 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { 8760 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Ptr), 8761 isEqualOp ? *Ptr : S.Context.getPointerDiffType(), 8762 }; 8763 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 8764 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/ isEqualOp); 8765 8766 bool NeedVolatile = !(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() && 8767 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile(); 8768 if (NeedVolatile) { 8769 // volatile version 8770 ParamTypes[0] = 8771 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(*Ptr)); 8772 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 8773 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/isEqualOp); 8774 } 8775 8776 if (!(*Ptr).isRestrictQualified() && 8777 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict()) { 8778 // restrict version 8779 ParamTypes[0] 8780 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getRestrictType(*Ptr)); 8781 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 8782 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/isEqualOp); 8783 8784 if (NeedVolatile) { 8785 // volatile restrict version 8786 ParamTypes[0] 8787 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType( 8788 S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(*Ptr, 8789 (Qualifiers::Volatile | 8790 Qualifiers::Restrict))); 8791 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 8792 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/isEqualOp); 8793 } 8794 } 8795 } 8796 8797 if (isEqualOp) { 8798 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 8799 Ptr = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_begin(), 8800 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_end(); 8801 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 8802 // Make sure we don't add the same candidate twice. 8803 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)).second) 8804 continue; 8805 8806 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { 8807 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Ptr), 8808 *Ptr, 8809 }; 8810 8811 // non-volatile version 8812 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 8813 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true); 8814 8815 bool NeedVolatile = !(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() && 8816 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile(); 8817 if (NeedVolatile) { 8818 // volatile version 8819 ParamTypes[0] = 8820 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(*Ptr)); 8821 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 8822 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true); 8823 } 8824 8825 if (!(*Ptr).isRestrictQualified() && 8826 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict()) { 8827 // restrict version 8828 ParamTypes[0] 8829 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getRestrictType(*Ptr)); 8830 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 8831 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true); 8832 8833 if (NeedVolatile) { 8834 // volatile restrict version 8835 ParamTypes[0] 8836 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType( 8837 S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(*Ptr, 8838 (Qualifiers::Volatile | 8839 Qualifiers::Restrict))); 8840 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 8841 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true); 8842 } 8843 } 8844 } 8845 } 8846 } 8847 8848 // C++ [over.built]p18: 8849 // 8850 // For every triple (L, VQ, R), where L is an arithmetic type, 8851 // VQ is either volatile or empty, and R is a promoted 8852 // arithmetic type, there exist candidate operator functions of 8853 // the form 8854 // 8855 // VQ L& operator=(VQ L&, R); 8856 // VQ L& operator*=(VQ L&, R); 8857 // VQ L& operator/=(VQ L&, R); 8858 // VQ L& operator+=(VQ L&, R); 8859 // VQ L& operator-=(VQ L&, R); 8860 void addAssignmentArithmeticOverloads(bool isEqualOp) { 8861 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType) 8862 return; 8863 8864 for (unsigned Left = 0; Left < NumArithmeticTypes; ++Left) { 8865 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedArithmeticType; 8866 Right < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Right) { 8867 QualType ParamTypes[2]; 8868 ParamTypes[1] = ArithmeticTypes[Right]; 8869 auto LeftBaseTy = AdjustAddressSpaceForBuiltinOperandType( 8870 S, ArithmeticTypes[Left], Args[0]); 8871 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty). 8872 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(LeftBaseTy); 8873 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 8874 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/isEqualOp); 8875 8876 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile'). 8877 if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) { 8878 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getVolatileType(LeftBaseTy); 8879 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]); 8880 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 8881 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/isEqualOp); 8882 } 8883 } 8884 } 8885 8886 // Extension: Add the binary operators =, +=, -=, *=, /= for vector types. 8887 for (QualType Vec1Ty : CandidateTypes[0].vector_types()) 8888 for (QualType Vec2Ty : CandidateTypes[0].vector_types()) { 8889 QualType ParamTypes[2]; 8890 ParamTypes[1] = Vec2Ty; 8891 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty). 8892 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(Vec1Ty); 8893 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 8894 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/isEqualOp); 8895 8896 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile'). 8897 if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) { 8898 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getVolatileType(Vec1Ty); 8899 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]); 8900 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 8901 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/isEqualOp); 8902 } 8903 } 8904 } 8905 8906 // C++ [over.built]p22: 8907 // 8908 // For every triple (L, VQ, R), where L is an integral type, VQ 8909 // is either volatile or empty, and R is a promoted integral 8910 // type, there exist candidate operator functions of the form 8911 // 8912 // VQ L& operator%=(VQ L&, R); 8913 // VQ L& operator<<=(VQ L&, R); 8914 // VQ L& operator>>=(VQ L&, R); 8915 // VQ L& operator&=(VQ L&, R); 8916 // VQ L& operator^=(VQ L&, R); 8917 // VQ L& operator|=(VQ L&, R); 8918 void addAssignmentIntegralOverloads() { 8919 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType) 8920 return; 8921 8922 for (unsigned Left = FirstIntegralType; Left < LastIntegralType; ++Left) { 8923 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedIntegralType; 8924 Right < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Right) { 8925 QualType ParamTypes[2]; 8926 ParamTypes[1] = ArithmeticTypes[Right]; 8927 auto LeftBaseTy = AdjustAddressSpaceForBuiltinOperandType( 8928 S, ArithmeticTypes[Left], Args[0]); 8929 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty). 8930 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(LeftBaseTy); 8931 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 8932 if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) { 8933 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile'). 8934 ParamTypes[0] = LeftBaseTy; 8935 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getVolatileType(ParamTypes[0]); 8936 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]); 8937 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 8938 } 8939 } 8940 } 8941 } 8942 8943 // C++ [over.operator]p23: 8944 // 8945 // There also exist candidate operator functions of the form 8946 // 8947 // bool operator!(bool); 8948 // bool operator&&(bool, bool); 8949 // bool operator||(bool, bool); 8950 void addExclaimOverload() { 8951 QualType ParamTy = S.Context.BoolTy; 8952 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(&ParamTy, Args, CandidateSet, 8953 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/false, 8954 /*NumContextualBoolArguments=*/1); 8955 } 8956 void addAmpAmpOrPipePipeOverload() { 8957 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { S.Context.BoolTy, S.Context.BoolTy }; 8958 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 8959 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/false, 8960 /*NumContextualBoolArguments=*/2); 8961 } 8962 8963 // C++ [over.built]p13: 8964 // 8965 // For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T there 8966 // exist candidate operator functions of the form 8967 // 8968 // T* operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t); [ABOVE] 8969 // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t); 8970 // T* operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t); [ABOVE] 8971 // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*); [ABOVE] 8972 // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*); 8973 void addSubscriptOverloads() { 8974 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 8975 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(), 8976 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end(); 8977 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 8978 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, S.Context.getPointerDiffType() }; 8979 QualType PointeeType = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType(); 8980 if (!PointeeType->isObjectType()) 8981 continue; 8982 8983 // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t) 8984 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 8985 } 8986 8987 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 8988 Ptr = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_begin(), 8989 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_end(); 8990 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 8991 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { S.Context.getPointerDiffType(), *Ptr }; 8992 QualType PointeeType = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType(); 8993 if (!PointeeType->isObjectType()) 8994 continue; 8995 8996 // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*) 8997 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 8998 } 8999 } 9000 9001 // C++ [over.built]p11: 9002 // For every quintuple (C1, C2, T, CV1, CV2), where C2 is a class type, 9003 // C1 is the same type as C2 or is a derived class of C2, T is an object 9004 // type or a function type, and CV1 and CV2 are cv-qualifier-seqs, 9005 // there exist candidate operator functions of the form 9006 // 9007 // CV12 T& operator->*(CV1 C1*, CV2 T C2::*); 9008 // 9009 // where CV12 is the union of CV1 and CV2. 9010 void addArrowStarOverloads() { 9011 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 9012 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(), 9013 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end(); 9014 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 9015 QualType C1Ty = (*Ptr); 9016 QualType C1; 9017 QualifierCollector Q1; 9018 C1 = QualType(Q1.strip(C1Ty->getPointeeType()), 0); 9019 if (!isa<RecordType>(C1)) 9020 continue; 9021 // heuristic to reduce number of builtin candidates in the set. 9022 // Add volatile/restrict version only if there are conversions to a 9023 // volatile/restrict type. 9024 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile() && Q1.hasVolatile()) 9025 continue; 9026 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict() && Q1.hasRestrict()) 9027 continue; 9028 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 9029 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[1].member_pointer_begin(), 9030 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].member_pointer_end(); 9031 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) { 9032 const MemberPointerType *mptr = cast<MemberPointerType>(*MemPtr); 9033 QualType C2 = QualType(mptr->getClass(), 0); 9034 C2 = C2.getUnqualifiedType(); 9035 if (C1 != C2 && !S.IsDerivedFrom(CandidateSet.getLocation(), C1, C2)) 9036 break; 9037 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *MemPtr }; 9038 // build CV12 T& 9039 QualType T = mptr->getPointeeType(); 9040 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile() && 9041 T.isVolatileQualified()) 9042 continue; 9043 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict() && 9044 T.isRestrictQualified()) 9045 continue; 9046 T = Q1.apply(S.Context, T); 9047 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 9048 } 9049 } 9050 } 9051 9052 // Note that we don't consider the first argument, since it has been 9053 // contextually converted to bool long ago. The candidates below are 9054 // therefore added as binary. 9055 // 9056 // C++ [over.built]p25: 9057 // For every type T, where T is a pointer, pointer-to-member, or scoped 9058 // enumeration type, there exist candidate operator functions of the form 9059 // 9060 // T operator?(bool, T, T); 9061 // 9062 void addConditionalOperatorOverloads() { 9063 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled. 9064 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes; 9065 9066 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < 2; ++ArgIdx) { 9067 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 9068 Ptr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_begin(), 9069 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_end(); 9070 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 9071 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)).second) 9072 continue; 9073 9074 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr }; 9075 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 9076 } 9077 9078 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 9079 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(), 9080 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end(); 9081 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) { 9082 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr)).second) 9083 continue; 9084 9085 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *MemPtr, *MemPtr }; 9086 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 9087 } 9088 9089 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) { 9090 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 9091 Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(), 9092 EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end(); 9093 Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) { 9094 if (!(*Enum)->castAs<EnumType>()->getDecl()->isScoped()) 9095 continue; 9096 9097 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum)).second) 9098 continue; 9099 9100 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Enum, *Enum }; 9101 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 9102 } 9103 } 9104 } 9105 } 9106 }; 9107 9108 } // end anonymous namespace 9109 9110 /// AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates - Add the appropriate built-in 9111 /// operator overloads to the candidate set (C++ [over.built]), based 9112 /// on the operator @p Op and the arguments given. For example, if the 9113 /// operator is a binary '+', this routine might add "int 9114 /// operator+(int, int)" to cover integer addition. 9115 void Sema::AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(OverloadedOperatorKind Op, 9116 SourceLocation OpLoc, 9117 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 9118 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) { 9119 // Find all of the types that the arguments can convert to, but only 9120 // if the operator we're looking at has built-in operator candidates 9121 // that make use of these types. Also record whether we encounter non-record 9122 // candidate types or either arithmetic or enumeral candidate types. 9123 Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals; 9124 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.addConst(); 9125 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) 9126 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals += CollectVRQualifiers(Context, Args[ArgIdx]); 9127 9128 bool HasNonRecordCandidateType = false; 9129 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType = false; 9130 SmallVector<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet, 2> CandidateTypes; 9131 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) { 9132 CandidateTypes.emplace_back(*this); 9133 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].AddTypesConvertedFrom(Args[ArgIdx]->getType(), 9134 OpLoc, 9135 true, 9136 (Op == OO_Exclaim || 9137 Op == OO_AmpAmp || 9138 Op == OO_PipePipe), 9139 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals); 9140 HasNonRecordCandidateType = HasNonRecordCandidateType || 9141 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasNonRecordTypes(); 9142 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType = 9143 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType || 9144 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes(); 9145 } 9146 9147 // Exit early when no non-record types have been added to the candidate set 9148 // for any of the arguments to the operator. 9149 // 9150 // We can't exit early for !, ||, or &&, since there we have always have 9151 // 'bool' overloads. 9152 if (!HasNonRecordCandidateType && 9153 !(Op == OO_Exclaim || Op == OO_AmpAmp || Op == OO_PipePipe)) 9154 return; 9155 9156 // Setup an object to manage the common state for building overloads. 9157 BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder OpBuilder(*this, Args, 9158 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals, 9159 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType, 9160 CandidateTypes, CandidateSet); 9161 9162 // Dispatch over the operation to add in only those overloads which apply. 9163 switch (Op) { 9164 case OO_None: 9165 case NUM_OVERLOADED_OPERATORS: 9166 llvm_unreachable("Expected an overloaded operator"); 9167 9168 case OO_New: 9169 case OO_Delete: 9170 case OO_Array_New: 9171 case OO_Array_Delete: 9172 case OO_Call: 9173 llvm_unreachable( 9174 "Special operators don't use AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates"); 9175 9176 case OO_Comma: 9177 case OO_Arrow: 9178 case OO_Coawait: 9179 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3: 9180 // -- For the operator ',', the unary operator '&', the 9181 // operator '->', or the operator 'co_await', the 9182 // built-in candidates set is empty. 9183 break; 9184 9185 case OO_Plus: // '+' is either unary or binary 9186 if (Args.size() == 1) 9187 OpBuilder.addUnaryPlusPointerOverloads(); 9188 LLVM_FALLTHROUGH; 9189 9190 case OO_Minus: // '-' is either unary or binary 9191 if (Args.size() == 1) { 9192 OpBuilder.addUnaryPlusOrMinusArithmeticOverloads(); 9193 } else { 9194 OpBuilder.addBinaryPlusOrMinusPointerOverloads(Op); 9195 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(); 9196 OpBuilder.addMatrixBinaryArithmeticOverloads(); 9197 } 9198 break; 9199 9200 case OO_Star: // '*' is either unary or binary 9201 if (Args.size() == 1) 9202 OpBuilder.addUnaryStarPointerOverloads(); 9203 else { 9204 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(); 9205 OpBuilder.addMatrixBinaryArithmeticOverloads(); 9206 } 9207 break; 9208 9209 case OO_Slash: 9210 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(); 9211 break; 9212 9213 case OO_PlusPlus: 9214 case OO_MinusMinus: 9215 OpBuilder.addPlusPlusMinusMinusArithmeticOverloads(Op); 9216 OpBuilder.addPlusPlusMinusMinusPointerOverloads(); 9217 break; 9218 9219 case OO_EqualEqual: 9220 case OO_ExclaimEqual: 9221 OpBuilder.addEqualEqualOrNotEqualMemberPointerOrNullptrOverloads(); 9222 LLVM_FALLTHROUGH; 9223 9224 case OO_Less: 9225 case OO_Greater: 9226 case OO_LessEqual: 9227 case OO_GreaterEqual: 9228 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryPointerOrEnumeralOverloads(); 9229 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(); 9230 break; 9231 9232 case OO_Spaceship: 9233 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryPointerOrEnumeralOverloads(); 9234 OpBuilder.addThreeWayArithmeticOverloads(); 9235 break; 9236 9237 case OO_Percent: 9238 case OO_Caret: 9239 case OO_Pipe: 9240 case OO_LessLess: 9241 case OO_GreaterGreater: 9242 OpBuilder.addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(Op); 9243 break; 9244 9245 case OO_Amp: // '&' is either unary or binary 9246 if (Args.size() == 1) 9247 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3: 9248 // -- For the operator ',', the unary operator '&', or the 9249 // operator '->', the built-in candidates set is empty. 9250 break; 9251 9252 OpBuilder.addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(Op); 9253 break; 9254 9255 case OO_Tilde: 9256 OpBuilder.addUnaryTildePromotedIntegralOverloads(); 9257 break; 9258 9259 case OO_Equal: 9260 OpBuilder.addAssignmentMemberPointerOrEnumeralOverloads(); 9261 LLVM_FALLTHROUGH; 9262 9263 case OO_PlusEqual: 9264 case OO_MinusEqual: 9265 OpBuilder.addAssignmentPointerOverloads(Op == OO_Equal); 9266 LLVM_FALLTHROUGH; 9267 9268 case OO_StarEqual: 9269 case OO_SlashEqual: 9270 OpBuilder.addAssignmentArithmeticOverloads(Op == OO_Equal); 9271 break; 9272 9273 case OO_PercentEqual: 9274 case OO_LessLessEqual: 9275 case OO_GreaterGreaterEqual: 9276 case OO_AmpEqual: 9277 case OO_CaretEqual: 9278 case OO_PipeEqual: 9279 OpBuilder.addAssignmentIntegralOverloads(); 9280 break; 9281 9282 case OO_Exclaim: 9283 OpBuilder.addExclaimOverload(); 9284 break; 9285 9286 case OO_AmpAmp: 9287 case OO_PipePipe: 9288 OpBuilder.addAmpAmpOrPipePipeOverload(); 9289 break; 9290 9291 case OO_Subscript: 9292 OpBuilder.addSubscriptOverloads(); 9293 break; 9294 9295 case OO_ArrowStar: 9296 OpBuilder.addArrowStarOverloads(); 9297 break; 9298 9299 case OO_Conditional: 9300 OpBuilder.addConditionalOperatorOverloads(); 9301 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(); 9302 break; 9303 } 9304 } 9305 9306 /// Add function candidates found via argument-dependent lookup 9307 /// to the set of overloading candidates. 9308 /// 9309 /// This routine performs argument-dependent name lookup based on the 9310 /// given function name (which may also be an operator name) and adds 9311 /// all of the overload candidates found by ADL to the overload 9312 /// candidate set (C++ [basic.lookup.argdep]). 9313 void 9314 Sema::AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(DeclarationName Name, 9315 SourceLocation Loc, 9316 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 9317 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs, 9318 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet, 9319 bool PartialOverloading) { 9320 ADLResult Fns; 9321 9322 // FIXME: This approach for uniquing ADL results (and removing 9323 // redundant candidates from the set) relies on pointer-equality, 9324 // which means we need to key off the canonical decl. However, 9325 // always going back to the canonical decl might not get us the 9326 // right set of default arguments. What default arguments are 9327 // we supposed to consider on ADL candidates, anyway? 9328 9329 // FIXME: Pass in the explicit template arguments? 9330 ArgumentDependentLookup(Name, Loc, Args, Fns); 9331 9332 // Erase all of the candidates we already knew about. 9333 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = CandidateSet.begin(), 9334 CandEnd = CandidateSet.end(); 9335 Cand != CandEnd; ++Cand) 9336 if (Cand->Function) { 9337 Fns.erase(Cand->Function); 9338 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = Cand->Function->getPrimaryTemplate()) 9339 Fns.erase(FunTmpl); 9340 } 9341 9342 // For each of the ADL candidates we found, add it to the overload 9343 // set. 9344 for (ADLResult::iterator I = Fns.begin(), E = Fns.end(); I != E; ++I) { 9345 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(*I, AS_none); 9346 9347 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*I)) { 9348 if (ExplicitTemplateArgs) 9349 continue; 9350 9351 AddOverloadCandidate( 9352 FD, FoundDecl, Args, CandidateSet, /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, 9353 PartialOverloading, /*AllowExplicit=*/true, 9354 /*AllowExplicitConversions=*/false, ADLCallKind::UsesADL); 9355 if (CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().shouldAddReversed(Context, FD)) { 9356 AddOverloadCandidate( 9357 FD, FoundDecl, {Args[1], Args[0]}, CandidateSet, 9358 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, PartialOverloading, 9359 /*AllowExplicit=*/true, /*AllowExplicitConversions=*/false, 9360 ADLCallKind::UsesADL, None, OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed); 9361 } 9362 } else { 9363 auto *FTD = cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*I); 9364 AddTemplateOverloadCandidate( 9365 FTD, FoundDecl, ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, CandidateSet, 9366 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, PartialOverloading, 9367 /*AllowExplicit=*/true, ADLCallKind::UsesADL); 9368 if (CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().shouldAddReversed( 9369 Context, FTD->getTemplatedDecl())) { 9370 AddTemplateOverloadCandidate( 9371 FTD, FoundDecl, ExplicitTemplateArgs, {Args[1], Args[0]}, 9372 CandidateSet, /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, PartialOverloading, 9373 /*AllowExplicit=*/true, ADLCallKind::UsesADL, 9374 OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed); 9375 } 9376 } 9377 } 9378 } 9379 9380 namespace { 9381 enum class Comparison { Equal, Better, Worse }; 9382 } 9383 9384 /// Compares the enable_if attributes of two FunctionDecls, for the purposes of 9385 /// overload resolution. 9386 /// 9387 /// Cand1's set of enable_if attributes are said to be "better" than Cand2's iff 9388 /// Cand1's first N enable_if attributes have precisely the same conditions as 9389 /// Cand2's first N enable_if attributes (where N = the number of enable_if 9390 /// attributes on Cand2), and Cand1 has more than N enable_if attributes. 9391 /// 9392 /// Note that you can have a pair of candidates such that Cand1's enable_if 9393 /// attributes are worse than Cand2's, and Cand2's enable_if attributes are 9394 /// worse than Cand1's. 9395 static Comparison compareEnableIfAttrs(const Sema &S, const FunctionDecl *Cand1, 9396 const FunctionDecl *Cand2) { 9397 // Common case: One (or both) decls don't have enable_if attrs. 9398 bool Cand1Attr = Cand1->hasAttr<EnableIfAttr>(); 9399 bool Cand2Attr = Cand2->hasAttr<EnableIfAttr>(); 9400 if (!Cand1Attr || !Cand2Attr) { 9401 if (Cand1Attr == Cand2Attr) 9402 return Comparison::Equal; 9403 return Cand1Attr ? Comparison::Better : Comparison::Worse; 9404 } 9405 9406 auto Cand1Attrs = Cand1->specific_attrs<EnableIfAttr>(); 9407 auto Cand2Attrs = Cand2->specific_attrs<EnableIfAttr>(); 9408 9409 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID Cand1ID, Cand2ID; 9410 for (auto Pair : zip_longest(Cand1Attrs, Cand2Attrs)) { 9411 Optional<EnableIfAttr *> Cand1A = std::get<0>(Pair); 9412 Optional<EnableIfAttr *> Cand2A = std::get<1>(Pair); 9413 9414 // It's impossible for Cand1 to be better than (or equal to) Cand2 if Cand1 9415 // has fewer enable_if attributes than Cand2, and vice versa. 9416 if (!Cand1A) 9417 return Comparison::Worse; 9418 if (!Cand2A) 9419 return Comparison::Better; 9420 9421 Cand1ID.clear(); 9422 Cand2ID.clear(); 9423 9424 (*Cand1A)->getCond()->Profile(Cand1ID, S.getASTContext(), true); 9425 (*Cand2A)->getCond()->Profile(Cand2ID, S.getASTContext(), true); 9426 if (Cand1ID != Cand2ID) 9427 return Comparison::Worse; 9428 } 9429 9430 return Comparison::Equal; 9431 } 9432 9433 static Comparison 9434 isBetterMultiversionCandidate(const OverloadCandidate &Cand1, 9435 const OverloadCandidate &Cand2) { 9436 if (!Cand1.Function || !Cand1.Function->isMultiVersion() || !Cand2.Function || 9437 !Cand2.Function->isMultiVersion()) 9438 return Comparison::Equal; 9439 9440 // If both are invalid, they are equal. If one of them is invalid, the other 9441 // is better. 9442 if (Cand1.Function->isInvalidDecl()) { 9443 if (Cand2.Function->isInvalidDecl()) 9444 return Comparison::Equal; 9445 return Comparison::Worse; 9446 } 9447 if (Cand2.Function->isInvalidDecl()) 9448 return Comparison::Better; 9449 9450 // If this is a cpu_dispatch/cpu_specific multiversion situation, prefer 9451 // cpu_dispatch, else arbitrarily based on the identifiers. 9452 bool Cand1CPUDisp = Cand1.Function->hasAttr<CPUDispatchAttr>(); 9453 bool Cand2CPUDisp = Cand2.Function->hasAttr<CPUDispatchAttr>(); 9454 const auto *Cand1CPUSpec = Cand1.Function->getAttr<CPUSpecificAttr>(); 9455 const auto *Cand2CPUSpec = Cand2.Function->getAttr<CPUSpecificAttr>(); 9456 9457 if (!Cand1CPUDisp && !Cand2CPUDisp && !Cand1CPUSpec && !Cand2CPUSpec) 9458 return Comparison::Equal; 9459 9460 if (Cand1CPUDisp && !Cand2CPUDisp) 9461 return Comparison::Better; 9462 if (Cand2CPUDisp && !Cand1CPUDisp) 9463 return Comparison::Worse; 9464 9465 if (Cand1CPUSpec && Cand2CPUSpec) { 9466 if (Cand1CPUSpec->cpus_size() != Cand2CPUSpec->cpus_size()) 9467 return Cand1CPUSpec->cpus_size() < Cand2CPUSpec->cpus_size() 9468 ? Comparison::Better 9469 : Comparison::Worse; 9470 9471 std::pair<CPUSpecificAttr::cpus_iterator, CPUSpecificAttr::cpus_iterator> 9472 FirstDiff = std::mismatch( 9473 Cand1CPUSpec->cpus_begin(), Cand1CPUSpec->cpus_end(), 9474 Cand2CPUSpec->cpus_begin(), 9475 [](const IdentifierInfo *LHS, const IdentifierInfo *RHS) { 9476 return LHS->getName() == RHS->getName(); 9477 }); 9478 9479 assert(FirstDiff.first != Cand1CPUSpec->cpus_end() && 9480 "Two different cpu-specific versions should not have the same " 9481 "identifier list, otherwise they'd be the same decl!"); 9482 return (*FirstDiff.first)->getName() < (*FirstDiff.second)->getName() 9483 ? Comparison::Better 9484 : Comparison::Worse; 9485 } 9486 llvm_unreachable("No way to get here unless both had cpu_dispatch"); 9487 } 9488 9489 /// Compute the type of the implicit object parameter for the given function, 9490 /// if any. Returns None if there is no implicit object parameter, and a null 9491 /// QualType if there is a 'matches anything' implicit object parameter. 9492 static Optional<QualType> getImplicitObjectParamType(ASTContext &Context, 9493 const FunctionDecl *F) { 9494 if (!isa<CXXMethodDecl>(F) || isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(F)) 9495 return llvm::None; 9496 9497 auto *M = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(F); 9498 // Static member functions' object parameters match all types. 9499 if (M->isStatic()) 9500 return QualType(); 9501 9502 QualType T = M->getThisObjectType(); 9503 if (M->getRefQualifier() == RQ_RValue) 9504 return Context.getRValueReferenceType(T); 9505 return Context.getLValueReferenceType(T); 9506 } 9507 9508 static bool haveSameParameterTypes(ASTContext &Context, const FunctionDecl *F1, 9509 const FunctionDecl *F2, unsigned NumParams) { 9510 if (declaresSameEntity(F1, F2)) 9511 return true; 9512 9513 auto NextParam = [&](const FunctionDecl *F, unsigned &I, bool First) { 9514 if (First) { 9515 if (Optional<QualType> T = getImplicitObjectParamType(Context, F)) 9516 return *T; 9517 } 9518 assert(I < F->getNumParams()); 9519 return F->getParamDecl(I++)->getType(); 9520 }; 9521 9522 unsigned I1 = 0, I2 = 0; 9523 for (unsigned I = 0; I != NumParams; ++I) { 9524 QualType T1 = NextParam(F1, I1, I == 0); 9525 QualType T2 = NextParam(F2, I2, I == 0); 9526 if (!T1.isNull() && !T1.isNull() && !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, T2)) 9527 return false; 9528 } 9529 return true; 9530 } 9531 9532 /// isBetterOverloadCandidate - Determines whether the first overload 9533 /// candidate is a better candidate than the second (C++ 13.3.3p1). 9534 bool clang::isBetterOverloadCandidate( 9535 Sema &S, const OverloadCandidate &Cand1, const OverloadCandidate &Cand2, 9536 SourceLocation Loc, OverloadCandidateSet::CandidateSetKind Kind) { 9537 // Define viable functions to be better candidates than non-viable 9538 // functions. 9539 if (!Cand2.Viable) 9540 return Cand1.Viable; 9541 else if (!Cand1.Viable) 9542 return false; 9543 9544 // C++ [over.match.best]p1: 9545 // 9546 // -- if F is a static member function, ICS1(F) is defined such 9547 // that ICS1(F) is neither better nor worse than ICS1(G) for 9548 // any function G, and, symmetrically, ICS1(G) is neither 9549 // better nor worse than ICS1(F). 9550 unsigned StartArg = 0; 9551 if (Cand1.IgnoreObjectArgument || Cand2.IgnoreObjectArgument) 9552 StartArg = 1; 9553 9554 auto IsIllFormedConversion = [&](const ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS) { 9555 // We don't allow incompatible pointer conversions in C++. 9556 if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 9557 return ICS.isStandard() && 9558 ICS.Standard.Second == ICK_Incompatible_Pointer_Conversion; 9559 9560 // The only ill-formed conversion we allow in C++ is the string literal to 9561 // char* conversion, which is only considered ill-formed after C++11. 9562 return S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && !S.getLangOpts().WritableStrings && 9563 hasDeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtrConversion(ICS); 9564 }; 9565 9566 // Define functions that don't require ill-formed conversions for a given 9567 // argument to be better candidates than functions that do. 9568 unsigned NumArgs = Cand1.Conversions.size(); 9569 assert(Cand2.Conversions.size() == NumArgs && "Overload candidate mismatch"); 9570 bool HasBetterConversion = false; 9571 for (unsigned ArgIdx = StartArg; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) { 9572 bool Cand1Bad = IsIllFormedConversion(Cand1.Conversions[ArgIdx]); 9573 bool Cand2Bad = IsIllFormedConversion(Cand2.Conversions[ArgIdx]); 9574 if (Cand1Bad != Cand2Bad) { 9575 if (Cand1Bad) 9576 return false; 9577 HasBetterConversion = true; 9578 } 9579 } 9580 9581 if (HasBetterConversion) 9582 return true; 9583 9584 // C++ [over.match.best]p1: 9585 // A viable function F1 is defined to be a better function than another 9586 // viable function F2 if for all arguments i, ICSi(F1) is not a worse 9587 // conversion sequence than ICSi(F2), and then... 9588 bool HasWorseConversion = false; 9589 for (unsigned ArgIdx = StartArg; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) { 9590 switch (CompareImplicitConversionSequences(S, Loc, 9591 Cand1.Conversions[ArgIdx], 9592 Cand2.Conversions[ArgIdx])) { 9593 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better: 9594 // Cand1 has a better conversion sequence. 9595 HasBetterConversion = true; 9596 break; 9597 9598 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse: 9599 if (Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function && 9600 Cand1.isReversed() != Cand2.isReversed() && 9601 haveSameParameterTypes(S.Context, Cand1.Function, Cand2.Function, 9602 NumArgs)) { 9603 // Work around large-scale breakage caused by considering reversed 9604 // forms of operator== in C++20: 9605 // 9606 // When comparing a function against a reversed function with the same 9607 // parameter types, if we have a better conversion for one argument and 9608 // a worse conversion for the other, the implicit conversion sequences 9609 // are treated as being equally good. 9610 // 9611 // This prevents a comparison function from being considered ambiguous 9612 // with a reversed form that is written in the same way. 9613 // 9614 // We diagnose this as an extension from CreateOverloadedBinOp. 9615 HasWorseConversion = true; 9616 break; 9617 } 9618 9619 // Cand1 can't be better than Cand2. 9620 return false; 9621 9622 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable: 9623 // Do nothing. 9624 break; 9625 } 9626 } 9627 9628 // -- for some argument j, ICSj(F1) is a better conversion sequence than 9629 // ICSj(F2), or, if not that, 9630 if (HasBetterConversion && !HasWorseConversion) 9631 return true; 9632 9633 // -- the context is an initialization by user-defined conversion 9634 // (see 8.5, 13.3.1.5) and the standard conversion sequence 9635 // from the return type of F1 to the destination type (i.e., 9636 // the type of the entity being initialized) is a better 9637 // conversion sequence than the standard conversion sequence 9638 // from the return type of F2 to the destination type. 9639 if (Kind == OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_InitByUserDefinedConversion && 9640 Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function && 9641 isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand1.Function) && 9642 isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand2.Function)) { 9643 // First check whether we prefer one of the conversion functions over the 9644 // other. This only distinguishes the results in non-standard, extension 9645 // cases such as the conversion from a lambda closure type to a function 9646 // pointer or block. 9647 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result = 9648 compareConversionFunctions(S, Cand1.Function, Cand2.Function); 9649 if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable) 9650 Result = CompareStandardConversionSequences(S, Loc, 9651 Cand1.FinalConversion, 9652 Cand2.FinalConversion); 9653 9654 if (Result != ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable) 9655 return Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 9656 9657 // FIXME: Compare kind of reference binding if conversion functions 9658 // convert to a reference type used in direct reference binding, per 9659 // C++14 [over.match.best]p1 section 2 bullet 3. 9660 } 9661 9662 // FIXME: Work around a defect in the C++17 guaranteed copy elision wording, 9663 // as combined with the resolution to CWG issue 243. 9664 // 9665 // When the context is initialization by constructor ([over.match.ctor] or 9666 // either phase of [over.match.list]), a constructor is preferred over 9667 // a conversion function. 9668 if (Kind == OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_InitByConstructor && NumArgs == 1 && 9669 Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function && 9670 isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Cand1.Function) != 9671 isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Cand2.Function)) 9672 return isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Cand1.Function); 9673 9674 // -- F1 is a non-template function and F2 is a function template 9675 // specialization, or, if not that, 9676 bool Cand1IsSpecialization = Cand1.Function && 9677 Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(); 9678 bool Cand2IsSpecialization = Cand2.Function && 9679 Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(); 9680 if (Cand1IsSpecialization != Cand2IsSpecialization) 9681 return Cand2IsSpecialization; 9682 9683 // -- F1 and F2 are function template specializations, and the function 9684 // template for F1 is more specialized than the template for F2 9685 // according to the partial ordering rules described in 14.5.5.2, or, 9686 // if not that, 9687 if (Cand1IsSpecialization && Cand2IsSpecialization) { 9688 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *BetterTemplate = S.getMoreSpecializedTemplate( 9689 Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(), 9690 Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(), Loc, 9691 isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand1.Function) ? TPOC_Conversion 9692 : TPOC_Call, 9693 Cand1.ExplicitCallArguments, Cand2.ExplicitCallArguments, 9694 Cand1.isReversed() ^ Cand2.isReversed())) 9695 return BetterTemplate == Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(); 9696 } 9697 9698 // -— F1 and F2 are non-template functions with the same 9699 // parameter-type-lists, and F1 is more constrained than F2 [...], 9700 if (Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function && !Cand1IsSpecialization && 9701 !Cand2IsSpecialization && Cand1.Function->hasPrototype() && 9702 Cand2.Function->hasPrototype()) { 9703 auto *PT1 = cast<FunctionProtoType>(Cand1.Function->getFunctionType()); 9704 auto *PT2 = cast<FunctionProtoType>(Cand2.Function->getFunctionType()); 9705 if (PT1->getNumParams() == PT2->getNumParams() && 9706 PT1->isVariadic() == PT2->isVariadic() && 9707 S.FunctionParamTypesAreEqual(PT1, PT2)) { 9708 Expr *RC1 = Cand1.Function->getTrailingRequiresClause(); 9709 Expr *RC2 = Cand2.Function->getTrailingRequiresClause(); 9710 if (RC1 && RC2) { 9711 bool AtLeastAsConstrained1, AtLeastAsConstrained2; 9712 if (S.IsAtLeastAsConstrained(Cand1.Function, {RC1}, Cand2.Function, 9713 {RC2}, AtLeastAsConstrained1) || 9714 S.IsAtLeastAsConstrained(Cand2.Function, {RC2}, Cand1.Function, 9715 {RC1}, AtLeastAsConstrained2)) 9716 return false; 9717 if (AtLeastAsConstrained1 != AtLeastAsConstrained2) 9718 return AtLeastAsConstrained1; 9719 } else if (RC1 || RC2) { 9720 return RC1 != nullptr; 9721 } 9722 } 9723 } 9724 9725 // -- F1 is a constructor for a class D, F2 is a constructor for a base 9726 // class B of D, and for all arguments the corresponding parameters of 9727 // F1 and F2 have the same type. 9728 // FIXME: Implement the "all parameters have the same type" check. 9729 bool Cand1IsInherited = 9730 dyn_cast_or_null<ConstructorUsingShadowDecl>(Cand1.FoundDecl.getDecl()); 9731 bool Cand2IsInherited = 9732 dyn_cast_or_null<ConstructorUsingShadowDecl>(Cand2.FoundDecl.getDecl()); 9733 if (Cand1IsInherited != Cand2IsInherited) 9734 return Cand2IsInherited; 9735 else if (Cand1IsInherited) { 9736 assert(Cand2IsInherited); 9737 auto *Cand1Class = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Cand1.Function->getDeclContext()); 9738 auto *Cand2Class = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Cand2.Function->getDeclContext()); 9739 if (Cand1Class->isDerivedFrom(Cand2Class)) 9740 return true; 9741 if (Cand2Class->isDerivedFrom(Cand1Class)) 9742 return false; 9743 // Inherited from sibling base classes: still ambiguous. 9744 } 9745 9746 // -- F2 is a rewritten candidate (12.4.1.2) and F1 is not 9747 // -- F1 and F2 are rewritten candidates, and F2 is a synthesized candidate 9748 // with reversed order of parameters and F1 is not 9749 // 9750 // We rank reversed + different operator as worse than just reversed, but 9751 // that comparison can never happen, because we only consider reversing for 9752 // the maximally-rewritten operator (== or <=>). 9753 if (Cand1.RewriteKind != Cand2.RewriteKind) 9754 return Cand1.RewriteKind < Cand2.RewriteKind; 9755 9756 // Check C++17 tie-breakers for deduction guides. 9757 { 9758 auto *Guide1 = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXDeductionGuideDecl>(Cand1.Function); 9759 auto *Guide2 = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXDeductionGuideDecl>(Cand2.Function); 9760 if (Guide1 && Guide2) { 9761 // -- F1 is generated from a deduction-guide and F2 is not 9762 if (Guide1->isImplicit() != Guide2->isImplicit()) 9763 return Guide2->isImplicit(); 9764 9765 // -- F1 is the copy deduction candidate(16.3.1.8) and F2 is not 9766 if (Guide1->isCopyDeductionCandidate()) 9767 return true; 9768 } 9769 } 9770 9771 // Check for enable_if value-based overload resolution. 9772 if (Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function) { 9773 Comparison Cmp = compareEnableIfAttrs(S, Cand1.Function, Cand2.Function); 9774 if (Cmp != Comparison::Equal) 9775 return Cmp == Comparison::Better; 9776 } 9777 9778 if (S.getLangOpts().CUDA && Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function) { 9779 FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext); 9780 return S.IdentifyCUDAPreference(Caller, Cand1.Function) > 9781 S.IdentifyCUDAPreference(Caller, Cand2.Function); 9782 } 9783 9784 bool HasPS1 = Cand1.Function != nullptr && 9785 functionHasPassObjectSizeParams(Cand1.Function); 9786 bool HasPS2 = Cand2.Function != nullptr && 9787 functionHasPassObjectSizeParams(Cand2.Function); 9788 if (HasPS1 != HasPS2 && HasPS1) 9789 return true; 9790 9791 Comparison MV = isBetterMultiversionCandidate(Cand1, Cand2); 9792 return MV == Comparison::Better; 9793 } 9794 9795 /// Determine whether two declarations are "equivalent" for the purposes of 9796 /// name lookup and overload resolution. This applies when the same internal/no 9797 /// linkage entity is defined by two modules (probably by textually including 9798 /// the same header). In such a case, we don't consider the declarations to 9799 /// declare the same entity, but we also don't want lookups with both 9800 /// declarations visible to be ambiguous in some cases (this happens when using 9801 /// a modularized libstdc++). 9802 bool Sema::isEquivalentInternalLinkageDeclaration(const NamedDecl *A, 9803 const NamedDecl *B) { 9804 auto *VA = dyn_cast_or_null<ValueDecl>(A); 9805 auto *VB = dyn_cast_or_null<ValueDecl>(B); 9806 if (!VA || !VB) 9807 return false; 9808 9809 // The declarations must be declaring the same name as an internal linkage 9810 // entity in different modules. 9811 if (!VA->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->Equals( 9812 VB->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()) || 9813 getOwningModule(VA) == getOwningModule(VB) || 9814 VA->isExternallyVisible() || VB->isExternallyVisible()) 9815 return false; 9816 9817 // Check that the declarations appear to be equivalent. 9818 // 9819 // FIXME: Checking the type isn't really enough to resolve the ambiguity. 9820 // For constants and functions, we should check the initializer or body is 9821 // the same. For non-constant variables, we shouldn't allow it at all. 9822 if (Context.hasSameType(VA->getType(), VB->getType())) 9823 return true; 9824 9825 // Enum constants within unnamed enumerations will have different types, but 9826 // may still be similar enough to be interchangeable for our purposes. 9827 if (auto *EA = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(VA)) { 9828 if (auto *EB = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(VB)) { 9829 // Only handle anonymous enums. If the enumerations were named and 9830 // equivalent, they would have been merged to the same type. 9831 auto *EnumA = cast<EnumDecl>(EA->getDeclContext()); 9832 auto *EnumB = cast<EnumDecl>(EB->getDeclContext()); 9833 if (EnumA->hasNameForLinkage() || EnumB->hasNameForLinkage() || 9834 !Context.hasSameType(EnumA->getIntegerType(), 9835 EnumB->getIntegerType())) 9836 return false; 9837 // Allow this only if the value is the same for both enumerators. 9838 return llvm::APSInt::isSameValue(EA->getInitVal(), EB->getInitVal()); 9839 } 9840 } 9841 9842 // Nothing else is sufficiently similar. 9843 return false; 9844 } 9845 9846 void Sema::diagnoseEquivalentInternalLinkageDeclarations( 9847 SourceLocation Loc, const NamedDecl *D, ArrayRef<const NamedDecl *> Equiv) { 9848 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_equivalent_internal_linkage_decl_in_modules) << D; 9849 9850 Module *M = getOwningModule(D); 9851 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_equivalent_internal_linkage_decl) 9852 << !M << (M ? M->getFullModuleName() : ""); 9853 9854 for (auto *E : Equiv) { 9855 Module *M = getOwningModule(E); 9856 Diag(E->getLocation(), diag::note_equivalent_internal_linkage_decl) 9857 << !M << (M ? M->getFullModuleName() : ""); 9858 } 9859 } 9860 9861 /// Computes the best viable function (C++ 13.3.3) 9862 /// within an overload candidate set. 9863 /// 9864 /// \param Loc The location of the function name (or operator symbol) for 9865 /// which overload resolution occurs. 9866 /// 9867 /// \param Best If overload resolution was successful or found a deleted 9868 /// function, \p Best points to the candidate function found. 9869 /// 9870 /// \returns The result of overload resolution. 9871 OverloadingResult 9872 OverloadCandidateSet::BestViableFunction(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 9873 iterator &Best) { 9874 llvm::SmallVector<OverloadCandidate *, 16> Candidates; 9875 std::transform(begin(), end(), std::back_inserter(Candidates), 9876 [](OverloadCandidate &Cand) { return &Cand; }); 9877 9878 // [CUDA] HD->H or HD->D calls are technically not allowed by CUDA but 9879 // are accepted by both clang and NVCC. However, during a particular 9880 // compilation mode only one call variant is viable. We need to 9881 // exclude non-viable overload candidates from consideration based 9882 // only on their host/device attributes. Specifically, if one 9883 // candidate call is WrongSide and the other is SameSide, we ignore 9884 // the WrongSide candidate. 9885 if (S.getLangOpts().CUDA) { 9886 const FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext); 9887 bool ContainsSameSideCandidate = 9888 llvm::any_of(Candidates, [&](OverloadCandidate *Cand) { 9889 // Check viable function only. 9890 return Cand->Viable && Cand->Function && 9891 S.IdentifyCUDAPreference(Caller, Cand->Function) == 9892 Sema::CFP_SameSide; 9893 }); 9894 if (ContainsSameSideCandidate) { 9895 auto IsWrongSideCandidate = [&](OverloadCandidate *Cand) { 9896 // Check viable function only to avoid unnecessary data copying/moving. 9897 return Cand->Viable && Cand->Function && 9898 S.IdentifyCUDAPreference(Caller, Cand->Function) == 9899 Sema::CFP_WrongSide; 9900 }; 9901 llvm::erase_if(Candidates, IsWrongSideCandidate); 9902 } 9903 } 9904 9905 // Find the best viable function. 9906 Best = end(); 9907 for (auto *Cand : Candidates) { 9908 Cand->Best = false; 9909 if (Cand->Viable) 9910 if (Best == end() || 9911 isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *Cand, *Best, Loc, Kind)) 9912 Best = Cand; 9913 } 9914 9915 // If we didn't find any viable functions, abort. 9916 if (Best == end()) 9917 return OR_No_Viable_Function; 9918 9919 llvm::SmallVector<const NamedDecl *, 4> EquivalentCands; 9920 9921 llvm::SmallVector<OverloadCandidate*, 4> PendingBest; 9922 PendingBest.push_back(&*Best); 9923 Best->Best = true; 9924 9925 // Make sure that this function is better than every other viable 9926 // function. If not, we have an ambiguity. 9927 while (!PendingBest.empty()) { 9928 auto *Curr = PendingBest.pop_back_val(); 9929 for (auto *Cand : Candidates) { 9930 if (Cand->Viable && !Cand->Best && 9931 !isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *Curr, *Cand, Loc, Kind)) { 9932 PendingBest.push_back(Cand); 9933 Cand->Best = true; 9934 9935 if (S.isEquivalentInternalLinkageDeclaration(Cand->Function, 9936 Curr->Function)) 9937 EquivalentCands.push_back(Cand->Function); 9938 else 9939 Best = end(); 9940 } 9941 } 9942 } 9943 9944 // If we found more than one best candidate, this is ambiguous. 9945 if (Best == end()) 9946 return OR_Ambiguous; 9947 9948 // Best is the best viable function. 9949 if (Best->Function && Best->Function->isDeleted()) 9950 return OR_Deleted; 9951 9952 if (!EquivalentCands.empty()) 9953 S.diagnoseEquivalentInternalLinkageDeclarations(Loc, Best->Function, 9954 EquivalentCands); 9955 9956 return OR_Success; 9957 } 9958 9959 namespace { 9960 9961 enum OverloadCandidateKind { 9962 oc_function, 9963 oc_method, 9964 oc_reversed_binary_operator, 9965 oc_constructor, 9966 oc_implicit_default_constructor, 9967 oc_implicit_copy_constructor, 9968 oc_implicit_move_constructor, 9969 oc_implicit_copy_assignment, 9970 oc_implicit_move_assignment, 9971 oc_implicit_equality_comparison, 9972 oc_inherited_constructor 9973 }; 9974 9975 enum OverloadCandidateSelect { 9976 ocs_non_template, 9977 ocs_template, 9978 ocs_described_template, 9979 }; 9980 9981 static std::pair<OverloadCandidateKind, OverloadCandidateSelect> 9982 ClassifyOverloadCandidate(Sema &S, NamedDecl *Found, FunctionDecl *Fn, 9983 OverloadCandidateRewriteKind CRK, 9984 std::string &Description) { 9985 9986 bool isTemplate = Fn->isTemplateDecl() || Found->isTemplateDecl(); 9987 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = Fn->getPrimaryTemplate()) { 9988 isTemplate = true; 9989 Description = S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText( 9990 FunTmpl->getTemplateParameters(), *Fn->getTemplateSpecializationArgs()); 9991 } 9992 9993 OverloadCandidateSelect Select = [&]() { 9994 if (!Description.empty()) 9995 return ocs_described_template; 9996 return isTemplate ? ocs_template : ocs_non_template; 9997 }(); 9998 9999 OverloadCandidateKind Kind = [&]() { 10000 if (Fn->isImplicit() && Fn->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_EqualEqual) 10001 return oc_implicit_equality_comparison; 10002 10003 if (CRK & CRK_Reversed) 10004 return oc_reversed_binary_operator; 10005 10006 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Ctor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn)) { 10007 if (!Ctor->isImplicit()) { 10008 if (isa<ConstructorUsingShadowDecl>(Found)) 10009 return oc_inherited_constructor; 10010 else 10011 return oc_constructor; 10012 } 10013 10014 if (Ctor->isDefaultConstructor()) 10015 return oc_implicit_default_constructor; 10016 10017 if (Ctor->isMoveConstructor()) 10018 return oc_implicit_move_constructor; 10019 10020 assert(Ctor->isCopyConstructor() && 10021 "unexpected sort of implicit constructor"); 10022 return oc_implicit_copy_constructor; 10023 } 10024 10025 if (CXXMethodDecl *Meth = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) { 10026 // This actually gets spelled 'candidate function' for now, but 10027 // it doesn't hurt to split it out. 10028 if (!Meth->isImplicit()) 10029 return oc_method; 10030 10031 if (Meth->isMoveAssignmentOperator()) 10032 return oc_implicit_move_assignment; 10033 10034 if (Meth->isCopyAssignmentOperator()) 10035 return oc_implicit_copy_assignment; 10036 10037 assert(isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Meth) && "expected conversion"); 10038 return oc_method; 10039 } 10040 10041 return oc_function; 10042 }(); 10043 10044 return std::make_pair(Kind, Select); 10045 } 10046 10047 void MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(Sema &S, Decl *FoundDecl) { 10048 // FIXME: It'd be nice to only emit a note once per using-decl per overload 10049 // set. 10050 if (auto *Shadow = dyn_cast<ConstructorUsingShadowDecl>(FoundDecl)) 10051 S.Diag(FoundDecl->getLocation(), 10052 diag::note_ovl_candidate_inherited_constructor) 10053 << Shadow->getNominatedBaseClass(); 10054 } 10055 10056 } // end anonymous namespace 10057 10058 static bool isFunctionAlwaysEnabled(const ASTContext &Ctx, 10059 const FunctionDecl *FD) { 10060 for (auto *EnableIf : FD->specific_attrs<EnableIfAttr>()) { 10061 bool AlwaysTrue; 10062 if (EnableIf->getCond()->isValueDependent() || 10063 !EnableIf->getCond()->EvaluateAsBooleanCondition(AlwaysTrue, Ctx)) 10064 return false; 10065 if (!AlwaysTrue) 10066 return false; 10067 } 10068 return true; 10069 } 10070 10071 /// Returns true if we can take the address of the function. 10072 /// 10073 /// \param Complain - If true, we'll emit a diagnostic 10074 /// \param InOverloadResolution - For the purposes of emitting a diagnostic, are 10075 /// we in overload resolution? 10076 /// \param Loc - The location of the statement we're complaining about. Ignored 10077 /// if we're not complaining, or if we're in overload resolution. 10078 static bool checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(Sema &S, const FunctionDecl *FD, 10079 bool Complain, 10080 bool InOverloadResolution, 10081 SourceLocation Loc) { 10082 if (!isFunctionAlwaysEnabled(S.Context, FD)) { 10083 if (Complain) { 10084 if (InOverloadResolution) 10085 S.Diag(FD->getBeginLoc(), 10086 diag::note_addrof_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_enable_if_attr); 10087 else 10088 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_addrof_function_disabled_by_enable_if_attr) << FD; 10089 } 10090 return false; 10091 } 10092 10093 if (FD->getTrailingRequiresClause()) { 10094 ConstraintSatisfaction Satisfaction; 10095 if (S.CheckFunctionConstraints(FD, Satisfaction, Loc)) 10096 return false; 10097 if (!Satisfaction.IsSatisfied) { 10098 if (Complain) { 10099 if (InOverloadResolution) 10100 S.Diag(FD->getBeginLoc(), 10101 diag::note_ovl_candidate_unsatisfied_constraints); 10102 else 10103 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_addrof_function_constraints_not_satisfied) 10104 << FD; 10105 S.DiagnoseUnsatisfiedConstraint(Satisfaction); 10106 } 10107 return false; 10108 } 10109 } 10110 10111 auto I = llvm::find_if(FD->parameters(), [](const ParmVarDecl *P) { 10112 return P->hasAttr<PassObjectSizeAttr>(); 10113 }); 10114 if (I == FD->param_end()) 10115 return true; 10116 10117 if (Complain) { 10118 // Add one to ParamNo because it's user-facing 10119 unsigned ParamNo = std::distance(FD->param_begin(), I) + 1; 10120 if (InOverloadResolution) 10121 S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), 10122 diag::note_ovl_candidate_has_pass_object_size_params) 10123 << ParamNo; 10124 else 10125 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_address_of_function_with_pass_object_size_params) 10126 << FD << ParamNo; 10127 } 10128 return false; 10129 } 10130 10131 static bool checkAddressOfCandidateIsAvailable(Sema &S, 10132 const FunctionDecl *FD) { 10133 return checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(S, FD, /*Complain=*/true, 10134 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true, 10135 /*Loc=*/SourceLocation()); 10136 } 10137 10138 bool Sema::checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(const FunctionDecl *Function, 10139 bool Complain, 10140 SourceLocation Loc) { 10141 return ::checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(*this, Function, Complain, 10142 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, 10143 Loc); 10144 } 10145 10146 // Notes the location of an overload candidate. 10147 void Sema::NoteOverloadCandidate(NamedDecl *Found, FunctionDecl *Fn, 10148 OverloadCandidateRewriteKind RewriteKind, 10149 QualType DestType, bool TakingAddress) { 10150 if (TakingAddress && !checkAddressOfCandidateIsAvailable(*this, Fn)) 10151 return; 10152 if (Fn->isMultiVersion() && Fn->hasAttr<TargetAttr>() && 10153 !Fn->getAttr<TargetAttr>()->isDefaultVersion()) 10154 return; 10155 10156 std::string FnDesc; 10157 std::pair<OverloadCandidateKind, OverloadCandidateSelect> KSPair = 10158 ClassifyOverloadCandidate(*this, Found, Fn, RewriteKind, FnDesc); 10159 PartialDiagnostic PD = PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate) 10160 << (unsigned)KSPair.first << (unsigned)KSPair.second 10161 << Fn << FnDesc; 10162 10163 HandleFunctionTypeMismatch(PD, Fn->getType(), DestType); 10164 Diag(Fn->getLocation(), PD); 10165 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(*this, Found); 10166 } 10167 10168 static void 10169 MaybeDiagnoseAmbiguousConstraints(Sema &S, ArrayRef<OverloadCandidate> Cands) { 10170 // Perhaps the ambiguity was caused by two atomic constraints that are 10171 // 'identical' but not equivalent: 10172 // 10173 // void foo() requires (sizeof(T) > 4) { } // #1 10174 // void foo() requires (sizeof(T) > 4) && T::value { } // #2 10175 // 10176 // The 'sizeof(T) > 4' constraints are seemingly equivalent and should cause 10177 // #2 to subsume #1, but these constraint are not considered equivalent 10178 // according to the subsumption rules because they are not the same 10179 // source-level construct. This behavior is quite confusing and we should try 10180 // to help the user figure out what happened. 10181 10182 SmallVector<const Expr *, 3> FirstAC, SecondAC; 10183 FunctionDecl *FirstCand = nullptr, *SecondCand = nullptr; 10184 for (auto I = Cands.begin(), E = Cands.end(); I != E; ++I) { 10185 if (!I->Function) 10186 continue; 10187 SmallVector<const Expr *, 3> AC; 10188 if (auto *Template = I->Function->getPrimaryTemplate()) 10189 Template->getAssociatedConstraints(AC); 10190 else 10191 I->Function->getAssociatedConstraints(AC); 10192 if (AC.empty()) 10193 continue; 10194 if (FirstCand == nullptr) { 10195 FirstCand = I->Function; 10196 FirstAC = AC; 10197 } else if (SecondCand == nullptr) { 10198 SecondCand = I->Function; 10199 SecondAC = AC; 10200 } else { 10201 // We have more than one pair of constrained functions - this check is 10202 // expensive and we'd rather not try to diagnose it. 10203 return; 10204 } 10205 } 10206 if (!SecondCand) 10207 return; 10208 // The diagnostic can only happen if there are associated constraints on 10209 // both sides (there needs to be some identical atomic constraint). 10210 if (S.MaybeEmitAmbiguousAtomicConstraintsDiagnostic(FirstCand, FirstAC, 10211 SecondCand, SecondAC)) 10212 // Just show the user one diagnostic, they'll probably figure it out 10213 // from here. 10214 return; 10215 } 10216 10217 // Notes the location of all overload candidates designated through 10218 // OverloadedExpr 10219 void Sema::NoteAllOverloadCandidates(Expr *OverloadedExpr, QualType DestType, 10220 bool TakingAddress) { 10221 assert(OverloadedExpr->getType() == Context.OverloadTy); 10222 10223 OverloadExpr::FindResult Ovl = OverloadExpr::find(OverloadedExpr); 10224 OverloadExpr *OvlExpr = Ovl.Expression; 10225 10226 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(), 10227 IEnd = OvlExpr->decls_end(); 10228 I != IEnd; ++I) { 10229 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = 10230 dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()) ) { 10231 NoteOverloadCandidate(*I, FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl(), CRK_None, DestType, 10232 TakingAddress); 10233 } else if (FunctionDecl *Fun 10234 = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()) ) { 10235 NoteOverloadCandidate(*I, Fun, CRK_None, DestType, TakingAddress); 10236 } 10237 } 10238 } 10239 10240 /// Diagnoses an ambiguous conversion. The partial diagnostic is the 10241 /// "lead" diagnostic; it will be given two arguments, the source and 10242 /// target types of the conversion. 10243 void ImplicitConversionSequence::DiagnoseAmbiguousConversion( 10244 Sema &S, 10245 SourceLocation CaretLoc, 10246 const PartialDiagnostic &PDiag) const { 10247 S.Diag(CaretLoc, PDiag) 10248 << Ambiguous.getFromType() << Ambiguous.getToType(); 10249 // FIXME: The note limiting machinery is borrowed from 10250 // OverloadCandidateSet::NoteCandidates; there's an opportunity for 10251 // refactoring here. 10252 const OverloadsShown ShowOverloads = S.Diags.getShowOverloads(); 10253 unsigned CandsShown = 0; 10254 AmbiguousConversionSequence::const_iterator I, E; 10255 for (I = Ambiguous.begin(), E = Ambiguous.end(); I != E; ++I) { 10256 if (CandsShown >= 4 && ShowOverloads == Ovl_Best) 10257 break; 10258 ++CandsShown; 10259 S.NoteOverloadCandidate(I->first, I->second); 10260 } 10261 if (I != E) 10262 S.Diag(SourceLocation(), diag::note_ovl_too_many_candidates) << int(E - I); 10263 } 10264 10265 static void DiagnoseBadConversion(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand, 10266 unsigned I, bool TakingCandidateAddress) { 10267 const ImplicitConversionSequence &Conv = Cand->Conversions[I]; 10268 assert(Conv.isBad()); 10269 assert(Cand->Function && "for now, candidate must be a function"); 10270 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function; 10271 10272 // There's a conversion slot for the object argument if this is a 10273 // non-constructor method. Note that 'I' corresponds the 10274 // conversion-slot index. 10275 bool isObjectArgument = false; 10276 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn) && !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn)) { 10277 if (I == 0) 10278 isObjectArgument = true; 10279 else 10280 I--; 10281 } 10282 10283 std::string FnDesc; 10284 std::pair<OverloadCandidateKind, OverloadCandidateSelect> FnKindPair = 10285 ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Cand->FoundDecl, Fn, Cand->getRewriteKind(), 10286 FnDesc); 10287 10288 Expr *FromExpr = Conv.Bad.FromExpr; 10289 QualType FromTy = Conv.Bad.getFromType(); 10290 QualType ToTy = Conv.Bad.getToType(); 10291 10292 if (FromTy == S.Context.OverloadTy) { 10293 assert(FromExpr && "overload set argument came from implicit argument?"); 10294 Expr *E = FromExpr->IgnoreParens(); 10295 if (isa<UnaryOperator>(E)) 10296 E = cast<UnaryOperator>(E)->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParens(); 10297 DeclarationName Name = cast<OverloadExpr>(E)->getName(); 10298 10299 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_overload) 10300 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc 10301 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << ToTy 10302 << Name << I + 1; 10303 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 10304 return; 10305 } 10306 10307 // Do some hand-waving analysis to see if the non-viability is due 10308 // to a qualifier mismatch. 10309 CanQualType CFromTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromTy); 10310 CanQualType CToTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToTy); 10311 if (CanQual<ReferenceType> RT = CToTy->getAs<ReferenceType>()) 10312 CToTy = RT->getPointeeType(); 10313 else { 10314 // TODO: detect and diagnose the full richness of const mismatches. 10315 if (CanQual<PointerType> FromPT = CFromTy->getAs<PointerType>()) 10316 if (CanQual<PointerType> ToPT = CToTy->getAs<PointerType>()) { 10317 CFromTy = FromPT->getPointeeType(); 10318 CToTy = ToPT->getPointeeType(); 10319 } 10320 } 10321 10322 if (CToTy.getUnqualifiedType() == CFromTy.getUnqualifiedType() && 10323 !CToTy.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(CFromTy)) { 10324 Qualifiers FromQs = CFromTy.getQualifiers(); 10325 Qualifiers ToQs = CToTy.getQualifiers(); 10326 10327 if (FromQs.getAddressSpace() != ToQs.getAddressSpace()) { 10328 if (isObjectArgument) 10329 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_addrspace_this) 10330 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second 10331 << FnDesc << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) 10332 << FromQs.getAddressSpace() << ToQs.getAddressSpace(); 10333 else 10334 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_addrspace) 10335 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second 10336 << FnDesc << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) 10337 << FromQs.getAddressSpace() << ToQs.getAddressSpace() 10338 << ToTy->isReferenceType() << I + 1; 10339 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 10340 return; 10341 } 10342 10343 if (FromQs.getObjCLifetime() != ToQs.getObjCLifetime()) { 10344 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_ownership) 10345 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc 10346 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << FromTy 10347 << FromQs.getObjCLifetime() << ToQs.getObjCLifetime() 10348 << (unsigned)isObjectArgument << I + 1; 10349 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 10350 return; 10351 } 10352 10353 if (FromQs.getObjCGCAttr() != ToQs.getObjCGCAttr()) { 10354 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_gc) 10355 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc 10356 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << FromTy 10357 << FromQs.getObjCGCAttr() << ToQs.getObjCGCAttr() 10358 << (unsigned)isObjectArgument << I + 1; 10359 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 10360 return; 10361 } 10362 10363 if (FromQs.hasUnaligned() != ToQs.hasUnaligned()) { 10364 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_unaligned) 10365 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc 10366 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << FromTy 10367 << FromQs.hasUnaligned() << I + 1; 10368 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 10369 return; 10370 } 10371 10372 unsigned CVR = FromQs.getCVRQualifiers() & ~ToQs.getCVRQualifiers(); 10373 assert(CVR && "unexpected qualifiers mismatch"); 10374 10375 if (isObjectArgument) { 10376 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_cvr_this) 10377 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc 10378 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << FromTy 10379 << (CVR - 1); 10380 } else { 10381 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_cvr) 10382 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc 10383 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << FromTy 10384 << (CVR - 1) << I + 1; 10385 } 10386 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 10387 return; 10388 } 10389 10390 // Special diagnostic for failure to convert an initializer list, since 10391 // telling the user that it has type void is not useful. 10392 if (FromExpr && isa<InitListExpr>(FromExpr)) { 10393 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_list_argument) 10394 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc 10395 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << FromTy 10396 << ToTy << (unsigned)isObjectArgument << I + 1; 10397 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 10398 return; 10399 } 10400 10401 // Diagnose references or pointers to incomplete types differently, 10402 // since it's far from impossible that the incompleteness triggered 10403 // the failure. 10404 QualType TempFromTy = FromTy.getNonReferenceType(); 10405 if (const PointerType *PTy = TempFromTy->getAs<PointerType>()) 10406 TempFromTy = PTy->getPointeeType(); 10407 if (TempFromTy->isIncompleteType()) { 10408 // Emit the generic diagnostic and, optionally, add the hints to it. 10409 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_conv_incomplete) 10410 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc 10411 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << FromTy 10412 << ToTy << (unsigned)isObjectArgument << I + 1 10413 << (unsigned)(Cand->Fix.Kind); 10414 10415 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 10416 return; 10417 } 10418 10419 // Diagnose base -> derived pointer conversions. 10420 unsigned BaseToDerivedConversion = 0; 10421 if (const PointerType *FromPtrTy = FromTy->getAs<PointerType>()) { 10422 if (const PointerType *ToPtrTy = ToTy->getAs<PointerType>()) { 10423 if (ToPtrTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs( 10424 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()) && 10425 !FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() && 10426 !ToPtrTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() && 10427 S.IsDerivedFrom(SourceLocation(), ToPtrTy->getPointeeType(), 10428 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType())) 10429 BaseToDerivedConversion = 1; 10430 } 10431 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtrTy 10432 = FromTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) { 10433 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtrTy 10434 = ToTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) 10435 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *FromIface = FromPtrTy->getInterfaceDecl()) 10436 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ToIface = ToPtrTy->getInterfaceDecl()) 10437 if (ToPtrTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs( 10438 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()) && 10439 FromIface->isSuperClassOf(ToIface)) 10440 BaseToDerivedConversion = 2; 10441 } else if (const ReferenceType *ToRefTy = ToTy->getAs<ReferenceType>()) { 10442 if (ToRefTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(FromTy) && 10443 !FromTy->isIncompleteType() && 10444 !ToRefTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() && 10445 S.IsDerivedFrom(SourceLocation(), ToRefTy->getPointeeType(), FromTy)) { 10446 BaseToDerivedConversion = 3; 10447 } else if (ToTy->isLValueReferenceType() && !FromExpr->isLValue() && 10448 ToTy.getNonReferenceType().getCanonicalType() == 10449 FromTy.getNonReferenceType().getCanonicalType()) { 10450 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_lvalue) 10451 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc 10452 << (unsigned)isObjectArgument << I + 1 10453 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()); 10454 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 10455 return; 10456 } 10457 } 10458 10459 if (BaseToDerivedConversion) { 10460 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_base_to_derived_conv) 10461 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc 10462 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) 10463 << (BaseToDerivedConversion - 1) << FromTy << ToTy << I + 1; 10464 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 10465 return; 10466 } 10467 10468 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(CFromTy) && 10469 isa<PointerType>(CToTy)) { 10470 Qualifiers FromQs = CFromTy.getQualifiers(); 10471 Qualifiers ToQs = CToTy.getQualifiers(); 10472 if (FromQs.getObjCLifetime() != ToQs.getObjCLifetime()) { 10473 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_arc_conv) 10474 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second 10475 << FnDesc << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) 10476 << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned)isObjectArgument << I + 1; 10477 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 10478 return; 10479 } 10480 } 10481 10482 if (TakingCandidateAddress && 10483 !checkAddressOfCandidateIsAvailable(S, Cand->Function)) 10484 return; 10485 10486 // Emit the generic diagnostic and, optionally, add the hints to it. 10487 PartialDiagnostic FDiag = S.PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_conv); 10488 FDiag << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc 10489 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << FromTy 10490 << ToTy << (unsigned)isObjectArgument << I + 1 10491 << (unsigned)(Cand->Fix.Kind); 10492 10493 // If we can fix the conversion, suggest the FixIts. 10494 for (std::vector<FixItHint>::iterator HI = Cand->Fix.Hints.begin(), 10495 HE = Cand->Fix.Hints.end(); HI != HE; ++HI) 10496 FDiag << *HI; 10497 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), FDiag); 10498 10499 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 10500 } 10501 10502 /// Additional arity mismatch diagnosis specific to a function overload 10503 /// candidates. This is not covered by the more general DiagnoseArityMismatch() 10504 /// over a candidate in any candidate set. 10505 static bool CheckArityMismatch(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand, 10506 unsigned NumArgs) { 10507 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function; 10508 unsigned MinParams = Fn->getMinRequiredArguments(); 10509 10510 // With invalid overloaded operators, it's possible that we think we 10511 // have an arity mismatch when in fact it looks like we have the 10512 // right number of arguments, because only overloaded operators have 10513 // the weird behavior of overloading member and non-member functions. 10514 // Just don't report anything. 10515 if (Fn->isInvalidDecl() && 10516 Fn->getDeclName().getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName) 10517 return true; 10518 10519 if (NumArgs < MinParams) { 10520 assert((Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments) || 10521 (Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction && 10522 Cand->DeductionFailure.Result == Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments)); 10523 } else { 10524 assert((Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments) || 10525 (Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction && 10526 Cand->DeductionFailure.Result == Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments)); 10527 } 10528 10529 return false; 10530 } 10531 10532 /// General arity mismatch diagnosis over a candidate in a candidate set. 10533 static void DiagnoseArityMismatch(Sema &S, NamedDecl *Found, Decl *D, 10534 unsigned NumFormalArgs) { 10535 assert(isa<FunctionDecl>(D) && 10536 "The templated declaration should at least be a function" 10537 " when diagnosing bad template argument deduction due to too many" 10538 " or too few arguments"); 10539 10540 FunctionDecl *Fn = cast<FunctionDecl>(D); 10541 10542 // TODO: treat calls to a missing default constructor as a special case 10543 const auto *FnTy = Fn->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 10544 unsigned MinParams = Fn->getMinRequiredArguments(); 10545 10546 // at least / at most / exactly 10547 unsigned mode, modeCount; 10548 if (NumFormalArgs < MinParams) { 10549 if (MinParams != FnTy->getNumParams() || FnTy->isVariadic() || 10550 FnTy->isTemplateVariadic()) 10551 mode = 0; // "at least" 10552 else 10553 mode = 2; // "exactly" 10554 modeCount = MinParams; 10555 } else { 10556 if (MinParams != FnTy->getNumParams()) 10557 mode = 1; // "at most" 10558 else 10559 mode = 2; // "exactly" 10560 modeCount = FnTy->getNumParams(); 10561 } 10562 10563 std::string Description; 10564 std::pair<OverloadCandidateKind, OverloadCandidateSelect> FnKindPair = 10565 ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Found, Fn, CRK_None, Description); 10566 10567 if (modeCount == 1 && Fn->getParamDecl(0)->getDeclName()) 10568 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_arity_one) 10569 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second 10570 << Description << mode << Fn->getParamDecl(0) << NumFormalArgs; 10571 else 10572 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_arity) 10573 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second 10574 << Description << mode << modeCount << NumFormalArgs; 10575 10576 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found); 10577 } 10578 10579 /// Arity mismatch diagnosis specific to a function overload candidate. 10580 static void DiagnoseArityMismatch(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand, 10581 unsigned NumFormalArgs) { 10582 if (!CheckArityMismatch(S, Cand, NumFormalArgs)) 10583 DiagnoseArityMismatch(S, Cand->FoundDecl, Cand->Function, NumFormalArgs); 10584 } 10585 10586 static TemplateDecl *getDescribedTemplate(Decl *Templated) { 10587 if (TemplateDecl *TD = Templated->getDescribedTemplate()) 10588 return TD; 10589 llvm_unreachable("Unsupported: Getting the described template declaration" 10590 " for bad deduction diagnosis"); 10591 } 10592 10593 /// Diagnose a failed template-argument deduction. 10594 static void DiagnoseBadDeduction(Sema &S, NamedDecl *Found, Decl *Templated, 10595 DeductionFailureInfo &DeductionFailure, 10596 unsigned NumArgs, 10597 bool TakingCandidateAddress) { 10598 TemplateParameter Param = DeductionFailure.getTemplateParameter(); 10599 NamedDecl *ParamD; 10600 (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl*>()) || 10601 (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl*>()) || 10602 (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl*>()); 10603 switch (DeductionFailure.Result) { 10604 case Sema::TDK_Success: 10605 llvm_unreachable("TDK_success while diagnosing bad deduction"); 10606 10607 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: { 10608 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for incomplete deduction result"); 10609 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), 10610 diag::note_ovl_candidate_incomplete_deduction) 10611 << ParamD->getDeclName(); 10612 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found); 10613 return; 10614 } 10615 10616 case Sema::TDK_IncompletePack: { 10617 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for incomplete deduction result"); 10618 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), 10619 diag::note_ovl_candidate_incomplete_deduction_pack) 10620 << ParamD->getDeclName() 10621 << (DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()->pack_size() + 1) 10622 << *DeductionFailure.getFirstArg(); 10623 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found); 10624 return; 10625 } 10626 10627 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: { 10628 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for bad qualifiers deduction result"); 10629 TemplateTypeParmDecl *TParam = cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD); 10630 10631 QualType Param = DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()->getAsType(); 10632 10633 // Param will have been canonicalized, but it should just be a 10634 // qualified version of ParamD, so move the qualifiers to that. 10635 QualifierCollector Qs; 10636 Qs.strip(Param); 10637 QualType NonCanonParam = Qs.apply(S.Context, TParam->getTypeForDecl()); 10638 assert(S.Context.hasSameType(Param, NonCanonParam)); 10639 10640 // Arg has also been canonicalized, but there's nothing we can do 10641 // about that. It also doesn't matter as much, because it won't 10642 // have any template parameters in it (because deduction isn't 10643 // done on dependent types). 10644 QualType Arg = DeductionFailure.getSecondArg()->getAsType(); 10645 10646 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_underqualified) 10647 << ParamD->getDeclName() << Arg << NonCanonParam; 10648 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found); 10649 return; 10650 } 10651 10652 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: { 10653 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for inconsistent deduction result"); 10654 int which = 0; 10655 if (isa<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD)) 10656 which = 0; 10657 else if (isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD)) { 10658 // Deduction might have failed because we deduced arguments of two 10659 // different types for a non-type template parameter. 10660 // FIXME: Use a different TDK value for this. 10661 QualType T1 = 10662 DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()->getNonTypeTemplateArgumentType(); 10663 QualType T2 = 10664 DeductionFailure.getSecondArg()->getNonTypeTemplateArgumentType(); 10665 if (!T1.isNull() && !T2.isNull() && !S.Context.hasSameType(T1, T2)) { 10666 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), 10667 diag::note_ovl_candidate_inconsistent_deduction_types) 10668 << ParamD->getDeclName() << *DeductionFailure.getFirstArg() << T1 10669 << *DeductionFailure.getSecondArg() << T2; 10670 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found); 10671 return; 10672 } 10673 10674 which = 1; 10675 } else { 10676 which = 2; 10677 } 10678 10679 // Tweak the diagnostic if the problem is that we deduced packs of 10680 // different arities. We'll print the actual packs anyway in case that 10681 // includes additional useful information. 10682 if (DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()->getKind() == TemplateArgument::Pack && 10683 DeductionFailure.getSecondArg()->getKind() == TemplateArgument::Pack && 10684 DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()->pack_size() != 10685 DeductionFailure.getSecondArg()->pack_size()) { 10686 which = 3; 10687 } 10688 10689 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), 10690 diag::note_ovl_candidate_inconsistent_deduction) 10691 << which << ParamD->getDeclName() << *DeductionFailure.getFirstArg() 10692 << *DeductionFailure.getSecondArg(); 10693 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found); 10694 return; 10695 } 10696 10697 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments: 10698 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for invalid explicit arguments"); 10699 if (ParamD->getDeclName()) 10700 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), 10701 diag::note_ovl_candidate_explicit_arg_mismatch_named) 10702 << ParamD->getDeclName(); 10703 else { 10704 int index = 0; 10705 if (TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD)) 10706 index = TTP->getIndex(); 10707 else if (NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *NTTP 10708 = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD)) 10709 index = NTTP->getIndex(); 10710 else 10711 index = cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD)->getIndex(); 10712 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), 10713 diag::note_ovl_candidate_explicit_arg_mismatch_unnamed) 10714 << (index + 1); 10715 } 10716 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found); 10717 return; 10718 10719 case Sema::TDK_ConstraintsNotSatisfied: { 10720 // Format the template argument list into the argument string. 10721 SmallString<128> TemplateArgString; 10722 TemplateArgumentList *Args = DeductionFailure.getTemplateArgumentList(); 10723 TemplateArgString = " "; 10724 TemplateArgString += S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText( 10725 getDescribedTemplate(Templated)->getTemplateParameters(), *Args); 10726 if (TemplateArgString.size() == 1) 10727 TemplateArgString.clear(); 10728 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), 10729 diag::note_ovl_candidate_unsatisfied_constraints) 10730 << TemplateArgString; 10731 10732 S.DiagnoseUnsatisfiedConstraint( 10733 static_cast<CNSInfo*>(DeductionFailure.Data)->Satisfaction); 10734 return; 10735 } 10736 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments: 10737 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments: 10738 DiagnoseArityMismatch(S, Found, Templated, NumArgs); 10739 return; 10740 10741 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth: 10742 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), 10743 diag::note_ovl_candidate_instantiation_depth); 10744 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found); 10745 return; 10746 10747 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: { 10748 // Format the template argument list into the argument string. 10749 SmallString<128> TemplateArgString; 10750 if (TemplateArgumentList *Args = 10751 DeductionFailure.getTemplateArgumentList()) { 10752 TemplateArgString = " "; 10753 TemplateArgString += S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText( 10754 getDescribedTemplate(Templated)->getTemplateParameters(), *Args); 10755 if (TemplateArgString.size() == 1) 10756 TemplateArgString.clear(); 10757 } 10758 10759 // If this candidate was disabled by enable_if, say so. 10760 PartialDiagnosticAt *PDiag = DeductionFailure.getSFINAEDiagnostic(); 10761 if (PDiag && PDiag->second.getDiagID() == 10762 diag::err_typename_nested_not_found_enable_if) { 10763 // FIXME: Use the source range of the condition, and the fully-qualified 10764 // name of the enable_if template. These are both present in PDiag. 10765 S.Diag(PDiag->first, diag::note_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_enable_if) 10766 << "'enable_if'" << TemplateArgString; 10767 return; 10768 } 10769 10770 // We found a specific requirement that disabled the enable_if. 10771 if (PDiag && PDiag->second.getDiagID() == 10772 diag::err_typename_nested_not_found_requirement) { 10773 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), 10774 diag::note_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_requirement) 10775 << PDiag->second.getStringArg(0) << TemplateArgString; 10776 return; 10777 } 10778 10779 // Format the SFINAE diagnostic into the argument string. 10780 // FIXME: Add a general mechanism to include a PartialDiagnostic *'s 10781 // formatted message in another diagnostic. 10782 SmallString<128> SFINAEArgString; 10783 SourceRange R; 10784 if (PDiag) { 10785 SFINAEArgString = ": "; 10786 R = SourceRange(PDiag->first, PDiag->first); 10787 PDiag->second.EmitToString(S.getDiagnostics(), SFINAEArgString); 10788 } 10789 10790 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), 10791 diag::note_ovl_candidate_substitution_failure) 10792 << TemplateArgString << SFINAEArgString << R; 10793 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found); 10794 return; 10795 } 10796 10797 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch: 10798 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested: { 10799 // Format the template argument list into the argument string. 10800 SmallString<128> TemplateArgString; 10801 if (TemplateArgumentList *Args = 10802 DeductionFailure.getTemplateArgumentList()) { 10803 TemplateArgString = " "; 10804 TemplateArgString += S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText( 10805 getDescribedTemplate(Templated)->getTemplateParameters(), *Args); 10806 if (TemplateArgString.size() == 1) 10807 TemplateArgString.clear(); 10808 } 10809 10810 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_deduced_mismatch) 10811 << (*DeductionFailure.getCallArgIndex() + 1) 10812 << *DeductionFailure.getFirstArg() << *DeductionFailure.getSecondArg() 10813 << TemplateArgString 10814 << (DeductionFailure.Result == Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested); 10815 break; 10816 } 10817 10818 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: { 10819 // FIXME: Provide a source location to indicate what we couldn't match. 10820 TemplateArgument FirstTA = *DeductionFailure.getFirstArg(); 10821 TemplateArgument SecondTA = *DeductionFailure.getSecondArg(); 10822 if (FirstTA.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Template && 10823 SecondTA.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Template) { 10824 TemplateName FirstTN = FirstTA.getAsTemplate(); 10825 TemplateName SecondTN = SecondTA.getAsTemplate(); 10826 if (FirstTN.getKind() == TemplateName::Template && 10827 SecondTN.getKind() == TemplateName::Template) { 10828 if (FirstTN.getAsTemplateDecl()->getName() == 10829 SecondTN.getAsTemplateDecl()->getName()) { 10830 // FIXME: This fixes a bad diagnostic where both templates are named 10831 // the same. This particular case is a bit difficult since: 10832 // 1) It is passed as a string to the diagnostic printer. 10833 // 2) The diagnostic printer only attempts to find a better 10834 // name for types, not decls. 10835 // Ideally, this should folded into the diagnostic printer. 10836 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), 10837 diag::note_ovl_candidate_non_deduced_mismatch_qualified) 10838 << FirstTN.getAsTemplateDecl() << SecondTN.getAsTemplateDecl(); 10839 return; 10840 } 10841 } 10842 } 10843 10844 if (TakingCandidateAddress && isa<FunctionDecl>(Templated) && 10845 !checkAddressOfCandidateIsAvailable(S, cast<FunctionDecl>(Templated))) 10846 return; 10847 10848 // FIXME: For generic lambda parameters, check if the function is a lambda 10849 // call operator, and if so, emit a prettier and more informative 10850 // diagnostic that mentions 'auto' and lambda in addition to 10851 // (or instead of?) the canonical template type parameters. 10852 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), 10853 diag::note_ovl_candidate_non_deduced_mismatch) 10854 << FirstTA << SecondTA; 10855 return; 10856 } 10857 // TODO: diagnose these individually, then kill off 10858 // note_ovl_candidate_bad_deduction, which is uselessly vague. 10859 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure: 10860 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_deduction); 10861 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found); 10862 return; 10863 case Sema::TDK_CUDATargetMismatch: 10864 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), 10865 diag::note_cuda_ovl_candidate_target_mismatch); 10866 return; 10867 } 10868 } 10869 10870 /// Diagnose a failed template-argument deduction, for function calls. 10871 static void DiagnoseBadDeduction(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand, 10872 unsigned NumArgs, 10873 bool TakingCandidateAddress) { 10874 unsigned TDK = Cand->DeductionFailure.Result; 10875 if (TDK == Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments || TDK == Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments) { 10876 if (CheckArityMismatch(S, Cand, NumArgs)) 10877 return; 10878 } 10879 DiagnoseBadDeduction(S, Cand->FoundDecl, Cand->Function, // pattern 10880 Cand->DeductionFailure, NumArgs, TakingCandidateAddress); 10881 } 10882 10883 /// CUDA: diagnose an invalid call across targets. 10884 static void DiagnoseBadTarget(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) { 10885 FunctionDecl *Caller = cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext); 10886 FunctionDecl *Callee = Cand->Function; 10887 10888 Sema::CUDAFunctionTarget CallerTarget = S.IdentifyCUDATarget(Caller), 10889 CalleeTarget = S.IdentifyCUDATarget(Callee); 10890 10891 std::string FnDesc; 10892 std::pair<OverloadCandidateKind, OverloadCandidateSelect> FnKindPair = 10893 ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Cand->FoundDecl, Callee, 10894 Cand->getRewriteKind(), FnDesc); 10895 10896 S.Diag(Callee->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_target) 10897 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)ocs_non_template 10898 << FnDesc /* Ignored */ 10899 << CalleeTarget << CallerTarget; 10900 10901 // This could be an implicit constructor for which we could not infer the 10902 // target due to a collsion. Diagnose that case. 10903 CXXMethodDecl *Meth = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Callee); 10904 if (Meth != nullptr && Meth->isImplicit()) { 10905 CXXRecordDecl *ParentClass = Meth->getParent(); 10906 Sema::CXXSpecialMember CSM; 10907 10908 switch (FnKindPair.first) { 10909 default: 10910 return; 10911 case oc_implicit_default_constructor: 10912 CSM = Sema::CXXDefaultConstructor; 10913 break; 10914 case oc_implicit_copy_constructor: 10915 CSM = Sema::CXXCopyConstructor; 10916 break; 10917 case oc_implicit_move_constructor: 10918 CSM = Sema::CXXMoveConstructor; 10919 break; 10920 case oc_implicit_copy_assignment: 10921 CSM = Sema::CXXCopyAssignment; 10922 break; 10923 case oc_implicit_move_assignment: 10924 CSM = Sema::CXXMoveAssignment; 10925 break; 10926 }; 10927 10928 bool ConstRHS = false; 10929 if (Meth->getNumParams()) { 10930 if (const ReferenceType *RT = 10931 Meth->getParamDecl(0)->getType()->getAs<ReferenceType>()) { 10932 ConstRHS = RT->getPointeeType().isConstQualified(); 10933 } 10934 } 10935 10936 S.inferCUDATargetForImplicitSpecialMember(ParentClass, CSM, Meth, 10937 /* ConstRHS */ ConstRHS, 10938 /* Diagnose */ true); 10939 } 10940 } 10941 10942 static void DiagnoseFailedEnableIfAttr(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) { 10943 FunctionDecl *Callee = Cand->Function; 10944 EnableIfAttr *Attr = static_cast<EnableIfAttr*>(Cand->DeductionFailure.Data); 10945 10946 S.Diag(Callee->getLocation(), 10947 diag::note_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_function_cond_attr) 10948 << Attr->getCond()->getSourceRange() << Attr->getMessage(); 10949 } 10950 10951 static void DiagnoseFailedExplicitSpec(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) { 10952 ExplicitSpecifier ES = ExplicitSpecifier::getFromDecl(Cand->Function); 10953 assert(ES.isExplicit() && "not an explicit candidate"); 10954 10955 unsigned Kind; 10956 switch (Cand->Function->getDeclKind()) { 10957 case Decl::Kind::CXXConstructor: 10958 Kind = 0; 10959 break; 10960 case Decl::Kind::CXXConversion: 10961 Kind = 1; 10962 break; 10963 case Decl::Kind::CXXDeductionGuide: 10964 Kind = Cand->Function->isImplicit() ? 0 : 2; 10965 break; 10966 default: 10967 llvm_unreachable("invalid Decl"); 10968 } 10969 10970 // Note the location of the first (in-class) declaration; a redeclaration 10971 // (particularly an out-of-class definition) will typically lack the 10972 // 'explicit' specifier. 10973 // FIXME: This is probably a good thing to do for all 'candidate' notes. 10974 FunctionDecl *First = Cand->Function->getFirstDecl(); 10975 if (FunctionDecl *Pattern = First->getTemplateInstantiationPattern()) 10976 First = Pattern->getFirstDecl(); 10977 10978 S.Diag(First->getLocation(), 10979 diag::note_ovl_candidate_explicit) 10980 << Kind << (ES.getExpr() ? 1 : 0) 10981 << (ES.getExpr() ? ES.getExpr()->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()); 10982 } 10983 10984 static void DiagnoseOpenCLExtensionDisabled(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) { 10985 FunctionDecl *Callee = Cand->Function; 10986 10987 S.Diag(Callee->getLocation(), 10988 diag::note_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_extension) 10989 << S.getOpenCLExtensionsFromDeclExtMap(Callee); 10990 } 10991 10992 /// Generates a 'note' diagnostic for an overload candidate. We've 10993 /// already generated a primary error at the call site. 10994 /// 10995 /// It really does need to be a single diagnostic with its caret 10996 /// pointed at the candidate declaration. Yes, this creates some 10997 /// major challenges of technical writing. Yes, this makes pointing 10998 /// out problems with specific arguments quite awkward. It's still 10999 /// better than generating twenty screens of text for every failed 11000 /// overload. 11001 /// 11002 /// It would be great to be able to express per-candidate problems 11003 /// more richly for those diagnostic clients that cared, but we'd 11004 /// still have to be just as careful with the default diagnostics. 11005 /// \param CtorDestAS Addr space of object being constructed (for ctor 11006 /// candidates only). 11007 static void NoteFunctionCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand, 11008 unsigned NumArgs, 11009 bool TakingCandidateAddress, 11010 LangAS CtorDestAS = LangAS::Default) { 11011 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function; 11012 11013 // Note deleted candidates, but only if they're viable. 11014 if (Cand->Viable) { 11015 if (Fn->isDeleted()) { 11016 std::string FnDesc; 11017 std::pair<OverloadCandidateKind, OverloadCandidateSelect> FnKindPair = 11018 ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Cand->FoundDecl, Fn, 11019 Cand->getRewriteKind(), FnDesc); 11020 11021 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_deleted) 11022 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc 11023 << (Fn->isDeleted() ? (Fn->isDeletedAsWritten() ? 1 : 2) : 0); 11024 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 11025 return; 11026 } 11027 11028 // We don't really have anything else to say about viable candidates. 11029 S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Cand->FoundDecl, Fn, Cand->getRewriteKind()); 11030 return; 11031 } 11032 11033 switch (Cand->FailureKind) { 11034 case ovl_fail_too_many_arguments: 11035 case ovl_fail_too_few_arguments: 11036 return DiagnoseArityMismatch(S, Cand, NumArgs); 11037 11038 case ovl_fail_bad_deduction: 11039 return DiagnoseBadDeduction(S, Cand, NumArgs, 11040 TakingCandidateAddress); 11041 11042 case ovl_fail_illegal_constructor: { 11043 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_illegal_constructor) 11044 << (Fn->getPrimaryTemplate() ? 1 : 0); 11045 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 11046 return; 11047 } 11048 11049 case ovl_fail_object_addrspace_mismatch: { 11050 Qualifiers QualsForPrinting; 11051 QualsForPrinting.setAddressSpace(CtorDestAS); 11052 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), 11053 diag::note_ovl_candidate_illegal_constructor_adrspace_mismatch) 11054 << QualsForPrinting; 11055 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 11056 return; 11057 } 11058 11059 case ovl_fail_trivial_conversion: 11060 case ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion: 11061 case ovl_fail_final_conversion_not_exact: 11062 return S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Cand->FoundDecl, Fn, Cand->getRewriteKind()); 11063 11064 case ovl_fail_bad_conversion: { 11065 unsigned I = (Cand->IgnoreObjectArgument ? 1 : 0); 11066 for (unsigned N = Cand->Conversions.size(); I != N; ++I) 11067 if (Cand->Conversions[I].isBad()) 11068 return DiagnoseBadConversion(S, Cand, I, TakingCandidateAddress); 11069 11070 // FIXME: this currently happens when we're called from SemaInit 11071 // when user-conversion overload fails. Figure out how to handle 11072 // those conditions and diagnose them well. 11073 return S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Cand->FoundDecl, Fn, Cand->getRewriteKind()); 11074 } 11075 11076 case ovl_fail_bad_target: 11077 return DiagnoseBadTarget(S, Cand); 11078 11079 case ovl_fail_enable_if: 11080 return DiagnoseFailedEnableIfAttr(S, Cand); 11081 11082 case ovl_fail_explicit: 11083 return DiagnoseFailedExplicitSpec(S, Cand); 11084 11085 case ovl_fail_ext_disabled: 11086 return DiagnoseOpenCLExtensionDisabled(S, Cand); 11087 11088 case ovl_fail_inhctor_slice: 11089 // It's generally not interesting to note copy/move constructors here. 11090 if (cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn)->isCopyOrMoveConstructor()) 11091 return; 11092 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), 11093 diag::note_ovl_candidate_inherited_constructor_slice) 11094 << (Fn->getPrimaryTemplate() ? 1 : 0) 11095 << Fn->getParamDecl(0)->getType()->isRValueReferenceType(); 11096 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 11097 return; 11098 11099 case ovl_fail_addr_not_available: { 11100 bool Available = checkAddressOfCandidateIsAvailable(S, Cand->Function); 11101 (void)Available; 11102 assert(!Available); 11103 break; 11104 } 11105 case ovl_non_default_multiversion_function: 11106 // Do nothing, these should simply be ignored. 11107 break; 11108 11109 case ovl_fail_constraints_not_satisfied: { 11110 std::string FnDesc; 11111 std::pair<OverloadCandidateKind, OverloadCandidateSelect> FnKindPair = 11112 ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Cand->FoundDecl, Fn, 11113 Cand->getRewriteKind(), FnDesc); 11114 11115 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), 11116 diag::note_ovl_candidate_constraints_not_satisfied) 11117 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)ocs_non_template 11118 << FnDesc /* Ignored */; 11119 ConstraintSatisfaction Satisfaction; 11120 if (S.CheckFunctionConstraints(Fn, Satisfaction)) 11121 break; 11122 S.DiagnoseUnsatisfiedConstraint(Satisfaction); 11123 } 11124 } 11125 } 11126 11127 static void NoteSurrogateCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) { 11128 // Desugar the type of the surrogate down to a function type, 11129 // retaining as many typedefs as possible while still showing 11130 // the function type (and, therefore, its parameter types). 11131 QualType FnType = Cand->Surrogate->getConversionType(); 11132 bool isLValueReference = false; 11133 bool isRValueReference = false; 11134 bool isPointer = false; 11135 if (const LValueReferenceType *FnTypeRef = 11136 FnType->getAs<LValueReferenceType>()) { 11137 FnType = FnTypeRef->getPointeeType(); 11138 isLValueReference = true; 11139 } else if (const RValueReferenceType *FnTypeRef = 11140 FnType->getAs<RValueReferenceType>()) { 11141 FnType = FnTypeRef->getPointeeType(); 11142 isRValueReference = true; 11143 } 11144 if (const PointerType *FnTypePtr = FnType->getAs<PointerType>()) { 11145 FnType = FnTypePtr->getPointeeType(); 11146 isPointer = true; 11147 } 11148 // Desugar down to a function type. 11149 FnType = QualType(FnType->getAs<FunctionType>(), 0); 11150 // Reconstruct the pointer/reference as appropriate. 11151 if (isPointer) FnType = S.Context.getPointerType(FnType); 11152 if (isRValueReference) FnType = S.Context.getRValueReferenceType(FnType); 11153 if (isLValueReference) FnType = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(FnType); 11154 11155 S.Diag(Cand->Surrogate->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_surrogate_cand) 11156 << FnType; 11157 } 11158 11159 static void NoteBuiltinOperatorCandidate(Sema &S, StringRef Opc, 11160 SourceLocation OpLoc, 11161 OverloadCandidate *Cand) { 11162 assert(Cand->Conversions.size() <= 2 && "builtin operator is not binary"); 11163 std::string TypeStr("operator"); 11164 TypeStr += Opc; 11165 TypeStr += "("; 11166 TypeStr += Cand->BuiltinParamTypes[0].getAsString(); 11167 if (Cand->Conversions.size() == 1) { 11168 TypeStr += ")"; 11169 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_builtin_candidate) << TypeStr; 11170 } else { 11171 TypeStr += ", "; 11172 TypeStr += Cand->BuiltinParamTypes[1].getAsString(); 11173 TypeStr += ")"; 11174 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_builtin_candidate) << TypeStr; 11175 } 11176 } 11177 11178 static void NoteAmbiguousUserConversions(Sema &S, SourceLocation OpLoc, 11179 OverloadCandidate *Cand) { 11180 for (const ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS : Cand->Conversions) { 11181 if (ICS.isBad()) break; // all meaningless after first invalid 11182 if (!ICS.isAmbiguous()) continue; 11183 11184 ICS.DiagnoseAmbiguousConversion( 11185 S, OpLoc, S.PDiag(diag::note_ambiguous_type_conversion)); 11186 } 11187 } 11188 11189 static SourceLocation GetLocationForCandidate(const OverloadCandidate *Cand) { 11190 if (Cand->Function) 11191 return Cand->Function->getLocation(); 11192 if (Cand->IsSurrogate) 11193 return Cand->Surrogate->getLocation(); 11194 return SourceLocation(); 11195 } 11196 11197 static unsigned RankDeductionFailure(const DeductionFailureInfo &DFI) { 11198 switch ((Sema::TemplateDeductionResult)DFI.Result) { 11199 case Sema::TDK_Success: 11200 case Sema::TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure: 11201 llvm_unreachable("non-deduction failure while diagnosing bad deduction"); 11202 11203 case Sema::TDK_Invalid: 11204 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: 11205 case Sema::TDK_IncompletePack: 11206 return 1; 11207 11208 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: 11209 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: 11210 return 2; 11211 11212 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: 11213 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch: 11214 case Sema::TDK_ConstraintsNotSatisfied: 11215 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested: 11216 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: 11217 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure: 11218 case Sema::TDK_CUDATargetMismatch: 11219 return 3; 11220 11221 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth: 11222 return 4; 11223 11224 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments: 11225 return 5; 11226 11227 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments: 11228 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments: 11229 return 6; 11230 } 11231 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled deduction result"); 11232 } 11233 11234 namespace { 11235 struct CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay { 11236 Sema &S; 11237 SourceLocation Loc; 11238 size_t NumArgs; 11239 OverloadCandidateSet::CandidateSetKind CSK; 11240 11241 CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay( 11242 Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, size_t NArgs, 11243 OverloadCandidateSet::CandidateSetKind CSK) 11244 : S(S), NumArgs(NArgs), CSK(CSK) {} 11245 11246 OverloadFailureKind EffectiveFailureKind(const OverloadCandidate *C) const { 11247 // If there are too many or too few arguments, that's the high-order bit we 11248 // want to sort by, even if the immediate failure kind was something else. 11249 if (C->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments || 11250 C->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments) 11251 return static_cast<OverloadFailureKind>(C->FailureKind); 11252 11253 if (C->Function) { 11254 if (NumArgs > C->Function->getNumParams() && !C->Function->isVariadic()) 11255 return ovl_fail_too_many_arguments; 11256 if (NumArgs < C->Function->getMinRequiredArguments()) 11257 return ovl_fail_too_few_arguments; 11258 } 11259 11260 return static_cast<OverloadFailureKind>(C->FailureKind); 11261 } 11262 11263 bool operator()(const OverloadCandidate *L, 11264 const OverloadCandidate *R) { 11265 // Fast-path this check. 11266 if (L == R) return false; 11267 11268 // Order first by viability. 11269 if (L->Viable) { 11270 if (!R->Viable) return true; 11271 11272 // TODO: introduce a tri-valued comparison for overload 11273 // candidates. Would be more worthwhile if we had a sort 11274 // that could exploit it. 11275 if (isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *L, *R, SourceLocation(), CSK)) 11276 return true; 11277 if (isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *R, *L, SourceLocation(), CSK)) 11278 return false; 11279 } else if (R->Viable) 11280 return false; 11281 11282 assert(L->Viable == R->Viable); 11283 11284 // Criteria by which we can sort non-viable candidates: 11285 if (!L->Viable) { 11286 OverloadFailureKind LFailureKind = EffectiveFailureKind(L); 11287 OverloadFailureKind RFailureKind = EffectiveFailureKind(R); 11288 11289 // 1. Arity mismatches come after other candidates. 11290 if (LFailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments || 11291 LFailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments) { 11292 if (RFailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments || 11293 RFailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments) { 11294 int LDist = std::abs((int)L->getNumParams() - (int)NumArgs); 11295 int RDist = std::abs((int)R->getNumParams() - (int)NumArgs); 11296 if (LDist == RDist) { 11297 if (LFailureKind == RFailureKind) 11298 // Sort non-surrogates before surrogates. 11299 return !L->IsSurrogate && R->IsSurrogate; 11300 // Sort candidates requiring fewer parameters than there were 11301 // arguments given after candidates requiring more parameters 11302 // than there were arguments given. 11303 return LFailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments; 11304 } 11305 return LDist < RDist; 11306 } 11307 return false; 11308 } 11309 if (RFailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments || 11310 RFailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments) 11311 return true; 11312 11313 // 2. Bad conversions come first and are ordered by the number 11314 // of bad conversions and quality of good conversions. 11315 if (LFailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_conversion) { 11316 if (RFailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_conversion) 11317 return true; 11318 11319 // The conversion that can be fixed with a smaller number of changes, 11320 // comes first. 11321 unsigned numLFixes = L->Fix.NumConversionsFixed; 11322 unsigned numRFixes = R->Fix.NumConversionsFixed; 11323 numLFixes = (numLFixes == 0) ? UINT_MAX : numLFixes; 11324 numRFixes = (numRFixes == 0) ? UINT_MAX : numRFixes; 11325 if (numLFixes != numRFixes) { 11326 return numLFixes < numRFixes; 11327 } 11328 11329 // If there's any ordering between the defined conversions... 11330 // FIXME: this might not be transitive. 11331 assert(L->Conversions.size() == R->Conversions.size()); 11332 11333 int leftBetter = 0; 11334 unsigned I = (L->IgnoreObjectArgument || R->IgnoreObjectArgument); 11335 for (unsigned E = L->Conversions.size(); I != E; ++I) { 11336 switch (CompareImplicitConversionSequences(S, Loc, 11337 L->Conversions[I], 11338 R->Conversions[I])) { 11339 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better: 11340 leftBetter++; 11341 break; 11342 11343 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse: 11344 leftBetter--; 11345 break; 11346 11347 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable: 11348 break; 11349 } 11350 } 11351 if (leftBetter > 0) return true; 11352 if (leftBetter < 0) return false; 11353 11354 } else if (RFailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_conversion) 11355 return false; 11356 11357 if (LFailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction) { 11358 if (RFailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_deduction) 11359 return true; 11360 11361 if (L->DeductionFailure.Result != R->DeductionFailure.Result) 11362 return RankDeductionFailure(L->DeductionFailure) 11363 < RankDeductionFailure(R->DeductionFailure); 11364 } else if (RFailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction) 11365 return false; 11366 11367 // TODO: others? 11368 } 11369 11370 // Sort everything else by location. 11371 SourceLocation LLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(L); 11372 SourceLocation RLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(R); 11373 11374 // Put candidates without locations (e.g. builtins) at the end. 11375 if (LLoc.isInvalid()) return false; 11376 if (RLoc.isInvalid()) return true; 11377 11378 return S.SourceMgr.isBeforeInTranslationUnit(LLoc, RLoc); 11379 } 11380 }; 11381 } 11382 11383 /// CompleteNonViableCandidate - Normally, overload resolution only 11384 /// computes up to the first bad conversion. Produces the FixIt set if 11385 /// possible. 11386 static void 11387 CompleteNonViableCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand, 11388 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 11389 OverloadCandidateSet::CandidateSetKind CSK) { 11390 assert(!Cand->Viable); 11391 11392 // Don't do anything on failures other than bad conversion. 11393 if (Cand->FailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_conversion) 11394 return; 11395 11396 // We only want the FixIts if all the arguments can be corrected. 11397 bool Unfixable = false; 11398 // Use a implicit copy initialization to check conversion fixes. 11399 Cand->Fix.setConversionChecker(TryCopyInitialization); 11400 11401 // Attempt to fix the bad conversion. 11402 unsigned ConvCount = Cand->Conversions.size(); 11403 for (unsigned ConvIdx = (Cand->IgnoreObjectArgument ? 1 : 0); /**/; 11404 ++ConvIdx) { 11405 assert(ConvIdx != ConvCount && "no bad conversion in candidate"); 11406 if (Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].isInitialized() && 11407 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].isBad()) { 11408 Unfixable = !Cand->TryToFixBadConversion(ConvIdx, S); 11409 break; 11410 } 11411 } 11412 11413 // FIXME: this should probably be preserved from the overload 11414 // operation somehow. 11415 bool SuppressUserConversions = false; 11416 11417 unsigned ConvIdx = 0; 11418 unsigned ArgIdx = 0; 11419 ArrayRef<QualType> ParamTypes; 11420 bool Reversed = Cand->isReversed(); 11421 11422 if (Cand->IsSurrogate) { 11423 QualType ConvType 11424 = Cand->Surrogate->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType(); 11425 if (const PointerType *ConvPtrType = ConvType->getAs<PointerType>()) 11426 ConvType = ConvPtrType->getPointeeType(); 11427 ParamTypes = ConvType->castAs<FunctionProtoType>()->getParamTypes(); 11428 // Conversion 0 is 'this', which doesn't have a corresponding parameter. 11429 ConvIdx = 1; 11430 } else if (Cand->Function) { 11431 ParamTypes = 11432 Cand->Function->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>()->getParamTypes(); 11433 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Cand->Function) && 11434 !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Cand->Function) && !Reversed) { 11435 // Conversion 0 is 'this', which doesn't have a corresponding parameter. 11436 ConvIdx = 1; 11437 if (CSK == OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator && 11438 Cand->Function->getDeclName().getCXXOverloadedOperator() != OO_Call) 11439 // Argument 0 is 'this', which doesn't have a corresponding parameter. 11440 ArgIdx = 1; 11441 } 11442 } else { 11443 // Builtin operator. 11444 assert(ConvCount <= 3); 11445 ParamTypes = Cand->BuiltinParamTypes; 11446 } 11447 11448 // Fill in the rest of the conversions. 11449 for (unsigned ParamIdx = Reversed ? ParamTypes.size() - 1 : 0; 11450 ConvIdx != ConvCount; 11451 ++ConvIdx, ++ArgIdx, ParamIdx += (Reversed ? -1 : 1)) { 11452 assert(ArgIdx < Args.size() && "no argument for this arg conversion"); 11453 if (Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].isInitialized()) { 11454 // We've already checked this conversion. 11455 } else if (ParamIdx < ParamTypes.size()) { 11456 if (ParamTypes[ParamIdx]->isDependentType()) 11457 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].setAsIdentityConversion( 11458 Args[ArgIdx]->getType()); 11459 else { 11460 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx] = 11461 TryCopyInitialization(S, Args[ArgIdx], ParamTypes[ParamIdx], 11462 SuppressUserConversions, 11463 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true, 11464 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/ 11465 S.getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount); 11466 // Store the FixIt in the candidate if it exists. 11467 if (!Unfixable && Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].isBad()) 11468 Unfixable = !Cand->TryToFixBadConversion(ConvIdx, S); 11469 } 11470 } else 11471 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].setEllipsis(); 11472 } 11473 } 11474 11475 SmallVector<OverloadCandidate *, 32> OverloadCandidateSet::CompleteCandidates( 11476 Sema &S, OverloadCandidateDisplayKind OCD, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 11477 SourceLocation OpLoc, 11478 llvm::function_ref<bool(OverloadCandidate &)> Filter) { 11479 // Sort the candidates by viability and position. Sorting directly would 11480 // be prohibitive, so we make a set of pointers and sort those. 11481 SmallVector<OverloadCandidate*, 32> Cands; 11482 if (OCD == OCD_AllCandidates) Cands.reserve(size()); 11483 for (iterator Cand = begin(), LastCand = end(); Cand != LastCand; ++Cand) { 11484 if (!Filter(*Cand)) 11485 continue; 11486 switch (OCD) { 11487 case OCD_AllCandidates: 11488 if (!Cand->Viable) { 11489 if (!Cand->Function && !Cand->IsSurrogate) { 11490 // This a non-viable builtin candidate. We do not, in general, 11491 // want to list every possible builtin candidate. 11492 continue; 11493 } 11494 CompleteNonViableCandidate(S, Cand, Args, Kind); 11495 } 11496 break; 11497 11498 case OCD_ViableCandidates: 11499 if (!Cand->Viable) 11500 continue; 11501 break; 11502 11503 case OCD_AmbiguousCandidates: 11504 if (!Cand->Best) 11505 continue; 11506 break; 11507 } 11508 11509 Cands.push_back(Cand); 11510 } 11511 11512 llvm::stable_sort( 11513 Cands, CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay(S, OpLoc, Args.size(), Kind)); 11514 11515 return Cands; 11516 } 11517 11518 /// When overload resolution fails, prints diagnostic messages containing the 11519 /// candidates in the candidate set. 11520 void OverloadCandidateSet::NoteCandidates(PartialDiagnosticAt PD, 11521 Sema &S, OverloadCandidateDisplayKind OCD, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 11522 StringRef Opc, SourceLocation OpLoc, 11523 llvm::function_ref<bool(OverloadCandidate &)> Filter) { 11524 11525 auto Cands = CompleteCandidates(S, OCD, Args, OpLoc, Filter); 11526 11527 S.Diag(PD.first, PD.second); 11528 11529 NoteCandidates(S, Args, Cands, Opc, OpLoc); 11530 11531 if (OCD == OCD_AmbiguousCandidates) 11532 MaybeDiagnoseAmbiguousConstraints(S, {begin(), end()}); 11533 } 11534 11535 void OverloadCandidateSet::NoteCandidates(Sema &S, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 11536 ArrayRef<OverloadCandidate *> Cands, 11537 StringRef Opc, SourceLocation OpLoc) { 11538 bool ReportedAmbiguousConversions = false; 11539 11540 const OverloadsShown ShowOverloads = S.Diags.getShowOverloads(); 11541 unsigned CandsShown = 0; 11542 auto I = Cands.begin(), E = Cands.end(); 11543 for (; I != E; ++I) { 11544 OverloadCandidate *Cand = *I; 11545 11546 // Set an arbitrary limit on the number of candidate functions we'll spam 11547 // the user with. FIXME: This limit should depend on details of the 11548 // candidate list. 11549 if (CandsShown >= 4 && ShowOverloads == Ovl_Best) { 11550 break; 11551 } 11552 ++CandsShown; 11553 11554 if (Cand->Function) 11555 NoteFunctionCandidate(S, Cand, Args.size(), 11556 /*TakingCandidateAddress=*/false, DestAS); 11557 else if (Cand->IsSurrogate) 11558 NoteSurrogateCandidate(S, Cand); 11559 else { 11560 assert(Cand->Viable && 11561 "Non-viable built-in candidates are not added to Cands."); 11562 // Generally we only see ambiguities including viable builtin 11563 // operators if overload resolution got screwed up by an 11564 // ambiguous user-defined conversion. 11565 // 11566 // FIXME: It's quite possible for different conversions to see 11567 // different ambiguities, though. 11568 if (!ReportedAmbiguousConversions) { 11569 NoteAmbiguousUserConversions(S, OpLoc, Cand); 11570 ReportedAmbiguousConversions = true; 11571 } 11572 11573 // If this is a viable builtin, print it. 11574 NoteBuiltinOperatorCandidate(S, Opc, OpLoc, Cand); 11575 } 11576 } 11577 11578 if (I != E) 11579 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_too_many_candidates) << int(E - I); 11580 } 11581 11582 static SourceLocation 11583 GetLocationForCandidate(const TemplateSpecCandidate *Cand) { 11584 return Cand->Specialization ? Cand->Specialization->getLocation() 11585 : SourceLocation(); 11586 } 11587 11588 namespace { 11589 struct CompareTemplateSpecCandidatesForDisplay { 11590 Sema &S; 11591 CompareTemplateSpecCandidatesForDisplay(Sema &S) : S(S) {} 11592 11593 bool operator()(const TemplateSpecCandidate *L, 11594 const TemplateSpecCandidate *R) { 11595 // Fast-path this check. 11596 if (L == R) 11597 return false; 11598 11599 // Assuming that both candidates are not matches... 11600 11601 // Sort by the ranking of deduction failures. 11602 if (L->DeductionFailure.Result != R->DeductionFailure.Result) 11603 return RankDeductionFailure(L->DeductionFailure) < 11604 RankDeductionFailure(R->DeductionFailure); 11605 11606 // Sort everything else by location. 11607 SourceLocation LLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(L); 11608 SourceLocation RLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(R); 11609 11610 // Put candidates without locations (e.g. builtins) at the end. 11611 if (LLoc.isInvalid()) 11612 return false; 11613 if (RLoc.isInvalid()) 11614 return true; 11615 11616 return S.SourceMgr.isBeforeInTranslationUnit(LLoc, RLoc); 11617 } 11618 }; 11619 } 11620 11621 /// Diagnose a template argument deduction failure. 11622 /// We are treating these failures as overload failures due to bad 11623 /// deductions. 11624 void TemplateSpecCandidate::NoteDeductionFailure(Sema &S, 11625 bool ForTakingAddress) { 11626 DiagnoseBadDeduction(S, FoundDecl, Specialization, // pattern 11627 DeductionFailure, /*NumArgs=*/0, ForTakingAddress); 11628 } 11629 11630 void TemplateSpecCandidateSet::destroyCandidates() { 11631 for (iterator i = begin(), e = end(); i != e; ++i) { 11632 i->DeductionFailure.Destroy(); 11633 } 11634 } 11635 11636 void TemplateSpecCandidateSet::clear() { 11637 destroyCandidates(); 11638 Candidates.clear(); 11639 } 11640 11641 /// NoteCandidates - When no template specialization match is found, prints 11642 /// diagnostic messages containing the non-matching specializations that form 11643 /// the candidate set. 11644 /// This is analoguous to OverloadCandidateSet::NoteCandidates() with 11645 /// OCD == OCD_AllCandidates and Cand->Viable == false. 11646 void TemplateSpecCandidateSet::NoteCandidates(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc) { 11647 // Sort the candidates by position (assuming no candidate is a match). 11648 // Sorting directly would be prohibitive, so we make a set of pointers 11649 // and sort those. 11650 SmallVector<TemplateSpecCandidate *, 32> Cands; 11651 Cands.reserve(size()); 11652 for (iterator Cand = begin(), LastCand = end(); Cand != LastCand; ++Cand) { 11653 if (Cand->Specialization) 11654 Cands.push_back(Cand); 11655 // Otherwise, this is a non-matching builtin candidate. We do not, 11656 // in general, want to list every possible builtin candidate. 11657 } 11658 11659 llvm::sort(Cands, CompareTemplateSpecCandidatesForDisplay(S)); 11660 11661 // FIXME: Perhaps rename OverloadsShown and getShowOverloads() 11662 // for generalization purposes (?). 11663 const OverloadsShown ShowOverloads = S.Diags.getShowOverloads(); 11664 11665 SmallVectorImpl<TemplateSpecCandidate *>::iterator I, E; 11666 unsigned CandsShown = 0; 11667 for (I = Cands.begin(), E = Cands.end(); I != E; ++I) { 11668 TemplateSpecCandidate *Cand = *I; 11669 11670 // Set an arbitrary limit on the number of candidates we'll spam 11671 // the user with. FIXME: This limit should depend on details of the 11672 // candidate list. 11673 if (CandsShown >= 4 && ShowOverloads == Ovl_Best) 11674 break; 11675 ++CandsShown; 11676 11677 assert(Cand->Specialization && 11678 "Non-matching built-in candidates are not added to Cands."); 11679 Cand->NoteDeductionFailure(S, ForTakingAddress); 11680 } 11681 11682 if (I != E) 11683 S.Diag(Loc, diag::note_ovl_too_many_candidates) << int(E - I); 11684 } 11685 11686 // [PossiblyAFunctionType] --> [Return] 11687 // NonFunctionType --> NonFunctionType 11688 // R (A) --> R(A) 11689 // R (*)(A) --> R (A) 11690 // R (&)(A) --> R (A) 11691 // R (S::*)(A) --> R (A) 11692 QualType Sema::ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(QualType PossiblyAFunctionType) { 11693 QualType Ret = PossiblyAFunctionType; 11694 if (const PointerType *ToTypePtr = 11695 PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<PointerType>()) 11696 Ret = ToTypePtr->getPointeeType(); 11697 else if (const ReferenceType *ToTypeRef = 11698 PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<ReferenceType>()) 11699 Ret = ToTypeRef->getPointeeType(); 11700 else if (const MemberPointerType *MemTypePtr = 11701 PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<MemberPointerType>()) 11702 Ret = MemTypePtr->getPointeeType(); 11703 Ret = 11704 Context.getCanonicalType(Ret).getUnqualifiedType(); 11705 return Ret; 11706 } 11707 11708 static bool completeFunctionType(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *FD, SourceLocation Loc, 11709 bool Complain = true) { 11710 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 && FD->getReturnType()->isUndeducedType() && 11711 S.DeduceReturnType(FD, Loc, Complain)) 11712 return true; 11713 11714 auto *FPT = FD->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 11715 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17 && 11716 isUnresolvedExceptionSpec(FPT->getExceptionSpecType()) && 11717 !S.ResolveExceptionSpec(Loc, FPT)) 11718 return true; 11719 11720 return false; 11721 } 11722 11723 namespace { 11724 // A helper class to help with address of function resolution 11725 // - allows us to avoid passing around all those ugly parameters 11726 class AddressOfFunctionResolver { 11727 Sema& S; 11728 Expr* SourceExpr; 11729 const QualType& TargetType; 11730 QualType TargetFunctionType; // Extracted function type from target type 11731 11732 bool Complain; 11733 //DeclAccessPair& ResultFunctionAccessPair; 11734 ASTContext& Context; 11735 11736 bool TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction; 11737 bool FoundNonTemplateFunction; 11738 bool StaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer; 11739 bool HasComplained; 11740 11741 OverloadExpr::FindResult OvlExprInfo; 11742 OverloadExpr *OvlExpr; 11743 TemplateArgumentListInfo OvlExplicitTemplateArgs; 11744 SmallVector<std::pair<DeclAccessPair, FunctionDecl*>, 4> Matches; 11745 TemplateSpecCandidateSet FailedCandidates; 11746 11747 public: 11748 AddressOfFunctionResolver(Sema &S, Expr *SourceExpr, 11749 const QualType &TargetType, bool Complain) 11750 : S(S), SourceExpr(SourceExpr), TargetType(TargetType), 11751 Complain(Complain), Context(S.getASTContext()), 11752 TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction( 11753 !!TargetType->getAs<MemberPointerType>()), 11754 FoundNonTemplateFunction(false), 11755 StaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer(false), 11756 HasComplained(false), 11757 OvlExprInfo(OverloadExpr::find(SourceExpr)), 11758 OvlExpr(OvlExprInfo.Expression), 11759 FailedCandidates(OvlExpr->getNameLoc(), /*ForTakingAddress=*/true) { 11760 ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionTypeFromTargetType(); 11761 11762 if (TargetFunctionType->isFunctionType()) { 11763 if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *UME = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(OvlExpr)) 11764 if (!UME->isImplicitAccess() && 11765 !S.ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(UME)) 11766 StaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer = true; 11767 } else if (OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) { 11768 DeclAccessPair dap; 11769 if (FunctionDecl *Fn = S.ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization( 11770 OvlExpr, false, &dap)) { 11771 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) 11772 if (!Method->isStatic()) { 11773 // If the target type is a non-function type and the function found 11774 // is a non-static member function, pretend as if that was the 11775 // target, it's the only possible type to end up with. 11776 TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction = true; 11777 11778 // And skip adding the function if its not in the proper form. 11779 // We'll diagnose this due to an empty set of functions. 11780 if (!OvlExprInfo.HasFormOfMemberPointer) 11781 return; 11782 } 11783 11784 Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(dap, Fn)); 11785 } 11786 return; 11787 } 11788 11789 if (OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) 11790 OvlExpr->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(OvlExplicitTemplateArgs); 11791 11792 if (FindAllFunctionsThatMatchTargetTypeExactly()) { 11793 // C++ [over.over]p4: 11794 // If more than one function is selected, [...] 11795 if (Matches.size() > 1 && !eliminiateSuboptimalOverloadCandidates()) { 11796 if (FoundNonTemplateFunction) 11797 EliminateAllTemplateMatches(); 11798 else 11799 EliminateAllExceptMostSpecializedTemplate(); 11800 } 11801 } 11802 11803 if (S.getLangOpts().CUDA && Matches.size() > 1) 11804 EliminateSuboptimalCudaMatches(); 11805 } 11806 11807 bool hasComplained() const { return HasComplained; } 11808 11809 private: 11810 bool candidateHasExactlyCorrectType(const FunctionDecl *FD) { 11811 QualType Discard; 11812 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(TargetFunctionType, FD->getType()) || 11813 S.IsFunctionConversion(FD->getType(), TargetFunctionType, Discard); 11814 } 11815 11816 /// \return true if A is considered a better overload candidate for the 11817 /// desired type than B. 11818 bool isBetterCandidate(const FunctionDecl *A, const FunctionDecl *B) { 11819 // If A doesn't have exactly the correct type, we don't want to classify it 11820 // as "better" than anything else. This way, the user is required to 11821 // disambiguate for us if there are multiple candidates and no exact match. 11822 return candidateHasExactlyCorrectType(A) && 11823 (!candidateHasExactlyCorrectType(B) || 11824 compareEnableIfAttrs(S, A, B) == Comparison::Better); 11825 } 11826 11827 /// \return true if we were able to eliminate all but one overload candidate, 11828 /// false otherwise. 11829 bool eliminiateSuboptimalOverloadCandidates() { 11830 // Same algorithm as overload resolution -- one pass to pick the "best", 11831 // another pass to be sure that nothing is better than the best. 11832 auto Best = Matches.begin(); 11833 for (auto I = Matches.begin()+1, E = Matches.end(); I != E; ++I) 11834 if (isBetterCandidate(I->second, Best->second)) 11835 Best = I; 11836 11837 const FunctionDecl *BestFn = Best->second; 11838 auto IsBestOrInferiorToBest = [this, BestFn]( 11839 const std::pair<DeclAccessPair, FunctionDecl *> &Pair) { 11840 return BestFn == Pair.second || isBetterCandidate(BestFn, Pair.second); 11841 }; 11842 11843 // Note: We explicitly leave Matches unmodified if there isn't a clear best 11844 // option, so we can potentially give the user a better error 11845 if (!llvm::all_of(Matches, IsBestOrInferiorToBest)) 11846 return false; 11847 Matches[0] = *Best; 11848 Matches.resize(1); 11849 return true; 11850 } 11851 11852 bool isTargetTypeAFunction() const { 11853 return TargetFunctionType->isFunctionType(); 11854 } 11855 11856 // [ToType] [Return] 11857 11858 // R (*)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = false 11859 // R (&)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = false 11860 // R (S::*)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = true 11861 void inline ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionTypeFromTargetType() { 11862 TargetFunctionType = S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(TargetType); 11863 } 11864 11865 // return true if any matching specializations were found 11866 bool AddMatchingTemplateFunction(FunctionTemplateDecl* FunctionTemplate, 11867 const DeclAccessPair& CurAccessFunPair) { 11868 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method 11869 = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl())) { 11870 // Skip non-static function templates when converting to pointer, and 11871 // static when converting to member pointer. 11872 if (Method->isStatic() == TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction) 11873 return false; 11874 } 11875 else if (TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction) 11876 return false; 11877 11878 // C++ [over.over]p2: 11879 // If the name is a function template, template argument deduction is 11880 // done (14.8.2.2), and if the argument deduction succeeds, the 11881 // resulting template argument list is used to generate a single 11882 // function template specialization, which is added to the set of 11883 // overloaded functions considered. 11884 FunctionDecl *Specialization = nullptr; 11885 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(FailedCandidates.getLocation()); 11886 if (Sema::TemplateDeductionResult Result 11887 = S.DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, 11888 &OvlExplicitTemplateArgs, 11889 TargetFunctionType, Specialization, 11890 Info, /*IsAddressOfFunction*/true)) { 11891 // Make a note of the failed deduction for diagnostics. 11892 FailedCandidates.addCandidate() 11893 .set(CurAccessFunPair, FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl(), 11894 MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result, Info)); 11895 return false; 11896 } 11897 11898 // Template argument deduction ensures that we have an exact match or 11899 // compatible pointer-to-function arguments that would be adjusted by ICS. 11900 // This function template specicalization works. 11901 assert(S.isSameOrCompatibleFunctionType( 11902 Context.getCanonicalType(Specialization->getType()), 11903 Context.getCanonicalType(TargetFunctionType))); 11904 11905 if (!S.checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(Specialization)) 11906 return false; 11907 11908 Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(CurAccessFunPair, Specialization)); 11909 return true; 11910 } 11911 11912 bool AddMatchingNonTemplateFunction(NamedDecl* Fn, 11913 const DeclAccessPair& CurAccessFunPair) { 11914 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) { 11915 // Skip non-static functions when converting to pointer, and static 11916 // when converting to member pointer. 11917 if (Method->isStatic() == TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction) 11918 return false; 11919 } 11920 else if (TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction) 11921 return false; 11922 11923 if (FunctionDecl *FunDecl = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Fn)) { 11924 if (S.getLangOpts().CUDA) 11925 if (FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext)) 11926 if (!Caller->isImplicit() && !S.IsAllowedCUDACall(Caller, FunDecl)) 11927 return false; 11928 if (FunDecl->isMultiVersion()) { 11929 const auto *TA = FunDecl->getAttr<TargetAttr>(); 11930 if (TA && !TA->isDefaultVersion()) 11931 return false; 11932 } 11933 11934 // If any candidate has a placeholder return type, trigger its deduction 11935 // now. 11936 if (completeFunctionType(S, FunDecl, SourceExpr->getBeginLoc(), 11937 Complain)) { 11938 HasComplained |= Complain; 11939 return false; 11940 } 11941 11942 if (!S.checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(FunDecl)) 11943 return false; 11944 11945 // If we're in C, we need to support types that aren't exactly identical. 11946 if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || 11947 candidateHasExactlyCorrectType(FunDecl)) { 11948 Matches.push_back(std::make_pair( 11949 CurAccessFunPair, cast<FunctionDecl>(FunDecl->getCanonicalDecl()))); 11950 FoundNonTemplateFunction = true; 11951 return true; 11952 } 11953 } 11954 11955 return false; 11956 } 11957 11958 bool FindAllFunctionsThatMatchTargetTypeExactly() { 11959 bool Ret = false; 11960 11961 // If the overload expression doesn't have the form of a pointer to 11962 // member, don't try to convert it to a pointer-to-member type. 11963 if (IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction()) 11964 return false; 11965 11966 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(), 11967 E = OvlExpr->decls_end(); 11968 I != E; ++I) { 11969 // Look through any using declarations to find the underlying function. 11970 NamedDecl *Fn = (*I)->getUnderlyingDecl(); 11971 11972 // C++ [over.over]p3: 11973 // Non-member functions and static member functions match 11974 // targets of type "pointer-to-function" or "reference-to-function." 11975 // Nonstatic member functions match targets of 11976 // type "pointer-to-member-function." 11977 // Note that according to DR 247, the containing class does not matter. 11978 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate 11979 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Fn)) { 11980 if (AddMatchingTemplateFunction(FunctionTemplate, I.getPair())) 11981 Ret = true; 11982 } 11983 // If we have explicit template arguments supplied, skip non-templates. 11984 else if (!OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs() && 11985 AddMatchingNonTemplateFunction(Fn, I.getPair())) 11986 Ret = true; 11987 } 11988 assert(Ret || Matches.empty()); 11989 return Ret; 11990 } 11991 11992 void EliminateAllExceptMostSpecializedTemplate() { 11993 // [...] and any given function template specialization F1 is 11994 // eliminated if the set contains a second function template 11995 // specialization whose function template is more specialized 11996 // than the function template of F1 according to the partial 11997 // ordering rules of 14.5.5.2. 11998 11999 // The algorithm specified above is quadratic. We instead use a 12000 // two-pass algorithm (similar to the one used to identify the 12001 // best viable function in an overload set) that identifies the 12002 // best function template (if it exists). 12003 12004 UnresolvedSet<4> MatchesCopy; // TODO: avoid! 12005 for (unsigned I = 0, E = Matches.size(); I != E; ++I) 12006 MatchesCopy.addDecl(Matches[I].second, Matches[I].first.getAccess()); 12007 12008 // TODO: It looks like FailedCandidates does not serve much purpose 12009 // here, since the no_viable diagnostic has index 0. 12010 UnresolvedSetIterator Result = S.getMostSpecialized( 12011 MatchesCopy.begin(), MatchesCopy.end(), FailedCandidates, 12012 SourceExpr->getBeginLoc(), S.PDiag(), 12013 S.PDiag(diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous) 12014 << Matches[0].second->getDeclName(), 12015 S.PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate) 12016 << (unsigned)oc_function << (unsigned)ocs_described_template, 12017 Complain, TargetFunctionType); 12018 12019 if (Result != MatchesCopy.end()) { 12020 // Make it the first and only element 12021 Matches[0].first = Matches[Result - MatchesCopy.begin()].first; 12022 Matches[0].second = cast<FunctionDecl>(*Result); 12023 Matches.resize(1); 12024 } else 12025 HasComplained |= Complain; 12026 } 12027 12028 void EliminateAllTemplateMatches() { 12029 // [...] any function template specializations in the set are 12030 // eliminated if the set also contains a non-template function, [...] 12031 for (unsigned I = 0, N = Matches.size(); I != N; ) { 12032 if (Matches[I].second->getPrimaryTemplate() == nullptr) 12033 ++I; 12034 else { 12035 Matches[I] = Matches[--N]; 12036 Matches.resize(N); 12037 } 12038 } 12039 } 12040 12041 void EliminateSuboptimalCudaMatches() { 12042 S.EraseUnwantedCUDAMatches(dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext), Matches); 12043 } 12044 12045 public: 12046 void ComplainNoMatchesFound() const { 12047 assert(Matches.empty()); 12048 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_no_viable) 12049 << OvlExpr->getName() << TargetFunctionType 12050 << OvlExpr->getSourceRange(); 12051 if (FailedCandidates.empty()) 12052 S.NoteAllOverloadCandidates(OvlExpr, TargetFunctionType, 12053 /*TakingAddress=*/true); 12054 else { 12055 // We have some deduction failure messages. Use them to diagnose 12056 // the function templates, and diagnose the non-template candidates 12057 // normally. 12058 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(), 12059 IEnd = OvlExpr->decls_end(); 12060 I != IEnd; ++I) 12061 if (FunctionDecl *Fun = 12062 dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl())) 12063 if (!functionHasPassObjectSizeParams(Fun)) 12064 S.NoteOverloadCandidate(*I, Fun, CRK_None, TargetFunctionType, 12065 /*TakingAddress=*/true); 12066 FailedCandidates.NoteCandidates(S, OvlExpr->getBeginLoc()); 12067 } 12068 } 12069 12070 bool IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction() const { 12071 return TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction && 12072 !OvlExprInfo.HasFormOfMemberPointer; 12073 } 12074 12075 void ComplainIsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction() const { 12076 // TODO: Should we condition this on whether any functions might 12077 // have matched, or is it more appropriate to do that in callers? 12078 // TODO: a fixit wouldn't hurt. 12079 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getNameLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_no_qualifier) 12080 << TargetType << OvlExpr->getSourceRange(); 12081 } 12082 12083 bool IsStaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer() const { 12084 return StaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer; 12085 } 12086 12087 void ComplainIsStaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer() const { 12088 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getBeginLoc(), 12089 diag::err_invalid_form_pointer_member_function) 12090 << OvlExpr->getSourceRange(); 12091 } 12092 12093 void ComplainOfInvalidConversion() const { 12094 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_not_func_ptrref) 12095 << OvlExpr->getName() << TargetType; 12096 } 12097 12098 void ComplainMultipleMatchesFound() const { 12099 assert(Matches.size() > 1); 12100 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous) 12101 << OvlExpr->getName() << OvlExpr->getSourceRange(); 12102 S.NoteAllOverloadCandidates(OvlExpr, TargetFunctionType, 12103 /*TakingAddress=*/true); 12104 } 12105 12106 bool hadMultipleCandidates() const { return (OvlExpr->getNumDecls() > 1); } 12107 12108 int getNumMatches() const { return Matches.size(); } 12109 12110 FunctionDecl* getMatchingFunctionDecl() const { 12111 if (Matches.size() != 1) return nullptr; 12112 return Matches[0].second; 12113 } 12114 12115 const DeclAccessPair* getMatchingFunctionAccessPair() const { 12116 if (Matches.size() != 1) return nullptr; 12117 return &Matches[0].first; 12118 } 12119 }; 12120 } 12121 12122 /// ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction - Try to resolve the address of 12123 /// an overloaded function (C++ [over.over]), where @p From is an 12124 /// expression with overloaded function type and @p ToType is the type 12125 /// we're trying to resolve to. For example: 12126 /// 12127 /// @code 12128 /// int f(double); 12129 /// int f(int); 12130 /// 12131 /// int (*pfd)(double) = f; // selects f(double) 12132 /// @endcode 12133 /// 12134 /// This routine returns the resulting FunctionDecl if it could be 12135 /// resolved, and NULL otherwise. When @p Complain is true, this 12136 /// routine will emit diagnostics if there is an error. 12137 FunctionDecl * 12138 Sema::ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(Expr *AddressOfExpr, 12139 QualType TargetType, 12140 bool Complain, 12141 DeclAccessPair &FoundResult, 12142 bool *pHadMultipleCandidates) { 12143 assert(AddressOfExpr->getType() == Context.OverloadTy); 12144 12145 AddressOfFunctionResolver Resolver(*this, AddressOfExpr, TargetType, 12146 Complain); 12147 int NumMatches = Resolver.getNumMatches(); 12148 FunctionDecl *Fn = nullptr; 12149 bool ShouldComplain = Complain && !Resolver.hasComplained(); 12150 if (NumMatches == 0 && ShouldComplain) { 12151 if (Resolver.IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction()) 12152 Resolver.ComplainIsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction(); 12153 else 12154 Resolver.ComplainNoMatchesFound(); 12155 } 12156 else if (NumMatches > 1 && ShouldComplain) 12157 Resolver.ComplainMultipleMatchesFound(); 12158 else if (NumMatches == 1) { 12159 Fn = Resolver.getMatchingFunctionDecl(); 12160 assert(Fn); 12161 if (auto *FPT = Fn->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) 12162 ResolveExceptionSpec(AddressOfExpr->getExprLoc(), FPT); 12163 FoundResult = *Resolver.getMatchingFunctionAccessPair(); 12164 if (Complain) { 12165 if (Resolver.IsStaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer()) 12166 Resolver.ComplainIsStaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer(); 12167 else 12168 CheckAddressOfMemberAccess(AddressOfExpr, FoundResult); 12169 } 12170 } 12171 12172 if (pHadMultipleCandidates) 12173 *pHadMultipleCandidates = Resolver.hadMultipleCandidates(); 12174 return Fn; 12175 } 12176 12177 /// Given an expression that refers to an overloaded function, try to 12178 /// resolve that function to a single function that can have its address taken. 12179 /// This will modify `Pair` iff it returns non-null. 12180 /// 12181 /// This routine can only succeed if from all of the candidates in the overload 12182 /// set for SrcExpr that can have their addresses taken, there is one candidate 12183 /// that is more constrained than the rest. 12184 FunctionDecl * 12185 Sema::resolveAddressOfSingleOverloadCandidate(Expr *E, DeclAccessPair &Pair) { 12186 OverloadExpr::FindResult R = OverloadExpr::find(E); 12187 OverloadExpr *Ovl = R.Expression; 12188 bool IsResultAmbiguous = false; 12189 FunctionDecl *Result = nullptr; 12190 DeclAccessPair DAP; 12191 SmallVector<FunctionDecl *, 2> AmbiguousDecls; 12192 12193 auto CheckMoreConstrained = 12194 [&] (FunctionDecl *FD1, FunctionDecl *FD2) -> Optional<bool> { 12195 SmallVector<const Expr *, 1> AC1, AC2; 12196 FD1->getAssociatedConstraints(AC1); 12197 FD2->getAssociatedConstraints(AC2); 12198 bool AtLeastAsConstrained1, AtLeastAsConstrained2; 12199 if (IsAtLeastAsConstrained(FD1, AC1, FD2, AC2, AtLeastAsConstrained1)) 12200 return None; 12201 if (IsAtLeastAsConstrained(FD2, AC2, FD1, AC1, AtLeastAsConstrained2)) 12202 return None; 12203 if (AtLeastAsConstrained1 == AtLeastAsConstrained2) 12204 return None; 12205 return AtLeastAsConstrained1; 12206 }; 12207 12208 // Don't use the AddressOfResolver because we're specifically looking for 12209 // cases where we have one overload candidate that lacks 12210 // enable_if/pass_object_size/... 12211 for (auto I = Ovl->decls_begin(), E = Ovl->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) { 12212 auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(I->getUnderlyingDecl()); 12213 if (!FD) 12214 return nullptr; 12215 12216 if (!checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(FD)) 12217 continue; 12218 12219 // We have more than one result - see if it is more constrained than the 12220 // previous one. 12221 if (Result) { 12222 Optional<bool> MoreConstrainedThanPrevious = CheckMoreConstrained(FD, 12223 Result); 12224 if (!MoreConstrainedThanPrevious) { 12225 IsResultAmbiguous = true; 12226 AmbiguousDecls.push_back(FD); 12227 continue; 12228 } 12229 if (!*MoreConstrainedThanPrevious) 12230 continue; 12231 // FD is more constrained - replace Result with it. 12232 } 12233 IsResultAmbiguous = false; 12234 DAP = I.getPair(); 12235 Result = FD; 12236 } 12237 12238 if (IsResultAmbiguous) 12239 return nullptr; 12240 12241 if (Result) { 12242 SmallVector<const Expr *, 1> ResultAC; 12243 // We skipped over some ambiguous declarations which might be ambiguous with 12244 // the selected result. 12245 for (FunctionDecl *Skipped : AmbiguousDecls) 12246 if (!CheckMoreConstrained(Skipped, Result).hasValue()) 12247 return nullptr; 12248 Pair = DAP; 12249 } 12250 return Result; 12251 } 12252 12253 /// Given an overloaded function, tries to turn it into a non-overloaded 12254 /// function reference using resolveAddressOfSingleOverloadCandidate. This 12255 /// will perform access checks, diagnose the use of the resultant decl, and, if 12256 /// requested, potentially perform a function-to-pointer decay. 12257 /// 12258 /// Returns false if resolveAddressOfSingleOverloadCandidate fails. 12259 /// Otherwise, returns true. This may emit diagnostics and return true. 12260 bool Sema::resolveAndFixAddressOfSingleOverloadCandidate( 12261 ExprResult &SrcExpr, bool DoFunctionPointerConverion) { 12262 Expr *E = SrcExpr.get(); 12263 assert(E->getType() == Context.OverloadTy && "SrcExpr must be an overload"); 12264 12265 DeclAccessPair DAP; 12266 FunctionDecl *Found = resolveAddressOfSingleOverloadCandidate(E, DAP); 12267 if (!Found || Found->isCPUDispatchMultiVersion() || 12268 Found->isCPUSpecificMultiVersion()) 12269 return false; 12270 12271 // Emitting multiple diagnostics for a function that is both inaccessible and 12272 // unavailable is consistent with our behavior elsewhere. So, always check 12273 // for both. 12274 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Found, E->getExprLoc()); 12275 CheckAddressOfMemberAccess(E, DAP); 12276 Expr *Fixed = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(E, DAP, Found); 12277 if (DoFunctionPointerConverion && Fixed->getType()->isFunctionType()) 12278 SrcExpr = DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(Fixed, /*Diagnose=*/false); 12279 else 12280 SrcExpr = Fixed; 12281 return true; 12282 } 12283 12284 /// Given an expression that refers to an overloaded function, try to 12285 /// resolve that overloaded function expression down to a single function. 12286 /// 12287 /// This routine can only resolve template-ids that refer to a single function 12288 /// template, where that template-id refers to a single template whose template 12289 /// arguments are either provided by the template-id or have defaults, 12290 /// as described in C++0x [temp.arg.explicit]p3. 12291 /// 12292 /// If no template-ids are found, no diagnostics are emitted and NULL is 12293 /// returned. 12294 FunctionDecl * 12295 Sema::ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(OverloadExpr *ovl, 12296 bool Complain, 12297 DeclAccessPair *FoundResult) { 12298 // C++ [over.over]p1: 12299 // [...] [Note: any redundant set of parentheses surrounding the 12300 // overloaded function name is ignored (5.1). ] 12301 // C++ [over.over]p1: 12302 // [...] The overloaded function name can be preceded by the & 12303 // operator. 12304 12305 // If we didn't actually find any template-ids, we're done. 12306 if (!ovl->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) 12307 return nullptr; 12308 12309 TemplateArgumentListInfo ExplicitTemplateArgs; 12310 ovl->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(ExplicitTemplateArgs); 12311 TemplateSpecCandidateSet FailedCandidates(ovl->getNameLoc()); 12312 12313 // Look through all of the overloaded functions, searching for one 12314 // whose type matches exactly. 12315 FunctionDecl *Matched = nullptr; 12316 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = ovl->decls_begin(), 12317 E = ovl->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) { 12318 // C++0x [temp.arg.explicit]p3: 12319 // [...] In contexts where deduction is done and fails, or in contexts 12320 // where deduction is not done, if a template argument list is 12321 // specified and it, along with any default template arguments, 12322 // identifies a single function template specialization, then the 12323 // template-id is an lvalue for the function template specialization. 12324 FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate 12325 = cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()); 12326 12327 // C++ [over.over]p2: 12328 // If the name is a function template, template argument deduction is 12329 // done (14.8.2.2), and if the argument deduction succeeds, the 12330 // resulting template argument list is used to generate a single 12331 // function template specialization, which is added to the set of 12332 // overloaded functions considered. 12333 FunctionDecl *Specialization = nullptr; 12334 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(FailedCandidates.getLocation()); 12335 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result 12336 = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, &ExplicitTemplateArgs, 12337 Specialization, Info, 12338 /*IsAddressOfFunction*/true)) { 12339 // Make a note of the failed deduction for diagnostics. 12340 // TODO: Actually use the failed-deduction info? 12341 FailedCandidates.addCandidate() 12342 .set(I.getPair(), FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl(), 12343 MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result, Info)); 12344 continue; 12345 } 12346 12347 assert(Specialization && "no specialization and no error?"); 12348 12349 // Multiple matches; we can't resolve to a single declaration. 12350 if (Matched) { 12351 if (Complain) { 12352 Diag(ovl->getExprLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous) 12353 << ovl->getName(); 12354 NoteAllOverloadCandidates(ovl); 12355 } 12356 return nullptr; 12357 } 12358 12359 Matched = Specialization; 12360 if (FoundResult) *FoundResult = I.getPair(); 12361 } 12362 12363 if (Matched && 12364 completeFunctionType(*this, Matched, ovl->getExprLoc(), Complain)) 12365 return nullptr; 12366 12367 return Matched; 12368 } 12369 12370 // Resolve and fix an overloaded expression that can be resolved 12371 // because it identifies a single function template specialization. 12372 // 12373 // Last three arguments should only be supplied if Complain = true 12374 // 12375 // Return true if it was logically possible to so resolve the 12376 // expression, regardless of whether or not it succeeded. Always 12377 // returns true if 'complain' is set. 12378 bool Sema::ResolveAndFixSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization( 12379 ExprResult &SrcExpr, bool doFunctionPointerConverion, 12380 bool complain, SourceRange OpRangeForComplaining, 12381 QualType DestTypeForComplaining, 12382 unsigned DiagIDForComplaining) { 12383 assert(SrcExpr.get()->getType() == Context.OverloadTy); 12384 12385 OverloadExpr::FindResult ovl = OverloadExpr::find(SrcExpr.get()); 12386 12387 DeclAccessPair found; 12388 ExprResult SingleFunctionExpression; 12389 if (FunctionDecl *fn = ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization( 12390 ovl.Expression, /*complain*/ false, &found)) { 12391 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(fn, SrcExpr.get()->getBeginLoc())) { 12392 SrcExpr = ExprError(); 12393 return true; 12394 } 12395 12396 // It is only correct to resolve to an instance method if we're 12397 // resolving a form that's permitted to be a pointer to member. 12398 // Otherwise we'll end up making a bound member expression, which 12399 // is illegal in all the contexts we resolve like this. 12400 if (!ovl.HasFormOfMemberPointer && 12401 isa<CXXMethodDecl>(fn) && 12402 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(fn)->isInstance()) { 12403 if (!complain) return false; 12404 12405 Diag(ovl.Expression->getExprLoc(), 12406 diag::err_bound_member_function) 12407 << 0 << ovl.Expression->getSourceRange(); 12408 12409 // TODO: I believe we only end up here if there's a mix of 12410 // static and non-static candidates (otherwise the expression 12411 // would have 'bound member' type, not 'overload' type). 12412 // Ideally we would note which candidate was chosen and why 12413 // the static candidates were rejected. 12414 SrcExpr = ExprError(); 12415 return true; 12416 } 12417 12418 // Fix the expression to refer to 'fn'. 12419 SingleFunctionExpression = 12420 FixOverloadedFunctionReference(SrcExpr.get(), found, fn); 12421 12422 // If desired, do function-to-pointer decay. 12423 if (doFunctionPointerConverion) { 12424 SingleFunctionExpression = 12425 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(SingleFunctionExpression.get()); 12426 if (SingleFunctionExpression.isInvalid()) { 12427 SrcExpr = ExprError(); 12428 return true; 12429 } 12430 } 12431 } 12432 12433 if (!SingleFunctionExpression.isUsable()) { 12434 if (complain) { 12435 Diag(OpRangeForComplaining.getBegin(), DiagIDForComplaining) 12436 << ovl.Expression->getName() 12437 << DestTypeForComplaining 12438 << OpRangeForComplaining 12439 << ovl.Expression->getQualifierLoc().getSourceRange(); 12440 NoteAllOverloadCandidates(SrcExpr.get()); 12441 12442 SrcExpr = ExprError(); 12443 return true; 12444 } 12445 12446 return false; 12447 } 12448 12449 SrcExpr = SingleFunctionExpression; 12450 return true; 12451 } 12452 12453 /// Add a single candidate to the overload set. 12454 static void AddOverloadedCallCandidate(Sema &S, 12455 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, 12456 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs, 12457 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 12458 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, 12459 bool PartialOverloading, 12460 bool KnownValid) { 12461 NamedDecl *Callee = FoundDecl.getDecl(); 12462 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Callee)) 12463 Callee = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Callee)->getTargetDecl(); 12464 12465 if (FunctionDecl *Func = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Callee)) { 12466 if (ExplicitTemplateArgs) { 12467 assert(!KnownValid && "Explicit template arguments?"); 12468 return; 12469 } 12470 // Prevent ill-formed function decls to be added as overload candidates. 12471 if (!dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Func->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>())) 12472 return; 12473 12474 S.AddOverloadCandidate(Func, FoundDecl, Args, CandidateSet, 12475 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, 12476 PartialOverloading); 12477 return; 12478 } 12479 12480 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FuncTemplate 12481 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Callee)) { 12482 S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FuncTemplate, FoundDecl, 12483 ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, CandidateSet, 12484 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, 12485 PartialOverloading); 12486 return; 12487 } 12488 12489 assert(!KnownValid && "unhandled case in overloaded call candidate"); 12490 } 12491 12492 /// Add the overload candidates named by callee and/or found by argument 12493 /// dependent lookup to the given overload set. 12494 void Sema::AddOverloadedCallCandidates(UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE, 12495 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 12496 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, 12497 bool PartialOverloading) { 12498 12499 #ifndef NDEBUG 12500 // Verify that ArgumentDependentLookup is consistent with the rules 12501 // in C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3: 12502 // 12503 // Let X be the lookup set produced by unqualified lookup (3.4.1) 12504 // and let Y be the lookup set produced by argument dependent 12505 // lookup (defined as follows). If X contains 12506 // 12507 // -- a declaration of a class member, or 12508 // 12509 // -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a 12510 // using-declaration, or 12511 // 12512 // -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function 12513 // template 12514 // 12515 // then Y is empty. 12516 12517 if (ULE->requiresADL()) { 12518 for (UnresolvedLookupExpr::decls_iterator I = ULE->decls_begin(), 12519 E = ULE->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) { 12520 assert(!(*I)->getDeclContext()->isRecord()); 12521 assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(*I) || 12522 !(*I)->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod()); 12523 assert((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()->isFunctionOrFunctionTemplate()); 12524 } 12525 } 12526 #endif 12527 12528 // It would be nice to avoid this copy. 12529 TemplateArgumentListInfo TABuffer; 12530 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs = nullptr; 12531 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) { 12532 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TABuffer); 12533 ExplicitTemplateArgs = &TABuffer; 12534 } 12535 12536 for (UnresolvedLookupExpr::decls_iterator I = ULE->decls_begin(), 12537 E = ULE->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) 12538 AddOverloadedCallCandidate(*this, I.getPair(), ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, 12539 CandidateSet, PartialOverloading, 12540 /*KnownValid*/ true); 12541 12542 if (ULE->requiresADL()) 12543 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(ULE->getName(), ULE->getExprLoc(), 12544 Args, ExplicitTemplateArgs, 12545 CandidateSet, PartialOverloading); 12546 } 12547 12548 /// Determine whether a declaration with the specified name could be moved into 12549 /// a different namespace. 12550 static bool canBeDeclaredInNamespace(const DeclarationName &Name) { 12551 switch (Name.getCXXOverloadedOperator()) { 12552 case OO_New: case OO_Array_New: 12553 case OO_Delete: case OO_Array_Delete: 12554 return false; 12555 12556 default: 12557 return true; 12558 } 12559 } 12560 12561 /// Attempt to recover from an ill-formed use of a non-dependent name in a 12562 /// template, where the non-dependent name was declared after the template 12563 /// was defined. This is common in code written for a compilers which do not 12564 /// correctly implement two-stage name lookup. 12565 /// 12566 /// Returns true if a viable candidate was found and a diagnostic was issued. 12567 static bool 12568 DiagnoseTwoPhaseLookup(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation FnLoc, 12569 const CXXScopeSpec &SS, LookupResult &R, 12570 OverloadCandidateSet::CandidateSetKind CSK, 12571 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs, 12572 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 12573 bool *DoDiagnoseEmptyLookup = nullptr) { 12574 if (!SemaRef.inTemplateInstantiation() || !SS.isEmpty()) 12575 return false; 12576 12577 for (DeclContext *DC = SemaRef.CurContext; DC; DC = DC->getParent()) { 12578 if (DC->isTransparentContext()) 12579 continue; 12580 12581 SemaRef.LookupQualifiedName(R, DC); 12582 12583 if (!R.empty()) { 12584 R.suppressDiagnostics(); 12585 12586 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) { 12587 // Don't diagnose names we find in classes; we get much better 12588 // diagnostics for these from DiagnoseEmptyLookup. 12589 R.clear(); 12590 if (DoDiagnoseEmptyLookup) 12591 *DoDiagnoseEmptyLookup = true; 12592 return false; 12593 } 12594 12595 OverloadCandidateSet Candidates(FnLoc, CSK); 12596 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) 12597 AddOverloadedCallCandidate(SemaRef, I.getPair(), 12598 ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, 12599 Candidates, false, /*KnownValid*/ false); 12600 12601 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 12602 if (Candidates.BestViableFunction(SemaRef, FnLoc, Best) != OR_Success) { 12603 // No viable functions. Don't bother the user with notes for functions 12604 // which don't work and shouldn't be found anyway. 12605 R.clear(); 12606 return false; 12607 } 12608 12609 // Find the namespaces where ADL would have looked, and suggest 12610 // declaring the function there instead. 12611 Sema::AssociatedNamespaceSet AssociatedNamespaces; 12612 Sema::AssociatedClassSet AssociatedClasses; 12613 SemaRef.FindAssociatedClassesAndNamespaces(FnLoc, Args, 12614 AssociatedNamespaces, 12615 AssociatedClasses); 12616 Sema::AssociatedNamespaceSet SuggestedNamespaces; 12617 if (canBeDeclaredInNamespace(R.getLookupName())) { 12618 DeclContext *Std = SemaRef.getStdNamespace(); 12619 for (Sema::AssociatedNamespaceSet::iterator 12620 it = AssociatedNamespaces.begin(), 12621 end = AssociatedNamespaces.end(); it != end; ++it) { 12622 // Never suggest declaring a function within namespace 'std'. 12623 if (Std && Std->Encloses(*it)) 12624 continue; 12625 12626 // Never suggest declaring a function within a namespace with a 12627 // reserved name, like __gnu_cxx. 12628 NamespaceDecl *NS = dyn_cast<NamespaceDecl>(*it); 12629 if (NS && 12630 NS->getQualifiedNameAsString().find("__") != std::string::npos) 12631 continue; 12632 12633 SuggestedNamespaces.insert(*it); 12634 } 12635 } 12636 12637 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup) 12638 << R.getLookupName(); 12639 if (SuggestedNamespaces.empty()) { 12640 SemaRef.Diag(Best->Function->getLocation(), 12641 diag::note_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup) 12642 << R.getLookupName() << 0; 12643 } else if (SuggestedNamespaces.size() == 1) { 12644 SemaRef.Diag(Best->Function->getLocation(), 12645 diag::note_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup) 12646 << R.getLookupName() << 1 << *SuggestedNamespaces.begin(); 12647 } else { 12648 // FIXME: It would be useful to list the associated namespaces here, 12649 // but the diagnostics infrastructure doesn't provide a way to produce 12650 // a localized representation of a list of items. 12651 SemaRef.Diag(Best->Function->getLocation(), 12652 diag::note_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup) 12653 << R.getLookupName() << 2; 12654 } 12655 12656 // Try to recover by calling this function. 12657 return true; 12658 } 12659 12660 R.clear(); 12661 } 12662 12663 return false; 12664 } 12665 12666 /// Attempt to recover from ill-formed use of a non-dependent operator in a 12667 /// template, where the non-dependent operator was declared after the template 12668 /// was defined. 12669 /// 12670 /// Returns true if a viable candidate was found and a diagnostic was issued. 12671 static bool 12672 DiagnoseTwoPhaseOperatorLookup(Sema &SemaRef, OverloadedOperatorKind Op, 12673 SourceLocation OpLoc, 12674 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args) { 12675 DeclarationName OpName = 12676 SemaRef.Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op); 12677 LookupResult R(SemaRef, OpName, OpLoc, Sema::LookupOperatorName); 12678 return DiagnoseTwoPhaseLookup(SemaRef, OpLoc, CXXScopeSpec(), R, 12679 OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator, 12680 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs=*/nullptr, Args); 12681 } 12682 12683 namespace { 12684 class BuildRecoveryCallExprRAII { 12685 Sema &SemaRef; 12686 public: 12687 BuildRecoveryCallExprRAII(Sema &S) : SemaRef(S) { 12688 assert(SemaRef.IsBuildingRecoveryCallExpr == false); 12689 SemaRef.IsBuildingRecoveryCallExpr = true; 12690 } 12691 12692 ~BuildRecoveryCallExprRAII() { 12693 SemaRef.IsBuildingRecoveryCallExpr = false; 12694 } 12695 }; 12696 12697 } 12698 12699 /// Attempts to recover from a call where no functions were found. 12700 /// 12701 /// Returns true if new candidates were found. 12702 static ExprResult 12703 BuildRecoveryCallExpr(Sema &SemaRef, Scope *S, Expr *Fn, 12704 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE, 12705 SourceLocation LParenLoc, 12706 MutableArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 12707 SourceLocation RParenLoc, 12708 bool EmptyLookup, bool AllowTypoCorrection) { 12709 // Do not try to recover if it is already building a recovery call. 12710 // This stops infinite loops for template instantiations like 12711 // 12712 // template <typename T> auto foo(T t) -> decltype(foo(t)) {} 12713 // template <typename T> auto foo(T t) -> decltype(foo(&t)) {} 12714 // 12715 if (SemaRef.IsBuildingRecoveryCallExpr) 12716 return ExprError(); 12717 BuildRecoveryCallExprRAII RCE(SemaRef); 12718 12719 CXXScopeSpec SS; 12720 SS.Adopt(ULE->getQualifierLoc()); 12721 SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc = ULE->getTemplateKeywordLoc(); 12722 12723 TemplateArgumentListInfo TABuffer; 12724 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs = nullptr; 12725 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) { 12726 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TABuffer); 12727 ExplicitTemplateArgs = &TABuffer; 12728 } 12729 12730 LookupResult R(SemaRef, ULE->getName(), ULE->getNameLoc(), 12731 Sema::LookupOrdinaryName); 12732 bool DoDiagnoseEmptyLookup = EmptyLookup; 12733 if (!DiagnoseTwoPhaseLookup( 12734 SemaRef, Fn->getExprLoc(), SS, R, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal, 12735 ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, &DoDiagnoseEmptyLookup)) { 12736 NoTypoCorrectionCCC NoTypoValidator{}; 12737 FunctionCallFilterCCC FunctionCallValidator(SemaRef, Args.size(), 12738 ExplicitTemplateArgs != nullptr, 12739 dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(Fn)); 12740 CorrectionCandidateCallback &Validator = 12741 AllowTypoCorrection 12742 ? static_cast<CorrectionCandidateCallback &>(FunctionCallValidator) 12743 : static_cast<CorrectionCandidateCallback &>(NoTypoValidator); 12744 if (!DoDiagnoseEmptyLookup || 12745 SemaRef.DiagnoseEmptyLookup(S, SS, R, Validator, ExplicitTemplateArgs, 12746 Args)) 12747 return ExprError(); 12748 } 12749 12750 assert(!R.empty() && "lookup results empty despite recovery"); 12751 12752 // If recovery created an ambiguity, just bail out. 12753 if (R.isAmbiguous()) { 12754 R.suppressDiagnostics(); 12755 return ExprError(); 12756 } 12757 12758 // Build an implicit member call if appropriate. Just drop the 12759 // casts and such from the call, we don't really care. 12760 ExprResult NewFn = ExprError(); 12761 if ((*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember()) 12762 NewFn = SemaRef.BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, TemplateKWLoc, R, 12763 ExplicitTemplateArgs, S); 12764 else if (ExplicitTemplateArgs || TemplateKWLoc.isValid()) 12765 NewFn = SemaRef.BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, TemplateKWLoc, R, false, 12766 ExplicitTemplateArgs); 12767 else 12768 NewFn = SemaRef.BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, false); 12769 12770 if (NewFn.isInvalid()) 12771 return ExprError(); 12772 12773 // This shouldn't cause an infinite loop because we're giving it 12774 // an expression with viable lookup results, which should never 12775 // end up here. 12776 return SemaRef.BuildCallExpr(/*Scope*/ nullptr, NewFn.get(), LParenLoc, 12777 MultiExprArg(Args.data(), Args.size()), 12778 RParenLoc); 12779 } 12780 12781 /// Constructs and populates an OverloadedCandidateSet from 12782 /// the given function. 12783 /// \returns true when an the ExprResult output parameter has been set. 12784 bool Sema::buildOverloadedCallSet(Scope *S, Expr *Fn, 12785 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE, 12786 MultiExprArg Args, 12787 SourceLocation RParenLoc, 12788 OverloadCandidateSet *CandidateSet, 12789 ExprResult *Result) { 12790 #ifndef NDEBUG 12791 if (ULE->requiresADL()) { 12792 // To do ADL, we must have found an unqualified name. 12793 assert(!ULE->getQualifier() && "qualified name with ADL"); 12794 12795 // We don't perform ADL for implicit declarations of builtins. 12796 // Verify that this was correctly set up. 12797 FunctionDecl *F; 12798 if (ULE->decls_begin() != ULE->decls_end() && 12799 ULE->decls_begin() + 1 == ULE->decls_end() && 12800 (F = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*ULE->decls_begin())) && 12801 F->getBuiltinID() && F->isImplicit()) 12802 llvm_unreachable("performing ADL for builtin"); 12803 12804 // We don't perform ADL in C. 12805 assert(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && "ADL enabled in C"); 12806 } 12807 #endif 12808 12809 UnbridgedCastsSet UnbridgedCasts; 12810 if (checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(*this, Args, UnbridgedCasts)) { 12811 *Result = ExprError(); 12812 return true; 12813 } 12814 12815 // Add the functions denoted by the callee to the set of candidate 12816 // functions, including those from argument-dependent lookup. 12817 AddOverloadedCallCandidates(ULE, Args, *CandidateSet); 12818 12819 if (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && 12820 CurContext->isDependentContext() && !isSFINAEContext() && 12821 (isa<FunctionDecl>(CurContext) || isa<CXXRecordDecl>(CurContext))) { 12822 12823 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 12824 if (CandidateSet->empty() || 12825 CandidateSet->BestViableFunction(*this, Fn->getBeginLoc(), Best) == 12826 OR_No_Viable_Function) { 12827 // In Microsoft mode, if we are inside a template class member function 12828 // then create a type dependent CallExpr. The goal is to postpone name 12829 // lookup to instantiation time to be able to search into type dependent 12830 // base classes. 12831 CallExpr *CE = 12832 CallExpr::Create(Context, Fn, Args, Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue, 12833 RParenLoc, CurFPFeatureOverrides()); 12834 CE->markDependentForPostponedNameLookup(); 12835 *Result = CE; 12836 return true; 12837 } 12838 } 12839 12840 if (CandidateSet->empty()) 12841 return false; 12842 12843 UnbridgedCasts.restore(); 12844 return false; 12845 } 12846 12847 // Guess at what the return type for an unresolvable overload should be. 12848 static QualType chooseRecoveryType(OverloadCandidateSet &CS, 12849 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator *Best) { 12850 llvm::Optional<QualType> Result; 12851 // Adjust Type after seeing a candidate. 12852 auto ConsiderCandidate = [&](const OverloadCandidate &Candidate) { 12853 if (!Candidate.Function) 12854 return; 12855 if (Candidate.Function->isInvalidDecl()) 12856 return; 12857 QualType T = Candidate.Function->getReturnType(); 12858 if (T.isNull()) 12859 return; 12860 if (!Result) 12861 Result = T; 12862 else if (Result != T) 12863 Result = QualType(); 12864 }; 12865 12866 // Look for an unambiguous type from a progressively larger subset. 12867 // e.g. if types disagree, but all *viable* overloads return int, choose int. 12868 // 12869 // First, consider only the best candidate. 12870 if (Best && *Best != CS.end()) 12871 ConsiderCandidate(**Best); 12872 // Next, consider only viable candidates. 12873 if (!Result) 12874 for (const auto &C : CS) 12875 if (C.Viable) 12876 ConsiderCandidate(C); 12877 // Finally, consider all candidates. 12878 if (!Result) 12879 for (const auto &C : CS) 12880 ConsiderCandidate(C); 12881 12882 return Result.getValueOr(QualType()); 12883 } 12884 12885 /// FinishOverloadedCallExpr - given an OverloadCandidateSet, builds and returns 12886 /// the completed call expression. If overload resolution fails, emits 12887 /// diagnostics and returns ExprError() 12888 static ExprResult FinishOverloadedCallExpr(Sema &SemaRef, Scope *S, Expr *Fn, 12889 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE, 12890 SourceLocation LParenLoc, 12891 MultiExprArg Args, 12892 SourceLocation RParenLoc, 12893 Expr *ExecConfig, 12894 OverloadCandidateSet *CandidateSet, 12895 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator *Best, 12896 OverloadingResult OverloadResult, 12897 bool AllowTypoCorrection) { 12898 if (CandidateSet->empty()) 12899 return BuildRecoveryCallExpr(SemaRef, S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args, 12900 RParenLoc, /*EmptyLookup=*/true, 12901 AllowTypoCorrection); 12902 12903 switch (OverloadResult) { 12904 case OR_Success: { 12905 FunctionDecl *FDecl = (*Best)->Function; 12906 SemaRef.CheckUnresolvedLookupAccess(ULE, (*Best)->FoundDecl); 12907 if (SemaRef.DiagnoseUseOfDecl(FDecl, ULE->getNameLoc())) 12908 return ExprError(); 12909 Fn = SemaRef.FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Fn, (*Best)->FoundDecl, FDecl); 12910 return SemaRef.BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, FDecl, LParenLoc, Args, RParenLoc, 12911 ExecConfig, /*IsExecConfig=*/false, 12912 (*Best)->IsADLCandidate); 12913 } 12914 12915 case OR_No_Viable_Function: { 12916 // Try to recover by looking for viable functions which the user might 12917 // have meant to call. 12918 ExprResult Recovery = BuildRecoveryCallExpr(SemaRef, S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, 12919 Args, RParenLoc, 12920 /*EmptyLookup=*/false, 12921 AllowTypoCorrection); 12922 if (!Recovery.isInvalid()) 12923 return Recovery; 12924 12925 // If the user passes in a function that we can't take the address of, we 12926 // generally end up emitting really bad error messages. Here, we attempt to 12927 // emit better ones. 12928 for (const Expr *Arg : Args) { 12929 if (!Arg->getType()->isFunctionType()) 12930 continue; 12931 if (auto *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(Arg->IgnoreParenImpCasts())) { 12932 auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(DRE->getDecl()); 12933 if (FD && 12934 !SemaRef.checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(FD, /*Complain=*/true, 12935 Arg->getExprLoc())) 12936 return ExprError(); 12937 } 12938 } 12939 12940 CandidateSet->NoteCandidates( 12941 PartialDiagnosticAt( 12942 Fn->getBeginLoc(), 12943 SemaRef.PDiag(diag::err_ovl_no_viable_function_in_call) 12944 << ULE->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange()), 12945 SemaRef, OCD_AllCandidates, Args); 12946 break; 12947 } 12948 12949 case OR_Ambiguous: 12950 CandidateSet->NoteCandidates( 12951 PartialDiagnosticAt(Fn->getBeginLoc(), 12952 SemaRef.PDiag(diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_call) 12953 << ULE->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange()), 12954 SemaRef, OCD_AmbiguousCandidates, Args); 12955 break; 12956 12957 case OR_Deleted: { 12958 CandidateSet->NoteCandidates( 12959 PartialDiagnosticAt(Fn->getBeginLoc(), 12960 SemaRef.PDiag(diag::err_ovl_deleted_call) 12961 << ULE->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange()), 12962 SemaRef, OCD_AllCandidates, Args); 12963 12964 // We emitted an error for the unavailable/deleted function call but keep 12965 // the call in the AST. 12966 FunctionDecl *FDecl = (*Best)->Function; 12967 Fn = SemaRef.FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Fn, (*Best)->FoundDecl, FDecl); 12968 return SemaRef.BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, FDecl, LParenLoc, Args, RParenLoc, 12969 ExecConfig, /*IsExecConfig=*/false, 12970 (*Best)->IsADLCandidate); 12971 } 12972 } 12973 12974 // Overload resolution failed, try to recover. 12975 SmallVector<Expr *, 8> SubExprs = {Fn}; 12976 SubExprs.append(Args.begin(), Args.end()); 12977 return SemaRef.CreateRecoveryExpr(Fn->getBeginLoc(), RParenLoc, SubExprs, 12978 chooseRecoveryType(*CandidateSet, Best)); 12979 } 12980 12981 static void markUnaddressableCandidatesUnviable(Sema &S, 12982 OverloadCandidateSet &CS) { 12983 for (auto I = CS.begin(), E = CS.end(); I != E; ++I) { 12984 if (I->Viable && 12985 !S.checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(I->Function, /*Complain=*/false)) { 12986 I->Viable = false; 12987 I->FailureKind = ovl_fail_addr_not_available; 12988 } 12989 } 12990 } 12991 12992 /// BuildOverloadedCallExpr - Given the call expression that calls Fn 12993 /// (which eventually refers to the declaration Func) and the call 12994 /// arguments Args/NumArgs, attempt to resolve the function call down 12995 /// to a specific function. If overload resolution succeeds, returns 12996 /// the call expression produced by overload resolution. 12997 /// Otherwise, emits diagnostics and returns ExprError. 12998 ExprResult Sema::BuildOverloadedCallExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Fn, 12999 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE, 13000 SourceLocation LParenLoc, 13001 MultiExprArg Args, 13002 SourceLocation RParenLoc, 13003 Expr *ExecConfig, 13004 bool AllowTypoCorrection, 13005 bool CalleesAddressIsTaken) { 13006 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Fn->getExprLoc(), 13007 OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal); 13008 ExprResult result; 13009 13010 if (buildOverloadedCallSet(S, Fn, ULE, Args, LParenLoc, &CandidateSet, 13011 &result)) 13012 return result; 13013 13014 // If the user handed us something like `(&Foo)(Bar)`, we need to ensure that 13015 // functions that aren't addressible are considered unviable. 13016 if (CalleesAddressIsTaken) 13017 markUnaddressableCandidatesUnviable(*this, CandidateSet); 13018 13019 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 13020 OverloadingResult OverloadResult = 13021 CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, Fn->getBeginLoc(), Best); 13022 13023 return FinishOverloadedCallExpr(*this, S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args, RParenLoc, 13024 ExecConfig, &CandidateSet, &Best, 13025 OverloadResult, AllowTypoCorrection); 13026 } 13027 13028 static bool IsOverloaded(const UnresolvedSetImpl &Functions) { 13029 return Functions.size() > 1 || 13030 (Functions.size() == 1 && 13031 isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>((*Functions.begin())->getUnderlyingDecl())); 13032 } 13033 13034 ExprResult Sema::CreateUnresolvedLookupExpr(CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass, 13035 NestedNameSpecifierLoc NNSLoc, 13036 DeclarationNameInfo DNI, 13037 const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns, 13038 bool PerformADL) { 13039 return UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, NamingClass, NNSLoc, DNI, 13040 PerformADL, IsOverloaded(Fns), 13041 Fns.begin(), Fns.end()); 13042 } 13043 13044 /// Create a unary operation that may resolve to an overloaded 13045 /// operator. 13046 /// 13047 /// \param OpLoc The location of the operator itself (e.g., '*'). 13048 /// 13049 /// \param Opc The UnaryOperatorKind that describes this operator. 13050 /// 13051 /// \param Fns The set of non-member functions that will be 13052 /// considered by overload resolution. The caller needs to build this 13053 /// set based on the context using, e.g., 13054 /// LookupOverloadedOperatorName() and ArgumentDependentLookup(). This 13055 /// set should not contain any member functions; those will be added 13056 /// by CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(). 13057 /// 13058 /// \param Input The input argument. 13059 ExprResult 13060 Sema::CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc, UnaryOperatorKind Opc, 13061 const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns, 13062 Expr *Input, bool PerformADL) { 13063 OverloadedOperatorKind Op = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc); 13064 assert(Op != OO_None && "Invalid opcode for overloaded unary operator"); 13065 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op); 13066 // TODO: provide better source location info. 13067 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, OpLoc); 13068 13069 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Input)) 13070 return ExprError(); 13071 13072 Expr *Args[2] = { Input, nullptr }; 13073 unsigned NumArgs = 1; 13074 13075 // For post-increment and post-decrement, add the implicit '0' as 13076 // the second argument, so that we know this is a post-increment or 13077 // post-decrement. 13078 if (Opc == UO_PostInc || Opc == UO_PostDec) { 13079 llvm::APSInt Zero(Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy), false); 13080 Args[1] = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, Zero, Context.IntTy, 13081 SourceLocation()); 13082 NumArgs = 2; 13083 } 13084 13085 ArrayRef<Expr *> ArgsArray(Args, NumArgs); 13086 13087 if (Input->isTypeDependent()) { 13088 if (Fns.empty()) 13089 return UnaryOperator::Create(Context, Input, Opc, Context.DependentTy, 13090 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary, OpLoc, false, 13091 CurFPFeatureOverrides()); 13092 13093 CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = nullptr; // lookup ignores member operators 13094 ExprResult Fn = CreateUnresolvedLookupExpr( 13095 NamingClass, NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo, Fns); 13096 if (Fn.isInvalid()) 13097 return ExprError(); 13098 return CXXOperatorCallExpr::Create(Context, Op, Fn.get(), ArgsArray, 13099 Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue, OpLoc, 13100 CurFPFeatureOverrides()); 13101 } 13102 13103 // Build an empty overload set. 13104 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(OpLoc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator); 13105 13106 // Add the candidates from the given function set. 13107 AddNonMemberOperatorCandidates(Fns, ArgsArray, CandidateSet); 13108 13109 // Add operator candidates that are member functions. 13110 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, ArgsArray, CandidateSet); 13111 13112 // Add candidates from ADL. 13113 if (PerformADL) { 13114 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(OpName, OpLoc, ArgsArray, 13115 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs*/nullptr, 13116 CandidateSet); 13117 } 13118 13119 // Add builtin operator candidates. 13120 AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, ArgsArray, CandidateSet); 13121 13122 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1); 13123 13124 // Perform overload resolution. 13125 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 13126 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) { 13127 case OR_Success: { 13128 // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator. 13129 FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function; 13130 13131 if (FnDecl) { 13132 Expr *Base = nullptr; 13133 // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that 13134 // operator. 13135 13136 // Convert the arguments. 13137 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl)) { 13138 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Args[0], nullptr, Best->FoundDecl); 13139 13140 ExprResult InputRes = 13141 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Input, /*Qualifier=*/nullptr, 13142 Best->FoundDecl, Method); 13143 if (InputRes.isInvalid()) 13144 return ExprError(); 13145 Base = Input = InputRes.get(); 13146 } else { 13147 // Convert the arguments. 13148 ExprResult InputInit 13149 = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter( 13150 Context, 13151 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)), 13152 SourceLocation(), 13153 Input); 13154 if (InputInit.isInvalid()) 13155 return ExprError(); 13156 Input = InputInit.get(); 13157 } 13158 13159 // Build the actual expression node. 13160 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl, Best->FoundDecl, 13161 Base, HadMultipleCandidates, 13162 OpLoc); 13163 if (FnExpr.isInvalid()) 13164 return ExprError(); 13165 13166 // Determine the result type. 13167 QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getReturnType(); 13168 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy); 13169 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context); 13170 13171 Args[0] = Input; 13172 CallExpr *TheCall = CXXOperatorCallExpr::Create( 13173 Context, Op, FnExpr.get(), ArgsArray, ResultTy, VK, OpLoc, 13174 CurFPFeatureOverrides(), Best->IsADLCandidate); 13175 13176 if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getReturnType(), OpLoc, TheCall, FnDecl)) 13177 return ExprError(); 13178 13179 if (CheckFunctionCall(FnDecl, TheCall, 13180 FnDecl->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>())) 13181 return ExprError(); 13182 return CheckForImmediateInvocation(MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall), FnDecl); 13183 } else { 13184 // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then 13185 // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in 13186 // operator node. 13187 ExprResult InputRes = PerformImplicitConversion( 13188 Input, Best->BuiltinParamTypes[0], Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing, 13189 CCK_ForBuiltinOverloadedOp); 13190 if (InputRes.isInvalid()) 13191 return ExprError(); 13192 Input = InputRes.get(); 13193 break; 13194 } 13195 } 13196 13197 case OR_No_Viable_Function: 13198 // This is an erroneous use of an operator which can be overloaded by 13199 // a non-member function. Check for non-member operators which were 13200 // defined too late to be candidates. 13201 if (DiagnoseTwoPhaseOperatorLookup(*this, Op, OpLoc, ArgsArray)) 13202 // FIXME: Recover by calling the found function. 13203 return ExprError(); 13204 13205 // No viable function; fall through to handling this as a 13206 // built-in operator, which will produce an error message for us. 13207 break; 13208 13209 case OR_Ambiguous: 13210 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates( 13211 PartialDiagnosticAt(OpLoc, 13212 PDiag(diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_unary) 13213 << UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc) 13214 << Input->getType() << Input->getSourceRange()), 13215 *this, OCD_AmbiguousCandidates, ArgsArray, 13216 UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc); 13217 return ExprError(); 13218 13219 case OR_Deleted: 13220 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates( 13221 PartialDiagnosticAt(OpLoc, PDiag(diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper) 13222 << UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc) 13223 << Input->getSourceRange()), 13224 *this, OCD_AllCandidates, ArgsArray, UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), 13225 OpLoc); 13226 return ExprError(); 13227 } 13228 13229 // Either we found no viable overloaded operator or we matched a 13230 // built-in operator. In either case, fall through to trying to 13231 // build a built-in operation. 13232 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input); 13233 } 13234 13235 /// Perform lookup for an overloaded binary operator. 13236 void Sema::LookupOverloadedBinOp(OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, 13237 OverloadedOperatorKind Op, 13238 const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns, 13239 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, bool PerformADL) { 13240 SourceLocation OpLoc = CandidateSet.getLocation(); 13241 13242 OverloadedOperatorKind ExtraOp = 13243 CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().AllowRewrittenCandidates 13244 ? getRewrittenOverloadedOperator(Op) 13245 : OO_None; 13246 13247 // Add the candidates from the given function set. This also adds the 13248 // rewritten candidates using these functions if necessary. 13249 AddNonMemberOperatorCandidates(Fns, Args, CandidateSet); 13250 13251 // Add operator candidates that are member functions. 13252 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, Args, CandidateSet); 13253 if (CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().shouldAddReversed(Op)) 13254 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, {Args[1], Args[0]}, CandidateSet, 13255 OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed); 13256 13257 // In C++20, also add any rewritten member candidates. 13258 if (ExtraOp) { 13259 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(ExtraOp, OpLoc, Args, CandidateSet); 13260 if (CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().shouldAddReversed(ExtraOp)) 13261 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(ExtraOp, OpLoc, {Args[1], Args[0]}, 13262 CandidateSet, 13263 OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed); 13264 } 13265 13266 // Add candidates from ADL. Per [over.match.oper]p2, this lookup is not 13267 // performed for an assignment operator (nor for operator[] nor operator->, 13268 // which don't get here). 13269 if (Op != OO_Equal && PerformADL) { 13270 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op); 13271 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(OpName, OpLoc, Args, 13272 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs*/ nullptr, 13273 CandidateSet); 13274 if (ExtraOp) { 13275 DeclarationName ExtraOpName = 13276 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(ExtraOp); 13277 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(ExtraOpName, OpLoc, Args, 13278 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs*/ nullptr, 13279 CandidateSet); 13280 } 13281 } 13282 13283 // Add builtin operator candidates. 13284 // 13285 // FIXME: We don't add any rewritten candidates here. This is strictly 13286 // incorrect; a builtin candidate could be hidden by a non-viable candidate, 13287 // resulting in our selecting a rewritten builtin candidate. For example: 13288 // 13289 // enum class E { e }; 13290 // bool operator!=(E, E) requires false; 13291 // bool k = E::e != E::e; 13292 // 13293 // ... should select the rewritten builtin candidate 'operator==(E, E)'. But 13294 // it seems unreasonable to consider rewritten builtin candidates. A core 13295 // issue has been filed proposing to removed this requirement. 13296 AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, Args, CandidateSet); 13297 } 13298 13299 /// Create a binary operation that may resolve to an overloaded 13300 /// operator. 13301 /// 13302 /// \param OpLoc The location of the operator itself (e.g., '+'). 13303 /// 13304 /// \param Opc The BinaryOperatorKind that describes this operator. 13305 /// 13306 /// \param Fns The set of non-member functions that will be 13307 /// considered by overload resolution. The caller needs to build this 13308 /// set based on the context using, e.g., 13309 /// LookupOverloadedOperatorName() and ArgumentDependentLookup(). This 13310 /// set should not contain any member functions; those will be added 13311 /// by CreateOverloadedBinOp(). 13312 /// 13313 /// \param LHS Left-hand argument. 13314 /// \param RHS Right-hand argument. 13315 /// \param PerformADL Whether to consider operator candidates found by ADL. 13316 /// \param AllowRewrittenCandidates Whether to consider candidates found by 13317 /// C++20 operator rewrites. 13318 /// \param DefaultedFn If we are synthesizing a defaulted operator function, 13319 /// the function in question. Such a function is never a candidate in 13320 /// our overload resolution. This also enables synthesizing a three-way 13321 /// comparison from < and == as described in C++20 [class.spaceship]p1. 13322 ExprResult Sema::CreateOverloadedBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc, 13323 BinaryOperatorKind Opc, 13324 const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns, Expr *LHS, 13325 Expr *RHS, bool PerformADL, 13326 bool AllowRewrittenCandidates, 13327 FunctionDecl *DefaultedFn) { 13328 Expr *Args[2] = { LHS, RHS }; 13329 LHS=RHS=nullptr; // Please use only Args instead of LHS/RHS couple 13330 13331 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus20) 13332 AllowRewrittenCandidates = false; 13333 13334 OverloadedOperatorKind Op = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc); 13335 13336 // If either side is type-dependent, create an appropriate dependent 13337 // expression. 13338 if (Args[0]->isTypeDependent() || Args[1]->isTypeDependent()) { 13339 if (Fns.empty()) { 13340 // If there are no functions to store, just build a dependent 13341 // BinaryOperator or CompoundAssignment. 13342 if (Opc <= BO_Assign || Opc > BO_OrAssign) 13343 return BinaryOperator::Create( 13344 Context, Args[0], Args[1], Opc, Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue, 13345 OK_Ordinary, OpLoc, CurFPFeatureOverrides()); 13346 return CompoundAssignOperator::Create( 13347 Context, Args[0], Args[1], Opc, Context.DependentTy, VK_LValue, 13348 OK_Ordinary, OpLoc, CurFPFeatureOverrides(), Context.DependentTy, 13349 Context.DependentTy); 13350 } 13351 13352 // FIXME: save results of ADL from here? 13353 CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = nullptr; // lookup ignores member operators 13354 // TODO: provide better source location info in DNLoc component. 13355 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op); 13356 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, OpLoc); 13357 ExprResult Fn = CreateUnresolvedLookupExpr( 13358 NamingClass, NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo, Fns, PerformADL); 13359 if (Fn.isInvalid()) 13360 return ExprError(); 13361 return CXXOperatorCallExpr::Create(Context, Op, Fn.get(), Args, 13362 Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue, OpLoc, 13363 CurFPFeatureOverrides()); 13364 } 13365 13366 // Always do placeholder-like conversions on the RHS. 13367 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[1])) 13368 return ExprError(); 13369 13370 // Do placeholder-like conversion on the LHS; note that we should 13371 // not get here with a PseudoObject LHS. 13372 assert(Args[0]->getObjectKind() != OK_ObjCProperty); 13373 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[0])) 13374 return ExprError(); 13375 13376 // If this is the assignment operator, we only perform overload resolution 13377 // if the left-hand side is a class or enumeration type. This is actually 13378 // a hack. The standard requires that we do overload resolution between the 13379 // various built-in candidates, but as DR507 points out, this can lead to 13380 // problems. So we do it this way, which pretty much follows what GCC does. 13381 // Note that we go the traditional code path for compound assignment forms. 13382 if (Opc == BO_Assign && !Args[0]->getType()->isOverloadableType()) 13383 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]); 13384 13385 // If this is the .* operator, which is not overloadable, just 13386 // create a built-in binary operator. 13387 if (Opc == BO_PtrMemD) 13388 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]); 13389 13390 // Build the overload set. 13391 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet( 13392 OpLoc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator, 13393 OverloadCandidateSet::OperatorRewriteInfo(Op, AllowRewrittenCandidates)); 13394 if (DefaultedFn) 13395 CandidateSet.exclude(DefaultedFn); 13396 LookupOverloadedBinOp(CandidateSet, Op, Fns, Args, PerformADL); 13397 13398 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1); 13399 13400 // Perform overload resolution. 13401 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 13402 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) { 13403 case OR_Success: { 13404 // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator. 13405 FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function; 13406 13407 bool IsReversed = Best->isReversed(); 13408 if (IsReversed) 13409 std::swap(Args[0], Args[1]); 13410 13411 if (FnDecl) { 13412 Expr *Base = nullptr; 13413 // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that 13414 // operator. 13415 13416 OverloadedOperatorKind ChosenOp = 13417 FnDecl->getDeclName().getCXXOverloadedOperator(); 13418 13419 // C++2a [over.match.oper]p9: 13420 // If a rewritten operator== candidate is selected by overload 13421 // resolution for an operator@, its return type shall be cv bool 13422 if (Best->RewriteKind && ChosenOp == OO_EqualEqual && 13423 !FnDecl->getReturnType()->isBooleanType()) { 13424 bool IsExtension = 13425 FnDecl->getReturnType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType(); 13426 Diag(OpLoc, IsExtension ? diag::ext_ovl_rewrite_equalequal_not_bool 13427 : diag::err_ovl_rewrite_equalequal_not_bool) 13428 << FnDecl->getReturnType() << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc) 13429 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange(); 13430 Diag(FnDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at); 13431 if (!IsExtension) 13432 return ExprError(); 13433 } 13434 13435 if (AllowRewrittenCandidates && !IsReversed && 13436 CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().isReversible()) { 13437 // We could have reversed this operator, but didn't. Check if some 13438 // reversed form was a viable candidate, and if so, if it had a 13439 // better conversion for either parameter. If so, this call is 13440 // formally ambiguous, and allowing it is an extension. 13441 llvm::SmallVector<FunctionDecl*, 4> AmbiguousWith; 13442 for (OverloadCandidate &Cand : CandidateSet) { 13443 if (Cand.Viable && Cand.Function && Cand.isReversed() && 13444 haveSameParameterTypes(Context, Cand.Function, FnDecl, 2)) { 13445 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < 2; ++ArgIdx) { 13446 if (CompareImplicitConversionSequences( 13447 *this, OpLoc, Cand.Conversions[ArgIdx], 13448 Best->Conversions[ArgIdx]) == 13449 ImplicitConversionSequence::Better) { 13450 AmbiguousWith.push_back(Cand.Function); 13451 break; 13452 } 13453 } 13454 } 13455 } 13456 13457 if (!AmbiguousWith.empty()) { 13458 bool AmbiguousWithSelf = 13459 AmbiguousWith.size() == 1 && 13460 declaresSameEntity(AmbiguousWith.front(), FnDecl); 13461 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary_reversed) 13462 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc) 13463 << Args[0]->getType() << Args[1]->getType() << AmbiguousWithSelf 13464 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange(); 13465 if (AmbiguousWithSelf) { 13466 Diag(FnDecl->getLocation(), 13467 diag::note_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary_reversed_self); 13468 } else { 13469 Diag(FnDecl->getLocation(), 13470 diag::note_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary_selected_candidate); 13471 for (auto *F : AmbiguousWith) 13472 Diag(F->getLocation(), 13473 diag::note_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary_reversed_candidate); 13474 } 13475 } 13476 } 13477 13478 // Convert the arguments. 13479 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl)) { 13480 // Best->Access is only meaningful for class members. 13481 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Args[0], Args[1], Best->FoundDecl); 13482 13483 ExprResult Arg1 = 13484 PerformCopyInitialization( 13485 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, 13486 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)), 13487 SourceLocation(), Args[1]); 13488 if (Arg1.isInvalid()) 13489 return ExprError(); 13490 13491 ExprResult Arg0 = 13492 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Args[0], /*Qualifier=*/nullptr, 13493 Best->FoundDecl, Method); 13494 if (Arg0.isInvalid()) 13495 return ExprError(); 13496 Base = Args[0] = Arg0.getAs<Expr>(); 13497 Args[1] = RHS = Arg1.getAs<Expr>(); 13498 } else { 13499 // Convert the arguments. 13500 ExprResult Arg0 = PerformCopyInitialization( 13501 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, 13502 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)), 13503 SourceLocation(), Args[0]); 13504 if (Arg0.isInvalid()) 13505 return ExprError(); 13506 13507 ExprResult Arg1 = 13508 PerformCopyInitialization( 13509 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, 13510 FnDecl->getParamDecl(1)), 13511 SourceLocation(), Args[1]); 13512 if (Arg1.isInvalid()) 13513 return ExprError(); 13514 Args[0] = LHS = Arg0.getAs<Expr>(); 13515 Args[1] = RHS = Arg1.getAs<Expr>(); 13516 } 13517 13518 // Build the actual expression node. 13519 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl, 13520 Best->FoundDecl, Base, 13521 HadMultipleCandidates, OpLoc); 13522 if (FnExpr.isInvalid()) 13523 return ExprError(); 13524 13525 // Determine the result type. 13526 QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getReturnType(); 13527 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy); 13528 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context); 13529 13530 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall = CXXOperatorCallExpr::Create( 13531 Context, ChosenOp, FnExpr.get(), Args, ResultTy, VK, OpLoc, 13532 CurFPFeatureOverrides(), Best->IsADLCandidate); 13533 13534 if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getReturnType(), OpLoc, TheCall, 13535 FnDecl)) 13536 return ExprError(); 13537 13538 ArrayRef<const Expr *> ArgsArray(Args, 2); 13539 const Expr *ImplicitThis = nullptr; 13540 // Cut off the implicit 'this'. 13541 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl)) { 13542 ImplicitThis = ArgsArray[0]; 13543 ArgsArray = ArgsArray.slice(1); 13544 } 13545 13546 // Check for a self move. 13547 if (Op == OO_Equal) 13548 DiagnoseSelfMove(Args[0], Args[1], OpLoc); 13549 13550 checkCall(FnDecl, nullptr, ImplicitThis, ArgsArray, 13551 isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl), OpLoc, TheCall->getSourceRange(), 13552 VariadicDoesNotApply); 13553 13554 ExprResult R = MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall); 13555 if (R.isInvalid()) 13556 return ExprError(); 13557 13558 R = CheckForImmediateInvocation(R, FnDecl); 13559 if (R.isInvalid()) 13560 return ExprError(); 13561 13562 // For a rewritten candidate, we've already reversed the arguments 13563 // if needed. Perform the rest of the rewrite now. 13564 if ((Best->RewriteKind & CRK_DifferentOperator) || 13565 (Op == OO_Spaceship && IsReversed)) { 13566 if (Op == OO_ExclaimEqual) { 13567 assert(ChosenOp == OO_EqualEqual && "unexpected operator name"); 13568 R = CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, UO_LNot, R.get()); 13569 } else { 13570 assert(ChosenOp == OO_Spaceship && "unexpected operator name"); 13571 llvm::APSInt Zero(Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy), false); 13572 Expr *ZeroLiteral = 13573 IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, Zero, Context.IntTy, OpLoc); 13574 13575 Sema::CodeSynthesisContext Ctx; 13576 Ctx.Kind = Sema::CodeSynthesisContext::RewritingOperatorAsSpaceship; 13577 Ctx.Entity = FnDecl; 13578 pushCodeSynthesisContext(Ctx); 13579 13580 R = CreateOverloadedBinOp( 13581 OpLoc, Opc, Fns, IsReversed ? ZeroLiteral : R.get(), 13582 IsReversed ? R.get() : ZeroLiteral, PerformADL, 13583 /*AllowRewrittenCandidates=*/false); 13584 13585 popCodeSynthesisContext(); 13586 } 13587 if (R.isInvalid()) 13588 return ExprError(); 13589 } else { 13590 assert(ChosenOp == Op && "unexpected operator name"); 13591 } 13592 13593 // Make a note in the AST if we did any rewriting. 13594 if (Best->RewriteKind != CRK_None) 13595 R = new (Context) CXXRewrittenBinaryOperator(R.get(), IsReversed); 13596 13597 return R; 13598 } else { 13599 // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then 13600 // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in 13601 // operator node. 13602 ExprResult ArgsRes0 = PerformImplicitConversion( 13603 Args[0], Best->BuiltinParamTypes[0], Best->Conversions[0], 13604 AA_Passing, CCK_ForBuiltinOverloadedOp); 13605 if (ArgsRes0.isInvalid()) 13606 return ExprError(); 13607 Args[0] = ArgsRes0.get(); 13608 13609 ExprResult ArgsRes1 = PerformImplicitConversion( 13610 Args[1], Best->BuiltinParamTypes[1], Best->Conversions[1], 13611 AA_Passing, CCK_ForBuiltinOverloadedOp); 13612 if (ArgsRes1.isInvalid()) 13613 return ExprError(); 13614 Args[1] = ArgsRes1.get(); 13615 break; 13616 } 13617 } 13618 13619 case OR_No_Viable_Function: { 13620 // C++ [over.match.oper]p9: 13621 // If the operator is the operator , [...] and there are no 13622 // viable functions, then the operator is assumed to be the 13623 // built-in operator and interpreted according to clause 5. 13624 if (Opc == BO_Comma) 13625 break; 13626 13627 // When defaulting an 'operator<=>', we can try to synthesize a three-way 13628 // compare result using '==' and '<'. 13629 if (DefaultedFn && Opc == BO_Cmp) { 13630 ExprResult E = BuildSynthesizedThreeWayComparison(OpLoc, Fns, Args[0], 13631 Args[1], DefaultedFn); 13632 if (E.isInvalid() || E.isUsable()) 13633 return E; 13634 } 13635 13636 // For class as left operand for assignment or compound assignment 13637 // operator do not fall through to handling in built-in, but report that 13638 // no overloaded assignment operator found 13639 ExprResult Result = ExprError(); 13640 StringRef OpcStr = BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc); 13641 auto Cands = CandidateSet.CompleteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, 13642 Args, OpLoc); 13643 if (Args[0]->getType()->isRecordType() && 13644 Opc >= BO_Assign && Opc <= BO_OrAssign) { 13645 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_oper) 13646 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc) 13647 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange(); 13648 if (Args[0]->getType()->isIncompleteType()) { 13649 Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_assign_lhs_incomplete) 13650 << Args[0]->getType() 13651 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange(); 13652 } 13653 } else { 13654 // This is an erroneous use of an operator which can be overloaded by 13655 // a non-member function. Check for non-member operators which were 13656 // defined too late to be candidates. 13657 if (DiagnoseTwoPhaseOperatorLookup(*this, Op, OpLoc, Args)) 13658 // FIXME: Recover by calling the found function. 13659 return ExprError(); 13660 13661 // No viable function; try to create a built-in operation, which will 13662 // produce an error. Then, show the non-viable candidates. 13663 Result = CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]); 13664 } 13665 assert(Result.isInvalid() && 13666 "C++ binary operator overloading is missing candidates!"); 13667 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, Args, Cands, OpcStr, OpLoc); 13668 return Result; 13669 } 13670 13671 case OR_Ambiguous: 13672 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates( 13673 PartialDiagnosticAt(OpLoc, PDiag(diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary) 13674 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc) 13675 << Args[0]->getType() 13676 << Args[1]->getType() 13677 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() 13678 << Args[1]->getSourceRange()), 13679 *this, OCD_AmbiguousCandidates, Args, BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), 13680 OpLoc); 13681 return ExprError(); 13682 13683 case OR_Deleted: 13684 if (isImplicitlyDeleted(Best->Function)) { 13685 FunctionDecl *DeletedFD = Best->Function; 13686 DefaultedFunctionKind DFK = getDefaultedFunctionKind(DeletedFD); 13687 if (DFK.isSpecialMember()) { 13688 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_special_oper) 13689 << Args[0]->getType() << DFK.asSpecialMember(); 13690 } else { 13691 assert(DFK.isComparison()); 13692 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_comparison) 13693 << Args[0]->getType() << DeletedFD; 13694 } 13695 13696 // The user probably meant to call this special member. Just 13697 // explain why it's deleted. 13698 NoteDeletedFunction(DeletedFD); 13699 return ExprError(); 13700 } 13701 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates( 13702 PartialDiagnosticAt( 13703 OpLoc, PDiag(diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper) 13704 << getOperatorSpelling(Best->Function->getDeclName() 13705 .getCXXOverloadedOperator()) 13706 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() 13707 << Args[1]->getSourceRange()), 13708 *this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), 13709 OpLoc); 13710 return ExprError(); 13711 } 13712 13713 // We matched a built-in operator; build it. 13714 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]); 13715 } 13716 13717 ExprResult Sema::BuildSynthesizedThreeWayComparison( 13718 SourceLocation OpLoc, const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns, Expr *LHS, Expr *RHS, 13719 FunctionDecl *DefaultedFn) { 13720 const ComparisonCategoryInfo *Info = 13721 Context.CompCategories.lookupInfoForType(DefaultedFn->getReturnType()); 13722 // If we're not producing a known comparison category type, we can't 13723 // synthesize a three-way comparison. Let the caller diagnose this. 13724 if (!Info) 13725 return ExprResult((Expr*)nullptr); 13726 13727 // If we ever want to perform this synthesis more generally, we will need to 13728 // apply the temporary materialization conversion to the operands. 13729 assert(LHS->isGLValue() && RHS->isGLValue() && 13730 "cannot use prvalue expressions more than once"); 13731 Expr *OrigLHS = LHS; 13732 Expr *OrigRHS = RHS; 13733 13734 // Replace the LHS and RHS with OpaqueValueExprs; we're going to refer to 13735 // each of them multiple times below. 13736 LHS = new (Context) 13737 OpaqueValueExpr(LHS->getExprLoc(), LHS->getType(), LHS->getValueKind(), 13738 LHS->getObjectKind(), LHS); 13739 RHS = new (Context) 13740 OpaqueValueExpr(RHS->getExprLoc(), RHS->getType(), RHS->getValueKind(), 13741 RHS->getObjectKind(), RHS); 13742 13743 ExprResult Eq = CreateOverloadedBinOp(OpLoc, BO_EQ, Fns, LHS, RHS, true, true, 13744 DefaultedFn); 13745 if (Eq.isInvalid()) 13746 return ExprError(); 13747 13748 ExprResult Less = CreateOverloadedBinOp(OpLoc, BO_LT, Fns, LHS, RHS, true, 13749 true, DefaultedFn); 13750 if (Less.isInvalid()) 13751 return ExprError(); 13752 13753 ExprResult Greater; 13754 if (Info->isPartial()) { 13755 Greater = CreateOverloadedBinOp(OpLoc, BO_LT, Fns, RHS, LHS, true, true, 13756 DefaultedFn); 13757 if (Greater.isInvalid()) 13758 return ExprError(); 13759 } 13760 13761 // Form the list of comparisons we're going to perform. 13762 struct Comparison { 13763 ExprResult Cmp; 13764 ComparisonCategoryResult Result; 13765 } Comparisons[4] = 13766 { {Eq, Info->isStrong() ? ComparisonCategoryResult::Equal 13767 : ComparisonCategoryResult::Equivalent}, 13768 {Less, ComparisonCategoryResult::Less}, 13769 {Greater, ComparisonCategoryResult::Greater}, 13770 {ExprResult(), ComparisonCategoryResult::Unordered}, 13771 }; 13772 13773 int I = Info->isPartial() ? 3 : 2; 13774 13775 // Combine the comparisons with suitable conditional expressions. 13776 ExprResult Result; 13777 for (; I >= 0; --I) { 13778 // Build a reference to the comparison category constant. 13779 auto *VI = Info->lookupValueInfo(Comparisons[I].Result); 13780 // FIXME: Missing a constant for a comparison category. Diagnose this? 13781 if (!VI) 13782 return ExprResult((Expr*)nullptr); 13783 ExprResult ThisResult = 13784 BuildDeclarationNameExpr(CXXScopeSpec(), DeclarationNameInfo(), VI->VD); 13785 if (ThisResult.isInvalid()) 13786 return ExprError(); 13787 13788 // Build a conditional unless this is the final case. 13789 if (Result.get()) { 13790 Result = ActOnConditionalOp(OpLoc, OpLoc, Comparisons[I].Cmp.get(), 13791 ThisResult.get(), Result.get()); 13792 if (Result.isInvalid()) 13793 return ExprError(); 13794 } else { 13795 Result = ThisResult; 13796 } 13797 } 13798 13799 // Build a PseudoObjectExpr to model the rewriting of an <=> operator, and to 13800 // bind the OpaqueValueExprs before they're (repeatedly) used. 13801 Expr *SyntacticForm = BinaryOperator::Create( 13802 Context, OrigLHS, OrigRHS, BO_Cmp, Result.get()->getType(), 13803 Result.get()->getValueKind(), Result.get()->getObjectKind(), OpLoc, 13804 CurFPFeatureOverrides()); 13805 Expr *SemanticForm[] = {LHS, RHS, Result.get()}; 13806 return PseudoObjectExpr::Create(Context, SyntacticForm, SemanticForm, 2); 13807 } 13808 13809 ExprResult 13810 Sema::CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(SourceLocation LLoc, 13811 SourceLocation RLoc, 13812 Expr *Base, Expr *Idx) { 13813 Expr *Args[2] = { Base, Idx }; 13814 DeclarationName OpName = 13815 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Subscript); 13816 13817 // If either side is type-dependent, create an appropriate dependent 13818 // expression. 13819 if (Args[0]->isTypeDependent() || Args[1]->isTypeDependent()) { 13820 13821 CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = nullptr; // lookup ignores member operators 13822 // CHECKME: no 'operator' keyword? 13823 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, LLoc); 13824 OpNameInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange(LLoc, RLoc)); 13825 ExprResult Fn = CreateUnresolvedLookupExpr( 13826 NamingClass, NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo, UnresolvedSet<0>()); 13827 if (Fn.isInvalid()) 13828 return ExprError(); 13829 // Can't add any actual overloads yet 13830 13831 return CXXOperatorCallExpr::Create(Context, OO_Subscript, Fn.get(), Args, 13832 Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue, RLoc, 13833 CurFPFeatureOverrides()); 13834 } 13835 13836 // Handle placeholders on both operands. 13837 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[0])) 13838 return ExprError(); 13839 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[1])) 13840 return ExprError(); 13841 13842 // Build an empty overload set. 13843 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(LLoc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator); 13844 13845 // Subscript can only be overloaded as a member function. 13846 13847 // Add operator candidates that are member functions. 13848 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(OO_Subscript, LLoc, Args, CandidateSet); 13849 13850 // Add builtin operator candidates. 13851 AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(OO_Subscript, LLoc, Args, CandidateSet); 13852 13853 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1); 13854 13855 // Perform overload resolution. 13856 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 13857 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, LLoc, Best)) { 13858 case OR_Success: { 13859 // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator. 13860 FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function; 13861 13862 if (FnDecl) { 13863 // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that 13864 // operator. 13865 13866 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LLoc, Args[0], Args[1], Best->FoundDecl); 13867 13868 // Convert the arguments. 13869 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl); 13870 ExprResult Arg0 = 13871 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Args[0], /*Qualifier=*/nullptr, 13872 Best->FoundDecl, Method); 13873 if (Arg0.isInvalid()) 13874 return ExprError(); 13875 Args[0] = Arg0.get(); 13876 13877 // Convert the arguments. 13878 ExprResult InputInit 13879 = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter( 13880 Context, 13881 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)), 13882 SourceLocation(), 13883 Args[1]); 13884 if (InputInit.isInvalid()) 13885 return ExprError(); 13886 13887 Args[1] = InputInit.getAs<Expr>(); 13888 13889 // Build the actual expression node. 13890 DeclarationNameInfo OpLocInfo(OpName, LLoc); 13891 OpLocInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange(LLoc, RLoc)); 13892 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl, 13893 Best->FoundDecl, 13894 Base, 13895 HadMultipleCandidates, 13896 OpLocInfo.getLoc(), 13897 OpLocInfo.getInfo()); 13898 if (FnExpr.isInvalid()) 13899 return ExprError(); 13900 13901 // Determine the result type 13902 QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getReturnType(); 13903 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy); 13904 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context); 13905 13906 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall = CXXOperatorCallExpr::Create( 13907 Context, OO_Subscript, FnExpr.get(), Args, ResultTy, VK, RLoc, 13908 CurFPFeatureOverrides()); 13909 if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getReturnType(), LLoc, TheCall, FnDecl)) 13910 return ExprError(); 13911 13912 if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall, 13913 Method->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>())) 13914 return ExprError(); 13915 13916 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall); 13917 } else { 13918 // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then 13919 // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in 13920 // operator node. 13921 ExprResult ArgsRes0 = PerformImplicitConversion( 13922 Args[0], Best->BuiltinParamTypes[0], Best->Conversions[0], 13923 AA_Passing, CCK_ForBuiltinOverloadedOp); 13924 if (ArgsRes0.isInvalid()) 13925 return ExprError(); 13926 Args[0] = ArgsRes0.get(); 13927 13928 ExprResult ArgsRes1 = PerformImplicitConversion( 13929 Args[1], Best->BuiltinParamTypes[1], Best->Conversions[1], 13930 AA_Passing, CCK_ForBuiltinOverloadedOp); 13931 if (ArgsRes1.isInvalid()) 13932 return ExprError(); 13933 Args[1] = ArgsRes1.get(); 13934 13935 break; 13936 } 13937 } 13938 13939 case OR_No_Viable_Function: { 13940 PartialDiagnostic PD = CandidateSet.empty() 13941 ? (PDiag(diag::err_ovl_no_oper) 13942 << Args[0]->getType() << /*subscript*/ 0 13943 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange()) 13944 : (PDiag(diag::err_ovl_no_viable_subscript) 13945 << Args[0]->getType() << Args[0]->getSourceRange() 13946 << Args[1]->getSourceRange()); 13947 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(PartialDiagnosticAt(LLoc, PD), *this, 13948 OCD_AllCandidates, Args, "[]", LLoc); 13949 return ExprError(); 13950 } 13951 13952 case OR_Ambiguous: 13953 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates( 13954 PartialDiagnosticAt(LLoc, PDiag(diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary) 13955 << "[]" << Args[0]->getType() 13956 << Args[1]->getType() 13957 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() 13958 << Args[1]->getSourceRange()), 13959 *this, OCD_AmbiguousCandidates, Args, "[]", LLoc); 13960 return ExprError(); 13961 13962 case OR_Deleted: 13963 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates( 13964 PartialDiagnosticAt(LLoc, PDiag(diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper) 13965 << "[]" << Args[0]->getSourceRange() 13966 << Args[1]->getSourceRange()), 13967 *this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, "[]", LLoc); 13968 return ExprError(); 13969 } 13970 13971 // We matched a built-in operator; build it. 13972 return CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Args[0], LLoc, Args[1], RLoc); 13973 } 13974 13975 /// BuildCallToMemberFunction - Build a call to a member 13976 /// function. MemExpr is the expression that refers to the member 13977 /// function (and includes the object parameter), Args/NumArgs are the 13978 /// arguments to the function call (not including the object 13979 /// parameter). The caller needs to validate that the member 13980 /// expression refers to a non-static member function or an overloaded 13981 /// member function. 13982 ExprResult 13983 Sema::BuildCallToMemberFunction(Scope *S, Expr *MemExprE, 13984 SourceLocation LParenLoc, 13985 MultiExprArg Args, 13986 SourceLocation RParenLoc) { 13987 assert(MemExprE->getType() == Context.BoundMemberTy || 13988 MemExprE->getType() == Context.OverloadTy); 13989 13990 // Dig out the member expression. This holds both the object 13991 // argument and the member function we're referring to. 13992 Expr *NakedMemExpr = MemExprE->IgnoreParens(); 13993 13994 // Determine whether this is a call to a pointer-to-member function. 13995 if (BinaryOperator *op = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NakedMemExpr)) { 13996 assert(op->getType() == Context.BoundMemberTy); 13997 assert(op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemD || op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemI); 13998 13999 QualType fnType = 14000 op->getRHS()->getType()->castAs<MemberPointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 14001 14002 const FunctionProtoType *proto = fnType->castAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 14003 QualType resultType = proto->getCallResultType(Context); 14004 ExprValueKind valueKind = Expr::getValueKindForType(proto->getReturnType()); 14005 14006 // Check that the object type isn't more qualified than the 14007 // member function we're calling. 14008 Qualifiers funcQuals = proto->getMethodQuals(); 14009 14010 QualType objectType = op->getLHS()->getType(); 14011 if (op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemI) 14012 objectType = objectType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 14013 Qualifiers objectQuals = objectType.getQualifiers(); 14014 14015 Qualifiers difference = objectQuals - funcQuals; 14016 difference.removeObjCGCAttr(); 14017 difference.removeAddressSpace(); 14018 if (difference) { 14019 std::string qualsString = difference.getAsString(); 14020 Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_pointer_to_member_call_drops_quals) 14021 << fnType.getUnqualifiedType() 14022 << qualsString 14023 << (qualsString.find(' ') == std::string::npos ? 1 : 2); 14024 } 14025 14026 CXXMemberCallExpr *call = CXXMemberCallExpr::Create( 14027 Context, MemExprE, Args, resultType, valueKind, RParenLoc, 14028 CurFPFeatureOverrides(), proto->getNumParams()); 14029 14030 if (CheckCallReturnType(proto->getReturnType(), op->getRHS()->getBeginLoc(), 14031 call, nullptr)) 14032 return ExprError(); 14033 14034 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(call, op, nullptr, proto, Args, RParenLoc)) 14035 return ExprError(); 14036 14037 if (CheckOtherCall(call, proto)) 14038 return ExprError(); 14039 14040 return MaybeBindToTemporary(call); 14041 } 14042 14043 if (isa<CXXPseudoDestructorExpr>(NakedMemExpr)) 14044 return CallExpr::Create(Context, MemExprE, Args, Context.VoidTy, VK_RValue, 14045 RParenLoc, CurFPFeatureOverrides()); 14046 14047 UnbridgedCastsSet UnbridgedCasts; 14048 if (checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(*this, Args, UnbridgedCasts)) 14049 return ExprError(); 14050 14051 MemberExpr *MemExpr; 14052 CXXMethodDecl *Method = nullptr; 14053 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(nullptr, AS_public); 14054 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = nullptr; 14055 if (isa<MemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr)) { 14056 MemExpr = cast<MemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr); 14057 Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MemExpr->getMemberDecl()); 14058 FoundDecl = MemExpr->getFoundDecl(); 14059 Qualifier = MemExpr->getQualifier(); 14060 UnbridgedCasts.restore(); 14061 } else { 14062 UnresolvedMemberExpr *UnresExpr = cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr); 14063 Qualifier = UnresExpr->getQualifier(); 14064 14065 QualType ObjectType = UnresExpr->getBaseType(); 14066 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification 14067 = UnresExpr->isArrow()? Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue() 14068 : UnresExpr->getBase()->Classify(Context); 14069 14070 // Add overload candidates 14071 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), 14072 OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal); 14073 14074 // FIXME: avoid copy. 14075 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = nullptr; 14076 if (UnresExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) { 14077 UnresExpr->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer); 14078 TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer; 14079 } 14080 14081 for (UnresolvedMemberExpr::decls_iterator I = UnresExpr->decls_begin(), 14082 E = UnresExpr->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) { 14083 14084 NamedDecl *Func = *I; 14085 CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Func->getDeclContext()); 14086 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Func)) 14087 Func = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Func)->getTargetDecl(); 14088 14089 14090 // Microsoft supports direct constructor calls. 14091 if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt && isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Func)) { 14092 AddOverloadCandidate(cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Func), I.getPair(), Args, 14093 CandidateSet, 14094 /*SuppressUserConversions*/ false); 14095 } else if ((Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Func))) { 14096 // If explicit template arguments were provided, we can't call a 14097 // non-template member function. 14098 if (TemplateArgs) 14099 continue; 14100 14101 AddMethodCandidate(Method, I.getPair(), ActingDC, ObjectType, 14102 ObjectClassification, Args, CandidateSet, 14103 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false); 14104 } else { 14105 AddMethodTemplateCandidate( 14106 cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Func), I.getPair(), ActingDC, 14107 TemplateArgs, ObjectType, ObjectClassification, Args, CandidateSet, 14108 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false); 14109 } 14110 } 14111 14112 DeclarationName DeclName = UnresExpr->getMemberName(); 14113 14114 UnbridgedCasts.restore(); 14115 14116 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 14117 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, UnresExpr->getBeginLoc(), 14118 Best)) { 14119 case OR_Success: 14120 Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function); 14121 FoundDecl = Best->FoundDecl; 14122 CheckUnresolvedMemberAccess(UnresExpr, Best->FoundDecl); 14123 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, UnresExpr->getNameLoc())) 14124 return ExprError(); 14125 // If FoundDecl is different from Method (such as if one is a template 14126 // and the other a specialization), make sure DiagnoseUseOfDecl is 14127 // called on both. 14128 // FIXME: This would be more comprehensively addressed by modifying 14129 // DiagnoseUseOfDecl to accept both the FoundDecl and the decl 14130 // being used. 14131 if (Method != FoundDecl.getDecl() && 14132 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Method, UnresExpr->getNameLoc())) 14133 return ExprError(); 14134 break; 14135 14136 case OR_No_Viable_Function: 14137 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates( 14138 PartialDiagnosticAt( 14139 UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), 14140 PDiag(diag::err_ovl_no_viable_member_function_in_call) 14141 << DeclName << MemExprE->getSourceRange()), 14142 *this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args); 14143 // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions! 14144 return ExprError(); 14145 14146 case OR_Ambiguous: 14147 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates( 14148 PartialDiagnosticAt(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), 14149 PDiag(diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_member_call) 14150 << DeclName << MemExprE->getSourceRange()), 14151 *this, OCD_AmbiguousCandidates, Args); 14152 // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions! 14153 return ExprError(); 14154 14155 case OR_Deleted: 14156 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates( 14157 PartialDiagnosticAt(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), 14158 PDiag(diag::err_ovl_deleted_member_call) 14159 << DeclName << MemExprE->getSourceRange()), 14160 *this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args); 14161 // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions! 14162 return ExprError(); 14163 } 14164 14165 MemExprE = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(MemExprE, FoundDecl, Method); 14166 14167 // If overload resolution picked a static member, build a 14168 // non-member call based on that function. 14169 if (Method->isStatic()) { 14170 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(MemExprE, Method, LParenLoc, Args, 14171 RParenLoc); 14172 } 14173 14174 MemExpr = cast<MemberExpr>(MemExprE->IgnoreParens()); 14175 } 14176 14177 QualType ResultType = Method->getReturnType(); 14178 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultType); 14179 ResultType = ResultType.getNonLValueExprType(Context); 14180 14181 assert(Method && "Member call to something that isn't a method?"); 14182 const auto *Proto = Method->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 14183 CXXMemberCallExpr *TheCall = CXXMemberCallExpr::Create( 14184 Context, MemExprE, Args, ResultType, VK, RParenLoc, 14185 CurFPFeatureOverrides(), Proto->getNumParams()); 14186 14187 // Check for a valid return type. 14188 if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getReturnType(), MemExpr->getMemberLoc(), 14189 TheCall, Method)) 14190 return ExprError(); 14191 14192 // Convert the object argument (for a non-static member function call). 14193 // We only need to do this if there was actually an overload; otherwise 14194 // it was done at lookup. 14195 if (!Method->isStatic()) { 14196 ExprResult ObjectArg = 14197 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(MemExpr->getBase(), Qualifier, 14198 FoundDecl, Method); 14199 if (ObjectArg.isInvalid()) 14200 return ExprError(); 14201 MemExpr->setBase(ObjectArg.get()); 14202 } 14203 14204 // Convert the rest of the arguments 14205 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, MemExpr, Method, Proto, Args, 14206 RParenLoc)) 14207 return ExprError(); 14208 14209 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(Method, LParenLoc, Args); 14210 14211 if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall, Proto)) 14212 return ExprError(); 14213 14214 // In the case the method to call was not selected by the overloading 14215 // resolution process, we still need to handle the enable_if attribute. Do 14216 // that here, so it will not hide previous -- and more relevant -- errors. 14217 if (auto *MemE = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr)) { 14218 if (const EnableIfAttr *Attr = 14219 CheckEnableIf(Method, LParenLoc, Args, true)) { 14220 Diag(MemE->getMemberLoc(), 14221 diag::err_ovl_no_viable_member_function_in_call) 14222 << Method << Method->getSourceRange(); 14223 Diag(Method->getLocation(), 14224 diag::note_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_function_cond_attr) 14225 << Attr->getCond()->getSourceRange() << Attr->getMessage(); 14226 return ExprError(); 14227 } 14228 } 14229 14230 if ((isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(CurContext) || 14231 isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(CurContext)) && 14232 TheCall->getMethodDecl()->isPure()) { 14233 const CXXMethodDecl *MD = TheCall->getMethodDecl(); 14234 14235 if (isa<CXXThisExpr>(MemExpr->getBase()->IgnoreParenCasts()) && 14236 MemExpr->performsVirtualDispatch(getLangOpts())) { 14237 Diag(MemExpr->getBeginLoc(), 14238 diag::warn_call_to_pure_virtual_member_function_from_ctor_dtor) 14239 << MD->getDeclName() << isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(CurContext) 14240 << MD->getParent(); 14241 14242 Diag(MD->getBeginLoc(), diag::note_previous_decl) << MD->getDeclName(); 14243 if (getLangOpts().AppleKext) 14244 Diag(MemExpr->getBeginLoc(), diag::note_pure_qualified_call_kext) 14245 << MD->getParent() << MD->getDeclName(); 14246 } 14247 } 14248 14249 if (CXXDestructorDecl *DD = 14250 dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(TheCall->getMethodDecl())) { 14251 // a->A::f() doesn't go through the vtable, except in AppleKext mode. 14252 bool CallCanBeVirtual = !MemExpr->hasQualifier() || getLangOpts().AppleKext; 14253 CheckVirtualDtorCall(DD, MemExpr->getBeginLoc(), /*IsDelete=*/false, 14254 CallCanBeVirtual, /*WarnOnNonAbstractTypes=*/true, 14255 MemExpr->getMemberLoc()); 14256 } 14257 14258 return CheckForImmediateInvocation(MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall), 14259 TheCall->getMethodDecl()); 14260 } 14261 14262 /// BuildCallToObjectOfClassType - Build a call to an object of class 14263 /// type (C++ [over.call.object]), which can end up invoking an 14264 /// overloaded function call operator (@c operator()) or performing a 14265 /// user-defined conversion on the object argument. 14266 ExprResult 14267 Sema::BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(Scope *S, Expr *Obj, 14268 SourceLocation LParenLoc, 14269 MultiExprArg Args, 14270 SourceLocation RParenLoc) { 14271 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Obj)) 14272 return ExprError(); 14273 ExprResult Object = Obj; 14274 14275 UnbridgedCastsSet UnbridgedCasts; 14276 if (checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(*this, Args, UnbridgedCasts)) 14277 return ExprError(); 14278 14279 assert(Object.get()->getType()->isRecordType() && 14280 "Requires object type argument"); 14281 14282 // C++ [over.call.object]p1: 14283 // If the primary-expression E in the function call syntax 14284 // evaluates to a class object of type "cv T", then the set of 14285 // candidate functions includes at least the function call 14286 // operators of T. The function call operators of T are obtained by 14287 // ordinary lookup of the name operator() in the context of 14288 // (E).operator(). 14289 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(LParenLoc, 14290 OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator); 14291 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Call); 14292 14293 if (RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, Object.get()->getType(), 14294 diag::err_incomplete_object_call, Object.get())) 14295 return true; 14296 14297 const auto *Record = Object.get()->getType()->castAs<RecordType>(); 14298 LookupResult R(*this, OpName, LParenLoc, LookupOrdinaryName); 14299 LookupQualifiedName(R, Record->getDecl()); 14300 R.suppressDiagnostics(); 14301 14302 for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = R.begin(), OperEnd = R.end(); 14303 Oper != OperEnd; ++Oper) { 14304 AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Object.get()->getType(), 14305 Object.get()->Classify(Context), Args, CandidateSet, 14306 /*SuppressUserConversion=*/false); 14307 } 14308 14309 // C++ [over.call.object]p2: 14310 // In addition, for each (non-explicit in C++0x) conversion function 14311 // declared in T of the form 14312 // 14313 // operator conversion-type-id () cv-qualifier; 14314 // 14315 // where cv-qualifier is the same cv-qualification as, or a 14316 // greater cv-qualification than, cv, and where conversion-type-id 14317 // denotes the type "pointer to function of (P1,...,Pn) returning 14318 // R", or the type "reference to pointer to function of 14319 // (P1,...,Pn) returning R", or the type "reference to function 14320 // of (P1,...,Pn) returning R", a surrogate call function [...] 14321 // is also considered as a candidate function. Similarly, 14322 // surrogate call functions are added to the set of candidate 14323 // functions for each conversion function declared in an 14324 // accessible base class provided the function is not hidden 14325 // within T by another intervening declaration. 14326 const auto &Conversions = 14327 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record->getDecl())->getVisibleConversionFunctions(); 14328 for (auto I = Conversions.begin(), E = Conversions.end(); I != E; ++I) { 14329 NamedDecl *D = *I; 14330 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext()); 14331 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D)) 14332 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl(); 14333 14334 // Skip over templated conversion functions; they aren't 14335 // surrogates. 14336 if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D)) 14337 continue; 14338 14339 CXXConversionDecl *Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D); 14340 if (!Conv->isExplicit()) { 14341 // Strip the reference type (if any) and then the pointer type (if 14342 // any) to get down to what might be a function type. 14343 QualType ConvType = Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType(); 14344 if (const PointerType *ConvPtrType = ConvType->getAs<PointerType>()) 14345 ConvType = ConvPtrType->getPointeeType(); 14346 14347 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = ConvType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) 14348 { 14349 AddSurrogateCandidate(Conv, I.getPair(), ActingContext, Proto, 14350 Object.get(), Args, CandidateSet); 14351 } 14352 } 14353 } 14354 14355 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1); 14356 14357 // Perform overload resolution. 14358 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 14359 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, Object.get()->getBeginLoc(), 14360 Best)) { 14361 case OR_Success: 14362 // Overload resolution succeeded; we'll build the appropriate call 14363 // below. 14364 break; 14365 14366 case OR_No_Viable_Function: { 14367 PartialDiagnostic PD = 14368 CandidateSet.empty() 14369 ? (PDiag(diag::err_ovl_no_oper) 14370 << Object.get()->getType() << /*call*/ 1 14371 << Object.get()->getSourceRange()) 14372 : (PDiag(diag::err_ovl_no_viable_object_call) 14373 << Object.get()->getType() << Object.get()->getSourceRange()); 14374 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates( 14375 PartialDiagnosticAt(Object.get()->getBeginLoc(), PD), *this, 14376 OCD_AllCandidates, Args); 14377 break; 14378 } 14379 case OR_Ambiguous: 14380 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates( 14381 PartialDiagnosticAt(Object.get()->getBeginLoc(), 14382 PDiag(diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_object_call) 14383 << Object.get()->getType() 14384 << Object.get()->getSourceRange()), 14385 *this, OCD_AmbiguousCandidates, Args); 14386 break; 14387 14388 case OR_Deleted: 14389 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates( 14390 PartialDiagnosticAt(Object.get()->getBeginLoc(), 14391 PDiag(diag::err_ovl_deleted_object_call) 14392 << Object.get()->getType() 14393 << Object.get()->getSourceRange()), 14394 *this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args); 14395 break; 14396 } 14397 14398 if (Best == CandidateSet.end()) 14399 return true; 14400 14401 UnbridgedCasts.restore(); 14402 14403 if (Best->Function == nullptr) { 14404 // Since there is no function declaration, this is one of the 14405 // surrogate candidates. Dig out the conversion function. 14406 CXXConversionDecl *Conv 14407 = cast<CXXConversionDecl>( 14408 Best->Conversions[0].UserDefined.ConversionFunction); 14409 14410 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LParenLoc, Object.get(), nullptr, 14411 Best->FoundDecl); 14412 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, LParenLoc)) 14413 return ExprError(); 14414 assert(Conv == Best->FoundDecl.getDecl() && 14415 "Found Decl & conversion-to-functionptr should be same, right?!"); 14416 // We selected one of the surrogate functions that converts the 14417 // object parameter to a function pointer. Perform the conversion 14418 // on the object argument, then let BuildCallExpr finish the job. 14419 14420 // Create an implicit member expr to refer to the conversion operator. 14421 // and then call it. 14422 ExprResult Call = BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(Object.get(), Best->FoundDecl, 14423 Conv, HadMultipleCandidates); 14424 if (Call.isInvalid()) 14425 return ExprError(); 14426 // Record usage of conversion in an implicit cast. 14427 Call = ImplicitCastExpr::Create( 14428 Context, Call.get()->getType(), CK_UserDefinedConversion, Call.get(), 14429 nullptr, VK_RValue, CurFPFeatureOverrides()); 14430 14431 return BuildCallExpr(S, Call.get(), LParenLoc, Args, RParenLoc); 14432 } 14433 14434 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LParenLoc, Object.get(), nullptr, Best->FoundDecl); 14435 14436 // We found an overloaded operator(). Build a CXXOperatorCallExpr 14437 // that calls this method, using Object for the implicit object 14438 // parameter and passing along the remaining arguments. 14439 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function); 14440 14441 // An error diagnostic has already been printed when parsing the declaration. 14442 if (Method->isInvalidDecl()) 14443 return ExprError(); 14444 14445 const auto *Proto = Method->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 14446 unsigned NumParams = Proto->getNumParams(); 14447 14448 DeclarationNameInfo OpLocInfo( 14449 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Call), LParenLoc); 14450 OpLocInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc)); 14451 ExprResult NewFn = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, Method, Best->FoundDecl, 14452 Obj, HadMultipleCandidates, 14453 OpLocInfo.getLoc(), 14454 OpLocInfo.getInfo()); 14455 if (NewFn.isInvalid()) 14456 return true; 14457 14458 // The number of argument slots to allocate in the call. If we have default 14459 // arguments we need to allocate space for them as well. We additionally 14460 // need one more slot for the object parameter. 14461 unsigned NumArgsSlots = 1 + std::max<unsigned>(Args.size(), NumParams); 14462 14463 // Build the full argument list for the method call (the implicit object 14464 // parameter is placed at the beginning of the list). 14465 SmallVector<Expr *, 8> MethodArgs(NumArgsSlots); 14466 14467 bool IsError = false; 14468 14469 // Initialize the implicit object parameter. 14470 ExprResult ObjRes = 14471 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Object.get(), /*Qualifier=*/nullptr, 14472 Best->FoundDecl, Method); 14473 if (ObjRes.isInvalid()) 14474 IsError = true; 14475 else 14476 Object = ObjRes; 14477 MethodArgs[0] = Object.get(); 14478 14479 // Check the argument types. 14480 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumParams; i++) { 14481 Expr *Arg; 14482 if (i < Args.size()) { 14483 Arg = Args[i]; 14484 14485 // Pass the argument. 14486 14487 ExprResult InputInit 14488 = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter( 14489 Context, 14490 Method->getParamDecl(i)), 14491 SourceLocation(), Arg); 14492 14493 IsError |= InputInit.isInvalid(); 14494 Arg = InputInit.getAs<Expr>(); 14495 } else { 14496 ExprResult DefArg 14497 = BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(LParenLoc, Method, Method->getParamDecl(i)); 14498 if (DefArg.isInvalid()) { 14499 IsError = true; 14500 break; 14501 } 14502 14503 Arg = DefArg.getAs<Expr>(); 14504 } 14505 14506 MethodArgs[i + 1] = Arg; 14507 } 14508 14509 // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...". 14510 if (Proto->isVariadic()) { 14511 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p7). 14512 for (unsigned i = NumParams, e = Args.size(); i < e; i++) { 14513 ExprResult Arg = DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Args[i], VariadicMethod, 14514 nullptr); 14515 IsError |= Arg.isInvalid(); 14516 MethodArgs[i + 1] = Arg.get(); 14517 } 14518 } 14519 14520 if (IsError) 14521 return true; 14522 14523 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(Method, LParenLoc, Args); 14524 14525 // Once we've built TheCall, all of the expressions are properly owned. 14526 QualType ResultTy = Method->getReturnType(); 14527 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy); 14528 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context); 14529 14530 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall = CXXOperatorCallExpr::Create( 14531 Context, OO_Call, NewFn.get(), MethodArgs, ResultTy, VK, RParenLoc, 14532 CurFPFeatureOverrides()); 14533 14534 if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getReturnType(), LParenLoc, TheCall, Method)) 14535 return true; 14536 14537 if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall, Proto)) 14538 return true; 14539 14540 return CheckForImmediateInvocation(MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall), Method); 14541 } 14542 14543 /// BuildOverloadedArrowExpr - Build a call to an overloaded @c operator-> 14544 /// (if one exists), where @c Base is an expression of class type and 14545 /// @c Member is the name of the member we're trying to find. 14546 ExprResult 14547 Sema::BuildOverloadedArrowExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Base, SourceLocation OpLoc, 14548 bool *NoArrowOperatorFound) { 14549 assert(Base->getType()->isRecordType() && 14550 "left-hand side must have class type"); 14551 14552 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Base)) 14553 return ExprError(); 14554 14555 SourceLocation Loc = Base->getExprLoc(); 14556 14557 // C++ [over.ref]p1: 14558 // 14559 // [...] An expression x->m is interpreted as (x.operator->())->m 14560 // for a class object x of type T if T::operator->() exists and if 14561 // the operator is selected as the best match function by the 14562 // overload resolution mechanism (13.3). 14563 DeclarationName OpName = 14564 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Arrow); 14565 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Loc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator); 14566 14567 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, Base->getType(), 14568 diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag, Base)) 14569 return ExprError(); 14570 14571 LookupResult R(*this, OpName, OpLoc, LookupOrdinaryName); 14572 LookupQualifiedName(R, Base->getType()->castAs<RecordType>()->getDecl()); 14573 R.suppressDiagnostics(); 14574 14575 for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = R.begin(), OperEnd = R.end(); 14576 Oper != OperEnd; ++Oper) { 14577 AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Base->getType(), Base->Classify(Context), 14578 None, CandidateSet, /*SuppressUserConversion=*/false); 14579 } 14580 14581 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1); 14582 14583 // Perform overload resolution. 14584 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 14585 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) { 14586 case OR_Success: 14587 // Overload resolution succeeded; we'll build the call below. 14588 break; 14589 14590 case OR_No_Viable_Function: { 14591 auto Cands = CandidateSet.CompleteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Base); 14592 if (CandidateSet.empty()) { 14593 QualType BaseType = Base->getType(); 14594 if (NoArrowOperatorFound) { 14595 // Report this specific error to the caller instead of emitting a 14596 // diagnostic, as requested. 14597 *NoArrowOperatorFound = true; 14598 return ExprError(); 14599 } 14600 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_arrow) 14601 << BaseType << Base->getSourceRange(); 14602 if (BaseType->isRecordType() && !BaseType->isPointerType()) { 14603 Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion) 14604 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, "."); 14605 } 14606 } else 14607 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_oper) 14608 << "operator->" << Base->getSourceRange(); 14609 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, Base, Cands); 14610 return ExprError(); 14611 } 14612 case OR_Ambiguous: 14613 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates( 14614 PartialDiagnosticAt(OpLoc, PDiag(diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_unary) 14615 << "->" << Base->getType() 14616 << Base->getSourceRange()), 14617 *this, OCD_AmbiguousCandidates, Base); 14618 return ExprError(); 14619 14620 case OR_Deleted: 14621 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates( 14622 PartialDiagnosticAt(OpLoc, PDiag(diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper) 14623 << "->" << Base->getSourceRange()), 14624 *this, OCD_AllCandidates, Base); 14625 return ExprError(); 14626 } 14627 14628 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Base, nullptr, Best->FoundDecl); 14629 14630 // Convert the object parameter. 14631 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function); 14632 ExprResult BaseResult = 14633 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Base, /*Qualifier=*/nullptr, 14634 Best->FoundDecl, Method); 14635 if (BaseResult.isInvalid()) 14636 return ExprError(); 14637 Base = BaseResult.get(); 14638 14639 // Build the operator call. 14640 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, Method, Best->FoundDecl, 14641 Base, HadMultipleCandidates, OpLoc); 14642 if (FnExpr.isInvalid()) 14643 return ExprError(); 14644 14645 QualType ResultTy = Method->getReturnType(); 14646 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy); 14647 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context); 14648 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall = 14649 CXXOperatorCallExpr::Create(Context, OO_Arrow, FnExpr.get(), Base, 14650 ResultTy, VK, OpLoc, CurFPFeatureOverrides()); 14651 14652 if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getReturnType(), OpLoc, TheCall, Method)) 14653 return ExprError(); 14654 14655 if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall, 14656 Method->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>())) 14657 return ExprError(); 14658 14659 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall); 14660 } 14661 14662 /// BuildLiteralOperatorCall - Build a UserDefinedLiteral by creating a call to 14663 /// a literal operator described by the provided lookup results. 14664 ExprResult Sema::BuildLiteralOperatorCall(LookupResult &R, 14665 DeclarationNameInfo &SuffixInfo, 14666 ArrayRef<Expr*> Args, 14667 SourceLocation LitEndLoc, 14668 TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) { 14669 SourceLocation UDSuffixLoc = SuffixInfo.getCXXLiteralOperatorNameLoc(); 14670 14671 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(UDSuffixLoc, 14672 OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal); 14673 AddNonMemberOperatorCandidates(R.asUnresolvedSet(), Args, CandidateSet, 14674 TemplateArgs); 14675 14676 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1); 14677 14678 // Perform overload resolution. This will usually be trivial, but might need 14679 // to perform substitutions for a literal operator template. 14680 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 14681 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, UDSuffixLoc, Best)) { 14682 case OR_Success: 14683 case OR_Deleted: 14684 break; 14685 14686 case OR_No_Viable_Function: 14687 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates( 14688 PartialDiagnosticAt(UDSuffixLoc, 14689 PDiag(diag::err_ovl_no_viable_function_in_call) 14690 << R.getLookupName()), 14691 *this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args); 14692 return ExprError(); 14693 14694 case OR_Ambiguous: 14695 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates( 14696 PartialDiagnosticAt(R.getNameLoc(), PDiag(diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_call) 14697 << R.getLookupName()), 14698 *this, OCD_AmbiguousCandidates, Args); 14699 return ExprError(); 14700 } 14701 14702 FunctionDecl *FD = Best->Function; 14703 ExprResult Fn = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FD, Best->FoundDecl, 14704 nullptr, HadMultipleCandidates, 14705 SuffixInfo.getLoc(), 14706 SuffixInfo.getInfo()); 14707 if (Fn.isInvalid()) 14708 return true; 14709 14710 // Check the argument types. This should almost always be a no-op, except 14711 // that array-to-pointer decay is applied to string literals. 14712 Expr *ConvArgs[2]; 14713 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) { 14714 ExprResult InputInit = PerformCopyInitialization( 14715 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, FD->getParamDecl(ArgIdx)), 14716 SourceLocation(), Args[ArgIdx]); 14717 if (InputInit.isInvalid()) 14718 return true; 14719 ConvArgs[ArgIdx] = InputInit.get(); 14720 } 14721 14722 QualType ResultTy = FD->getReturnType(); 14723 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy); 14724 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context); 14725 14726 UserDefinedLiteral *UDL = UserDefinedLiteral::Create( 14727 Context, Fn.get(), llvm::makeArrayRef(ConvArgs, Args.size()), ResultTy, 14728 VK, LitEndLoc, UDSuffixLoc, CurFPFeatureOverrides()); 14729 14730 if (CheckCallReturnType(FD->getReturnType(), UDSuffixLoc, UDL, FD)) 14731 return ExprError(); 14732 14733 if (CheckFunctionCall(FD, UDL, nullptr)) 14734 return ExprError(); 14735 14736 return CheckForImmediateInvocation(MaybeBindToTemporary(UDL), FD); 14737 } 14738 14739 /// Build a call to 'begin' or 'end' for a C++11 for-range statement. If the 14740 /// given LookupResult is non-empty, it is assumed to describe a member which 14741 /// will be invoked. Otherwise, the function will be found via argument 14742 /// dependent lookup. 14743 /// CallExpr is set to a valid expression and FRS_Success returned on success, 14744 /// otherwise CallExpr is set to ExprError() and some non-success value 14745 /// is returned. 14746 Sema::ForRangeStatus 14747 Sema::BuildForRangeBeginEndCall(SourceLocation Loc, 14748 SourceLocation RangeLoc, 14749 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo, 14750 LookupResult &MemberLookup, 14751 OverloadCandidateSet *CandidateSet, 14752 Expr *Range, ExprResult *CallExpr) { 14753 Scope *S = nullptr; 14754 14755 CandidateSet->clear(OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal); 14756 if (!MemberLookup.empty()) { 14757 ExprResult MemberRef = 14758 BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Range, Range->getType(), Loc, 14759 /*IsPtr=*/false, CXXScopeSpec(), 14760 /*TemplateKWLoc=*/SourceLocation(), 14761 /*FirstQualifierInScope=*/nullptr, 14762 MemberLookup, 14763 /*TemplateArgs=*/nullptr, S); 14764 if (MemberRef.isInvalid()) { 14765 *CallExpr = ExprError(); 14766 return FRS_DiagnosticIssued; 14767 } 14768 *CallExpr = BuildCallExpr(S, MemberRef.get(), Loc, None, Loc, nullptr); 14769 if (CallExpr->isInvalid()) { 14770 *CallExpr = ExprError(); 14771 return FRS_DiagnosticIssued; 14772 } 14773 } else { 14774 ExprResult FnR = CreateUnresolvedLookupExpr(/*NamingClass=*/nullptr, 14775 NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), 14776 NameInfo, UnresolvedSet<0>()); 14777 if (FnR.isInvalid()) 14778 return FRS_DiagnosticIssued; 14779 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(FnR.get()); 14780 14781 bool CandidateSetError = buildOverloadedCallSet(S, Fn, Fn, Range, Loc, 14782 CandidateSet, CallExpr); 14783 if (CandidateSet->empty() || CandidateSetError) { 14784 *CallExpr = ExprError(); 14785 return FRS_NoViableFunction; 14786 } 14787 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 14788 OverloadingResult OverloadResult = 14789 CandidateSet->BestViableFunction(*this, Fn->getBeginLoc(), Best); 14790 14791 if (OverloadResult == OR_No_Viable_Function) { 14792 *CallExpr = ExprError(); 14793 return FRS_NoViableFunction; 14794 } 14795 *CallExpr = FinishOverloadedCallExpr(*this, S, Fn, Fn, Loc, Range, 14796 Loc, nullptr, CandidateSet, &Best, 14797 OverloadResult, 14798 /*AllowTypoCorrection=*/false); 14799 if (CallExpr->isInvalid() || OverloadResult != OR_Success) { 14800 *CallExpr = ExprError(); 14801 return FRS_DiagnosticIssued; 14802 } 14803 } 14804 return FRS_Success; 14805 } 14806 14807 14808 /// FixOverloadedFunctionReference - E is an expression that refers to 14809 /// a C++ overloaded function (possibly with some parentheses and 14810 /// perhaps a '&' around it). We have resolved the overloaded function 14811 /// to the function declaration Fn, so patch up the expression E to 14812 /// refer (possibly indirectly) to Fn. Returns the new expr. 14813 Expr *Sema::FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Expr *E, DeclAccessPair Found, 14814 FunctionDecl *Fn) { 14815 if (ParenExpr *PE = dyn_cast<ParenExpr>(E)) { 14816 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(PE->getSubExpr(), 14817 Found, Fn); 14818 if (SubExpr == PE->getSubExpr()) 14819 return PE; 14820 14821 return new (Context) ParenExpr(PE->getLParen(), PE->getRParen(), SubExpr); 14822 } 14823 14824 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)) { 14825 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(ICE->getSubExpr(), 14826 Found, Fn); 14827 assert(Context.hasSameType(ICE->getSubExpr()->getType(), 14828 SubExpr->getType()) && 14829 "Implicit cast type cannot be determined from overload"); 14830 assert(ICE->path_empty() && "fixing up hierarchy conversion?"); 14831 if (SubExpr == ICE->getSubExpr()) 14832 return ICE; 14833 14834 return ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, ICE->getType(), ICE->getCastKind(), 14835 SubExpr, nullptr, ICE->getValueKind(), 14836 CurFPFeatureOverrides()); 14837 } 14838 14839 if (auto *GSE = dyn_cast<GenericSelectionExpr>(E)) { 14840 if (!GSE->isResultDependent()) { 14841 Expr *SubExpr = 14842 FixOverloadedFunctionReference(GSE->getResultExpr(), Found, Fn); 14843 if (SubExpr == GSE->getResultExpr()) 14844 return GSE; 14845 14846 // Replace the resulting type information before rebuilding the generic 14847 // selection expression. 14848 ArrayRef<Expr *> A = GSE->getAssocExprs(); 14849 SmallVector<Expr *, 4> AssocExprs(A.begin(), A.end()); 14850 unsigned ResultIdx = GSE->getResultIndex(); 14851 AssocExprs[ResultIdx] = SubExpr; 14852 14853 return GenericSelectionExpr::Create( 14854 Context, GSE->getGenericLoc(), GSE->getControllingExpr(), 14855 GSE->getAssocTypeSourceInfos(), AssocExprs, GSE->getDefaultLoc(), 14856 GSE->getRParenLoc(), GSE->containsUnexpandedParameterPack(), 14857 ResultIdx); 14858 } 14859 // Rather than fall through to the unreachable, return the original generic 14860 // selection expression. 14861 return GSE; 14862 } 14863 14864 if (UnaryOperator *UnOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(E)) { 14865 assert(UnOp->getOpcode() == UO_AddrOf && 14866 "Can only take the address of an overloaded function"); 14867 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) { 14868 if (Method->isStatic()) { 14869 // Do nothing: static member functions aren't any different 14870 // from non-member functions. 14871 } else { 14872 // Fix the subexpression, which really has to be an 14873 // UnresolvedLookupExpr holding an overloaded member function 14874 // or template. 14875 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(UnOp->getSubExpr(), 14876 Found, Fn); 14877 if (SubExpr == UnOp->getSubExpr()) 14878 return UnOp; 14879 14880 assert(isa<DeclRefExpr>(SubExpr) 14881 && "fixed to something other than a decl ref"); 14882 assert(cast<DeclRefExpr>(SubExpr)->getQualifier() 14883 && "fixed to a member ref with no nested name qualifier"); 14884 14885 // We have taken the address of a pointer to member 14886 // function. Perform the computation here so that we get the 14887 // appropriate pointer to member type. 14888 QualType ClassType 14889 = Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Method->getDeclContext())); 14890 QualType MemPtrType 14891 = Context.getMemberPointerType(Fn->getType(), ClassType.getTypePtr()); 14892 // Under the MS ABI, lock down the inheritance model now. 14893 if (Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft()) 14894 (void)isCompleteType(UnOp->getOperatorLoc(), MemPtrType); 14895 14896 return UnaryOperator::Create( 14897 Context, SubExpr, UO_AddrOf, MemPtrType, VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary, 14898 UnOp->getOperatorLoc(), false, CurFPFeatureOverrides()); 14899 } 14900 } 14901 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(UnOp->getSubExpr(), 14902 Found, Fn); 14903 if (SubExpr == UnOp->getSubExpr()) 14904 return UnOp; 14905 14906 return UnaryOperator::Create(Context, SubExpr, UO_AddrOf, 14907 Context.getPointerType(SubExpr->getType()), 14908 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary, UnOp->getOperatorLoc(), 14909 false, CurFPFeatureOverrides()); 14910 } 14911 14912 if (UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(E)) { 14913 // FIXME: avoid copy. 14914 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = nullptr; 14915 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) { 14916 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer); 14917 TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer; 14918 } 14919 14920 DeclRefExpr *DRE = 14921 BuildDeclRefExpr(Fn, Fn->getType(), VK_LValue, ULE->getNameInfo(), 14922 ULE->getQualifierLoc(), Found.getDecl(), 14923 ULE->getTemplateKeywordLoc(), TemplateArgs); 14924 DRE->setHadMultipleCandidates(ULE->getNumDecls() > 1); 14925 return DRE; 14926 } 14927 14928 if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemExpr = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(E)) { 14929 // FIXME: avoid copy. 14930 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = nullptr; 14931 if (MemExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) { 14932 MemExpr->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer); 14933 TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer; 14934 } 14935 14936 Expr *Base; 14937 14938 // If we're filling in a static method where we used to have an 14939 // implicit member access, rewrite to a simple decl ref. 14940 if (MemExpr->isImplicitAccess()) { 14941 if (cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)->isStatic()) { 14942 DeclRefExpr *DRE = BuildDeclRefExpr( 14943 Fn, Fn->getType(), VK_LValue, MemExpr->getNameInfo(), 14944 MemExpr->getQualifierLoc(), Found.getDecl(), 14945 MemExpr->getTemplateKeywordLoc(), TemplateArgs); 14946 DRE->setHadMultipleCandidates(MemExpr->getNumDecls() > 1); 14947 return DRE; 14948 } else { 14949 SourceLocation Loc = MemExpr->getMemberLoc(); 14950 if (MemExpr->getQualifier()) 14951 Loc = MemExpr->getQualifierLoc().getBeginLoc(); 14952 Base = 14953 BuildCXXThisExpr(Loc, MemExpr->getBaseType(), /*IsImplicit=*/true); 14954 } 14955 } else 14956 Base = MemExpr->getBase(); 14957 14958 ExprValueKind valueKind; 14959 QualType type; 14960 if (cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)->isStatic()) { 14961 valueKind = VK_LValue; 14962 type = Fn->getType(); 14963 } else { 14964 valueKind = VK_RValue; 14965 type = Context.BoundMemberTy; 14966 } 14967 14968 return BuildMemberExpr( 14969 Base, MemExpr->isArrow(), MemExpr->getOperatorLoc(), 14970 MemExpr->getQualifierLoc(), MemExpr->getTemplateKeywordLoc(), Fn, Found, 14971 /*HadMultipleCandidates=*/true, MemExpr->getMemberNameInfo(), 14972 type, valueKind, OK_Ordinary, TemplateArgs); 14973 } 14974 14975 llvm_unreachable("Invalid reference to overloaded function"); 14976 } 14977 14978 ExprResult Sema::FixOverloadedFunctionReference(ExprResult E, 14979 DeclAccessPair Found, 14980 FunctionDecl *Fn) { 14981 return FixOverloadedFunctionReference(E.get(), Found, Fn); 14982 } 14983